Quarterlytics / Industrials / Conglomerates / Compass Diversified

Compass Diversified

codi · NYSE Industrials
Claim this profile
Ticker codi
Exchange NYSE
Sector Industrials
Industry Conglomerates
Employees 3340
← All annual reports
FY2016 Annual Report · Compass Diversified
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
10 
2006
2016
YEARS
CODI

COMPASS DIVERSIFIED HOLDINGS

301 RIVERSIDE AVENUE • SECOND FLOOR • WESTPORT, CT 06880

WWW.COMPASSDIVERSIFIEDHOLDINGS.COM

2 
LETTER TO 
SHAREHOLDERS

4
OUR COMPANIES

14
CODI 
GOVERNANCE

16
CODI INFORMATION

17
FINANCIAL REVIEW

10 
2006
2016
YEARS
CODI

COMPANY HEADQUARTERS

301 RIVERSIDE AVENUE, SECOND FLOOR   

WESTPORT, CT 06880, (203) 221-1703

INDEPENDENT AUDITORS

GRANT THORNTON LLP, NEW YORK, NY

COMMON STOCK LISTING

NYSE TICKER: CODI

BROADRIDGE CORPORATE ISSUER SOLUTIONS

TRANSFER AGENT

P.O. BOX 1342

BRENTWOOD, NY 11717

INVESTOR RELATIONS CONTACT

LEON BERMAN, THE IGB GROUP   

(212) 477-8438, LBERMAN@IGBIR.COM 

ANNUAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS

MAY 24, 2017, 9:00 A.M., EST   

301 RIVERSIDE AVENUE, SECOND FLOOR   

WESTPORT, CT 06880

WEBSITE

WWW.COMPASSDIVERSIFIEDHOLDINGS.COM

10 
2006
2016
YEARS
CODI

Compass Diversified Holdings (“CODI”) offers shareowners an opportunity to own profitable middle market 

businesses with leading market positions in the branded products and niche industrial industries. 

We own controlling interests in ALL of our subsidiaries, enabling us to take a focused and proactive 

approach to managing them in order to create value for our shareowners.  We are exceedingly 

disciplined with respect to due diligence, valuation, terms and niche market leadership when 

identifying potential new subsidiaries.

Our shareowners deserve – AND we deliver – an extraordinarily high level of transparency 

in our financial reporting and governance processes.

As of December 31, 2016, CODI’s branded products group consisted of four subsidiaries and 

our niche industrial products group consisted of four subsidiaries.  We believe that these 

businesses will continue to produce stable and growing cash flows, allowing us to invest in their 

long-term growth and to make cash distributions to our shareowners.

2016 HIGHLIGHTS

Acquired 5.11 Tactical for $408 million in August

Sold FOXF shares generating $182.5 million in proceeds

Completed 4 add-on acquisitions

 
 
LETTER TO SHAREHOLDERS

Dear Fellow Shareowners,

Compass Diversified Holdings is pleased 
to report that in 2016 we continued to 
effectively execute upon our enduring 
strategy of allocating capital in a disciplined, 
patient manner, growing and investing in 
the cash flows of our subsidiary companies, 
opportunistically divesting subsidiaries from 
time to time and making cash distributions 
to our shareowners.  We celebrated our 
ten year anniversary as a public company, 
and are very pleased that our strategy and 
business model have proven to be effective 
in creating value for our shareowners over a 
long period of time. 

Our subsidiaries had another solid year in 
2016.  Pro forma consolidated revenue 
and EBITDA increased 12.4% and 6.3%, 
respectively, versus 2015, due primarily 
to the contributions of our acquisition of 
a new subsidiary company, 5.11 Tactical, 
into our Branded Products group as well 

2

 
as the add-on acquisitions completed by Sterno Products, ErgoBaby and Clean Earth.  Our Niche Industrials group posted 
combined revenue and EBITDA increases of 15.1% and 2.5%, respectively, versus the prior year.  Notably, Sterno Products 
saw its revenue increase 56% and its EBITDA rise 34% versus the prior year, fueled by its acquisition of Northern International, 
an industry leader in flameless candles and outdoor lighting products for the retail segment.  Our Branded Products group 
grew revenue and EBITDA by 9.6% and 10.9%, respectively, versus the prior year.  The results of the Branded Products group 
reflects strong growth from our ErgoBaby, Manitoba Harvest and 5.11 Tactical subsidiaries, which each reported year-over-year 
double digit EBITDA growth.  We believe that both groups are very well positioned to continue to generate positive results in 
line with our expectations going forward. 

Similar to 2015 and prior years, acquisitions within the middle market remained very competitive and expensive in 2016. Prices 
for assets continued to be high as the availability of both debt and equity capital to support these transactions was plentiful, and 
the demand for high quality assets exceeded the supply of compelling opportunities.  As a result, it continued to be challenging 
to acquire new subsidiary companies at values that we believed yielded appropriate risk-adjusted returns for our shareowners.  
Despite the challenging market, in August we successfully acquired 5.11 Tactical, a leading designer and marketer of purpose-
built tactical apparel and gear serving a wide range of global customers including law enforcement, military special operations, 
firefighters and outdoor enthusiasts.  In addition, our subsidiaries completed several add-on acquisitions, with Sterno Products 
acquiring Northern International in January, ErgoBaby acquiring Baby Tula, a designer and marketer of premium baby carriers, 
toddler carriers, slings, blankets and wraps, in May, and Clean Earth acquiring Phoenix Soil, a provider of environmental services 
for non-hazardous contaminated materials, in April, as well as EWS Alabama, a provider of hazardous and non-hazardous 
waste management services, in June.  The addition of 5.11 Tactical, at a sensible valuation, was a major accomplishment in 
2016, as we believe it possesses the specific qualities that we seek in all of our subsidiaries – a niche market leader with an 
exceptional management team, serving an industry with a favorable macroeconomic outlook, and having a demonstrated 
history of and potential for stable and growing revenue and cash flow.  In addition, the accretive add-on acquisitions, which 
were also completed at favorable valuations, further enhances the growth prospects for each of the respective subsidiaries.

Our strategy of opportunistically divesting subsidiaries in order to create value for our shareowners remains an important part of 
our efforts.  In 2016 our former wholly-owned subsidiary, Fox Factory Holding Corp., which we took public in 2013, completed 
three secondary offerings in which we participated, generating $182.5 million in proceeds.  In addition, we consummated 
the sale of our Tridien Medical subsidiary, enabling us to divest one of our smallest subsidiaries and redeploy that capital into 
opportunities that we believe will provide greater potential for long-term value creation for our shareowners.

Our balance sheet strength and strong liquidity position complements our growth in revenue and EBITDA in 2016 and positions 
us very well for continued success.  We again accessed the equity capital markets, completing a 5.6 million share offering in 
December that generated $99.7 million of net proceeds.  We utilized that capital to reduce our outstanding debt, allowing us 
to maintain the conservative approach to leverage that we have consistently employed and to which our shareholders have 
become accustomed to.  As we head into 2017, our leverage is low, we have access to significant capital to deploy to fuel our 
growth and support our ability to make cash distributions to shareowners, and we have no significant debt maturities until 2019.  

CODI shares outperformed all of the major indices in 2016 on a total return basis, and has done so over the 10 years that we 
have been a public company.  We continue to provide consistent distributions to our shareowners, delivering $1.44 per share in 
2016, bringing our cumulative distributions paid to $14.64 per share since our 2006 initial public offering.  We are confident that 
our business model and strategy of investing in and growing the cash flows of our subsidiaries, allocating capital with discipline 
and patience, and opportunistically divesting our subsidiaries will drive future value creation for our shareowners. 

We believe that we enter 2017 with an outstanding, diversified group of subsidiary companies that are very well positioned for 
solid performance, including growth in revenues and EBITDA on a consolidated basis.  We are steadfast in our commitment to 
our strategy, and believe that we, along with our team of exceptional colleagues, have the ability to execute our strategy and 
build on our ten year track record of success.  

We cannot overstate how privileged we are to work with an astonishingly talented and committed group of employees, 
subsidiary company management teams and their workforces, as well as our board of directors.  Their contributions are 
invaluable to our ability to create value for our shareowners and we are incredibly grateful for their unmatched dedication to 
building our company.  We are also exceedingly thankful for the support and trust of our shareowners.  It is our privilege to work 
on your behalf. 

Very Truly Yours,

Alan B. Offenberg 
Chief Executive Officer 

Ryan J. Faulkingham 
Chief Financial Officer 
Compass Group Management

Elias J. Sabo
Founding Partner

3

 
 
OUR COMPANIES

Advanced Circuits/John Yacoub, CEO

Liberty Safe/Kim Waddoups, CEO

Arnold Magnetic Technologies/Dan Miller, CEO

Manitoba Harvest/Bill Chiasson, CEO

Clean Earth/Chris Dods, CEO

Sterno Products/Don Hinshaw, CEO

Ergobaby/Margaret Hardin, CEO

5.11 Tactical/Tom Davin, CEO

2006
2016

4

222222000000066666
2222200000116
YYYYYEEEEEAAAAAAARRRRRRRRRSSSS

Headquartered in Los Angeles, 
California, and founded in 2003, 
Ergobaby is a premier designer, 
marketer and distributor of 
wearable baby carriers, blankets 
and swaddlers, nursing pillows, 
and related baby wearing 
products, under the Ergobaby 
and Tula brand names. Ergobaby 
products are sold in the United 
States and throughout the 
world. Ergobaby’s reputation 
for product innovation, reliability 
and safety has led to numerous 
awards and accolades. 

TO LEARN MORE ABOUT ERGOBABY, 
PLEASE VISIT: 
WWW.ERGOBABY.COM

5

2222000000000006666
2200111666
YYEEEAARRRSSS

Headquartered in Irvine, CA, 
Headquartered in Winnipeg, 
and founded in 2003. 5.11 is a 
Manitoba, and founded in 1998, 
leading provider of purpose-built 
Manitoba Harvest is a pioneer 
tactical apparel and gear for 
and global leader in branded, 
law enforcement, firefighters, 
hemp-based foods. The 
EMS, and military special 
company is the world’s largest 
operations as well as outdoor 
vertically-integrated hemp food 
and adventure enthusiasts. 5.11 
manufacturer and is strategically 
is a brand known for innovation 
located near its supply base in 
and authenticity, and works 
Canada. Manitoba Harvest’s 
directly with end users to 
100% all-natural product lineup 
create purpose-built apparel 
includes hemp hearts, hemp 
and gear designed to enhance 
protein powder and hemp 
the safety, accuracy, speed 
snacks and are currently carried 
and performance of tactical 
in about 7,000 retail locations 
professionals and enthusiasts 
across the U.S. and Canada.
worldwide.

6
4

TO LEARN MORE ABOUT 5.11, 
TO LEARN MORE ABOUT MANITOBA HARVEST, 
PLEASE VISIT: 
PLEASE VISIT: 
WWW.511TACTICAL.COM
WWW.MANITOBAHARVEST.COM

2220000000666
22222000116
YYYYYEEEEEAAAAAAAAAARRRRRRRRRSSS

Headquartered in Winnipeg, 
Headquartered in Winnipeg, 
Manitoba, and founded in 1998, 
Manitoba, and founded in 1998, 
Manitoba Harvest is a pioneer 
Manitoba Harvest is a pioneer 
and global leader in branded, 
and global leader in branded, 
hemp-based foods. The 
hemp-based foods. The 
company is the world’s largest 
company is the world’s largest 
vertically-integrated hemp food 
vertically-integrated hemp food 
manufacturer and is strategically 
manufacturer and is strategically 
located near its supply base in 
located near its supply base in 
Canada. Manitoba Harvest’s 
Canada. Manitoba Harvest’s 
100% all-natural product lineup 
100% all-natural product lineup 
includes hemp hearts, hemp 
includes hemp hearts, hemp 
protein powder and hemp 
protein powder and hemp 
snacks and are currently carried 
snacks and are currently carried 
in about 7,000 retail locations 
in about 7,000 retail locations 
across the U.S. and Canada.
across the U.S. and Canada.

7
5

TO LEARN MORE ABOUT MANITOBA HARVEST, 
TO LEARN MORE ABOUT MANITOBA HARVEST, 
PLEASE VISIT: 
PLEASE VISIT: 
WWW.MANITOBAHARVEST.COM
WWW.MANITOBAHARVEST.COM

2222000000666
2220001166
YYEEEAARRSSSSS

Headquartered in Payson, 
Utah, and founded in 1988, 
Liberty Safe is a designer and 
manufacturer of premium home 
and gun safes and accessories.  
Products are marketed under 
the Liberty® brand, as well 
as a portfolio of licensed and 
private label brands, including 
Cabela’s® and John Deere®. 
Liberty Safe’s products are the 
market share leader and are 
sold in various sporting goods, 
and farm and fleet retailers.  
Liberty also has the largest 
independent dealer network in 
the industry.  

8

TO LEARN MORE ABOUT LIBERTY SAFE, 
PLEASE VISIT: 
WWW.LIBERTYSAFE.COM

222222000000066666
2222200000116
YYYYYEEEEEAAAAAAAARRRRRRRRRSSSS

Headquartered in Hatboro, 
Pennsylvania, and founded in 
1990, Clean Earth is a provider 
of environmental services 
for a variety of contaminated 
materials including soils, dredged 
material and hazardous waste. 
Clean Earth analyzes, treats, 
documents and recycles 
waste streams generated in 
end-markets such as power, 
construction, oil & gas, 
infrastructure, industrial and 
dredging. Clean Earth operates 
18 permitted facilities in the 
eastern U.S. 

9

TO LEARN MORE ABOUT CLEAN EARTH, PLEASE VISIT: 
WWW.CLEANEARTHINC.COM

2222000000666
2220001166
YYEEEAARRSSSSS

Headquartered in Corona, CA, 
Sterno Products is a manufacturer 
and marketer of portable food 
warming fuel and creative 
table lighting solutions for the 
foodservice industry, as well as 
flameless candles and outdoor 
lighting products for consumers. 
Sterno Products line includes 
wick and gel chafing fuels, 
butane stoves and accessories, 
liquid and traditional wax candles, 
flameless candles, outdoor 
lighting products, catering 
equipment and lamps. For over 
100 years, the iconic “Sterno” 
brand has been synonymous 
with quality canned heat.

10

TO LEARN MORE ABOUT STERNO PRODUCTS, 
PLEASE VISIT: 
WWW.STERNOPRODUCTS.COM

222222000000066666
2222200000116
YYYYYEEEEEAAAAAAARRRRRRRRRSSSS

Headquartered in Rochester, N.Y., 
Arnold Magnetic Technologies  
is a global manufacturer of high 
performance magnets, precision 
magnetic assemblies and thin 
metals.  High performance 
materials from Arnold support 
motor systems that are smaller, 
lighter and more efficient while 
operating in high speed, high heat 
environments. Arnold ‘s advanced 
materials and magnetic 
assemblies serve a wide range 
of industries including aerospace 
& defense, automotive & 
motorsports, consumer & 
industrial, oil & gas, medical, 
and more. 

11

TO LEARN MORE ABOUT ARNOLD, 
PLEASE VISIT: 
WWW.ARNOLDMAGNETICS.COM

2222000000666
2220001166
YYEEEAARRSSSSS

Headquartered in Aurora, 
Colorado, and founded in 
1989, Advanced Circuits is the 
preeminent North American 
manufacturer of quick-turn, 
small-run and production rigid 
printed circuit boards (“PCBs”). 
Customers include research 
and development professionals 
from corporations and academic 
institutions in the United States 
and Canada. Advanced Circuits 
is able to meet its over 10,000 
customers’ demands for 
responsiveness, quality and 
timely delivery by shipping high 
quality, custom PCBs in as little 
as 24 hours.  

12

TO LEARN MORE ABOUT ADVANCED CIRCUITS, 
PLEASE VISIT: 
WWW.4PCB.COM

MINORITY EQUITY INVESTMENT IN FOX

SOLD REMAINING SHARES IN MARCH 2017. 
ACQUIRED IN 2008 FOR $80 MILLION. 
TOTAL PROCEEDS RECEIVED >$520 MILLION 

FOX/Larry Enterline, CEO

TO LEARN MORE ABOUT FOX, 
PLEASE VISIT: 
WWW.RIDEFOX.COM

FOX (NASDAQ: FOXF), 
headquartered in Scotts Valley, 
California, designs, engineers, 
manufactures and markets 
high-performance suspension 
products for customers world-
wide. FOX’s premium brand 
suspension products are used 
primarily on mountain bikes, 
side-by-side vehicles, on-road 
vehicles with off-road capabilities, 
off-road vehicles and trucks, all-
terrain vehicles, snowmobiles, 
specialty vehicles and applications, 
and motorcycles. Some of 
FOX’s products are specifically 
designed and marketed to some 
of the leading original equipment 
manufacturers, while others are 
distributed directly to consumers 
through a global network of 
dealers and distributors.  

13

CODI GOVERNANCE

Board of Directors

C. Sean Day has served as chairman of the Board since April 

Calavo Growers, Inc., and Inventure Foods Inc., all NASDAQ listed 

2006. Mr. Day has been the president of Seagin International, since 

companies. Mr. Edwards is a graduate of Lewis and Clark College 

1999, and he was the chairman of our Manager’s predecessor 

and The Thunderbird School of Global Management at Arizona 

from 1999 to 2006. Previously, Mr. Day was with Navios 

State University.

Corporation and Citicorp Venture Capital. Mr. Day is currently 

the chairman of the boards of directors of Teekay Corporation; 

D. Eugene Ewing has served as a director of the Company since 

Teekay Offshore GP LLC, the general partner of Teekay Offshore 

April 2006. Mr. Ewing has been the managing member of Deeper 

Partners LP, and a member of the boards of directors of Teekay GP 

Water Consulting, LLC, a private wealth and business consulting 

L.L.C., the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners LP, and Kirby 

company since March 2004. Previously, Mr. Ewing was with the 

Corporation, all NYSE listed companies. Mr. Day is a graduate of 

Fifth Third Bank. Prior to that, Mr. Ewing was a partner in Arthur 

the University of Capetown and Oxford University.

Andersen LLP. Mr. Ewing is a member of the board of directors of 

Darling Ingredients, Inc., a NYSE listed company.  Mr. Ewing also 

James J. Bottiglieri has served as a director of the Company 

serves on an advisory board to the Gatton College of Business & 

since December 2005. Mr. Bottiglieri was the Company’s 

Economics at the University of Kentucky. Mr. Ewing is a graduate of 

chief financial officer and an executive vice president of the 

the University of Kentucky. 

Company’s Manager from 2005 to 2013. Previously, Mr. 

Bottiglieri was the senior vice president and controller of WebMD 

Sarah G. McCoy has served as a director of the Company since 

Corporation. Prior to that, Mr. Bottiglieri was with Star Gas 

January 2017.  Previously, Ms. McCoy was the president and chief 

Corporation and a predecessor firm to KPMG LLP. Mr. Bottiglieri 

executive officer of CamelBak Products, LLC, a former subsidiary 

serves on the board of directors of Horizon Technology Finance 

of the Company, from November 2006 through January of 

Corporation, a NASDAQ listed company. Mr. Bottiglieri is a 

2016.   Prior to that, Ms. McCoy was a co-founder of Silver Steep 

graduate of Pace University.

Partners, a leading investment banking firm catering exclusively 

to companies in the outdoor and active lifestyle industries. Before 

Gordon M. Burns has served as a director of the Company 

Silver Steep, Ms. McCoy served as president of Sierra Designs and 

since May 2008. Mr. Burns has been a private investor since 1998. 

Ultimate Direction and as vice president at The North Face.  Ms. 

Previously, he was responsible for investment banking at UBS 

McCoy has served as a director and as lead independent director 

Securities and before that was a managing director at Salomon 

for Zumiez, a NASDAQ listed company, since 2010.  Ms. McCoy 

Brothers Inc. Mr. Burns served on the board of directors of Aztar 

also serves on the board of directors of The Outdoor Foundation 

Corporation, a NYSE listed company, from 1998 through 2007.  

a not-for-profit foundation established by Outdoor Industry 

Mr. Burns is a graduate of Yale University and the Harvard 

Association to inspire and grow future generations of outdoor 

Business School.

enthusiasts.  Ms. McCoy is a graduate of Dartmouth College.

Harold S. Edwards has served as a director of the Company 

Alan B. Offenberg has served as a director and chief executive 

since April 2006. Mr. Edwards has been the president and 

officer of the Company since February 2011. Mr. Offenberg has also 

chief executive officer of Limoneira Company, a NASDAQ listed 

been a partner of our Manager and its predecessor since 1998. 

company, since November 2003. Previously, Mr. Edwards was 

Previously, Mr. Offenberg was with Trigen Energy, Creditanstalt- 

the president of Puritan Medical Products, a division of Airgas Inc. 

Bankverein and GE Capital. Mr. Offenberg currently serves as a 

Prior to that, Mr. Edwards held management positions with Fisher 

director for all of our subsidiary companies other than 5.11, Inc., and 

Scientific International, Inc., Cargill, 

Inc., Agribrands International and 

the Ralston Purina Company. 

Mr. Edwards is currently 

a member of the 

boards of directors of 

Limoneira Company, 

14

Fresh Hemp Foods Ltd. Mr. Offenberg 
F

serves as the chairman of Clean 
s

Earth, Inc. Mr. Offenberg is a 

graduate of Tulane University 

and the Northeastern University 

Graduate School of Business.

The Audit Committee is comprised entirely of independent directors who meet the 

independence requirements of the New York Stock Exchange and includes at least one “audit 

committee financial expert,” as required by applicable SEC regulations. The audit committee is 

responsible for, among other things:

•   retaining and overseeing our independent accountants;

•   assisting the Company’s board of directors in its oversight of the integrity of our 

financial statements, the qualifications, independence and performance of our 

COMMITTEES

The Company’s operating 

agreement gives our 

board the authority 

to delegate its powers to 

independent auditors and our compliance with legal and regulatory requirements;

committees appointed 

•   reviewing and approving the plan and scope of the internal and external audit;

•   pre-approving any non-audit services provided by our independent auditors;

•   approving the fees to be paid to our independent auditors;

by the board. All of our 

standing committees 

•   reviewing with our chief executive officer and chief financial officer and independent auditors  

are comprised solely of 

the adequacy and effectiveness of our internal controls;

•   preparing the audit committee report to be filed with the SEC; reviewing hedging transactions; 

•   reviewing and assessing annually the audit committee’s performance and the 

adequacy of its charter, and

• 

reviewing and approving the calculation of all profit allocation payments made to the   

  Company’s Allocation Member.

Messrs. Burns, Ewing, and Edwards serve on our audit committee, and the board has determined 

that Mr. Ewing qualifies as an audit committee financial expert as defined by the SEC.  Mr. Ewing is 

the chairman of our audit committee.

independent directors. 

We have three standing 

committees - the 

audit committee, the 

compensation committee 

and the nominating and 

corporate governance 

The Compensation Committee is comprised entirely of independent directors who meet 

committee.

the independence requirements of the New York Stock Exchange. The responsibilities of the 

compensation committee include: 

•   reviewing our manager’s performance of its obligations under the management 

services agreement; 

•   reviewing the remuneration of our manager and approving the reimbursement paid to our  

  manager for the compensation of its financial staff;

•   determining the compensation of our independent directors;

•   granting rights to indemnification and reimbursement of expenses to our manager; and

•   making recommendations to the Board regarding equity-based and incentive 

compensation plans, policies and programs.

Messrs. Edwards, Ewing and Burns serve on our compensation committee.  Mr. Edwards is the 

chairman of our compensation committee. 

The Nominating & Corporate Governance Committee is comprised entirely of independent 

directors who meet the independence requirements of the New York Stock Exchange. The 

nominating and corporate governance committee is responsible for, among other things:

•   recommending the number of directors to comprise the board of directors; 

•  

identifying and evaluating individuals qualified to become members of the board of directors  

and soliciting recommendations for director nominees, including from the chairman and chief  

executive officer of the company; 

•   recommending to the board of directors the directors’ nominees for each annual  

shareholders’ meeting;

•   recommending to the board of directors the candidates for filling vacancies that may occur  

between annual shareholders’ meetings;

•   reviewing independent director compensation and board processes, self-evaluations and polices;

•   overseeing compliance with our code of ethics, anti-corruption policy, and conduct by our  

officers and directors; and 

•  monitoring developments in the law and practice of corporate governance.

Messrs. Burns, Ewing and Edwards serve on our nominating and corporate governance 

committee.  Mr. Burns is the chairman of our nominating and corporate governance committee. 

15

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CODI INFORMATION

Distributions Paid Since IPO

$14.64

$13.20

$11.76

$10.32

$8.88

$7.44

$6.00

$4.64

$3.28

$1.95

$1.25

$.70

$.70

$1.33

$1.36

$1.36

$1.44

$1.44

$1.44

$1.44

$1.44

$1.44

2006

2007

2008

2009

Distributions Paid Per Year

2010

2011

2012
Cumulative Distributions Paid

2013

2014

2015

2016

)

e
r
a
h
s

r
e
p

(

i

d
a
P
s
n
o
i
t
u
b
i
r
t
s
D

i

Trading

Our stock trades on the NYSE under the symbol “CODI”.  During fiscal year 2016, the highest and lowest trading 

prices per share were $19.50 and $13.65, respectively.  As of December 31, 2016, we had 59,900,000 shares 

outstanding that were held by approximately {23,000} beneficial holders.

Distributions

Our board of directors declared distributions of $1.44 per share for the year ended December 31, 2016.  The 

declaration and payment of any distribution is subject to a decision by our board of directors. In making such 

a decision, our board will take into account such matters as general business conditions, our specific financial 

condition, results of operations and capital requirements, as well as any other factors that it deems relevant.

Tax Reporting

CODI shareholders receive their tax information on a Form K-1.  We endeavor to provide this tax information as 

early as possible, and made information for tax year 2016 available for our shareholders as of February 24, 2017.  

Tax information is both mailed to shareholders and is available on our website.  We expect the items of income 

reported on Form K-1 to our shareholders to remain fairly limited, and to include interest income, dividend income, 

capital gains, interest expense and other expense.

Website

CODI’s website is www.compassdiversifiedholdings.com.  On our website, shareholders can find our press 

releases, documents filed with the SEC, investor events, and tax reporting, as well as information on our corporate 

governance policies and procedures, subsidiary companies, and board of directors.

16

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
FINANCIAL INFORMATION

17

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Form 10-K

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2016 

or

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from

to

Commission File Number: 001-34927

Compass Diversified Holdings
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

57-6218917
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

Commission File Number: 001-34926

Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware

20-3812051

(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

Sixty One Wilton Road
Second Floor
Westport, CT
(Address of principal executive offices)

06880
(Zip Code)

(203) 221-1703
(Registrants’ telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of Each Class
Shares representing beneficial interests in Compass
Diversified Holdings (“Common shares”)

Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered
New York Stock Exchange

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12 (g) of the Act: None

Indicate by check mark if the registrants are collectively a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  

    No  

Indicate by check mark if the registrants are collectively not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes  

    No  

Indicate by check mark whether the registrants (1) have filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 
during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrants were required to file such reports), and (2) have been subject to such filing 
requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  

    No  

Indicate by check mark whether the registrants have submitted electronically and posted on their corporate website, if any, every Interactive Data File required 
to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that 
the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  

    No  

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best 
of registrants’ knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 
10-K.

Indicate by check mark whether the registrants are collectively a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or a smaller reporting 
company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer”, “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

Large accelerated filer

Non-accelerated filer

Accelerated filer

Smaller reporting company

Indicate by check mark whether the registrants are collectively a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  

    No  

The aggregate market value of the outstanding common shares of trust stock held by non-affiliates of Compass Diversified Holdings at June 30, 2016 
was $747,581,483 based on the closing price on the New York Stock Exchange on that date. For purposes of the foregoing calculation only, all directors and 
officers of the registrant have been deemed affiliates. There were 59,900,000 common shares of trust stock without par value outstanding at February 24, 2017.

Certain information in the registrant’s definitive proxy statement to be filed with the Commission relating to the registrant’s 2016 Annual Meeting of 

Stockholders is incorporated by reference into Part III.

Documents Incorporated by Reference

Table of Contents

Business

Risk Factors

Unresolved Staff Comments
Properties

Legal Proceedings

Mine Safety Disclosures

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of 
Equity Securities

Selected Financial Data

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

Controls and Procedures

Other Information

Directors, and Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
Executive Compensation

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions and Director Independence
Principal Accountant Fees and Services

Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

Page

5

54

67
67

70

70

71

74

76
117

119
120

121

121

122
122

122

122
122

F-1

PART I

Item 1.
Item 1A.

Item 1B.

Item 2.
Item 3.

Item 4.

PART II

Item 5.

Item 6.

Item 7.

Item 7A.
Item 8.

Item 9.
Item 9A.

Item 9B.

PART III

Item 10.

Item 11.
Item 12.

Item 13.

Item 14.

PART IV

Item 15.

2

In reading this Annual Report on Form 10-K, references to:

NOTE TO READER

•
•
•

•
•

•
•
•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

•

the “Trust” and “Holdings” refer to Compass Diversified Holdings;
the “Company” refer to Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC;
“businesses”, “operating segments”, “subsidiaries” and “reporting units” all refer to, collectively, the businesses
controlled by the Company;
the “Manager” refer to Compass Group Management LLC (“CGM”);
the “initial businesses” refer to, collectively, Staffmark Holdings, Inc., Crosman Acquisition Corporation, Compass
AC Holdings, Inc. and Silvue Technologies Group, Inc.;
the "2014 acquisitions" refer to, collectively, the acquisitions of Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. and Sterno Products;
the "2015 acquisition" refer to the acquisition of Fresh Hemp Foods Ltd. ("Manitoba Harvest")
the "2015 dispositions" refer to, collectively, the sales of CamelBak Acquisition Corp. ("CamelBak") and AFM
Holding Corp. ("American Furniture" or "AFM")
the “Trust Agreement” refer to the Second Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of the Trust dated as of December
6, 2016;
the “2011 Credit Facility” refer to the Credit Facility with a group of lenders led by TD Securities (USA) LLC (“TD
Securities”) which provided for the 2011 Revolving Credit Facility and the 2011 Term Loan Facility;
the "2014 Credit Facility" refer to the credit agreement entered into on June 14, 2014 with a group of lenders led by
Bank of America N.A. as administrative agent, as amended from time to time, which provides for a Revolving Credit
Facility and a Term Loan;
the "2014 Revolving Credit Facility" refer to the $550 million Revolving Credit Facility provided by the 2014 Credit
Facility that matures in June 2019;
the "2014 Term Loan" refer to the $325 million Term Loan Facility, provided by the 2014 Credit Facility that matures
in June 2021;
the "2016 Incremental Term Loan" refer to the $250 million Tranche B Term Facility provided by the 2014 Credit
Facility (together with the 2014 Term Loan, the "Term Loans");
the “LLC Agreement” refer to the fifth amended and restated operating agreement of the Company dated as of
December 6, 2016;
“we”, “us” and “our” refer to the Trust, the Company and the businesses together.

3

Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Disclosure

This Annual Report on Form 10-K, including the sections entitled “Risk Factors,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of 
Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and “Business,” contains forward-looking statements. We may, in some cases, 
use words such as “project,” “predict,” “believe,” “anticipate,” “plan,” “expect,” “estimate,” “intend,” “should,” “would,” “could,” 
“potentially,” or “may” or other words that convey uncertainty of future events or outcomes to identify these forward-looking 
statements. Forward-looking statements in this Annual Report on Form 10-K are subject to a number of risks and uncertainties, 
some of which are beyond our control, including, among other things:

•

•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•

•
•
•
•

our ability to successfully operate our businesses on a combined basis, and to effectively integrate and improve any future
acquisitions;
our ability to remove our Manager and our Manager’s right to resign;
our trust and organizational structure, which may limit our ability to meet our dividend and distribution policy;
our ability to service and comply with the terms of our indebtedness;
our cash flow available for distribution and our ability to make distributions in the future to our shareholders;
our ability to pay the management fee, and profit allocation when due;
our ability to make and finance future acquisitions;
our ability to implement our acquisition and management strategies;
the regulatory environment in which our businesses operate;
trends in the industries in which our businesses operate;
changes in general economic or business conditions or economic or demographic trends in the United States and other
countries in which we have a presence, including changes in interest rates and inflation;
environmental risks affecting the business or operations of our businesses;
our and our Manager’s ability to retain or replace qualified employees of our businesses and our Manager;
costs and effects of legal and administrative proceedings, settlements, investigations and claims; and
extraordinary or force majeure events affecting the business or operations of our businesses.

Our actual results, performance, prospects or opportunities could differ materially from those expressed in or implied by the 
forward-looking statements. A description of some of the risks that could cause our actual results to differ appears under the section 
“Risk Factors”. Additional risks of which we are not currently aware or which we currently deem immaterial could also cause our 
actual results to differ.

In light of these risks, uncertainties and assumptions, you should not place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements. The 
forward-looking events discussed in this Annual Report on Form 10-K may not occur. These forward-looking statements are made 
as of the date of this Annual Report. We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements to 
reflect subsequent events or circumstances, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as required 
by law.

4

ITEM 1. BUSINESS

PART I

Compass  Diversified  Holdings,  a  Delaware  statutory  trust  (“Holdings”,  or  the  “Trust”),  was  incorporated  in  Delaware  on 
November 18, 2005. Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability Company (the “Company”), was 
also formed on November 18, 2005. The Trust and the Company (collectively “CODI”) were formed to acquire and manage a 
group of small and middle-market businesses headquartered in North America. The Trust is the sole owner of 100% of the Trust 
Interests, as defined in our LLC Agreement, of the Company. Pursuant to the LLC Agreement, the Trust owns an identical number 
of Trust Interests in the Company as exist for the number of outstanding shares of the Trust. Accordingly, our shareholders are 
treated  as  beneficial  owners  of Trust  Interests  in  the  Company  and,  as  such,  are  subject  to  tax  under  partnership  income  tax 
provisions.

The Company is the operating entity with a board of directors whose corporate governance responsibilities are similar to that of 
a Delaware corporation. The Company’s board of directors oversees the management of the Company and our businesses and the 
performance of Compass Group Management LLC (“CGM” or our “Manager”).  Certain persons who are employees and partners 
of our Manager receive a profit allocation as beneficial owners of 60.4% through Sostratus LLC of the Allocation Interests in us, 
as defined in our LLC Agreement.

Overview

We  acquire  controlling  interests  in  and  actively  manage  businesses  that  we  believe  (i) operate  in  industries  with  long-term 
macroeconomic  growth  opportunities,  (ii) have  positive  and  stable  cash  flows,  (iii) face  minimal  threats  of  technological  or 
competitive obsolescence, and (iv) have strong management teams largely in place.

Our unique public structure provides investors with an opportunity to participate in the ownership and growth of companies which 
have historically been owned by private equity firms, wealthy individuals or families. Through the acquisition of a diversified 
group of businesses with these characteristics, we believe we offer investors an opportunity to diversify their own portfolio risk 
while participating in the ongoing cash flows of those businesses through the receipt of quarterly distributions.

Our disciplined approach to our target market provides opportunities to methodically purchase attractive businesses at values that 
are accretive to our shareholders. For sellers of businesses, our unique financial structure allows us to acquire businesses efficiently 
with little or no third party financing contingencies and, following acquisition, to provide our businesses with substantial access 
to growth capital.

We believe that private company operators and corporate parents looking to sell their business units may consider us an attractive 
purchaser because of our ability to:

provide ongoing strategic and financial support for their businesses;

• 
•  maintain a long-term outlook as to the ownership of those businesses where such an outlook is required for maximization 

of our shareholders’ return on investment; and
consummate transactions efficiently without being dependent on third-party transaction financing.

• 

In particular, we believe that our outlook on length of ownership and active management on our part may alleviate the concern 
that many private company operators and parent companies may have with regard to their businesses going through multiple sale 
processes in a short period of time. We believe this outlook reduces both the risk that businesses may be sold at unfavorable points 
in the overall market cycle and enhances our ability to develop a comprehensive strategy to grow the earnings and cash flows of 
each of our businesses, which we expect will better enable us to meet our long-term objective of continuing to pay distributions 
to our shareholders while increasing shareholder value. Finally, it has been our experience, that our ability to acquire businesses 
without the cumbersome delays and conditions typical of third party transactional financing is appealing to sellers of businesses 
who are interested in confidentiality and certainty to close.

We  believe  our  management  team’s  strong  relationships  with  industry  executives,  accountants,  attorneys,  business  brokers, 
commercial and investment bankers, and other potential sources of acquisition opportunities offer us substantial opportunities to 
assess small to middle market businesses available for acquisition. In addition, the flexibility, creativity, experience and expertise 
of our management team in structuring transactions allows us to consider non-traditional and complex transactions tailored to fit 
a specific acquisition target.

In terms of the businesses in which we have a controlling interest as of December 31, 2016, we believe that these businesses have 
strong  management  teams,  operate  in  strong  markets  with  defensible  market  niches  and  maintain  long-standing  customer 
relationships. We believe that the strength of this model, which provides for significant industry, customer and geographic diversity, 
has become even more apparent in the recent challenging economic environment.

5

We categorize the businesses we own into two separate groups of businesses (i) branded consumer businesses and, (ii) niche 
industrial businesses. Branded consumer businesses are characterized as those businesses that we believe capitalize on a valuable 
brand name in their respective market sector. We believe that our branded consumer businesses are leaders in their particular 
product  category.  Niche  industrial  businesses  are  characterized  as  those  businesses  that  focus  on  manufacturing  and  selling 
particular products and industrial services within a specific market sector. We believe that our niche industrial businesses are 
leaders in their specific market sector.

The following is a brief summary of the businesses in which we own a controlling interest at December 31, 2016:

Branded Consumer Businesses

5.11 

5.11 ABR Corp. ("5.11 Tactical" or "5.11") is a leading provider of purpose-built tactical apparel and gear for law enforcement, 
firefighters, EMS, and military special operations as well as outdoor and adventure enthusiasts.  5.11 is a brand known for innovation 
and authenticity, and works directly with end users to create purpose-built apparel and gear designed to enhance the safety, accuracy, 
speed and performance of tactical professionals and enthusiasts worldwide.   Headquartered in Irvine, California, 5.11 operates 
sales offices and distribution centers globally, and 5.11 products are widely distributed in uniform stores, military exchanges, 
outdoor retail stores, its own retail stores and on 511tactical.com.  We made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in 5.11 
Tactical for  approximately $408.2 million in August 2016.  We currently own 97.5% of the outstanding stock of 5.11 on a primary 
basis and 85.1% on a fully diluted basis. 

Ergobaby

Ergobaby Carrier, Inc. (“Ergobaby”), headquartered in Los Angeles, California, is dedicated to building a global community of 
confident parents with smart, ergonomic solutions that enable and encourage bonding between parents and babies. Ergobaby offers 
a broad range of award-winning baby carriers, strollers, car seats, swaddlers, nursing pillows, and related products that fit into 
families’ daily lives seamlessly, comfortably and safely.  We made loans to, and purchased a controlling interest in, Ergobaby on 
September 16, 2010 for approximately $85.2 million. We currently own 83.5% of the outstanding stock of Ergobaby on a primary 
basis and 76.9% on a fully diluted basis.

Liberty Safe

Liberty Safe and Security Products, Inc. (“Liberty Safe” or “Liberty”), headquartered in Payson, Utah, is a designer, manufacturer 
and marketer of premium home, office and gun safes in North America. From its over 300,000 square foot manufacturing facility, 
Liberty produces a wide range of home and gun safe models in a broad assortment of sizes, features and styles. We made loans 
to, and purchased a controlling interest in, Liberty Safe on March 31, 2010 for approximately $70.2 million. We currently own 
88.6% of the outstanding stock of Liberty Safe on a primary basis and 84.7% on a fully diluted basis.

Manitoba Harvest 

Manitoba Harvest is a pioneer and global leader in branded, hemp-based foods.  Headquartered in Winnipeg, Manitoba, Manitoba 
Harvest's products are currently carried in approximately 13,000 retail stores across the United States and Canada.  Manitoba 
Harvest's hemp-exclusive, 100% all natural product lineup includes hemp hearts, hemp oil and hemp protein powder.  We made 
loans to, and purchased an 87% controlling interest in, Manitoba Harvest on July 10, 2015 for approximately $102.7 million (C
$130.3 million).  In December 2015, Manitoba Harvest acquired all of the outstanding stock of Hemp Oil Canada Inc. (“HOCI”), 
a wholesale supplier and a private label packager of hemp food products and ingredients, for approximately $32.7 million (C$44.7 
million).  In connection with the HOCI acquisition, the former shareholders of HOCI invested $6.8 million (C$9.3 million) in 
Manitoba Harvest equity, resulting in a dilution of our ownership interest.  We currently own 76.6% of the outstanding stock of 
Manitoba Harvest on a primary basis and 65.6% on a fully diluted basis.

Niche Industrial Businesses

Advanced Circuits

Compass AC Holdings, Inc. (“Advanced Circuits” or “ACI”), headquartered in Aurora, Colorado, is a provider of small-run, quick-
turn and volume production rigid printed circuit boards, or “PCBs”, throughout the United States. PCBs are a vital component of 
virtually all electronic products. The small-run and quick-turn portions of the PCB industry are characterized by customers requiring 

6

high levels of responsiveness, technical support and timely delivery. We made loans to, and purchased a controlling interest in, 
Advanced  Circuits,  on  May 16,  2006  for  approximately  $81.0  million. We  currently  own  69.4%  of  the  outstanding  stock  of 
Advanced Circuits on a primary basis and 69.3% on a fully diluted basis.

Arnold

AMT Acquisition Corporation (“Arnold” or “Arnold Magnetics”), headquartered in Rochester, New York, with nine additional 
facilities worldwide, is a manufacturer of engineered, application specific permanent magnets. Arnold Magnetics products are 
used in applications such as aerospace and defense, motorsport/ automotive, oil and gas, medical, general industrial, electric utility, 
reprographics, and advertising specialties.  Arnold Magnetics is the largest U.S. manufacturer of engineered magnets as well as 
only one of two domestic producers to design, engineer and manufacture rare earth magnetic solutions. We made loans to, and 
purchased a controlling interest in, Arnold on March 5, 2012 for approximately $128.8 million. We currently own 96.7% of the 
outstanding stock of Arnold on a primary basis and 84.7% on a fully diluted basis.

Clean Earth

Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. ("Clean Earth"), headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania, is a provider of environmental services for 
a variety of contaminated materials.  Clean Earth provides a one-stop shop solution that analyzes, treats, documents and recycles 
waste streams generated in multiple end-markets such as power, construction, commercial development, oil and gas, medical, 
infrastructure, industrial and dredging.  We made loans to, and purchased a controlling interest in, Clean Earth on August 26, 2014 
for approximately $251.4 million.  We currently own 97.5% of the outstanding stock of Clean Earth on a primary basis and 79.8%
on a fully diluted basis.

Sterno Products

Candle Lamp Company, LLC ("Sterno Products" or "Sterno"), headquartered in Corona, California, is a leading manufacturer and 
marketer of portable food warming devices and creative table lighting solutions for the food service industry and flameless candles 
and outdoor lighting products for consumers.  Sterno's product line includes wick and chafing fuels, butane stoves and accessories , 
liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and lamps.  We made loans to, and purchased all of the equity interests in, 
Sterno Products on October 10, 2014 for approximately $160.0 million.  We currently own 100.0% of the outstanding stock of 
Sterno Products on a primary basis and 89.5% on a fully diluted basis.  

Our businesses also represent our operating segments. See—“Our Businesses” and “Note E – Operating Segment Data” to our 
Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion of our businesses as our operating segments, including information related 
to geographies.  We also own approximately 14% of the Fox Factory Holding Corp., which we refer to as FOX, headquartered in 
Scotts Valley, California. FOX is a designer, manufacturer and marketer of high-performance suspension products used primarily 
on mountain bikes, side-by-side vehicles, on-road vehicles with off-road capabilities, off-road vehicles and trucks, all-terrain 
vehicles, or ATVs, snowmobiles, specialty vehicles and applications, and motorcycles.  FOX’s products offer innovative design, 
performance, durability and reliability that enhance ride dynamics by improving performance and control.  The FOX brand is 
associated with high-performance and technologically advanced products.  We made loans to and purchased a controlling interest 
in FOX on January 4, 2008, for approximately $80.4 million.  In July 2014, through a secondary offering, our ownership in FOX 
was lowered from approximately 53% to approximately 41%, and as a result we deconsolidated FOX as of July 10, 2014.  In 
March and August 2016, through two more secondary offerings and a share repurchase by FOX, our ownership in the outstanding 
common stock of FOX was further lowered to approximately 23% as of September 30, 2016.  In November 2016, through another 
secondary offering, our ownership in the outstanding common stock of FOX was further lowered to approximately 14% as of 
November 16, 2016. 

2016 Highlights

Acquisition of 5.11 

On August 31, 2016, we closed on the acquisition of 5.11, a leading provider of purpose-built tactical apparel and gear for law 
enforcement, firefighters, EMS, and military special operations as well as outdoor and adventure enthusiasts.   The purchase price 
for 5.11, net of transaction costs of $2.1 million, was $408.2 million.  We funded the acquisition through an Incremental Facility 
Amendment to the 2014 Credit Agreement.  The Incremental Facility Amendment provided an increase to the 2014 Revolving 
Credit Facility of $150.0 million, and an advance under the 2016 Incremental Term Loan in the amount of $250.0 million. 

7

Disposition of Tridien Medical

On September 21, 2016, a subsidiary of Hill-Rom Holdings, Inc. acquired our Tridien subsidiary, based on an enterprise value of 
$25 million.  After the allocation of the sales price to non-controlling equity holders and the payment of transaction expenses, the 
Company received approximately $22.7 million in net proceeds related to the sale.  We recognized a gain of $1.7 million on the 
sale of Tridien during the year ended December 31, 2016.

Sale of Trust Common Shares

On December 13, 2016, the Company closed on an underwritten public offering of 5,600,000 common shares of the Trust at a 
price of $18.65 per share (the "Offering"), for proceeds of $99.4 million after deducting the underwriter's discount and offering 
costs.  In connection with the Offering, the Trust, the Company and Compass Group Management LLC entered into an Underwriting 
Agreement  with  Merrill  Lynch,  Pierce,  Fenner  &  Smith  Incorporated  and  UBS  Securities  LLC,  as  managers  of  the  several 
underwriters listed therein (collectively, the “Underwriters”), pursuant to which CODI agreed to sell and the Underwriters agreed 
severally to purchase, subject to and upon terms and conditions set forth therein, 5,600,000 common shares. 

Partial Divestiture of FOX shares

In November 2016,the Company sold 3,500,000 shares of FOX common stock in a secondary offering, for total net proceeds of 
$71.8 million. This sale of the portion of our FOX shares in November 2016 qualified as a Sale Event under the Company's LLC 
Agreement.  Our board of directors declared a distribution to the Holders of the Allocation Interests of $13.4 million in connection 
with the Sale Event in the fourth quarter of 2016.  The profit allocation payment was made during the first quarter of 2017.  As a 
result of the November 2016 sale of FOX shares, our ownership interest in FOX was reduced to approximately 14%.  

On August 12, 2016, FOX closed on a secondary public offering of 4,025,000 shares held by certain FOX shareholders, including 
the Company.  The Company sold a total of 3,500,000 shares of FOX common stock in this offering, for total net proceeds of 
$63.0 million.  Upon completion of the offering, our ownership of FOX decreased from approximately 33% to approximately 
23%.   This sale of the portion of our FOX shares in August 2016 qualified as a Sale Event under the Company's LLC Agreement.  
Our board of directors declared a distribution to the Holders of the Allocation Interests of $11.6 million in connection with the 
Sale Event of FOX in August 2016.  The profit allocation payment, offset by the negative profit allocation resulting from the 
disposition of Tridien, was made during the quarter ended December 31, 2016.  

During  the  first  quarter  of  2016,  the  Company  sold  2,500,000  shares  of  FOX  common  stock  in  a  secondary  public  offering.  
Concurrently with the closing of the offering, FOX repurchased 500,000 shares of FOX common stock held by the Company.  As 
a result of the sale of shares through the offering and the repurchase of shares by FOX, we sold a total of 3,000,000 shares of FOX 
common stock, with total net proceeds of approximately $47.7 million.  Upon completion of the offering and repurchase of shares 
by FOX, our ownership interest in FOX was reduced from approximately 41% to 33%.  This sale of the portion of our FOX shares 
in March 2016 qualified as a Sale Event under the Company's LLC Agreement.  During the second quarter, our board of directors 
declared a distribution to the Holders of the Allocation Interests of $8.6 million in connection with the Sale Event of FOX.  The 
profit allocation payment was made during the quarter ended June 30, 2016.  

Acquisition of Baby Tula

On May 11, 2016, the Company's Ergobaby subsidiary acquired all of the outstanding membership interests in New Baby Tula 
LLC ("Baby Tula"), a maker of premium baby carriers, toddler carriers, slings, blankets and wraps.  The purchase price was $73.8 
million, net of transaction costs, plus a potential earn-out of $8.2 million based on 2017 financial performance.  Ergobaby paid 
$0.8 million in transaction costs in connection with the acquisition.  Ergobaby funded the acquisition and payment of related 
transaction costs through the issuance of an additional $68.2 million in intercompany loans with the Company, and the issuance 
of $8.2 million in Ergobaby shares to the selling shareholders. 

Acquisitions of EWS and Phoenix Soil

On June 1, 2016, the Company's Clean Earth subsidiary acquired certain of the assets and liabilities of EWS Alabama, Inc. ("EWS") .  
Clean Earth funded the acquisition and the related transaction costs through the issuance of additional intercompany debt with the 
Company.  Based in Glencoe, Alabama, EWS  provides a range of hazardous and non-hazardous waste management services from 
a fully permitted hazardous waste RCRA Part B facility. 

On April 15, 2016, Clean Earth acquired certain assets and liabilities of Phoenix Soil, LLC ("Phoenix Soil") and WIC, LLC 
(together with Phoenix Soil, the "Sellers").  Clean Earth funded the acquisition and the related transaction costs through the issuance 
of additional intercompany debt with the Company.  Phoenix Soil is based in Plainville, Connecticut and provides environmental 
services for nonhazardous contaminated materials with a primary focus on soil.  Phoenix Soil recently completed its transition to 

8

a new 58,000 square foot thermal desorption facility owned by WIC, LLC.  The acquisition increased Clean Earth's soil treatment 
capabilities and expand its geographic footprint into New England. 

Acquisition of Northern International, Inc.

On January 22, 2016,  Sterno Products, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, acquired all of the outstanding stock of  
Northern International, Inc. (NII), for a purchase price of approximately $35.8 million (C$50.6 million).  The purchase price 
includes an earn-out payable over two years of up to a maximum amount of $1.8 million (C$2.5 million), and is subject to working 
capital adjustments.  Headquartered in Coquitlam, British Columbia, Canada, NII sells flameless candles and outdoor lighting 
products through the retail segment.  Sterno Products financed the acquisition and payment of the related transaction costs through 
the issuance of an additional $37.0 million in intercompany loans with the Company.  

Ergobaby Share Repurchase

In June 2016, Ergobaby repurchased 77,425 shares of Ergobaby common stock from certain noncontrolling interest shareholders 
for a total purchase price of $15.4 million.  Ergobaby financed the repurchase of shares with an increase to the intercompany debt 
facility with the Company.  Subsequent to the repurchase, the noncontrolling interest in Ergobaby is 83.9% on a primary basis 
and 76.2% on a fully diluted basis.  The shares have been accounted for as treasury shares by Ergobaby.

2016 Distributions

For the 2016 fiscal year, we declared and paid distributions to our shareholders totaling $1.44 per share.

Tax Reporting

Information returns will be filed by the Trust and the Company with the IRS, as required, with respect to income, gain, loss, 
deduction and other items derived from the Company’s activities. The Company has and will file a partnership return with the 
IRS and intends to issue a Schedule K-1 to the trustee. The trustee intends to provide information to each holder of shares using 
a monthly convention as the calculation period. For 2016 and future years, the Trust will continue to file a Form 1065 and issue 
Schedule K-1 to shareholders.  For 2016, we delivered the Schedule K-1 to shareholders within the same time frame as we delivered 
the schedule to shareholders for the 2015 and 2014 taxable years.  The relevant and necessary information for tax purposes is 
readily available electronically through our website. Each holder will be deemed to have consented to provide relevant information, 
and if the shares are held through a broker or other nominee, to allow such broker or other nominee to provide such information 
as is reasonably requested by us for purposes of complying with our tax reporting obligations.

WHERE YOU CAN FIND ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

We have filed with the SEC Forms S-1 and S-3 under the Securities Act, and Forms 10-Q, 10-K, and 8-K under the Exchange Act, 
which include exhibits, schedules and amendments. In addition, copies of such reports are available free of charge that can be 
accessed  indirectly  through  our  website  http://www.compassdiversifiedholdings.com  and  are  available  as  soon  as  reasonably 
practicable after such documents are electronically filed or furnished with the SEC.

9

Organizational Structure (1)

1)

2)

3)

4)

5)

The percentage holdings shown in respect to the trust reflect the ownership of the common shares as of December 31, 2016.

Our non-affiliated holders of common shares own approximately 84.6% of the Trust common shares and CGI Maygar Holdings, 
LLC owns approximately 13.2% of the Trust common shares and is our single largest holder. Path Spirit Limited is the ultimate 
controlling person of CGI Maygar LLC.  Mr. Offenberg, our Chief Executive Officer, is not a director, officer or member of CGI 
or any of its affiliates.

60.4% beneficially owned by certain persons who are employees and partners of our Manager.  C. Sean Day, the Chairman 
of our Board of Directors, CGI and the former founding partner of the Manager, are non-managing members.

Mr. Offenberg is a partner of this entity.

The Allocation Interests, which carry the right to receive a profit allocation, represent less than 0.1% equity interest in the
Company.

Our Manager

Our Manager, CGM, has been engaged to manage the day-to-day operations and affairs of the Company and to execute our strategy, 
as discussed below. Our management team has worked together since 1998. Collectively, our management team has extensive 
experience in acquiring and managing small and middle market businesses. We believe our Manager is unique in the marketplace 
in terms of the success and experience of its employees in acquiring and managing diverse businesses of the size and general 
nature of our businesses. We believe this experience will provide us with an advantage in executing our overall strategy. Our 
management team devotes a majority of its time to the affairs of the Company.

10

We have entered into a management services agreement, (the “Management Services Agreement” or “MSA”) pursuant to which 
our Manager manages the day-to-day operations and affairs of the Company and oversees the management and operations of our 
businesses. We pay our Manager a quarterly management fee for the services it performs on our behalf. In addition, certain persons 
who are employees and partners of our Manager receive a profit allocation with respect to its Allocation Interests in us. All of the 
Allocation Interests in us are owned by Sostratus LLC. See Part III, Item 13 “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions” for 
further descriptions of the management fees and profit allocations.

The Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer are employees of our Manager and have been seconded to 
us. Neither the Trust nor the Company has any other employees. Although our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer 
are employees of our Manager, they report directly to the Company’s board of directors. The management fee paid to our Manager 
covers all expenses related to the services performed by our Manager, including the compensation of our Chief Executive Officer 
and other personnel providing services to us. The Company reimburses our Manager for the compensation and related costs and 
expenses of our Chief Financial Officer and his staff, who dedicate substantially all of their time to the affairs of the Company.

See Part III, Item 13, “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions and Director Independence.”

Market Opportunity

We acquire and actively manage small and middle market businesses. We characterize small to middle market businesses as those 
that generate annual cash flows of up to $60 million. We believe that the merger and acquisition market for small to middle market 
businesses is highly fragmented and provides opportunities to purchase businesses at attractive prices. We believe that the following 
factors contribute to lower acquisition multiples for small and middle market businesses:

• 
• 
• 

• 

there are fewer potential acquirers for these businesses;
third-party financing generally is less available for these acquisitions;
sellers of these businesses frequently consider non-economic factors, such as continuing board membership or the effect 
of the sale on their employees; and
these businesses are less frequently sold pursuant to an auction process.

Frequently, opportunities exist to augment existing management at such businesses and improve the performance of these businesses 
upon their acquisition. In the past, our management team has acquired businesses that were owned by entrepreneurs or large 
corporate parents. In these cases, our management team has frequently found that there have been opportunities to further build 
upon the management teams of acquired businesses beyond those that existed at the time of acquisition.  In addition, our management 
team has frequently found that financial reporting and management information systems of acquired businesses may be improved, 
both of which can lead to improvements in earnings and cash flow.  Finally, because these businesses tend to be too small to have 
their own corporate development efforts, opportunities frequently exist to assist these businesses as they pursue organic or external 
growth strategies that were often not pursued by their previous owners.

Our Strategy

We have two primary strategies that we use in order to provide distributions to our shareholders and increase shareholder value. 
First, we focus on growing the earnings and cash flow from our acquired businesses. We believe that the scale and scope of our 
businesses give us a diverse base of cash flow upon which to further build. Second, we identify, perform due diligence on, negotiate 
and consummate additional platform acquisitions of small to middle market businesses in attractive industry sectors in accordance 
with acquisition criteria established by the board of directors

Management Strategy

Our management strategy involves the proactive financial and operational management of the businesses we own in order to 
increase cash flow, pay distributions to our shareholders and increase shareholder value. Our Manager oversees and supports the 
management teams of each of our businesses by, among other things:

• 

• 

• 
• 
• 
• 

recruiting and retaining talented managers to operate our businesses using structured incentive compensation programs, 
including non-controlling equity ownership, tailored to each business;
regularly  monitoring  financial  and  operational  performance,  instilling  consistent  financial  discipline,  and  supporting 
management in the development and implementation of information systems to effectively achieve these goals;
assisting management in their analysis and pursuit of prudent organic growth strategies;
identifying and working with management to execute attractive external growth and acquisition opportunities;
assisting management in controlling and right-sizing overhead costs; and
forming strong subsidiary level boards of directors to supplement management in their development and implementation 
of strategic goals and objectives.

11

Specifically, while our businesses have different growth opportunities and potential rates of growth, we expect our Manager to 
work with the management teams of each of our businesses to increase the value of, and cash generated by, each business through 
various initiatives, including:

•  making selective capital investments to expand geographic reach, increase capacity, or reduce manufacturing costs of 

our businesses;
investing in product research and development for new products, processes or services for customers;
improving and expanding existing sales and marketing programs;
pursuing reductions in operating costs through improved operational efficiency or outsourcing of certain processes and 
products; and
consolidating or improving management of certain overhead functions.

• 
• 
• 

• 

Our businesses typically acquire and integrate complementary businesses. We believe that complementary add-on acquisitions 
improve our overall financial and operational performance by allowing us to:

• 
• 
• 
• 
• 

leverage manufacturing and distribution operations;
leverage branding and marketing programs, as well as customer relationships;
add experienced management or management expertise;
increase market share and penetrate new markets; and
realize cost synergies by allocating the corporate overhead expenses of our businesses across a larger number of businesses 
and by implementing and coordinating improved management practices.

We incur third party debt financing almost entirely at the Company level, which we use, in combination with our equity capital, 
to provide debt financing to each of our businesses and to acquire additional businesses.  We believe this financing structure is 
beneficial to the financial and operational activities of each of our businesses by aligning our interests as both equity holders of, 
and lenders to, our businesses, in a manner that we believe is more efficient than each of our businesses borrowing from third-
party lenders.

Acquisition Strategy

Our acquisition strategy involves the acquisition of businesses that we expect to produce stable and growing earnings and cash 
flow. In this respect, we expect to make acquisitions in industries other than those in which our businesses currently operate if we 
believe an acquisition presents an attractive opportunity. We believe that attractive opportunities will continue to present themselves, 
as private sector owners seek to monetize their interests in long-standing and privately-held businesses and large corporate parents 
seek to dispose of their “non-core” operations.

Our ideal acquisition candidate has the following characteristics:

is an established North American based company;

• 
•  maintains a significant market share in defensible industry niche (i.e., has a “reason to exist”);
• 
• 
•  maintains a diversified customer and supplier base.

has a solid and proven management team with meaningful incentives;
has low technological and/or product obsolescence risk; and

We benefit from our Manager’s ability to identify potential diverse acquisition opportunities in a variety of industries. In addition, 
we rely upon our management team’s experience and expertise in researching and valuing prospective target businesses, as well 
as negotiating the ultimate acquisition of such target businesses. In particular, because there may be a lack of information available 
about these target businesses, which may make it more difficult to understand or appropriately value such target businesses, on 
our behalf, our Manager:

• 
• 
• 
• 
• 
• 

engages in a substantial level of internal and third-party due diligence;
critically evaluates the target management team;
identifies and assesses any financial and operational strengths and weaknesses of the target business;
analyzes comparable businesses to assess financial and operational performances relative to industry competitors;
actively researches and evaluates information on the relevant industry; and
thoroughly negotiates appropriate terms and conditions of any acquisition.

The process of acquiring new businesses is both time-consuming and complex. Our management team historically has taken from 
two to twenty-four months to perform due diligence, negotiate and close acquisitions. Although our management team is always 
at various stages of evaluating several transactions at any given time, there may be periods of time during which our management 
team does not recommend any new acquisitions to us.  Even if an acquisition is recommended by our management team, our board 
of directors may not approve it.

12

A component of our acquisition financing strategy that we utilize in acquiring the businesses we own and manage is to provide 
both  equity  capital  and  debt  capital,  raised  at  the  parent  company  level  largely  through  our  existing  credit  facility,  to  close 
acquisitions. We believe, and it has been our experience, that having the ability to finance our acquisitions with capital resources 
raised by us, rather than negotiating separate third party financing, provides us with an advantage in successfully acquiring attractive 
businesses by minimizing delay and closing conditions that are often related to acquisition-specific financings. In addition, our 
strategy of providing this intercompany debt financing within the capital structure of the businesses we acquire and manage allows 
us the ability to distribute cash to the parent company through monthly interest payments and amortization of principle on these 
intercompany loans.

Upon acquisition of a new business, we rely on our Manager’s experience and expertise to work efficiently and effectively with 
the management of the new business to jointly develop and execute a successful business plan.

We believe our financing structure, in which both equity and debt capital are raised at the Company level, allows us to acquire 
businesses without transaction specific financing and is conducive to our ability to consummate transactions that may be attractive 
in both the short- and long-term.

In addition to acquiring businesses, we sell those businesses that we own from time to time when attractive opportunities arise 
that outweigh the future growth and value that we believe we will be able to bring such businesses consistent with our long-term 
investment strategy. As such, our decision to sell a business is based on our belief that doing so will increase shareholder value to 
a greater extent than through our continued ownership of that business. Upon the sale of a business, we may use the proceeds to 
retire debt or retain proceeds for acquisitions or general corporate purposes. We do not expect to make special distributions at the 
time of a sale of one of our businesses; instead, we expect to pay shareholder distributions over time solely through the earnings 
and cash flows of our businesses.

Since our inception in May 2006, we have recorded net gains on sales of our businesses of approximately $350 million (excluding 
the gains on the sale of our shares in FOX). We sold Crosman Acquisition Company (“Crosman”) in January 2007, Aeroglide 
Company (“Aeroglide”) and Silvue Technologies Group, Inc. (“Silvue”) in June 2008, Staffmark Holdings Inc. (“Staffmark”) in 
October 2011, HALO Branded Solutions (“HALO”) in May 2012, CamelBak in August 2015, American Furniture in October 
2015, and Tridien in September 2016.   

Investment in FOX

We own approximately 14% of the Fox Factory Holding Corp. (NASDAQ - FOXF) as of December 31, 2016.  We made loans to 
and purchased a controlling interest in FOX on January 4, 2008, for approximately $80.4 million.  In August 2013, FOX completed 
an initial public offering of its common stock.  As a result of the initial public offering, our ownership interest in FOX was reduced 
to approximately 53.9%.  No gain was reflected as a result of the sale of our FOX shares in the initial public offering because our 
majority classification of FOX did not change.  FOX used a portion of their net proceeds received from the sale of their shares as 
well as proceeds from a new external FOX credit facility to repay $61.5 million in outstanding indebtedness to us under their 
existing credit facility with us. In July 2014, through a secondary offering, our ownership in FOX was lowered from approximately 
53% to approximately 41%, and as a result we deconsolidated FOX as of July 10, 2014.  In March and August 2016, through two 
more secondary offerings and a share repurchase by FOX, our ownership in the outstanding common stock of FOX was further 
lowered to approximately 23% as of September 30, 2016. In November 2016, through another secondary offering, our ownership 
in the outstanding common stock of FOX was further lowered to approximately 14%.  We have recognized total net proceeds from 
the sales of our FOX shares of approximately $328.9 million.

Strategic Advantages

Based on the experience of our management team and its ability to identify and negotiate acquisitions, we believe we are well-
positioned to acquire additional businesses. Our management team has strong relationships with business brokers, investment and 
commercial bankers, accountants, attorneys and other potential sources of acquisition opportunities. In addition, our management 
team also has a successful track record of acquiring and managing small to middle market businesses in various industries. In 
negotiating  these  acquisitions,  we  believe  our  management  team  has  been  able  to  successfully  navigate  complex  situations 
surrounding  acquisitions,  including  corporate  spin-offs,  transitions  of  family-owned  businesses,  management  buy-outs  and 
reorganizations.

Our management team has a large network of approximately 2,000 deal intermediaries who we expect to expose us to potential 
acquisitions. Through this network, as well as our management team’s proprietary transaction sourcing efforts, we have a substantial 
pipeline  of  potential  acquisition  targets.  Our  management  team  also  has  a  well-established  network  of  contacts,  including 

13

professional managers, attorneys, accountants and other third-party consultants and advisors, who may be available to assist us 
in the performance of due diligence and the negotiation of acquisitions, as well as the management and operation of our acquired 
businesses.

Finally, because we intend to fund acquisitions through the utilization of our 2014 Revolving Credit Facility, we expect to minimize 
the delays and closing conditions typically associated with transaction specific financing, as is typically the case in such acquisitions. 
We believe this advantage can be a powerful one, especially in a tight credit environment, and is highly unusual in the marketplace 
for acquisitions in which we operate.

Valuation and Due Diligence

When  evaluating  businesses  or  assets  for  acquisition,  our  management  team  performs  a  rigorous  due  diligence  and  financial 
evaluation process. In doing so, we evaluate the operations of the target business as well as the outlook for the industry in which 
the target business operates. While valuation of a business is, by definition, a subjective process, we define valuations under a 
variety of analyses, including:

• 
• 
• 
• 

discounted cash flow analyses;
evaluation of trading values of comparable companies;
expected value matrices; and
examination of comparable recent transactions.

One outcome of this process is a projection of the expected cash flows from the target business. A further outcome is an understanding 
of the types and levels of risk associated with those projections. While future performance and projections are always uncertain, 
we believe that with detailed due diligence, future cash flows will be better estimated and the prospects for operating the business 
in the future better evaluated. To assist us in identifying material risks and validating key assumptions in our financial and operational 
analysis, in addition to our own analysis, we engage third-party experts to review key risk areas, including legal, tax, regulatory, 
accounting, insurance and environmental. We also engage technical, operational or industry consultants, as necessary.

A further critical component of the evaluation of potential target businesses is the assessment of the capability of the existing 
management team, including recent performance, expertise, experience, culture and incentives to perform. Where necessary, and 
consistent with our management strategy, we actively seek to augment, supplement or replace existing members of management 
who we believe are not likely to execute our business plan for the target business. Similarly, we analyze and evaluate the financial 
and operational information systems of target businesses and, where necessary, we enhance and improve those existing systems 
that are deemed to be inadequate or insufficient to support our business plan for the target business.

Financing

We have a credit facility with a group of lenders led by Bank of America N.A. that we entered into on June 6, 2014.  The 2014 
Credit Facility provided for (i) revolving loans, swing line loans and letters of credit up to a maximum aggregate amount of $400 
million, and (ii) a $325 million term loan.  On August 15, 2016, the Company amended the 2014 Credit Facility to, among other 
things, increase the aggregate amount of the 2014 Credit Facility by $400 million.  On August 31, 2016, the Company entered 
into an Incremental Facility Amendment to the 2014 Credit Agreement (the "Incremental Facility Amendment").  As a result of 
the Incremental Facility Amendment, the 2014 Credit Facility currently provides for (i) a revolving credit facility of $550 million
(as amended from time to time, the "2014 Revolving Credit Facility"), (ii) a $325 million term loan (the "2014 Term Loan Facility"), 
and (iii) a $250 million incremental term loan (the "2016 Incremental Term Loan"). The 2014 Term Loan and 2016 Incremental 
Term Loan expire in June 2021.  

At December 31, 2016, we had $565.7 million outstanding on the 2014 Term Loan and 2016 Incremental Term Loan.  All amounts 
outstanding under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility will become due on June 6, 2019, which is the maturity date of loans advanced 
under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility and the termination date of the revolving loan commitment. The 2014 Credit Facility 
also permits us, prior to the applicable maturity date, to increase the revolving loan commitment and/or obtain additional term 
loans in an aggregate amount of up to $200 million subject to certain restrictions and conditions.

The 2014 Credit Facility provides for letters of credit under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility in an aggregate face amount not 
to exceed $100 million outstanding at any time, as well as swing line loans of up to $25 million outstanding at one time. At no 
time may the (i) aggregate principal amount of all amounts outstanding under the Revolving Credit Facility, plus (ii) the aggregate 
amount of all outstanding letters of credit and swing line loans, exceed the borrowing availability under the 2014 Credit Facility. 
At December 31, 2016, we had outstanding letters of credit totaling approximately $4.2 million.  The borrowing availability under 
the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility at December 31, 2016 was approximately $541.2 million.

14

The 2014 Credit Facility and 2016 Incremental Facility are secured by all of the assets of the Company, including all of its equity 
interests in, and loans to, its consolidated subsidiaries. (See "Note J - Debt" to the consolidated financial statements for more detail 
regarding our 2014 Credit Facility and 2016 Incremental Facility).

We intend to finance future acquisitions through our 2014 Revolving Credit Facility, cash on hand and, if necessary, additional 
equity and debt financings. We believe, and it has been our experience, that having the ability to finance our acquisitions with the 
capital  resources  raised  by  us,  rather  than  negotiating  separate  third  party  financing  specifically  related  to  the  acquisition of 
individual businesses, provides us with an advantage in acquiring attractive businesses by minimizing delay and closing conditions 
that are often related to acquisition-specific financings. In this respect, we believe that in the future, we may need to pursue 
additional debt or equity financings, or offer equity in Holdings or target businesses to the sellers of such target businesses, in 
order to fund multiple future acquisitions.

Our Businesses

We categorize the businesses we own into two separate groups of businesses (i) branded consumer businesses, and (ii) niche 
industrial businesses. Branded consumer businesses are characterized as those businesses that we believe capitalize on a valuable 
brand name in their respective market sector. We believe that our branded consumer businesses are leaders in their particular 
product  category.  Niche  industrial  businesses  are  characterized  as  those  businesses  that  focus  on  manufacturing  and  selling 
particular products and industrial services within a specific market sector. We believe that our niche industrial businesses are 
leaders in their specific market sector.

The following table represents the percentage of net revenue and operating income each of our businesses contributed to our 
consolidated results since the date of acquisition for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

Branded Consumer:

5.11

Ergobaby

FOX (1)

Liberty Safe

Manitoba Harvest

Niche Industrial:

Advanced Circuits

Arnold Magnetics

Clean Earth

Sterno Products

Year ended December 31,

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

2016

2015

2014

Net Revenue

Operating Income

11.2%

10.6%

n/a

10.6%

6.1%

38.5%

8.8%

11.1%

19.3%

22.4%

61.5%

n/a

11.9%

n/a

13.9%

2.4%

28.2%

12.0%

16.5%

24.1%

19.2%

71.8%

n/a

12.9%

23.6%

14.2%

n/a

50.6%

13.5%

19.4%

10.7%

5.8%

49.4%

(17.8)%

n/a

30.0 %

26.4 %

n/a

23.2 %

0.6 %

36.0 %

n/a

14.1 %

(7.3)%

33.2 %

39.8 %

28.8 %

(22.6)%

13.9 %

32.9 %

64.0 %

9.0 %

13.1 %

15.8 %

66.8 %

n/a

28.7 %

27.4 %

(4.3)%

n/a

51.8 %

35.5 %

11.2 %

4.3 %

(2.9)%

48.2 %

100.0%

100.0%

100.0%

100.0 %

100.0 %

100.0 %

(1) The 2014 percentage includes the net sales attributable for FOX prior to July 10, 2014, when our ownership interest in FOX 
fell below 50%.  

5.11 

Branded Consumer Businesses

Overview
5.11 is a leading provider of purpose-built tactical apparel and gear for law enforcement, firefighters, EMS, and military special 
operations as well as outdoor and adventure enthusiasts.  5.11 is committed to product innovation, and works directly with end 
users to create apparel and gear designed to enhance the safety, accuracy, speed and performance of tactical professionals and 
enthusiasts worldwide.  Headquartered in Irvine, California, 5.11 operates sales offices and distribution centers globally.  5.11 
15

products are widely distributed in law enforcement dealers, uniform stores, military exchanges, outdoor retail stores, company 
owned retail stores and online.

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2016 (from the date of acquisition), 5.11 had net sales of approximately $109.8 million
and an operating loss of $10.2 million.  5.11 had total assets of $452.1 million at December 31, 2016.  5.11 net sales (from the 
date of acquisition) represented 11.2% of our consolidated net sales for the year ended December 31, 2016.

History of 5.11

5.11 was formed in 2003 after spinning out of outdoor apparel company, Royal Robins®.  The roots of 5.11, however, trace back 
to 1975, when American rock climber Royal Robins designed the 5.11® Pant; named after the difficulty level in the Yosemite 
Decimal System rating scale for rock climbing.   With difficulty levels ranging at the time from 5.0 (easy) to 5.10 (difficult), 5.11 
was then described: “After thorough inspection, you conclude this move is impossible; however, occasionally someone actually 
accomplishes it.”  

A product designed for people who were pushing the limits of what was possible, the 5.11® Pant was a success among climbers 
and outdoor enthusiasts.  In 1992, the FBI Academy, in Quantico, Virginia adopted the original 5.11® Pant as its primary training 
pant, forging a decades-long relationship that supports 5.11’s commitment to the public safety and the first responder communities.

In 2011, 5.11’s corporate headquarters was relocated from Modesto, California to Irvine, California.  In 2012, 5.11 acquired Beyond 
Clothing LLC, a technical survival systems outerwear company located in Seattle, Washington. We acquired a majority interest 
in 5.11 on August 31, 2016.

Industry

5.11 participates in the global professional and consumer soft goods market for tactical gear and apparel; the addressable global 
soft goods market is estimated by management to be approximately $79 billion.  

The domestic professional public safety market for tactical soft goods is estimated by management to be a $1.7 billion market 
consisting of sales to active-duty military, law enforcement, private security, fire, corrections officers and EMS.  The addressable 
domestic work wear and consumer wear markets are estimated by management to be $4.3 billion and $13.2 billion, respectively. 

The international professional public safety market for tactical soft goods is estimated by management to be a $11.7 billion market. 
The addressable international work wear and consumer wear markets are estimated by management to be $11.4 billion and $36.3 
billion, respectively. 

Products and Services

5.11 offers a portfolio of unique head-to-toe tactical gear with patented functional features for both professional and consumer 
use.  No individual product style accounts for more than 9% of total sales, and most product styles tend to have multi-year lifecycles. 
5.11  focuses  its  product  offering  through  six  major  categories:  tactical  apparel,  bags  and  packs,  footwear,  special  make  ups/
uniforms, accessories, and Beyond Clothing Systems (“Beyond”).

Tactical apparel represents 5.11’s largest product category.  Within this category, 5.11 offers a broad assortment of men’s and 
women’s pants, shorts, shirts, outerwear and base layers.  Apparel is offered in a variety of styles and fits intended to enhance 
comfort and mobility.  5.11 has historically designed and developed innovative “families” of products around proprietary fabrics 
that the company has created to meet the needs of its unique target market.  These product “families” typically start with a pant 
and then expand into other products.  Today, 5.11 offers four distinct pant lines, which anchor four different apparel families: the 
Apex™ Pant, the 5.11 Stryke™ Pant, the Taclite® Pro Pant, and the 5.11® Tactical Pant.

5.11  bags  and  packs  provide  reliable,  multifunctional  storage  options  designed  to  excel  in  a  wide  range  of  operational  and 
recreational settings.  This category includes backpacks, cases, load-bearing equipment, range bags and duffels.  In addition to 
bags/packs and apparel, 5.11 sells footwear, including boots, low-profile tactical shoes, socks and accessories, as well as special 
make ups or customized uniforms for public safety agencies.  5.11 also offers a wide selection of accessories including belts, hats, 
flashlights, gloves, knives, eyewear, watches, patches, slings and holsters.

Beyond, a wholly-owned subsidiary of 5.11, offers technical survival outerwear systems engineered specifically for missions in 
extreme temperatures.  Products are marketed under the Beyond brand name and include base layers and briefs, pullovers, softshell 
jackets, wind pants, rain pants and jackets made of advanced fabrics.  Virtually all Beyond products are manufactured in the United 
States to comply with the Berry Amendment.

16

5.11’s core product offerings and suggested average retail prices are listed below:

Pants and Shorts (Men’s and Women’s) - $49.99 to $269.99

• 
•  Woven Tops (Men’s and Women’s) - $39.99 to $229.99
•  Outerwear (Men’s and Women’s) - $69.99 to $119.99
• 
Footwear (Men’s and Women’s) - $99.99 to $149.99
•  Bags and Packs - $59.99 to $249.99
•  Accessories -  $19.99 to $79.99

Competitive Strengths

Leading Brand Recognition and Market Share - 5.11 is a leader in the tactical apparel market.  5.11 enjoys strong brand 
awareness and affinity in the public safety market given its long history of creating high performance and innovative products for 
public safety operators.  5.11’s heritage of developing purpose-built clothing and gear for law enforcement, firefighters, EMS, and 
military special operations has imbued the 5.11 brand with unrivaled authenticity in the tactical apparel and gear markets.

Diverse Customer Base - 5.11 has direct relationships with over 12,500 governmental departments and agencies, and utilizes an 
established network of over 1,500 dealers in over 90 countries.  5.11 wins a significant amount of business in the public safety 
channel through the achievement of “specified” product in thousands of individual contracts with governmental departments and 
agencies, providing for a broad base of long-term relationships.

Product Breadth and “At-Once” Availability - Requirements of outfitting entire agencies or departments necessitates carrying 
numerous, often infrequently used, sizes and colors of a given product.  These requirements, coupled with “at-once” product 
fulfillment demands and often poorly capitalized dealer customers carrying low levels of inventory, makes 5.11 the go-to provider 
of tactical gear and apparel.  5.11’s significant investment in inventory provides a competitive advantage versus its smaller less 
well capitalized competitors.

Business Strategies

Further Expand into Consumer Market - 5.11 is well-positioned to continue investing in retail locations throughout the United 
States.  5.11 currently has ten company-owned retail locations, and management believes that there are significant opportunities 
to increase this footprint.  5.11 also sells to many outdoor specialty retailers and management believes there are opportunities to 
expand sales through increased penetration and improved merchandising.

Continue Penetration of Domestic Professional Channel - 5.11 continues to benefit from the domestic professional public safety 
market,  which  provides  a  stable  base  of  recurring  growth.    Going  forward,  5.11  will  continue  to  grow  within  the  domestic 
professional public safety channel through (i) continued conversion of institutional contract opportunity pipeline; and (ii) market 
share gains from continued product innovation and improved merchandising.

International Market Expansion - The international market remains an underpenetrated opportunity for 5.11.  5.11 will continue 
international sales development through building country-specific sales and operations infrastructure, executing on both near and 
medium term large foreign government contract opportunities, and expanding consumer awareness of the 5.11 brand.

Customers and Distribution Channels

5.11 services a wide range of customers including first responders, the military, and outdoors enthusiasts in over 90 countries.  
The primary distribution channels can be segmented into two categories: professional and consumer.  5.11's working capital needs 
do not differ substantially from those of its competitors in the industry and generally reflect the need to carry significant amounts 
of inventory to meet the requirements of its customers.

The domestic professional channel is characterized by thousands of unique “specified” product contracts with individual public 
safety departments, serviced through a network of more than one-thousand local third party dealers.  Public safety departments 
include federal, state, county, city and local law enforcement, firefighters, and EMS,.  Similar to the domestic professional channel, 
the  international  professional  channel  also  consists  of  many  unique  “specified”  product  contracts  with  individual  foreign 
governmental departments, serviced either directly by 5.11 or through a network of international dealers.  Large contracts with 
government agencies are referred to as Direct-to-Agency (“DTA”).  A typical DTA sales process is driven primarily by lengthy 
governmental approval processes and can take upwards of 18 to 36 months. 

Within  the  consumer  segment,  the  consumer  wholesale  channel  is  comprised  of  (i)  outdoor  specialty  retailers,  (ii)  military 
exchanges, and (iii) online.  The consumer direct channel is comprised of (i) e-commerce sales directly through the 5.11 website, 
www.511tactical.com, and (ii) company-owned retail stores.  5.11 has ten company-owned retail locations in the U.S.; six stores 

17

are located in California (Fresno, Riverside, Sacramento, Carson, and San Diego) and one store is located in each Las Vegas, 
Nevada, Denver, Colorado, Salt Lake City, Utah, and Dallas, Texas.

For the year ending December 31, 2016, professional channel sales accounted for approximately 69% of total sales; approximately 
5% of total sales were in the form of DTA sales.  The consumer channel accounted for approximately 26% of total sales.  

5.11’s top 10 customers comprised approximately 27% and 29% of total sales in the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, 
respectively.

Sales and Marketing

5.11’s sales organization consists of a mix of direct employees, independent contractors and sales agencies.  The domestic salesforce 
develops direct relationships with thousands of individual public safety departments around the U.S. and participates in thousands 
of requests for proposal (RFP) processes annually.  The salesforce works directly with over 925 local dealers to service local public 
safety departments once a 5.11 product receives “spec” as part of the RFP process. 

The international salesforce covers three primary regions: Asia Pacific, Europe, Middle East and Africa ("EMEA") and Latin 
America.  While the company does fulfill some orders directly to international customers through its 5.11 website, most sales are 
serviced through third party distributors and dealers in foreign jurisdictions.

5.11 has implemented a multi-pronged marketing plan including investments in (i) professional and consumer product catalogues; 
(ii) print media; (iii) tradeshows; (iv) shop-in-shop retail concepts; and (v) digital and social media content.

Suppliers

5.11 operates an efficient, low-cost supply chain, sourcing most its products through contract manufacturers in the Asia Pacific 
region.  Production from Vietnam accounted for approximately 40% of 5.11’s purchases for the year ending December 31, 2016 
and represented 5.11’s largest sourcing region. No single core product is 100% sourced by any one vendor.  Management believes 
that 5.11’s principal manufacturers have the additional capacity to accommodate future growth.

Production  of  Beyond  products  occurs  primarily  through  domestic  subcontract  facilities  in  the  U.S.  and  through  the  brand’s 
headquarters in Seattle, Washington.  

To ensure vendor reliability and quality, 5.11 established a sourcing office in Hong Kong.  The office employs approximately 50 
individuals whose primary functions include vendor management, commercialization, product development, production planning, 
vendor compliance, quality assurance and compliance.  

Intellectual Property 

5.11  relies  on  brand  name  recognition  and  a  combination  of  trademarks  and  patents  in  order  to  differentiate  itself  from  the 
competition.  5.11 currently has 14 utility patents and 7 design patents issued, in addition to 14 utility and 3 design patents pending 
registration.  5.11 currently owns 306 registered trademarks including 2 trade dress registrations.  The company has in-house 
general counsel that manages the registration and defense of 5.11 intellectual property.

Regulatory Environment

Management is not aware of any existing, pending, or contingent liabilities that could have a material adverse effect on 5.11’s 
business.  5.11 is proactive regarding regulatory issues and is in compliance with all relevant regulations.  Management is not 
aware of any potential environmental issues.

Employees

As of December 31, 2016, 5.11 employed a total of 553 non-unionized, full-time employees, 36 independent contractors, and 66 
temporary workers.  None of 5.11’s employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements.  Management believes that 5.11 
has an excellent relationship with its employees.

Ergobaby

Overview

Ergobaby  is  dedicated  to  building  a  global  community  of  confident  parents  with  smart,  ergonomic  solutions  that  enable  and 
encourage bonding between parents and babies. Ergobaby offers a broad range of award-winning baby carriers, blankets and 

18

swaddlers, nursing pillows, and related products that fit into families’ daily lives seamlessly, comfortably and safely.  Ergobaby 
is headquartered in Los Angeles, California.

For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, Ergobaby had net sales of approximately $103.3 million, $86.5 
million and $82.3 million, respectively.  Ergobaby had operating income totaling $17.2 million, $22.2 million and $18.1 million 
in the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.  Ergobaby had total assets of $184.4 million and $110.5 
million at December 31, 2016 and 2015.  Ergobaby’s net sales represented 10.6%, 11.9% and 12.9% of our consolidated net sales 
for the year ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

History of Ergobaby

Ergobaby was founded in 2003 by Karin Frost, who designed her first baby carrier following the birth of her son. The baby carrier 
product  line  has  since  expanded  into  3-position  and  4-position  carriers,  with  multiple  style  variations.  In  its  second  year  of 
operations, Ergobaby sold 10,500 baby carriers and by 2016 sold over 1.1 million in the year.  In order to support the rapid growth, 
in 2007, Ergobaby made a strategic decision to establish an operating subsidiary (“EBEU”) in Hamburg, Germany. We purchased 
a majority interest in Ergobaby on September 16, 2010.

On November 18, 2011 Ergobaby acquired Orbit Baby for approximately $17.5 million. Founded in 2004 and based in Newark, 
California, Orbit Baby produced and marketed a luxury line of strollers and car seats that utilized a patented hub ring to allow 
parents to easily move car seats from car seat bases to stroller frames in an instant without the need for any additional components. 
During the second quarter of 2016, Ergobaby's board of directors approved a plan to dispose of the Orbit Baby product line and 
in the fourth quarter of 2016, most of the Orbit Baby tooling and intellectual property was sold to Orbit Baby’s Korean distributor.  

On May 12, 2016, Ergobaby acquired membership interests of New Baby Tula LLC (“Baby Tula”) for approximately $73.8 million, 
excluding a potential earn-out payment.  Baby Tula designs, markets and distributes baby carriers and accessories.

In 2013, Ergobaby expanded its portfolio into the sleep category. The launch of the Ergobaby Swaddler which focused on a unique, 
method of swaddling newborns while retaining healthy hip and arm positioning, was the first significant category expansion 
outside of baby carriers for the Ergobaby brand. In 2016, Ergobaby expanded its offering in the sleep category with the launch of 
its Baby Sleeping Bag.  Baby Tula is also in the sleep category with its blanket offering.   

In 2014, Ergobaby launched the Ergobaby Four-Position 360 Baby Carrier which expanded on Ergobaby’s leadership in the baby 
carrier category by offering an ergonomic, outward forward facing position for the baby and comfort for the parent.  The Ergobaby 
360 Carrier won the 2014 JPMA Innovation award in the baby carrier category.  In 2016, Ergobaby launched the 3-Position Adapt 
Baby Carrier that is geared for newborns to toddlers (7lbs-45lbs).

Industry

Ergobaby competes in the large and expanding infant and juvenile products industry. The industry exhibits little seasonality and 
is somewhat insulated from overall economic trends, as parents view spending on children as largely non-discretionary in nature. 
Consequently, parents spend consistently on their children, particularly on durable items, such as car seats, strollers, baby carriers, 
and related items that are viewed as necessities. Further, an emotional component is often a factor in parents’ purchasing decisions, 
as parents’ desire to purchase the best and safest products for their children.   As a result, according to the USDA’s most recent 
report on Expenditures on Children by Families 2013 (released in August 2014), parents on average, spend between $9,130 and 
$25,700 on their child on an annual basis for related housing, food, transportation, clothes, healthcare, daycare and other items, 
depending on age of the child and annual income. The amount spent by parents in the highest income group (before tax income 
greater than $106,540) was more than twice the amounts spent by parents in the lowest income group (before tax income of less 
than $61,530). On average, households spent between 14 - 25% of their before-tax income on a child. Similar patterns are seen 
in other counties around the world.

Demand drivers fueling the growing spending on infant and juvenile products include favorable demographic trends, such as (i) an 
increasing number of births worldwide; (ii) a high percentage of first time births; (iii) an increasing age of first time mothers and 
a  large  percentage  of  working  mothers  with  increased  disposable  income;  and  (iv) an  increasing  percentage  of  single  child 
households and two-family households.

In purchases of baby durables, parents often seek well-known and trusted brands that offer a sense of comfort regarding a product’s 
reliability and safety.  As a result, brand name, comfort and safety certifications can serve as a barrier to entry for competition in 
the market, as well as allow well-known brands such as Ergobaby and Baby Tula to compete in a growing premium segment.

19

Products and Services

Baby Carriers

Ergobaby has two main baby carrier product lines: baby carriers and related carrier accessories, sold under both the Ergobaby and 
Tula brands. Ergobaby’s baby carrier designs supports a natural, ergonomic sitting position for babies, eliminating compression 
of the spine and hips that can be caused by unsupported suspension. The baby carrier also balances the baby’s weight to parents’ 
hips and shoulders, and alleviates physical stress for the parent. Both Ergobaby’s 3-Position and 4-Position baby carriers have 
been  recognized  by  the  International  Hip  Dysplasia  Institute  as  being  “hip  healthy”. Additional  accessories  are  provided  to 
complement the baby carriers including the popular Infant Insert.

Within the Ergobaby Baby Carrier product line, Ergo sells 3-Position and 4-Position baby carriers in a variety of style and color 
variations and Baby Tula sells 3-Position, Standard, Toddler and Wrap Conversion fashion-oriented baby carriers.  Baby Carrier 
sales were approximately $84.0 million, $68.6 million and $63.1 million in the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015, and 2014, 
respectively, and represented approximately 81%, 79% and 77%, of total sales in 2016, 2015, and 2014, respectively.

Within the baby carrier accessories category, the Infant Insert is the largest sales component of the accessory category, representing 
more than half of total accessory sales for 2016, 2015, and 2014. Accessory sales were $10.5 million, $9.1 million, and $8.7 
million, in 2016, 2015, and 2014, respectively and represented approximately 10% in 2016, 11% in 2015 and 11% in 2014, of 
total sales.

Ergobaby’s core Baby Carrier product offerings with average retail prices are summarized below:

Ergo
• 
• 

Tula 
• 
• 

4 styles of baby carriers - $115 - $195
3 styles of Infant Inserts - $25 - $38

3 styles of baby carriers - $149 - $900
1 styles of Infant Inserts - $40

Competitive Strengths

Ergobaby  innovation  -  Ergobaby  Carriers  are  known  for  their  unsurpassed  comfort.    Ergobaby’s  superior  design  results  in 
improved comfort for both parent and baby. Parents are comfortable because baby’s weight is evenly distributed between the hips 
and shoulders while baby sits ergonomically in a natural sitting position. The concept of baby carrying has increased in popularity 
in the U.S. as parents recognize the emotional and functional benefits of carrying their baby. Consumers continually cite the 
comfort, design, and convenient “hands free” mobility the Ergobaby carrier offers as key purchasing criteria.  Ergobaby is also 
recognized as an industry leader in innovation.  With the relatively recent launch of the Ergo Four Position 360 Carrier in 2014 
and the launch of the Three Position ADAPT carrier in 2016, Ergobaby continues to innovate in the baby carrier segment on a 
regular basis.

Baby Tula Community - Tula enjoys an active and enthusiastic community who are vocal advocates for the brand.  The Tula 
community acts as both an avid source of feedback on new product launches, which influence future product and patterns, as well 
as brand influencers to the broader new parenting community.

Business Strategies

Increase Penetration of Current U.S. Distribution Channels - Ergobaby continues to benefit from steady expansion of the 
market for wearable baby carriers and related accessories in the U.S. and internationally.  Going forward, Ergobaby will continue 
to leverage and expand the awareness of its outstanding brands (both Ergobaby and Baby Tula) in order to capture additional 
market share in the U.S., as parents increasingly recognize the enhanced mobility, convenience, and the ability to remain close to 
the child that all Ergobaby carriers enable. Ergobaby currently markets its products to consumers in the U.S. through brick-and-
mortar retailers, national chain stores; online retailers; and directly through Ergobaby.com and Babytula.com websites. 

International Market Expansion - Testimony to the global strength of its lifestyle brand, Ergobaby derives approximately 56% 
of its sales from international markets. Like it has in the U.S., Ergobaby can continue to leverage the Ergo and Tula brand equity 
in the international markets it currently serves to aggressively drive future growth, as well as expand its international presence 
into new regions. The market for Ergobaby’s products abroad continues to grow rapidly, in part due to the growth in the number 

20

of births worldwide and the fact that in many parts of Europe and Asia, the concept of baby wearing is a culturally entrenched 
form of infant and child transport.

New Product Development - Management believes Ergobaby has an opportunity to leverage its unique, authentic lifestyle brands 
and expand its product line. Since its founding in 2003, Ergobaby has successfully introduced new carrier products to maintain 
innovation, uniqueness, and freshness within its baby carrier and travel system product lines. In addition to expanding into new 
product carriers like swaddling and nursing pillows, Ergobaby has become the baby carrier industry leader with the launch of the 
4-Position 360 baby carrier and looks to continue its leadership position with new product launches in 2017.

Customers and Distribution Channels

Ergobaby primarily sells its products through brick-and-mortar retailers, national chain stores, online retailers and distributors and 
derives approximately 56% of its sales from outside of the U.S. In Europe, Ergobaby products are sold through its German based 
subsidiary, which services brick-and-mortar retailers and online retailers in Germany and France; it’s United Kingdom based 
subsidiary;  and  its  Tula  subsidiary  in  Poland;  as  well  as  a  network  of  distributors  located  in  Finland,  Russia,  Belgium,  the 
Netherlands, Sweden, Norway, Spain, Denmark, Italy, Turkey and the Ukraine. Customers in Canada are predominately serviced 
by Ergobaby’s Canadian subsidiary.  Sales to customers outside of the U.S. and European markets are predominantly serviced 
through distributors granted rights, though not necessarily exclusive, to sell within a specific geographic region.

Sales and Marketing

Within the U.S., Ergobaby directly employ sales professionals and utilizes independent sales representatives assigned to differing 
U.S. territories managed by in-house sales professionals. Independent salespeople in the U.S. are paid on a commission basis 
based on customer type and sales territory.  In Europe, Ergobaby directly employs its salespeople and salespeople are paid a base 
salary and a commission on their sales, which is standard in that territory.

Ergobaby  has  implemented  a  multi-faceted  marketing  plan  which  includes  (i) online  marketing  efforts,  including  online 
advertisement, search engine optimization and social networking efforts; (ii) increasing tradeshow attendance at consumer and 
medical professional shows; and (iii) increasing promotional activities.

Ergobaby had approximately $12.8 million and $15.1 million in firm backlog orders at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Competition

The infant and juvenile products market is fragmented, with a few larger manufacturers and marketers with portfolios of brands 
and a multitude of smaller, private companies with relatively targeted product offerings.

Within the infant and juvenile products market, Ergobaby’s baby carriers primarily compete with companies that market wearable 
baby carriers. Within the wearable baby carrier market, several distinct segments exist, including (i) slings and wraps; (ii) soft-
structured baby carriers; and (iii) hard frame baby carriers.

The primary global competitors in this segment are Baby Bjorn, Chicco, Britax and Manduca, which also market products in the 
premium price range. Especially in the U.S., Ergobaby brands also compete with several smaller companies that have developed 
wearable carriers, such as Beco, Boba, and LilleBaby. Within the soft-structured baby carrier segment, Ergobaby benefits from 
strong distribution, good word of mouth, and the functionality of the design.

Suppliers

During 2016, Ergobaby sourced its Ergo carrier and carrier accessory products from Vietnam and India, and manufactured its 
stroller systems and accessory products in China.  Baby Tula products predominantly were produced from factories in Mexico, 
Poland and Turkey and were also produced in its own facility located in Poland.  In 2012, Ergobaby began sourcing carriers and 
accessories from a manufacturing facility in Vietnam.  Vietnam accounted for approximately 63% of Ergobaby’s purchases in 
2016.  Ergobaby partnered with a manufacturer located in India in 2009, which manufactures Ergobaby’s carriers and accessories, 
and represented approximately 18% of Ergobaby’s purchases in 2016.  The Orbit Baby stroller systems and accessories were 
manufactured in China and purchases from its primary China based manufacturing facility accounted for approximately 7% of 
Ergobaby purchases.  Baby Tula sourced its carrier and accessory and blanket products from Mexico, Poland and Turkey, purchases 
from these three locations accounted for approximately 11% of Ergobaby purchases.  Management believes its manufacturing 
partners have the additional capacity to accommodate Ergobaby’s projected growth.

21

Intellectual Property

Ergobaby maintains and defends a U.S. and international patent portfolio on some of its various products, including its 3-position 
and 4-position carriers.  Currently, it has 11 patents (including allowances) and 21 patents pending in the U.S. and other countries.  
Ergobaby also depends on brand name recognition and premium product offering to differentiate itself from competition.

Regulatory Environment

Management is not aware of any existing, pending, or contingent liabilities that could have a material adverse effect on Ergobaby’s 
business. Ergobaby is proactive regarding regulatory issues and is in compliance with all relevant regulations. Ergobaby maintains 
adequate product liability insurance coverage and to date has not incurred any losses. Management is not aware of any potential 
environmental issues.

Employees

As of December 31, 2016, Ergobaby employed 203 persons in 9 locations.  None of Ergobaby’s employees are subject to collective 
bargaining agreements. We believe that Ergobaby’s relationship with its employees is good.

Liberty Safe

Overview

Liberty Safe, headquartered in Payson, Utah and founded in 1988, is the premier designer, manufacturer, and marketer of home, 
gun and office safes in North America. From its over 314,000 square foot manufacturing facility, Liberty Safe produces a wide 
range of home, office and gun safe models in a broad assortment of sizes, features and styles ranging from an entry level product 
to good, better and best products. Products are marketed under the Liberty Safe brand, as well as a portfolio of licensed and private 
label brands, including including Cabela’s, Case IH, and John Deere. Liberty Safe’s products are the market share leader and are 
sold through an independent dealer network (“Dealer sales”) in addition to various sporting goods, farm and fleet, and home 
improvement retail outlets (“Non-Dealer sales” or “National sales”). Liberty Safe has the largest independent dealer network in 
the industry.

Historically, approximately 55% of Liberty Safe’s net sales are Non-Dealer sales and 45% are Dealer sales.

For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, Liberty Safe had net sales of approximately $103.8 million, $101.1 
million and $90.1 million, respectively, and operating income of $13.2 million and $11.9 million for the years ended December 
31, 2016 and 2015, respectively, and an operating loss of $2.7 million in 2014.  Liberty Safe had total assets of $72.1 million and 
$77.1 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.  Net sales from Liberty Safe represented 10.6%, 13.9% and 14.2% 
of our consolidated net sales for the year ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

History of Liberty Safe

The Liberty Safe brand and its leading market share has been built over a 28 year history of superior product quality, engineering 
and design innovation, and leading customer service and sales support. Liberty Safe has a long history of continuous improvement 
and innovative approaches to sales and marketing, product development and manufacturing processes. Significant investments 
over the last five years have solidified Liberty Safe’s reputation for providing substantial value to retailers and enhanced its long-
standing position as the leading producer of premium home, office and gun safes.

Liberty Safe commenced operations in 1988 and throughout 1991 and 1992, increased its distribution capabilities, establishing a 
regional  sales  force  model  to  better  serve  the  Dealer  channel.  This  expanded  sales  coverage  gave  Liberty  Safe  the  needed 
organizational structure to provide ready support and products nationwide, helping to establish its reputation for service to its 
customers. On the strength of its growing reputation and national sales presence, Liberty Safe achieved the status of the #1 selling 
safe company in America in 1994, according to Sargent and Greenleaf data, the major lock supplier to the industry, a position that 
it has maintained to this day. In 2001, Liberty Safe opened its current state-of-the-art facility in Payson, Utah and consolidated all 
of its manufacturing and distribution operations to a centralized location. As the only facility in the industry utilizing significant 
automation and a streamlined roll-form manufacturing process, it represented a significant step forward when compared to the 
production capabilities of its competitors. Incremental investments following the consolidation have solidified Liberty Safe’s 
position as the preeminent low-cost and most efficient domestic manufacturer.

22

Beginning in 2007, Liberty Safe reorganized its manufacturing process, retooled its product line for increased standardization 
throughout the production process and realigned employee incentives to increase labor efficiency. These improvements enabled 
Liberty Safe to shift from build-to-stock production to build-to-order with shorter lead time requirements, greater labor efficiency 
and reduced working capital.

During 2011, Liberty Safe constructed a new production line that has allowed Liberty to build entry level safe products in-house. 
This production line produces home and gun safe models that were previously completely sourced through foreign manufacturers. 
The production line began operations in February 2012 and Liberty is currently manufacturing three different sizes of safes on 
this line which translates into several new SKUs. Liberty invested over $9.0 million to build the line. This investment in production 
capacity now makes Liberty Safe the largest manufacturer of home, office and gun safes in the world. This added investment in 
capacity in the U.S. will allow Liberty Safe to provide shorter lead times and more competitive pricing to its North American 
customer base. This will allow Liberty Safe to capture additional market share, growing its revenue base and adding more margin 
dollars to the bottom line. 

We purchased a majority interest in Liberty Safe on March 31, 2010.

Industry

Liberty Safe competes in the broadly defined North American safe industry which includes fire and document safes, media and 
data safes, depository safes, gun safes and cabinets, home safes and hotel safes. According to Global Industry Analysts, (“GIA”) 
March 2008 report, the global safe industry was estimated to be approximately $2.9 billion of wholesale sales in 2008, and grew 
consistently at an estimated CAGR of 4.3% from 2000 to 2009.  Consistent growth has been one of the defining characteristics 
of this industry.  The safe industry experienced a boom and bust cycle in 2013 and 2014 as a result of the threat of increased 
legislation regulating gun ownership prompting significant demand in 2013.  The significant increase in demand experienced in 
2013 subsided in 2014 as retail chains overbought inventory in late 2013, resulting in depressed sales throughout 2014 for gun 
safe manufacturers.  The industry saw a return to normalized sales levels during 2015.

Products and Services

Liberty Safe offers home, office and gun safes with retail prices ranging from $400 to $8,000.  Liberty Safe produces 32 home 
and gun safe models with the most varied assortment of sizes, feature upgrades, accessories and styling options in the industry. 
Liberty Safe’s premium home and gun safe product line covers sizes from 12 cu. ft. to 50 cu. ft. with smaller sizes available for 
its personal home safe.  Liberty Safe markets its products under Company-owned brands and a portfolio of licensed and private 
label brands, including Case IH, Cabela’s, John Deere and others.  Liberty Safe also sells commercial safes, vault doors, handgun 
vaults, and a number of accessories and options. The overwhelming majority of revenue is derived from the sales of safes.

Competitive Strengths

#1 Premium Home and Gun Safe Brand with Strong Momentum in the Market - Liberty Safe achieved the status of #1 selling 
safe company in America in 1994 (per statistics provided by Sargent & Greenleaf, the primary lock supplier to the industry) and 
maintains this prominent position today.  Liberty Safe continues to gain market share from the various smaller participants who 
lack the distribution and sales and marketing capabilities of Liberty Safe. 

State-of-the-Art and Scalable Operations - Over the past five years, management has constructed a highly scalable operational 
platform and infrastructure that has positioned Liberty Safe for substantial sales growth and enhanced profitability in the coming 
years.  Liberty  Safe  transitioned  itself  from  a  manufacturing  oriented  operating  culture  to  a  demand-based,  sales-oriented 
organization. Its strategic transition required the implementation of a demand-based sales and operating platform, which included 
(i) new equipment to drive automation and capacity improvements; (ii) re-engineered product lines and production processes to 
drive efficiency through greater standardization in production; and (iii) new employee incentives tied to labor efficiency, which 
has improved worker performance as well as employee attitude. These initiatives are enhanced by an experienced senior executive 
team, a balanced sourcing and in-house manufacturing production strategy, advanced distribution capabilities and sophisticated 
IT systems. Liberty has combined its demand-based sales and operating initiatives with upgraded production equipment to drive 
multiple operational improvements. Since 2007, Liberty has reduced its lead times from 4 - 6 weeks to approximately twenty-one 
days or less. These shorter production cycles coupled with better demand forecasting have significantly reduced working capital 
needs for the business. During 2013, lead times actually increased due to a significant spike in demand for safes from its customers. 
That demand spike subsided towards the end of fiscal 2013 where again, shorter lead times were experienced. Improved automation 
and workflow organization have decreased labor hours from 8.2 in 2005 to 7.7 in 2016 for rolled steel safes. For the new production 
line built in 2011, the average labor hours per safe is 2.4.  These recent initiatives combined with Liberty’s cumulative historical 

23

investments in operational capabilities have created a lasting competitive advantage over its smaller competitors, who utilize labor-
intensive operations and lack the company’s lean manufacturing culture.

Historically, Liberty Safe maintained an optimal mix of in-house and Asian-sourced manufacturing in order to improve its ability 
to meet customer inventory needs. Beginning in 2012, Liberty Safe began manufacturing entry level safes that were previously 
completely sourced from an Asian manufacturer, on its new production line.  In 2013, the market enjoyed unprecedented heightened 
demand related to gun sales resulting from threats of additional gun legislation. This caused Liberty Safe to reinstitute its import 
channel of safes. In 2014, approximately 84% of safes were made in the United States while the balance came from imported 
product. This was necessary as demand exceeded Liberty’s manufacturing capacity in 2013.  As a result of the boom and bust 
cycle experienced by Liberty, and the return to more normalized levels of demand, Liberty canceled most of its import channel 
of safes during the second half of 2014.  In 2016, only about 3% of safes sold by Liberty were sourced in Asia.

For the past ten years, Liberty Safe has leased a manufacturing and distribution facility in Payson, Utah that management believes 
represents  the  most  scalable  domestic  facility  in  the  industry.  Liberty  Safe’s  multi-faceted  production  capabilities  allow  for 
substantial flexibility and scalable capacity, thus assuring a level of supply chain execution far superior to any of its competitors.

Reputation for High Quality Products - Liberty Safe offers only the highest quality products on a consistent basis, which over 
the years has gained it an enviable reputation and a key point of differentiation from its competitors. Liberty Safe distinguishes 
its products through tested security and fire protection features and industry leading design focused on functionality and aesthetics. 
The design of its safes meet rigorous internal benchmarks for security and fire protection, with most receiving certification from 
Underwriters Laboratory, Inc. (“UL”), the leading product safety standard certification, for its security capabilities. Additionally, 
Liberty Safe’s investment in accessories and feature options have made Liberty safes the most visually appealing and functional 
in the industry, while providing more customized solutions for retailers and consumers. 

Trusted Supplier to National Retailer and Dealer Accounts - Liberty Safe’s comprehensive, high-quality product offering and 
sophisticated sales and marketing programs have made it a critical supplier to a diverse group of national accounts and dealers. 
Initially a key supplier primarily to the dealer channel, it has expanded its business with national accounts, such as Gander Mountain, 
Cabela’s and John Deere. Liberty Safe provides a superior value proposition as a supplier for its national retailers and dealers via 
its well-recognized brands, lifetime product warranty, tailored merchandising, category management solutions and superior supply 
chain execution. Further, Liberty Safe’s products generate more profitable floor-space, with both high absolute gross profit and 
retail margins over 30%. High retail profitability plus increased inventory turns has entrenched Liberty Safe as a key partner in 
customers’ success in the safe category. As a core element of building its relationships, Liberty Safe has invested significantly in 
making  its  retailers  better  salespeople  through  a  proprietary  suite  of  training  tools,  including  in-store  training,  new  product 
demonstrations, online education programs and sales strategy literature.

Business Strategies

Liberty Safe has experienced strong historical growth while executing on multiple new sales and operational initiatives, positioning 
it to continue to increase its scale and improve profitability. Liberty’s growth strategy is rooted in the sales and marketing and 
operational initiatives that have spurred its expansion into new accounts and increased penetration of existing accounts. Liberty 
has significant opportunity in its existing channels to continue to build upon its already strong market share. In addition to growth 
within its current channels, Liberty’s core competencies can be successfully applied to ventures in the broader security equipment 
market. Liberty has explored certain of these opportunities, but due to the prioritization of operational initiatives and expansion 
opportunities within existing channels, they have not been aggressively pursued. Potential near-to-medium term areas for expansion 
of Liberty’s platform include:

•  Expand Liberty’s product line into the broader home and office safe market through current customers or new distribution 

• 

strategies;
Further develop international distribution by entering new countries and expanding current limited presence in Canada, 
Mexico and Europe;

•  Enter the residential security market through a strategic partnership with a provider of residential security service solutions 

to provide a more complete physical and electronic security solution; 

•  Acquire businesses within the premium home and gun safe industry and/or leverage Liberty’s platform into new products 

or channels; and

•  Offer additional accessory products to existing distribution networks.

24

Research and Development

Liberty Safe is the engineering and design leader in its sector, due to a history of first-to-market features and standard-setting 
design improvements. Liberty’s proactive solicitation of feedback and constant interaction with consumers and retail customers 
across diverse channels and geographies enables Liberty Safe to stay at the forefront of customer demands. Liberty’s approach to 
product development increases the likelihood of market acceptance by creating products that are more relevant to consumers’ 
demands. Research and development costs were $0.3 million in 2016, $0.6 million in 2015, and $1.0 million in 2014.

The below charts represents some of the recent innovations in product design (and functionality) that have come about from 
Liberty’s dedication to R&D:

Product
Cool Pocket ™
Integrated lighting system
New Palusol Heat activated door seal
Liberty Tough Doors
Marble gloss powder coat paint
4 in 1 Flex storage system
Door panels
Magnetic magazine mount
Bright view wand light kit
Bow hanger
Safe Alert sensor

Function/Benefit

Keeps documents 50% cooler than rest of safe
Automatic on/off interior lights
Seal expands seven times its size in fire
Enhanced protection against side bolt prying
Provides smooth glass finish
Adjustable shelving configurations
Pocket variety to store handguns and other items
Ammunition storage that adhere to any surface
Provides better lighting solution
Allows bow to hang in safe
Monitors and alerts owners of temperatures inside the safe

In addition to product enhancements, new products, such the plate-door National Security Classic, and a new, 6-SKU line of 
handgun vaults were launched in 2015 from Liberty’s commitment to R&D.  In 2016,  Liberty introduced a new 3-section “Extreme” 
interior design, new safe covers, new handgun vault designs, a couple of new safe sizes, and a few other new products.

Based on consumer feedback, Liberty saw demand for safes that were capable of holding more valuables within the safe but at a 
lower price point than Liberty’s current large safe models. Within 3 months of conception, Liberty introduced the successful 
Fatboy® series in February 2010. The Fatboy® and Fatboy Jr.® models, which are wider and deeper than traditional safes, were a 
natural complement to Liberty’s current products, targeted at a specific customer need. The introduction and success of the Fatboy® 
series demonstrates Liberty’s proven ability to recognize market opportunities, engineer a responsive product and execute market 
delivery. Beginning in 2012, Liberty Safe introduced five new SKUs, manufactured on its new production line, with a unique 
locking system to service the entry level safe market. 

Customers and Distribution Channels

Liberty Safe has fostered long-term relationships with leading national retailers (National or Non-Dealer) as well as numerous 
Dealers, enabling Liberty Safe to achieve considerable brand awareness and channel exposure.  Through significant investment 
in  its  national  accounts  sales  and  marketing  efforts,  Liberty  Safe  has  also  become  the  leading  supplier  to  National  accounts. 
Expansion into National accounts is part of Liberty Safe’s strategy to reach a broader customer base and more varied demographics.  
National account customers include sporting goods retailers, farm and fleet retailers, and home improvement retailers.  As of 
December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, Liberty Safe had 13, 15 and 14 Non-Dealer account customers, respectively, that are estimated 
to have accounted for approximately 50%, 55% and 56% of net sales, respectively.

Dealer customers include local hunting and fishing stores, hardware stores and numerous other local, independent store models. 
As of December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, there were 392, 356 and 321 Dealers that accounted for 50%, 45% and 44% of net 
sales, respectively.

Liberty Safe’s two largest customers accounted for approximately 36.5%, 37.1% and 30.0% of net sales in 2016, 2015 and 2014, 
respectively.

Seasonality

Liberty Safe typically experiences its lowest earnings in the second quarter due to lower demand for safes at the onset of summer.

25

Sales and Marketing

Liberty Safe possesses robust sales and marketing capabilities in the safe industry. Liberty Safe utilizes separate sales teams for 
National  accounts  and  Dealers,  which  enables  it  to  provide  more  focused  and  effective  strategies  to  manage  and  develop 
relationships within different channels. Liberty Safe has made significant recent investments in the development of a comprehensive 
sales and marketing program including merchandising, sales training and tools, promotions and supply chain management. Through 
these various initiatives, Liberty Safe offers highly adaptable programs to suit the varying needs of its retailers. This has enabled 
Liberty Safe to become a key supplier across diverse channels. Liberty Safe began advertising nationally on the Glenn Beck radio 
show in the second half of 2010. This advertising has been highly successful and Liberty has continued this advertising in each 
of the following years and intends on continuing this advertisement in the future.  Liberty also began advertising nationally with 
Sean Hannity during the last few months of 2016, and will continue that campaign throughout 2017.

Liberty Safe’s comprehensive service offering makes it uniquely suited to service national retailers in a variety of channels. Liberty 
Safe  has  designed  a  Store-within-a-Store  program  and  a  more  comprehensive  Safe  Category  Management  program  to  build 
relationships and increase its importance to retailers. Primarily utilized with sporting goods retailers, the Store-within-a-Store 
concept successfully integrates the effective sales strategies of its dealers for selling a high-price point, niche product into a larger 
store format. Centered on communicating the benefits of its products to customers, the program enables retailers to more effectively 
up-sell  customers  through  a  good-better-best  merchandising  platform,  increasing  margin  and  inventory  turns  for  its  retailers. 
Liberty’s Safe Category Management program builds on the Store-within-a-Store concept to provide greater sales and marketing 
control and more complete inventory management solutions. This program facilitates Liberty Safe becoming the sole supplier to 
retailers,  providing  large  incremental  expansion  and  stronger  relationships  at  accounts.  No  other  market  participant  has  the 
capabilities to provide a comprehensive suite of customer service solutions to national retailers, such as customized SKU programs, 
a Store-within-a-Store program and a Safe Category Management program. 

Competition

Liberty Safe is the premier brand in the premium home and gun safe industry, with an estimated 34% market share in the category. 
Liberty is in a class by itself when it comes to manufacturing technology and efficiency and supply chain capabilities. Competitors 
are generally more heavily focused on either smaller, sourced safes or large, domestically produced safes. Competitive domestic 
manufacturers run “blacksmith” type factories that are small, inefficient and require a tremendous amount of manual labor that 
produces inconsistent product. In addition, many of Liberty’s competitors are directly tied to a third-party brand, such as Browning, 
Winchester or RedHead / Bass Pro.

Liberty  competes  with  other  safe  manufacturers  based  on  price,  breadth  of  product  line,  technology,  product  supply  chain 
capabilities and marketing capabilities.

Channel diversity in the premium home and gun safe industry is rare, with most companies having greater concentration in either 
the dealer channel or national accounts, but rarely having the supply chain capabilities or sales and marketing programs to service 
both channels effectively such as Liberty Safe does. Major competitors have limited sales and marketing departments and programs, 
making it difficult for them to expand sales and gain market share.

Suppliers

Liberty’s primary raw materials are steel, sheetrock, wood, locks, handles and fabric, for which it receives multiple shipments per 
week. Materials, on average, account for approximately 60% of the total cost of a safe, with steel accounting for approximately 
40% of material costs. Liberty purchases its materials from a combination of domestic and foreign suppliers.  Historically, Liberty 
Safe has been able to pass on raw material price increases to its customers.

Liberty purchased approximately 29 million pounds of steel in 2016 primarily from domestic suppliers, using contracts that lock 
in prices two fiscal quarters in advance. Liberty Safe purchases coiled and flat steel in gauges from four to fourteen. Liberty Safe 
specifies rigorous requirements related to surface and edge finish and grain direction.  All steel products are checked to ASTM 
specification and dimensional tolerances before entering the production process.

Liberty Safe had approximately $8.4 million and $7.1 million in firm backlog orders at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Intellectual Property

Liberty Safe relies upon a combination of patents and trademarks in order to secure and protect its intellectual property rights.  
Liberty Safe currently owns 32 trademarks and 4 patents on proprietary technologies for safe products.

26

Regulatory Environment

Liberty Safe's management believes that Liberty Safe is in compliance with applicable environmental and occupational health and 
safety laws and regulations. Liberty Safe has recently moved to a powder paint application in order to reduce hazardous VOC 
emissions.

Employees

As of December 31, 2016, Liberty Safe had 322 full-time employees and 139 temporary employees. Liberty’s labor force is non-
union. Management believes that Liberty Safe has an excellent relationship with its employees.

Manitoba Harvest

Overview

Headquartered in Winnipeg, Manitoba, Manitoba Harvest is a pioneer and leader in branded, hemp-based foods.  Manitoba Harvest’s 
products,  which  Management  believes  are  among  the  fastest  growing  in  the  natural  foods  industry,  are  currently  carried  in 
approximately 13,000 retail stores across the United States and Canada.  Manitoba Harvest’s hemp-exclusive, all natural product 
lineup  includes  hemp  hearts,  protein  powder,  hemp  oil  and  snacks.   As  the  world’s  largest  vertically-integrated  hemp  food 
manufacturer, Manitoba Harvest is involved in every aspect of the hemp production process, from “seed-to-shelf.”  All of Manitoba 
Harvest’s products are an excellent source of plant-based protein and essential fatty acids, including omega-3, gamma-linolenic 
acid and stearidonic acid.  The hemp-based food market is rapidly growing as consumers become aware of the unique combination 
of great taste and nutritional benefits of hemp-based foods. We purchased a majority interest in Manitoba Harvest on July 10, 
2015.  

On December 15, 2015, Manitoba Harvest acquired all of the outstanding stock of Hemp Oil Canada Inc. (“HOCI”).  HOCI is a 
wholesale supplier and a private label packager of hemp food products and ingredients.  

For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015 (from the date of acquisition), Manitoba Harvest had net 
sales of $59.3 million (C$79.9 million) and $17.4 million (C$23.1 million), respectively, and operating income of $0.3 million
(C$0.4 million) in 2016, and an operating loss of $0.3 million (C$8.2 million) in 2015.  Manitoba Harvest had total assets of 
$148.4 million (C$200.8 million) at December 31, 2016 and $146.7 million (C$205.4 million) at December 31, 2015.  Net sales 
for Manitoba Harvest in 2016 represented 6.1% of our consolidated net sales.  Net sales for Manitoba Harvest (from the date of 
acquisition to December 31, 2015) represented 2.4% of our consolidated net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015.  In 2016, 
approximately 53% of Manitoba Harvest's gross sales were to customers in the United Sates and approximately 36% of gross sales 
were to customers within Canada.  The remaining 11% of gross sales were primarily to customers in Korea and Japan.

History of Manitoba Harvest

Founded in 1998 following the legalization of industrial hemp production in Canada, Manitoba Harvest has been an industry leader 
in the manufacture of the highest quality hemp food products while educating people on hemp nutrition.  Manitoba Harvest initially 
sold the company’s raw hemp seed and oil products in natural food stores with distribution and marketing efforts focused on 
promotion of consumer acceptance of hemp seeds as a food product.  In 2001, Manitoba Harvest began selling their products at 
Whole Foods and Loblaws, one of Canada’s largest supermarket chains, which allowed for expansion beyond natural food stores.  
As hemp food products continued to gain mainstream acceptance, Manitoba Harvest launched additional hemp-based products, 
including a hemp protein powder line, a hemp smoothie line and hemp based snacks.  Manitoba Harvest’s facility in Winnipeg 
achieved organic certification in 2004 and non-GMO verification in 2009.  Manitoba Harvest has the highest level of global 
certification in food safety and quality and is the first and only hemp-based food company to achieve British Retail Consortium 
Global Food Safety Initiative (“GFSI”) certification.  Leveraging its proven innovation capabilities and position as an industry 
leader,  Manitoba  Harvest  is  currently  introducing  new  product  formats  with  broad  appeal,  and  expanding  its  retail  channels, 
particularly grocery channels, to capitalize on strong demand from existing customers and to broaden its appeal to reach mainstream 
consumers.  With the acquisition of HOCI, Manitoba Harvest has added a leading manufacturer and supplier of hemp food products 
and ingredients for a global customer base.

Industry

Hemp is the distinct oilseed and fiber varieties of the plant species Cannabis sativa L., a tall fibrous plant that has been cultivated 
worldwide for more than 10,000 years.  The hemp crop was introduced to North American in the early 1600s, and it played an 
integral part in North America’s early history as it was used as a material for various products including riggings and sails on naval 

27

ships, paper and fuel oil.  Hemp is versatile, with diverse uses from food products to clothing, building materials, fuel and various 
other applications.  As a food product, hemp is packed with essential nutrients such as protein, healthy fats, fiber, magnesium and 
all 10 essential amino acids.  

As a crop, hemp is a low impact and environmentally sustainable resource that can be grown without pesticides or agricultural 
chemicals.  Hemp is beneficial to the agricultural supply chain, aiding in weed suppression and soil building, making it a favored 
rotation crop.  Hemp comes from the Cannabis sativa L. subspecies sativa, which is a different subspecies from that grown to 
produce marijuana, subspecies indica.  Hemp contains 0.001% Tetrahydrocannabinol (“THC”).  Although it is completely legal 
to further process and consume hemp-based food products in the U.S., it is currently illegal to cultivate hemp or process live seeds.  
As a result, U.S. marketers of hemp based products must import 100% of the hemp seed, oil and fiber that they need.  However, 
the regulatory environment in the U.S. is slowly changing.  The U.S. Agriculture Act of 2014 defined industrial hemp as distinct 
from marijuana and authorized institutions of higher learning and state agriculture departments to grow industrial hemp for research 
and agricultural pilot programs.  As a result, certain states that have legalized hemp cultivation have begun to authorize farmers 
to plant and grow hemp for experimental purposes.  

In Canada, the commercial cultivation of hemp was authorized in 1998 with the implementation of the Canadian Industrial Hemp 
Regulations,  which  governs  the  cultivation,  processing,  transportation,  sale,  import  and  export  of  industrial  hemp.    Since  its 
legalization, hemp has garnered significant interest among Canadian farmers and the Canadian government has supported the 
industry through market development funding and a favorable regulatory environment.  The Canadian agricultural industry views 
hemp as a valuable alternative crop that complements prairie crop production rotations and offers significant economic opportunity 
due to its numerous end uses.

Hemp-based foods are considered a superfood that are rich in healthy fats and other important minerals; furthermore, hemp seeds 
are an excellent dietary source of easily digestible plant based protein.  The unique nutritional profile of hemp foods appeals to a 
broad base of modern diets, ranging from paleo to vegetarian diets.  Manitoba Harvest broadly competes in the Nuts & Seeds and 
Protein Powder categories, which Nielsen estimates to be $4.4 billion and $540 million at retail, respectively.  The Hemp Industries 
Association estimates that retail sales of hemp food and body care products in the United States totaled $283 million in 2015.  

Products 

Manitoba Harvest is a global leader in branded, hemp-based foods.  The Company’s products are the fastest growing products in 
the  hemp  food  market  and  among  the  fastest  growing  in  the  entire  natural  foods  industry.   The  Company’s  hemp-exclusive, 
consumer-facing 100% all-natural product lineup includes Hemp Hearts, protein powder, and snacks.  HOCI processes natural 
and organic hemp seed which are sold as hulled seed, hemp oil, hemp protein, toasted hemp seed and coarse hemp powder.

Hemp Hearts - Hemp Hearts are raw shelled hemp seeds and have a slightly nutty taste, similar to that of a sunflower seed or a 
pine nut.  Hemp Hearts contain 10 grams of plant-based protein and 10 grams of omega essential fatty acids per 30 gram serving.  
Hemp Hearts can be used as a topping for yogurt, salads, cereal, as a component for smoothies and other meals, or eaten directly 
from the package.  Manitoba Harvest offers Hemp Hearts in all-natural and organic varieties through a number of SKUs.  Hemp 
Hearts are all-natural and non-GMO verified.  Hemp Hearts represented approximately 69% of Manitoba Harvest’s gross revenues 
in 2016.

Hemp Protein Powder - Manitoba Harvest offers a variety of plant based proteins that serve a multitude of culinary and dietary 
needs including Hemp Pro 70®, Hemp Pro 50®, Hemp Pro Fiber® and Hemp Protein Smoothie.  Hemp Pro 70® is a hemp protein 
concentrate that is 65% protein by weight and high in omega essential fatty acids.  Hemp Pro 70® is available in several flavors 
including vanilla and chocolate, which were introduced in 2014 as an extension of the protein powder product line.  Hemp Pro 
50® is a raw hemp protein powder that is 50% protein by weight and features a balance of protein and fiber.  Hemp Pro 70 and 
Hemp Pro 50 are plant-based products that are great complements to fruit smoothies, while Hemp Pro Fiber is a great source of 
protein, essential fatty acids and other nutrients that also offers a high amount of fiber per serving.  Hemp Pro Fiber® is raw hemp 
protein powder, but also offers 52% of the daily recommended fiber intake.   Hemp Pro Fiber is a versatile product that can be 
blended into smoothies, added to yogurt and hot cereal, or incorporated into baking products. Hemp Protein Smoothie was launched 
in 2015 and is a plant-based nutritional powder that includes 15 grams of protein and 2.6 grams of omega essential fatty acids per 
30 gram serving, and is designed to mix easily into smoothies and other drinks.   Manitoba Harvest offers hemp protein products 
in all-natural and organic varieties, and all protein powders are  non-GMO verified.   Hemp protein powders represent approximately 
17% of Manitoba Harvest’s gross revenue in 2016.

Hemp Snacks and Other Products - During 2015, Manitoba Harvest expanded their product lines with the introduction of Hemp 
Heart Bites, a convenient, bite sized crunchy snack product, and Hemp Heart Bars, which Manitoba Harvest believes will appeal 

28

to the mainstream consumer by featuring a simple and clean ingredient list that contains 10.5 grams of plant based protein and 10 
grams of omega essential fatty acids per 45 gram serving.  These products were launched in response to demand from existing 
consumers for a convenient, hemp-based food product.  Manitoba Harvest’s other products include Hemp Oil, in both liquid and 
soft-gel formats, and Hemp Bliss, an organic non-dairy beverage.  Hemp oil is a cold-pressed oil with no preservatives or artificial 
colors and is commonly used as a low heat culinary oil or as an ingredient in dressings or sauces.  Hemp snacks, Hemp oil and 
Hemp Bliss comprised approximately 14% of Manitoba Harvest's gross revenues in 2016.   

Competitive Strengths

Leading Brand Recognition & Market Share - Manitoba Harvest is an award winning pioneer and the global leader in branded, 
hemp based foods.  Consumer awareness of hemp-based foods and the Manitoba Harvest brand continues to grow rapidly.  Manitoba 
Harvest  has  developed  considerable  brand  equity  with  a  growing,  highly-loyal,  and  very  passionate  consumer  following.  
Consumers tend to be extremely loyal after incorporating Manitoba Harvest’s hemp foods into their lifestyle.  Management believes 
that Manitoba Harvest holds more than 50% of the market share of hemp heart seed sales and hemp protein powder sales in North 
America.

Strong Core Consumer Base - The core consumer demographic for Manitoba Harvest’s products is Naturalites, consumers who 
generally prefer all natural products; and consumers who focus on practicing a lifestyle of health and sustainability (“LOHAS”).  
Among its core consumer base, hemp-based foods have a high level of awareness and Manitoba Harvest possesses a high level 
of brand recognition among this consumer segment.  Consumers tend to be extremely loyal after incorporating Manitoba Harvest’s 
hemp foods into their lifestyle.  Consumers develop a bond with the Manitoba Harvest brand and appreciate that Manitoba Harvest 
seeks to positively impact the community and the environment with its actions.  Manitoba Harvest is a registered B-Corporation.  
As a B-Corporation, Manitoba Harvest is dedicated to creating a general public benefit, which is defined as having a material 
positive impact on society and the environment.  Through its actions, Manitoba Harvest inspires consumers to “live the brand” 
and lead happier and healthier lives.

Vertically-Integrated  Supply  Chain  with  Long-Term  Relationships  with  Suppliers  -  Manitoba  Harvest  enjoys  strong 
relationships with hemp farmers, some dating back to their inception in 1998.  Manitoba Harvest has a rigorous qualification 
process for its suppliers which includes an ongoing supplier scorecard and chooses to purchase hemp seeds from only the highest 
quality growers.  With limited exception, farmers working with Manitoba Harvest are exclusive to them.  In North America, hemp 
is only grown commercially in Canada and Manitoba Harvest accounts for more than 60% of the hemp supply, minimizing risk 
and ensuring quality hemp seeds for their product.  The majority of Canada’s hemp supply outside of Manitoba Harvest’s business 
goes into ingredient and wholesale markets, making Manitoba Harvest the only vertically-integrated, branded hemp-based food 
company in North America.  

Business Strategies

Manitoba Harvest’s management believes it is well positioned for continued topline growth.  As consumer awareness of and 
demand  for  hemp  based  foods  increases,  Manitoba  Harvest  will  continue  to  leverage  its  market  leadership  and  strong  brand 
awareness to grow through existing customers, broadened distribution, new product launches, and expanded ingredients business.  

Increasing consumer awareness - Manitoba Harvest was founded with the mission to educate consumers on the health and 
environmental benefits of hemp-based food products and has taken a grassroots approach to educating consumers.  Management 
estimates that its team interacts directly with more than 300,000 consumers annually, and distributed approximately two million 
samples to consumers during 2016.  In addition to sampling, Manitoba Harvest is driving consumer awareness through existing 
customer accounts by increasing its investment in in-store displays and product demos, particularly in the United States at retail 
accounts where consumers are less familiar with the benefits of hemp foods.  Additionally, Manitoba Harvest partners with certain 
retailers  to  increase  consumer  awareness.    Manitoba  Harvest  is  a  co-sponsor  of  Hemp  History  Week,  an annual  event 
that features hundreds of product demo’s and promo events in major retailers throughout the U.S., including Whole Foods Market.

Continued growth with existing customers - Manitoba Harvest expects to grow same store sales with existing customers by 
expanding the presence of their products on the shelf throughout stores through the introduction of new formats, improved retail 
product placement and increased investment in merchandising.  Manitoba Harvest also partners with its retail customers to develop 
new, consumer-centric products, such as the 2015 introduction of the hemp protein smoothie at a large Canadian retailer.  In 2016, 
the hemp protein smoothies were expanded into all channels in Canada and in the United States.

Expansion into new customers - Management believes it has significant opportunity to enter new grocery customers in the 
mainstream grocery channel, both in Canada and the United States.  The grocery channels in both the United States and Canada 
have experienced significant sales growth in all-natural and organic product categories while sales in traditional product categories 
29

have been flat or decreased.  Manitoba Harvest recently expanded its direct sales team to improve access and engagement with 
key retail accounts, adding additional brand ambassadors and territory managers for the purpose of expanding distribution with 
mainstream U.S. grocery chains by capitalizing on traditional US grocer emphasis on selling products that align with broad based 
consumer demand for healthy eating.  

Continued  innovation  and  new  product  development  -  In  2016,  the  company  introduced  Hemp  Heart  Toppers,  and  two 
new flavors of Hemp Heart Bites.  Additionally, a new portable, single serve format was introduced for Hemp Protein Smoothie 
and Hemp Heart Bites.  Management plans to continue to innovate on existing product lines through new formats and flavors as 
well as continued development of new product categories to broaden customer appeal and increase the number of hemp food usage 
occasions.

Expanded ingredient business - With the acquisition of HOCI in December 2015, Manitoba Harvest added a leading manufacturer 
and supplier of hemp food products and ingredients.  As hemp-based food usage continues to become more widely adopted, 
management believes the strategic acquisition of HOCI has positioned the company to capitalize on the growing opportunity to 
be the ingredient supplier of choice to other leading food manufacturers in complementary food product categories. 

Research and Development

Manitoba Harvest competes in the natural products industry, which is characterized by research and development and which yields 
food product innovations that contribute to human wellness and sustainable development.   The scope of research and development 
is focused on new product development, product enhancement, process design and improvement, packaging, and meeting the 
needs of the expanding international business.  The continued growth of Manitoba Harvest and ongoing partnerships with industry 
and government has enabled the company to fund research with universities to support the expansion of peer reviewed publications 
on the benefits of hemp food products.  Additionally, Management utilizes analytics to manage the evolution of its relationships 
with its customers, and conducts consumer research during early stages of new product development initiatives in order to identify 
key success factors.  Manitoba Harvest spent approximately $0.3 million on research and development in 2016, and $0.1 million 
on research and development during 2015 (post-acquisition).

Customers and Distributions Channels

Manitoba Harvest sells its products through three primary retail channels: natural foods, club and grocery.  After initially establishing 
the authenticity of its brand and products in the natural channel at retailers such as Whole Foods Markets and Sprouts, Manitoba 
Harvest expanded into the club and grocery channel, initially in Canada, and then in the United States and internationally.  HOCI 
sells their hemp food products and ingredients to value-added manufacturers to be used in hemp cereals, hemp milk, nutrition and 
protein bars and powders, baked goods and salad dressings.

Manitoba Harvest's three largest customers accounted for approximately 47% of total sales in 2016, and approximately 63% of 
total sales during 2015 (post acquisition).   

Sales and Marketing

Manitoba Harvest grows sales within existing retail partners by educating and engaging potential customers through in-store 
demos, consumer events and sampling.

Sales Organization - In addition to partnering with national natural food channel brokers, Manitoba Harvest’s sales organization 
consists of sales professionals with direct sales coverage of over 1,000 retail locations.  The sales force  is led by the Vice President 
of sales and consists of sales managers, territory managers and brand ambassadors dedicated to specific regions in Canada and 
the United States.  Manitoba Harvest’s sales force is focused on the natural, club and grocery channels, through direct key account 
coverage and winning sales through a focus on data for category and customer management.  In addition to direct sales, the 
company uses a network of distributors to service many of its customers.  

Marketing - Manitoba Harvest focuses the majority of marketing spend in three key areas: demonstrations/sampling, fixed trade 
spending and promotions.  Successful product demonstrations within the club and grocery channels have helped drive increased 
sales productivity.  Manitoba Harvest utilizes fixed trade spending to secure end-cap positions, ad space and off-shelf displays at 
various retailers.  Additionally, they strategically utilize promotions to position its products in prime display space at retailers.  To 
drive future growth, Manitoba Harvest plans to increase spending on demonstrations and sampling - for example the company 
distributed approximately two million Hemp Hearts, hemp protein powder, Hemp Heart Bites, and Hemp Heart Bars samples in 
2016 alone.

30

Competition

The emerging hemp foods category has a limited number of participants that offer a minimal number of hemp-based products 
while focusing on a broader assortment of food items.  While increasing, competition remains limited due to restricted raw hemp 
seed access in the United States.  Manitoba Harvest’s strong supplier relationships, regulated access to hemp seeds and deep 
knowledge of the growing and harvesting of hemp afford the company with a unique competitive advantage.  

Manitoba Harvest has the highest level of global certification in food safety and quality and is the first and only hemp-based food 
company to achieve British Retail Consortium (“BRC”) Global Food Safety Initiative certification.   

Suppliers

Manitoba Harvest and HOCI are strategically located near their supply of hemp in Canada, the only North American country 
where it is currently legal to grow hemp.  The commercial cultivation of hemp was authorized in 1998 with the implementation 
of the Canadian Industrial Hemp Regulations, which governs the cultivation, processing, transportation, sale, import and export 
of industrial hemp.  Industrial hemp is viewed by the Canadian and agricultural industry as a valuable new alternative crop that 
complements prairie crop production rotations and offers significant economic opportunity through numerous end uses.  The 
province  of  Manitoba  and  its  surrounding  prairie  area  have  emerged  as  a  leading  region  for  growing  hemp  due  to  the  ideal 
agricultural  characteristics  of  the  prairie  provinces;  a  long  growing  season,  sufficient  moisture  levels,  and  supportive  local 
governments that view hemp as a strategic crop.  The adaptability of hemp makes it ideal for areas of the provinces that have 
limited cropping options and where high value crops such as edible beans and sunflowers are considered high risk.  

Based on its close proximity to many of its growers, Manitoba Harvest has developed long-standing relationships with hemp 
suppliers and currently maintains relationships that provide access to over 60% of the hemp acreage in Canada.   Manitoba Harvest 
has a rigorous qualification process for its suppliers - maintaining an ongoing supplier scorecard and choosing to purchase hemp 
from high quality growers.  With limited exception, farmers working with Manitoba Harvest are exclusive to them.  Manitoba 
Harvest works with approximately 110 conventional hemp growers (48,750 acres), approximately 20 organic growers (18,000 
acres), and 7 hemp seed cleaners.  As early leaders of the hemp legalization movement, Manitoba Harvest’s founders have developed 
in-house expertise on the plant, which they share with their hemp grower partners to help them achieve optimal yield and quality 
harvests.  

Manitoba  Harvest  processes  100%  of  its  Hemp  Hearts,  hemp  oil  and  protein  powder  at  its  dedicated  hemp  food  products 
manufacturing facility.  Manitoba Harvest has leveraged nearly two decades of hemp food manufacturing expertise and has worked 
with research scientists to develop proprietary processing technology that is specific to hemp. Their facility in Winnipeg is 32,000 
square feet and has an annual processing capacity of 35 million pounds of hemp seed.  With the acquisition of HOCI in December 
2015, Manitoba Harvest added a newly constructed 37,000 square foot facility capable of processing 50 million pounds of hemp 
seed.  

Intellectual Property

Manitoba  Harvest  relies  on  brand  name  recognition  and  premium  natural  and  organic  offerings  in  the  hemp  food  market  to 
differentiate itself from the competition.  Manitoba Harvest holds several trademark registrations in multiple jurisdictions, primarily 
the United States and Canada.  

Regulatory Environment

Management is not aware of any existing, pending or contingent liabilities that could have a material adverse effect on Manitoba 
Harvest’s business. Manitoba Harvest is proactive regarding regulatory issues and is in compliance with all relevant regulations. 
Management is not aware of any potential environmental issues.

Employees

As of December 31, 2016, Manitoba Harvest employed approximately 150 persons.  None of Manitoba Harvest  employees are 
subject to collective bargaining agreements. Manitoba Harvest believes its relationship with its employees is good.

31

Niche Industrial Businesses

Advanced Circuits

Overview

Advanced Circuits, headquartered in Aurora, Colorado, is a provider of small-run, quick-turn and production rigid PCBs, throughout 
the United States.  Advanced Circuits also provides its customers with assembly services in order to meet its customers’ complete 
PCB needs. The small-run and quick-turn portions of the PCB industry are characterized by customers requiring high levels of 
responsiveness, technical support and timely delivery. Due to the critical roles that PCBs play in the research and development 
process of electronics, customers often place more emphasis on the turnaround time and quality of a customized PCB than on the 
price. Advanced Circuits meets this market need by manufacturing and delivering custom PCBs in as little as 24 hours, providing 
customers with over 98% error-free production and real-time customer service and product tracking 24 hours per day. In each of 
the years 2016, 2015 and 2014, over 60% of Advanced Circuits’ sales were derived from highly profitable small-run and quick-
turn production PCBs. Advanced Circuits’ success is demonstrated by its broad base of over 11,000 customers with which it does 
business throughout the year.

For the full fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, Advanced Circuits had net sales of approximately $86.0 million, 
$87.5 million and $85.9 million, respectively, and operating income of $22.7 million, $24.1 million and $22.5million, respectively.  
Advanced Circuits had total assets of $80.9 million and $80.6 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. Net sales 
from Advanced Circuits represented 8.8%, 12.0% and 13.5% of our consolidated net sales for the years 2016, 2015 and 2014, 
respectively.

History of Advanced Circuits

Advanced Circuits commenced operations in 1989 through the acquisition of a small Denver-based PCB manufacturer, Seiko 
Circuits. During its first years of operations, Advanced Circuits focused exclusively on manufacturing high volume, production 
run PCBs with a small group of proportionately large customers.  In 1992, after the loss of a significant customer, Advanced 
Circuits made a strategic shift to limit its dependence on any one customer. As a result, Advanced Circuits began focusing on 
developing a diverse customer base, and in particular, on meeting the demands of equipment manufacturers with low-volume, 
high-margin, customized small-run and quick-turn PCBs.

In 1997, Advanced Circuits increased its capacity and consolidated its facilities into its current headquarters in Aurora, Colorado. 
In 2003, to support its growth, Advanced Circuits expanded its PCB manufacturing facility by approximately 37,000 square feet 
or approximately 150%. In 2013, Advanced Circuits added approximately 50,000 square feet and moved its administrative and 
engineering group next door to its production facilities.

In March 2010, Advanced Circuits acquired Circuit Express, Inc. (“CEI”) for approximately $16.1 million. Based in Tempe, 
Arizona and founded in 1987, CEI focuses on quick-turn and small-run manufacturing of rigid PCBs primarily for aerospace and 
defense related industry customers. CEI also specializes in expedited delivery in as fast as 24 hours. 

On May 23, 2012, Advanced Circuits acquired Universal Circuits, Inc. (“UCI”) for approximately $2.3 million. UCI supplies 
PCBs to major military, aerospace, and medical original equipment manufacturers and contract manufacturers. UCI’s Minnesota 
facility meets certain Department of Defense clearance requirements and is noted for custom and advanced technologies. Universal 
Circuits’ sales are primarily in the long-lead sector.

We purchased a controlling interest in Advanced Circuits on May 16, 2006.

Industry

The  PCB  industry,  which  consists  of  both  large  global  PCB  manufacturers  and  small  regional  PCB  manufacturers,  is  a  vital 
component to all electronic equipment supply chains, as PCBs serve as the foundation for virtually all electronic products, including 
cellular telephones, appliances, personal computers, routers, switches and network servers. PCBs are used by manufacturers of 
these types of electronic products, as well as by persons and teams engaged in research and development of new types of equipment 
and technologies.

Production of PCBs in North America has declined since 2000 and was flat in the most recent fiscal years, with a less than 1% 
decrease, according to the IPC 2014 Analysis.  Orders for the fourth quarter of 2014 increased as compared to the fourth quarter 
in 2013, indicating that 2015 North American PCB production should have modest growth compared to 2014.  The rapid decline 

32

in United States production was caused by (i) reduced demand for and spending on PCBs following the technology and telecom 
industry decline in early 2000; and (ii) increased competition for volume production of PCBs from Asian competitors benefiting 
from both lower labor costs and less restrictive waste and environmental regulations. While Asian manufacturers have made large 
market share gains in the PCB industry overall, small-run and quick-turn production, some of the more complex volume production 
and military production have remained strong in the United States.

Both globally and domestically, the PCB market can be separated into three categories based on required lead time and order 
volume:
• 

Small-run PCBs — These PCBs are typically manufactured for customers in research and development departments of 
original  equipment  manufacturers,  or  OEMs,  and  academic  institutions.  Small-run  PCBs  are  manufactured  to  the 
specifications of the customer, within certain manufacturing guidelines designed to increase speed and reduce production 
costs. Prototyping is a critical stage in the research and development of new products. These small-runs are used in the 
design and launch of new electronic equipment and are typically ordered in volumes of 1 to 50 PCBs. Because the small-
run is used primarily in the research and development phase of a new electronic product, the life cycle is relatively short 
and requires accelerated delivery time frames of usually less than five days and very high, error-free quality. Order, 
production and delivery time, as well as responsiveness with respect to each, are key factors for customers as PCBs are 
indispensable to their research and development activities.

•  Quick-Turn Production PCBs — These PCBs are used for intermediate stages of testing for new products prior to full 
scale production. After a new product has successfully completed the small-run phase, customers undergo test marketing 
and other technical testing. This stage requires production of larger quantities of PCBs in a short period of time, generally 
10 days or less, while it does not yet require high production volumes. This transition stage between low-volume small-
run production and volume production is known as quick-turn production. Manufacturing specifications conform strictly 
to end product requirements and order quantities are typically in volumes of 10 to 500. Similar to small-run PCBs, response 
time remains crucial as the delivery of quick-turn PCBs can be a gating item in the development of electronic products. 
Orders for quick-turn production PCBs conform specifically to the customer’s exact end product requirements.

•  Volume Production PCBs — These PCBs, which we sometimes refer to as “long lead” and “sub-contract” are used in 
the full scale production of electronic equipment and specifications conform strictly to end product requirements. Volume 
Production PCBs are ordered in large quantities, usually over 100 units, and response time is less important, ranging 
between 15 days to 10 weeks or more.

These categories can be further distinguished based on board complexity, with each portion facing different competitive threats. 
Advanced Circuits competes largely in the small-run and quick-turn production portions of the North American market, which 
have not been significantly impacted by Asian-based manufacturers due to the quick response time required for these products. 
Management believes the North American PCB market is estimated to be approximately $3.5 billion in 2016.

Several significant trends are present within the PCB manufacturing industry, including:

• 

• 

• 

Increasing Customer Demand for Quick-Turn Production Services — Rapid advances in technology are significantly 
shortening product life-cycles and placing increased pressure on OEMs to develop new products in shorter periods of 
time. In response to these pressures, OEMs invest heavily in research and development, which results in a demand for 
PCB  companies  that  can  offer  engineering  support  and  quick-turn  production  services  to  minimize  the  product 
development process.
Increasing  Complexity  of  Electronic  Equipment —  OEMs  are  continually  designing  more  complex  and  higher 
performance electronic equipment, requiring sophisticated PCBs. To satisfy the demand for more advanced electronic 
products, PCBs are produced using exotic materials and increasingly have higher layer counts and greater component 
densities.  Maintaining  the  production  infrastructure  necessary  to  manufacture  PCBs  of  increasing  complexity  often 
requires  significant  capital  expenditures  and  has  acted  to  reduce  the  competitiveness  of  local  and  regional  PCB 
manufacturers lacking the scale to make such investments.
Shifting of High Volume Production to Asia — Asian based manufacturers of PCBs are capitalizing on their lower 
labor  costs  and  are  increasing  their  market  share  of  volume  production  of  PCBs  used,  for  example,  in  high-volume 
consumer electronics applications, such as personal computers and cell phones. Asian based manufacturers have been 
generally unable to meet the lead time requirements for small-run or quick-turn PCB production or the volume production 
of the most complex PCBs. This “off shoring” of high-volume production orders has placed increased pricing pressure 
and margin compression on many small domestic manufacturers that are no longer operating at full capacity. Many of 
these small producers are choosing to cease operations, rather than operate at a loss, as their scale, plant design and 
customer relationships do not allow them to focus profitably on the small-run and quick-turn sectors of the market.

33

Products and Services

A PCB is comprised of layers of laminate and contains patterns of electrical circuitry to connect electronic components. Advanced 
Circuits typically manufactures 2 to 20 layer PCBs, and has the capability to manufacture up even higher layer PCBs. The level 
of PCB complexity is determined by several characteristics, including size, layer count, density (line width and spacing), materials 
and functionality. Beyond complexity, a PCB’s unit cost is determined by the quantity of identical units ordered, as engineering 
and production setup costs per unit decrease with order volume, and required production time, as longer times often allow increased 
efficiencies and better production management. Advanced Circuits primarily manufactures lower complexity PCBs.

To manufacture PCBs, Advanced Circuits generally receives circuit designs from its customers in the form of computer data files 
emailed to one of its sales representatives or uploaded on its interactive website. These files are then reviewed to ensure data 
accuracy and product manufacturability. While processing these computer files, Advanced Circuits generates images of the circuit 
patterns that are then physically developed on individual layers, using advanced photographic processes. Through a variety of 
plating and etching processes, conductive materials are selectively added and removed to form horizontal layers of thin circuits, 
called traces, which are separated by insulating material. A finished multilayer PCB laminates together a number of layers of 
circuitry. Vertical connections between layers are achieved by metallic plating through small holes, called vias. Vias are made by 
highly specialized drilling equipment capable of achieving extremely fine tolerances with high accuracy.

Advanced Circuits assists its customers throughout the life-cycle of their products, from product conception through volume 
production. Advanced Circuits works closely with customers throughout each phase of the PCB development process, beginning 
with the PCB design verification stage using its unique online FreeDFM.com tool, FreeDFM.com™, which was launched in 2002, 
enables customers to receive a free manufacturability assessment report within minutes, resolving design problems that would 
prohibit manufacturability before the order process is completed and manufacturing begins. The combination of Advanced Circuits’ 
user-friendly website and its design verification tool reduces the amount of human labor involved in the manufacture of each order 
as PCBs move from Advanced Circuits’ website directly to its computer numerical control, or CNC, machines for production, 
saving Advanced Circuits and customers cost and time. As a result of its ability to rapidly and reliably respond to the critical 
customer requirements, Advanced Circuits receives a premium for their small-run and quick-turn PCBs as compared to volume 
production PCBs.

Advanced Circuits manufactures all high margin small-runs and quick-turn orders internally but often utilizes external partners 
to manufacture production orders that do not fit within its capabilities or capacity constraints at a given time. As a result, Advanced 
Circuits constantly adjusts the portion of volume production PCBs produced internally to both maximize profitability and ensure 
that internal capacity is fully utilized.

The following table shows Advanced Circuits’ gross revenue by products and services for the periods indicated:

Gross Sales by Products and Services (1)
Small-run Production

Quick-Turn Production

Volume Production (including assembly)

Third Party

Total

(1)  As a percentage of gross sales, exclusive of sale discounts.

Competitive Strengths

Year Ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

21.8%

31.8%

45.2%

1.2%

22.5%

31.0%

46.0%

0.5%

23.5%

31.3%

44.9%

0.3%

100.0%

100.0%

100.0%

Advanced Circuits has established itself as a leading provider of small-run and quick-turn PCBs in North America and focuses 
on satisfying customer demand for on-time delivery of high-quality PCBs. Advanced Circuits’ management believes the following 
factors differentiate it from many industry competitors:

•  Numerous Unique Orders Per Day — For the year ended December 31, 2016, Advanced Circuits received on average 
over 300 customer orders per day. Due to the large quantity of orders received, Advanced Circuits is able to combine 
multiple orders in a single panel design prior to production. Through this process, Advanced Circuits is able to reduce 
the number of costly, labor intensive equipment set-ups required to complete several manufacturing orders. As labor 
represents the single largest cost of production, management believes this capability gives Advanced Circuits a unique 
advantage over other industry participants. Advanced Circuits maintains proprietary software that maximizes the number 

34

of units placed on any one panel design. A single panel set-up typically accommodates 1 to 12 orders. Further, as a “critical 
mass” of like orders is required to maximize the efficiency of this process, management believes Advanced Circuits is 
uniquely positioned as an efficient manufacturer of small-run and quick-turn PCBs.

•  Diverse Customer Base — Advanced Circuits possesses a customer base with little industry or customer concentration 
exposure. During the fiscal year ended December 31, 2016, Advanced Circuits did business with over 9,000 customers 
and added over 180 new customers per month. For each of the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, no 
customer represented over 2% of net sales.

•  Highly Responsive Culture and Organization — A key strength of Advanced Circuits is its ability to quickly respond 
to customer orders and complete the production process. In contrast to many competitors that require a day or more to 
offer price quotes on small-run or quick-turn production, Advanced Circuits offers its customers quotes within seconds 
and the ability to place or track orders any time of day. In addition, Advanced Circuits’ production facility operates three 
shifts per day and is able to ship a customer’s product within 24 hours of receiving its order.

•  Proprietary FreeDFM.com Software — Advanced Circuits offers its customers unique design verification services 
through  its  online  FreeDFM.com  tool.  This  tool,  which  was  launched  in  2002,  enables  customers  to  receive  a  free 
manufacturability assessment report, within minutes, resolving design problems before customers place their orders. The 
service is relied upon by many of Advanced Circuits’ customers to reduce design errors and minimize production costs. 
Beyond  improved  customer  service,  FreeDFM.com  has  the  added  benefit  of  improving  the  efficiency  of Advanced 
Circuits’ engineers, as many routine design problems, which typically require an engineer’s time and attention to identify, 
are identified and sent back to customers automatically.

•  Established  Partner  Network — Advanced  Circuits  has  established  third  party  production  relationships  with  PCB 
manufacturers in North America and Asia. Through these relationships, Advanced Circuits is able to offer its customers 
a complete suite of products including those outside of its core production capabilities. Additionally, these relationships 
allow Advanced Circuits to outsource orders for volume production and focus internal capacity on higher margin, short 
lead time, production and quick-turn manufacturing.

Business Strategies

Advanced Circuits’ management is focused on strategies to increase market share and further improve operating efficiencies. The 
following is a discussion of these strategies:

Increase Portion of Revenue from Small-run and Quick-Turn Production — Advanced Circuits’ management believes it can 
grow revenues and cash flow by continuing to leverage its core small-run and quick-turn capabilities. Over its history, Advanced 
Circuits has developed a suite of capabilities that management believes allow it to offer a combination of price and customer 
service unequaled in the market. Though reductions in military spending have created headwinds recently, Advanced Circuits 
intends to leverage this factor, as well as its core skill set, to increase net sales derived from higher margin small-run and quick-
turn production PCBs. In this respect, marketing and advertising efforts focus on attracting and acquiring customers that are likely 
to require these premium services. And while production composition may shift, growth in these products and services is not 
expected to come at the expense of declining sales in volume production PCBs, as Advanced Circuits intends to leverage its 
extensive network of third-party manufacturing partners to continue to meet customers’ demand for these services.

Acquire Customers from Local and Regional Competitors — Advanced Circuits’ management believes the majority of its 
competition for small-run and quick-turn PCB orders comes from smaller scale local and regional PCB manufacturers. As an early 
mover in the small-run and quick-turn sector of the PCB market, Advanced Circuits has been able to grow faster and achieve 
greater production efficiencies than many industry participants. Management believes Advanced Circuits can continue to use these 
advantages  to  gain  market  share.  Further, Advanced  Circuits  continues  to  enter  into  small-run  and  quick-turn  manufacturing 
relationships  with  several  subscale  local  and  regional  PCB  manufacturers.  Management  believes  that  while  many  of  these 
manufacturers maintain strong, long-standing customer relationships, they are unable to produce PCBs with short turn-around 
times at competitive prices. As a result, Advanced Circuits sees an opportunity for growth by providing production support to 
these manufacturers or direct support to the customers of these manufacturers, whereby the manufacturers act more as a broker 
for the relationship.

Remain Committed to Customers and Employees — Advanced Circuits has remained focused on providing the highest quality 
products and services to its customers. We believe this focus has allowed Advanced Circuits to achieve its outstanding delivery 
and quality record. Advanced Circuits’ management believes this reputation is a key competitive differentiator and is focused on 
maintaining and building upon it. Similarly, management believes its committed base of employees is a key differentiating factor. 
Advanced  Circuits  currently  has  a  profit  sharing  program  and  tri-annual  bonuses  for  all  of  its  employees.  Management  also 
occasionally sets additional performance targets for individuals and departments and establishes rewards, such as lunch celebrations 
or paid vacations, if these goals are met. Management believes that Advanced Circuits’ emphasis on sharing rewards and creating 

35

a positive work environment has led to increased loyalty. Advanced Circuits plans to continue to focus on similar programs to 
maintain this competitive advantage.

Opportunistically Acquire  Smaller  PCB  Manufacturers —  Historically, Advanced  Circuits  has  selectively  made  tuck-in 
acquisitions of regional PCB manufacturers, including the acquisitions of Circuit Express, Inc. in 2010 and Universal Circuits, 
Inc. in 2012. Management will continue to seek tuck-in acquisitions of smaller PCB manufacturers where sales and operational 
efficiencies can be realized, or strategic technical capabilities expanded.

Research and Development

Advanced  Circuits  engages  in  continual  research  and  development  activities  in  the  ordinary  course  of  business  to  update  or 
strengthen its order processing, production and delivery systems. By engaging in these activities, Advanced Circuits expects to 
maintain and build upon the competitive strengths from which it benefits currently. Research and development expenses were not 
material in each of the last three years.

Customers and Distribution Channels

Advanced Circuits’ focus on customer service and product quality has resulted in a broad base of customers in a variety of end 
markets, including industrial, consumer, telecommunications, aerospace/defense, biotechnology and electronics manufacturing. 
These customers range in size from large, blue-chip manufacturers to small, not-for-profit university engineering departments. 
The following table sets forth management’s estimate of Advanced Circuits’ approximate customer breakdown by industry sector 
for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014:

Industry Sector

Electrical Equipment and Components

Measuring Instruments

Electronics Manufacturing Services

Engineer Services

Industrial and Commercial Machinery

Business Services

Wholesale Trade-Durable Goods

Educational Institutions

Transportation Equipment

All Other Sectors Combined

Total

Customer Distribution
2015

2014

2016

22%

4%

21%

4%

12%

2%

1%

17%

12%

5%

23%

6%

25%

3%

10%

1%

1%

15%

10%

6%

22%

5%

24%

5%

11%

1%

1%

14%

11%

6%

100%

100%

100%

Management estimates that over 75% of its orders are generated from existing customers.  Moreover, more than half of Advanced 
Circuits’ orders in each of the years 2016, 2015 and 2014 were delivered within five days (not including CEI orders).  In a typical 
year, no single customer represents more than 2% of Advanced Circuits’ sales.

Sales and Marketing

Advanced Circuits has established a “consumer products” marketing strategy to both acquire new customers and retain existing 
customers. Advanced Circuits uses initiatives such as direct mail postcards, web banners, aggressive pricing specials and proactive 
outbound customer call programs as part of this strategy. Advanced Circuits spends approximately 1% of net sales each year on 
its marketing initiatives and advertising and has 48 employees dedicated to its marketing and sales efforts. These individuals are 
organized geographically and each is responsible for a region of North America. The sales team takes a systematic approach to 
placing sales calls and receiving inquiries and, on average, will place over 200 outbound sales calls and receive approximately 
140 inbound phone inquiries per day. Beyond proactive customer acquisition initiatives, management believes a substantial portion 
of new customers are acquired through referrals from existing customers. In addition, other customers are acquired on-line where 
Advanced Circuits generates over 90% of its orders from its website.

Once a new client is acquired, Advanced Circuits offers an easy to use customer-oriented website and proprietary online design 
and review tools to ensure high levels of retention. By maintaining contact with its customers to ensure satisfaction with each 
order, Advanced Circuits believes it has developed strong customer loyalty, as demonstrated by over 75% of its orders being 

36

received from existing customers. Included in each customer order is an Advanced Circuits prepaid “bounce-back” card on which 
a customer can evaluate Advanced Circuits’ services and send back any comments or recommendations. Each of these cards is 
read by senior members of management, and Advanced Circuits adjusts its services to respond to the requests of its customer base.

Substantially all revenue is derived from sales within the United States.

Advanced  Circuits,  due  to  the  volume  of  small-run  and  quick  turn  sales,  had  a  negligible  amount  in  firm  backlog  orders  at 
December 31, 2016 and 2015.

Competition

There are currently an estimated 170 active domestic PCB manufacturers. Advanced Circuits’ competitors differ amongst its 
products and services.

Competitors  in  the  small-run  and  quick-turn  PCBs  production  industry  include  larger  companies  as  well  as  small  domestic 
manufacturers. The two largest independent domestic small-run and quick-turn PCB manufacturers in North America are TTM 
Technologies, Inc. and Viasystems Group, Inc. Though each of these companies produces small-run PCBs to varying degrees, in 
many ways they are not direct competitors with Advanced Circuits. In recent years, each of these firms has primarily focused on 
producing boards with greater complexity in response to the off shoring of low and medium layer count technology to Asia. 
Compared to Advanced Circuits, small-run and quick-turn PCB production accounts for much smaller portions of each of these 
firm’s revenues. Further, these competitors often have much greater customer concentrations and a greater portion of sales through 
large electronics manufacturing services intermediaries. Beyond large, public companies, Advanced Circuits’ competitors include 
numerous small, local and regional manufacturers, often with revenues under $20 million that have long-term customer relationships 
and  typically  produce  both  small-run  and  quick-turn  PCBs  and  production  PCBs  for  small  OEMs  and  EMS  companies. The 
competitive factors in small-run and quick-turn production PCBs are response time, quality, error-free production and customer 
service. Competitors in the long lead-time production PCBs generally include large companies, including Asian manufacturers, 
where price is the key competitive factor.

New market entrants into small-run and quick-turn production PCBs confront substantial barriers including significant investments 
in equipment, highly skilled workforce with extensive engineering knowledge and compliance with environmental regulations. 
Beyond these tangible barriers, Advanced Circuits’ management believes that its network of customers, established over the last 
two decades, would be very difficult for a competitor to replicate.

Suppliers

Advanced Circuits’ raw materials inventory is small relative to sales and must be regularly and rapidly replenished. Advanced 
Circuits uses a just-in-time procurement practice to maintain raw materials inventory at low levels. Additionally, Advanced Circuits 
has established consignment relationships with several vendors allowing it to pay for raw materials as used. Because it provides 
primarily lower-volume quick-turn services, this inventory policy does not hamper its ability to complete customer orders. Raw 
material costs constituted approximately 19%, 20% and 20% of net sales for each of the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, 
2015 and 2014, respectively.

The primary raw materials that are used in production are core materials, such as copper clad layers of glass and chemical solutions, 
and copper and gold for plating operations, photographic film and carbide drill bits. Multiple suppliers and sources exist for all 
materials. Adequate amounts of all raw materials have been available in the past, and Advanced Circuits’ management believes 
this will continue in the foreseeable future. Advanced Circuits works closely with its suppliers to incorporate technological advances 
in the raw materials they purchase. Advanced Circuits does not believe that it has significant exposure to fluctuations in raw 
material prices. The fact that price is not the primary factor affecting the purchase decision of many of Advanced Circuits’ customers 
has allowed management to historically pass along a portion of raw material price increases to its customers. Advanced Circuits 
does not knowingly purchase material originating in the Democratic Republic of the Congo or adjoining countries.

Intellectual Property

Advanced Circuits seeks to protect certain proprietary technology by entering into confidentiality and non-disclosure agreements 
with  its  employees,  consultants  and  customers,  as  needed,  and  generally  limits  access  to  and  distribution  of  its  proprietary 
information  and  processes. Advanced  Circuits’  management  does  not  believe  that  patents  are  critical  to  protecting Advanced 
Circuits’  core  intellectual  property,  but,  rather,  its  effective  and  quick  execution  of  fabrication  techniques,  its  website 
FreeDFM.com™ and its highly skilled workforce are the primary factors in maintaining its competitive position.

37

Advanced Circuits uses the following brand names: FreeDFM.com™, 4pcb.com™, 4PCB.com™, 33each.com™, barebonespcb.com™
and Advanced Circuits™. These trade names have strong brand equity and are material to Advanced Circuits’ business.

Regulatory Environment

Advanced Circuits’ manufacturing operations and facilities are subject to evolving federal, state and local environmental and 
occupational health and safety laws and regulations. These include laws and regulations governing air emissions, wastewater 
discharge and the storage and handling of chemicals and hazardous substances. Management believes that Advanced Circuits is 
in compliance, in all material respects, with applicable environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. 
New  requirements,  more  stringent  application  of  existing  requirements,  or  discovery  of  previously  unknown  environmental 
conditions may result in material environmental expenditures in the future.  Advanced Circuits has been recognized three times 
for exemplary environmental compliance as it was awarded the Denver Metro Wastewater Reclamation District Gold Award for 
the seven of the last ten years.

Employees

As  of  December 31,  2016, Advanced  Circuits  employed  517  persons.    None  of Advanced  Circuits’  employees  are  subject  to 
collective bargaining agreements. Advanced Circuits believes its relationship with its employees is good.

Arnold

Overview

Founded in 1895 and now headquartered in Rochester, New York, Arnold is a manufacturer of engineered, application specific 
magnet solutions. Arnold manufactures a wide range of permanent magnets and precision magnetic assemblies with facilities in 
the United States, the United Kingdom, Switzerland and China. Arnold has hundreds of customers in its primary markets including 
aerospace  and  defense,  motorsport/  automotive,  oil  and  gas,  medical,  general  industrial,  electric  utility,  reprographics,and 
advertising specialties. Arnold is the largest and, we believe, the most technically advanced U.S. manufacturer of engineered 
magnets. Arnold is one of two domestic producers to design, engineer and manufacture rare earth magnetic solutions. Arnold 
serves customers and generates revenues via three business units:

•  PMAG – Permanent Magnet and Assemblies Group- High performance magnets and assemblies for precision motors/
generators, Hall Effect sensor and beam focusing applications. PMAG also manufactures assemblies for the reprographic 
industry used in printing and copying systems.

•  Precision Thin Metals - Ultra thin gauge metal strip and foil products utilizing magnetic and non-magnetic alloys
•  Flexmag™ - Flexible bonded magnets for specialty advertising, industrial and medical applications.

Arnold operates a 70,000 square foot manufacturing assembly and distribution facility in Rochester, New York with nine additional 
facilities worldwide in countries including the U.K., Switzerland and China. 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, Arnold had net sales of approximately $108.2 million, $120.0 million 
and $123.2 million, respectively, with an operating loss of  $12.9 million in 2016, and operating income of $7.6 million in 2015 
and $7.1 million in 2014. Arnold had total assets of $114.9 million and $139.0 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.  
Net sales from Arnold represented 11.1%, 16.5% and 19.4% of our consolidated net sales for the years ended December 31, 2016, 
2015 and 2014, respectively.

History of Arnold

Arnold was founded in 1895 as the Arnold Electric Power Station Company. Arnold began producing AlNiCo permanent magnets 
in its Marengo, Illinois facility in the mid-1930s. In 1946, Allegheny Ludlum Steel Corporation (Allegheny) purchased Arnold, 
and over the next few years began production of several additional magnetic product lines under license agreement with the Western 
Electric Company.  In 1970, Arnold acquired Ogallala Electronics, which manufactured high power coils and electromagnets.

SPS Technologies (SPS), at the time a publicly traded company, purchased Arnold Engineering Company from Allegheny in 1986. 
Under SPS, Arnold made a series of acquisitions and partnerships to expand its portfolio and geographic reach. At the end of 2003, 
Precision Castparts, also a publicly traded company, acquired SPS.  In January 2005, Audax, a Boston-based private equity firm 
acquired Arnold from Precision Castparts.

38

In February 2007, Arnold Magnetic Technologies completed the acquisition of Precision Magnetics with operations in Sheffield, 
England; Lupfig, Switzerland; and Wayne, New Jersey. The Wayne, New Jersey facility was relocated to Rochester, NewJersey 
later that year.  In addition, Arnold’s Lupfig, Switzerland operation is a joint venture partner with a Chinese rare earth producer. 
The joint venture manufactures RECOMA® Samarium Cobalt blocks for the Asian market.

We purchased a majority interest in Arnold on March 5, 2012.

Industry

Permanent Magnets

There exists a broad range of permanent magnets which include Rare Earth Magnets and magnets made from specialty magnetic 
alloys. Magnets produced from these materials may be sliced, ground, coated and magnetized to customer requirements. Those 
industry players with the broadest portfolio of these magnets, such as Arnold, maintain a significant competitive advantage over 
competitors as they are able to offer one-stop shop capabilities to customers.  Management believes that being a manufacturer of 
these magnets, subject to patent rights, is another critical market advantage.

Rare Earth Magnets

• 

Samarium Cobalt (SmCo) – SmCo magnets are typically used in critical applications that require corrosion resistance 
or high temperature stability, such as motors, generators, actuators and sensors. Arnold markets its SmCo magnets under 
the trade name of RECOMA ®, and is DFARS (Defense Federal Acquisition Regulation) compliant.

•  Neodymium (Neo) – Neo magnets offer the highest magnetic energy level of any material in the market. Applications 
include  motors  and  generators,  VCM’s,  magnetic  resonance  imaging,  magnetic  inspection  systems,  sensors  and 
loudspeakers.

Other Permanent Magnet Types

•  AlNiCo – The AlNiCo family of magnets remains a preferred material for many mission critical applications. Its favorable 
linear temperature characteristics, high magnetic flux density and good corrosion resistance are ideally suited for use in 
applications requiring magnetic stability.  This material is manufactured by Arnold, making it a DFARS compliant material.
•  Hard Ferrite – Hard ferrite (ceramic) magnets were developed as a low cost alternative to metallic magnets (steel and 
AlNiCo). Although they exhibit lower energy when compared to other materials available today and are relatively brittle, 
ferrite magnets have gained acceptance due to their low price per magnetic output.
Injection Molded – Injection molded magnets are a composite of various types of resin and magnetic powders. The 
physical and magnetic properties of the product depend on the raw materials, but are generally lower in magnetic strength 
and resemble plastics in their physical properties. However, a major benefit of the injection molding process is that magnet 
material can be injection or over-molded, eliminating subsequent manufacturing steps.

• 

Magnetic Assemblies- Arnold offers complex, customized value added magnetic assemblies. These assemblies are used in devices 
such as motors, generators, beam focusing arrays, sensors, and solenoid actuators. Magnetic assembly production capabilities 
include magnet fabrication, machining, encapsulation or sleeving, balancing, and field mapping.

Precision Strip and Foil

Precision rolled thin metal foil products are manufactured from a wide range of materials for use in applications such as transformers, 
motor laminations, honeycomb structures, shielding, and composite structures. These products are commonly found in security 
tags, medical implants, aerospace structures, batteries and speaker domes. Arnold has the expertise and capability to roll, anneal, 
slit and coat a wide range of materials to extremely thin gauges (2.5 microns) and exacting tolerances.

Flexible Magnets

Flexible magnet products span the range of applications from advertising (refrigerator magnets and displays) to medical applications 
(needle counters) to sealing and holding applications (door gaskets).

Products and Services

PMAG

Arnold’s Precision Magnets and Assemblies (PMAG) segment is a leading global manufacturer of precision magnetic assemblies 
and  high-performance  magnets.  The  segment’s  products  include  tight  tolerance  assemblies  consisting  of  many  dozens  of 
components and employing RECOMA® SmCo, Neo, and AlNiCo magnets. These products are sold to a wide range of industries 
39

including aerospace and defense, motorsport/ automotive, oil and gas, medical, general industrial, electric utility and reprographics. 
Arnold has established a reputation in the magnetic industry as the engineering solutions provider, assisting customers to ensure 
their critical assemblies meet expectations.

PMAG  is Arnold’s  largest  business  unit  representing  approximately  72%  of Arnold  sales  on  an  annualized  basis  (including 
Reprographics) with a global footprint including manufacturing facilities in the U.S., U.K., Switzerland, and China.
PMAG—Products and Applications:

•  High precision magnetic rotors for use in electric motors and generators. Typically used in demanding applications such 

as aerospace, oil and gas exploration, energy recovery systems and under the hood automotive
Sealed pump couplings

• 
•  Beam focusing assemblies such as traveling wave tubes
•  Oil & Gas NMR tools as well as pipeline inspection and down hole power generation
•  Hall effect sensor systems

Arnold’s reprographics unit, which is part of the PMAG segment, produces systems and components for copier systems. The 
business unit’s state-of-the-art, high-volume precision magnetic assembly facility produces numerous assemblies per year. The 
reprographics unit utilizes components produced by the Flexmag segment.

Reprographics—products and applications:

•  Complex, multi-component, high-accuracy copier assemblies
•  Toner rolls
•  Toner and fuser assemblies

Precision Thin Metals

Arnold’s precision thin metals segment manufactures precision thin strip and foil products from an array of materials and represents 
approximately 8% of Arnold sales on an annualized basis. The Precision Thin Metals segment serves the aerospace and defense, 
power transmission, alternative energy (hybrids, wind, battery, solar), medical, security, and general industrial end-markets. With 
top-of-the-line equipment and superior engineering, Precision Thin Metals has developed unique processing capabilities that allow 
it to produce foils and strip with precision and quality that are unmatched in the industry (down to 1/10th thickness of a human 
hair). In addition, the segment’s facility is capable of increasing production from current levels with its existing equipment and 
is, we believe, well-positioned to realize future growth.

Precision Thin Metals—Products and Applications:

Security and product ID tags

•  Electrical steels for hybrid propulsion systems, electric motors, and micro turbines
• 
•  Honeycomb structures for aerospace applications
• 
•  Batteries
•  Military countermeasures

Irradiation windows

Flexmag

Arnold is one of two North American manufacturers of flexible rubber magnets for specialty advertising, medical, and reprographic 
applications. Flexmag represents approximately 20% of Arnold sales on an annualized basis. It primarily sells its products to 
specialty  advertisers  and  original  equipment  manufacturers.  With  highly  automated  manufacturing  processes,  Flexmag  can 
accommodate customer’s required short lead times. Flexmag benefits from a loyal customer base and significant barriers to entry 
in the industry. Flexmag’s success is driven by superior customer service, and proprietary formulations offering enhanced product 
performance.

Flexmag—products and applications:

•  Extruded and calendared flexible rubber magnets with optional laminated printable substrates
•  Retail displays
•  Theft detection/ security
Seals and enclosures
• 
Signage for various advertising and promotions
• 

Competitive Strengths

Competitive Landscape

40

The specialty magnets industry is highly fragmented, creating a competitive landscape with a variety of magnetic component 
manufacturers.  However,  few  have  the  breadth  of  capabilities  that Arnold  possesses.  Manufacturers  compete  on  the  basis  of 
technical innovation, co-development capabilities, time-to-market, quality, geographic reach and total cost of ownership. Industry 
competitors relevant to Arnold’s served markets range from large multinational manufacturers to small, regional participants. 
Given  these  dynamics,  we  believe  the  industry  will  likely  favor  players  that  are  able  to  achieve  vertical  integration  and  a 
diversification of offerings across a breadth of products along with magnet engineering and design expertise.

Barriers to Entry

• 

Low Substitution Risk – Arnold’s solutions are typically specified into its customers’ program designs through a co-
development and qualification process that often takes 6-18 months. Arnold’s customers are typically contractors and 
component  manufacturers  whose  products  are  integrated  into  end-customers’  applications. The  high  cost  of  failure, 
relatively low proportionate cost of magnets to the final product, sometimes lengthy testing and qualification process, 
and substantial upfront co-engineering investment required, represent significant barriers to customers changing solution 
providers such as Arnold.

•  Equipment and Processing – Arnold’s existing base of production equipment has a significant estimated replacement 
cost. A new entrant could require as much as 2-3 years of lead time to match the process performance requirements, 
customization of equipment and material formulations necessary to effectively compete in the specialty magnet industry. 
Further, given the program nature of a majority Arnold’s sales, management estimates that it could take 5-10 years to 
build  a  sufficient  book  of  business  and  base  of  institutional  knowledge  to  generate  positive  cash  flow  out  of  a  new 
manufacturing plant.

Business Strategies

Engineering and Product Development

Arnold’s engineers work closely with the customer to co-develop a product or process to provide system solutions, representing 
a significant competitive advantage. Arnold’s engineering expertise is leveraged with  state-of-the-art technology across the various 
business units located in North America, Europe and Asia Pacific. Arnold’s engineers work with customers on a global basis to 
optimize designs, guide material choices, and create magnetic models resulting in Arnold’s products being specified into customer 
designs.

Arnold has a talented and experienced engineering staff of design and application experts, quality personnel and technicians. 
Included in this team are engineers with backgrounds in materials science, physics, and metallurgical engineering. Other members 
of the team bring backgrounds in ceramics, mechanical engineering, chemical engineering and electrical engineering.

Arnold continues to be an industry leader with regard to new product formulations and innovations. As evidence of this, Arnold 
currently relies on a deep portfolio of “trade secrets” and internal intellectual property. Arnold continuously endeavors to introduce 
magnet solutions that exceed the performance of current offerings and meet customer design specifications.

Growth in Arnold’s business is primarily focused in three areas:

(i) Growing market share in existing end-markets and geographies, with a focus on aerospace and defense, and medical;

(ii) Vertical integration through new products and technologies; and

(iii)  Completing opportunistic acquisitions and partnerships to reduce product introduction and market penetration time.

Existing End-Markets and Geographies

Aerospace and Defense

In the aerospace and defense sector, Arnold is selling magnets, magnetic assemblies and ultra-thin foil solutions. Specifically, in 
the aerospace industry, Arnold’s assemblies have been designed into products, which enables Arnold to benefit from the market 
growth and a healthy flow of business based on current airframe orders. Through its OEM customers, essentially all new commercial 
aircraft placed in service contain assemblies produced by Arnold. Arnold’s sales to large aerospace and defense manufactures 
includes magnetic assemblies used in applications such as motors and generators, actuators, trigger mechanisms, and guidance 
systems, as well as magnets for these and other uses. In addition, it sells its ultra-thin foil for use in military countermeasures, 
honeycomb structures, brazing alloys, and motor laminations.

41

Automotive

In the automotive sector, Arnold is selling magnets and magnetic assemblies primarily to Tier 1 and 2 companies. It is estimated 
that the current automobile contains over 50 magnetic systems, and this number is expected to grow due to vehicle electrification 
initiatives in order to meet increasing fuel efficiency standards. Typical applications include magnets for Hall Effect sensors that 
are used in braking, passenger restraint, and steering and engine control systems. Emerging magnetic applications include electric 
traction drives, regenerative braking systems, starter generators, and electric turbo charging. The auto industry continues to adopt 
increasingly sophisticated technology to reduce vehicle weight and improve fuel efficiency. As much of this technology utilizes 
magnetic systems, Arnold expects to benefit from this trend.

Oil and Gas

Arnold currently provides magnets and precision assemblies for use in oil and gas exploration and production, applications which 
typically require exceptional collaboration and co-development with its customers. Arnold supplies products used in applications 
such as a new oil well shutoff valve, a new down-hole logging while drilling tool, and a down-hole magnetic transfer coupling. 
Other applications for which Arnold is actively involved include pipeline inspection, wireless tomography tools, and chip collection.

Power Transmission

Arnold’s  Precision  Thin  Metals  segment  supplies  grain-oriented  silicon  steel  produced  with  proprietary  methods  for  use  in 
transformers and inductors. These cores allow for the production of very efficient transformers and inductors while minimizing 
size. In addition, Arnold’s magnet solutions can be found in advanced automatic circuit re-closer solutions that substantially reduce 
the stress on system components on the grid. Arnold’s solutions are also present in new power storage systems. The permanent 
magnet bearings used in new designs improve the efficiency of the flywheel energy storage system.

General Industrial

Within the industrial sector, Arnold provides magnet assemblies as well as magnets for custom made motor systems. These include 
stepper motors, pick and place robotic systems, and new designs that are increasingly being required by regulation to meet energy 
efficiency standards. An example is a motor utilizing Arnold’s bonded magnets for use in commercial refrigeration systems.  Arnold 
also produces magnetic couplings for seal-less pumps used in chemical and oil & gas applications that allow chemical companies 
to meet environmental requirements.

Medical

Within  the  medical  sector, Arnold  provides  magnetic  assemblies,  magnets,  flexible  magnets,  and  ultrathin  foils.  Its  magnet 
assemblies and magnets are critical parts of motor systems for dental instruments as well as saws and grinders. Magnet assemblies 
are also provided for skin expansion systems, shunt valves, and position sensors. In addition, its Precision Thin Metals business 
unit is providing a specialty alloy for advanced breast cancer treatment.

New Products & Technologies

Flexcoat, launched in April 2010, this product was engineered to eliminate the issues associated with the conventional flexible 
magnetic product laminated with a printable surface. The solution is a printable coating that is applied to the magnet, which replaces 
substrates such as vinyl and paper that are currently adhered to the base magnet material. This results in a printed magnet that is 
now completely recyclable and is easier to process.

Research and Development

Arnold has a core research and development team, which has collectively over 30 years of combined industry experience. In 
addition to the core engineering group, a large number of other Arnold staff members assigned to the business units contribute to 
the research and development effort at various stages. Product development also includes collaborating with customers and field 
testing. This feedback helps ensure products will meet Arnold’s demanding standards of excellence as well as the constantly 
changing needs of end users. Arnold’s research and development activities are supported by state-of-the-art engineering software 
design tools, integrated manufacturing facilities and a performance testing center equipped to ensure product safety, durability 
and superior performance. Arnold spent approximately $0.3 million, $0.5 million and $1.0 million, respectively, in research and 
development activities in each of the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

42

Customers and Distribution Channels

Arnold’s focus on customer service and product quality has resulted in a broad base of customers in a variety of end markets. 
Products  are  used  in  applications  such  as  general  industrial,  reprographic  systems,  aerospace and  defense,  advertising  and 
promotion, consumer and appliance, energy, automotive and medical.

The following table sets forth management’s estimate of Arnold’s approximate customer breakdown by industry sector for the 
fiscal year ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014:

Industry Sector

General industrial

Aerospace and defense

Advertising and promotion

Consumer and appliance

Energy

Automotive

Medical

Reprographic

All Other Sectors Combined

Total

Customer Distribution

2016

2015

2014

24%

28%

13%

2%

3%

10%

3%

11%

6%

100%

27%

24%

13%

2%

9%

8%

3%

11%

3%

100%

27%

21%

12%

2%

8%

9%

2%

16%

3%

100%

Arnold has a large and diverse, blue-chip customer base. No customer represented greater that 10% of Arnold’s annual revenue 
in 2016. Sales to Arnold’s top ten customers were 29% of total sales for the year ended December 31, 2016, and 33% of total sales 
for each of the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively. 

Sales and Marketing

PMAG - Arnold’s PMAG segment supports a global team of direct sales and marketing professionals and critical design and 
application engineers. The PMAG sales force is organized for regional coverage with a focus on sales in U.S., Europe, and South 
East Asia. Arnold serves over 840 active customers globally. As the majority of revenues are project based in the PMAG business 
unit, technical sales are critical to the segment’s success. Arnold’s highly-qualified application engineers are often integrated into 
its customers’ product design, planning, and implementation phases, offering the most cost effective solution for demanding clients. 
The resulting intimate customer relationships yield a high close rate, with revenue achieved primarily after the prototype phase.

Precision Thin Metals – Similar to Arnold’s PMAG segment, the vast majority of Precision Thin Metals’ sales are technically 
driven engineered solutions. These teams communicate closely in order to take advantage of potential cross-selling opportunities. 
Approximately 80% of sales are in the domestic market.

Flexmag Products - The Flexmag business segment services over 540 customers globally. Its sales force is comprised of seven 
total sales professionals and supported by seven design and application engineers. This segment is primarily book/bill and has 
limited revenue subject to long-term purchase commitments.

The following table sets forth Arnold’s net sales by geographic location for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 
2014:

Geographic location

North America

Europe

Asia Pacific

All Other Locations Combined

Total

2016

2015

2014

66%

28%

6%

—%

100%

66%

28%

6%

—%

100%

58%

33%

9%

—%

100%

Arnold had firm backlog orders totaling approximately $28.1 million and $25.2 million, respectively, at December 31, 2016 
and 2015.

43

Competition

Management believes the following companies represent Arnold’s top competitors:

•  Thomas & Skinner
•  Magnum Magnetics
•  Electron Energy
•  Vacuumschmelze Gruner, Germany-based

Suppliers

Raw materials utilized by Arnold include nickel and cobalt, stainless steel shafts, Inconel sleeves, adhesives, laminates, aluminum 
extrusions and binders. Although Arnold considers its relationships with vendors to be strong, Arnold’s management team also 
maintains a variety of alternative sources of comparable quality, quantity and price. The management team therefore believes that 
it is not dependent upon any single vendor to meet its sourcing needs. Arnold is generally able to pass through material costs to 
its customers and believes that in the event of significant price increases by vendors that it could pass the increases to its customers.

Intellectual Property

Arnold currently relies on a deep portfolio of “trade secrets” and internal intellectual property.

Patents

Arnold currently has 14 patents; over half of the patents were granted in the U.S. with the remaining patents granted in European 
countries such as Germany, Great Britain, France and the Netherlands. Ten of the patents are related to methods of making magnetic 
strips. In 2004, Arnold was granted a patent related to a thermally-stable, high-temperature, SmCo molding compound. 

Trademarks

Arnold currently has 86 trademarks, 12 of which are in the U.S. The most notable trademarked items are the following: “RECOMA”, 
“PLASTIFORM”, “FLEXMAG” & “ARNOLD”. Application dates for various trademarks date back to as early as 1960.

Regulatory Environment

Arnold’s  domestic  manufacturing  and  assembly  operations  and  its  facilities  are  subject  to  evolving  Federal,  state  and  local 
environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. These include laws and regulations governing air emissions, 
wastewater discharge and the storage and handling of chemicals and hazardous substances. Arnold’s foreign manufacturing and 
assembly operations are also subject to local environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. Management 
believes that Arnold is in compliance, in all material respects, with applicable environmental and occupational health and safety 
laws and regulations. New requirements, more stringent application of existing requirements, or discovery of previously unknown 
environmental conditions could result in material environmental expenditures in the future.

Arnold is a major producer of both Samarium Cobalt permanent magnets under its brand name RECOMA® and Alnico (in both 
cast and sintered forms). Both materials from Arnold meet the current Berry Amendment or Defense Acquisition Regulations 
Systems (DFARS) requirements per clause 252.225.7014 further described under 10 U.S.C. 2533b. This provision covers the 
protection of strategic materials critical to national security. These magnet types are considered “specialty metals” under these 
regulations.

Employees

Arnold is led by a capable management team of industry veterans that possess a balanced combination of industry experience and 
operational expertise.  Arnold employs approximately 681 hourly and salaried employees located throughout North America, 
Europe and Asia. Arnold’s employees are compensated at levels commensurate with industry standards, based on their respective 
position and job grade.

Arnold’s  workforce  is  non-union  except  for  approximately  64  hourly  employees  at  its  Marengo,  Illinois  facilities,  which  are 
represented by the International Association of Machinists (IAM). Arnold enjoys good labor relations with its employees and 
union and has a three year contract in place with the IAM, which will expire in June 2019.

44

Clean Earth

Overview

Headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania, Clean Earth provides environmental services for a variety of contaminated materials 
including soils, dredged material, hazardous waste and drill cuttings. Clean Earth analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste 
streams generated in multiple end markets such as power, construction, oil and gas, medical, infrastructure, industrial and dredging. 
Treatment includes thermal desorption, dredged material stabilization, bioremediation, physical treatment/screening and chemical 
fixation. Before the company accepts contaminated materials, it identifies a third party “beneficial reuse” site such as commercial 
redevelopment or landfill capping where the materials will be sent after they are treated. Clean Earth operates 18 permitted facilities 
in the Eastern United States.  Revenues from the environmental recycling facilities are generally recognized at the time of receipt.

For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 (from the date of acquisition), Clean 
Earth had net sales of approximately $189.0 million, $175.4 million and $68.4 million, respectively, and operating income of $7.9 
million, $11.0 million and $2.7 million, respectively. Clean Earth had total assets of $356.3 million and $338.2 million at December 
31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.  Net sales from Clean Earth represented 19.3% of our consolidated net sales for the year ended 
December 31, 2016, 24.1% of our consolidated net sales for 2015, and 9.7% of our consolidated net sales for 2014 (from the date 
of acquisition). 

We purchased a majority interest in Clean Earth on August 26, 2014.

History of Clean Earth

Clean Earth was founded in 1990 with the establishment of a contaminated material treatment facility in New Castle, Delaware 
focused on processing soils. The treatment of contaminated materials has diversified significantly over the years as Clean Earth 
now also processes dredged material, coal ash, hazardous waste and drill cuttings. Clean Earth has been able to grow consistently 
via both organic initiatives and acquisition. In 1997, the Company opened Clean Earth of Carteret, which was the first “fixed-
based” bioremediation facility permitted in the State of New Jersey. In 1998, Clean Earth started offering hazardous waste treatment 
after acquiring S&W Waste, now Clean Earth of North Jersey, a fully permitted commercial Resource Conservation and Recovery 
Act (“RCRA”) Part B Treatment, Storage & Disposal Facility (“TSDF”). That same year, Clean Earth also expanded services into 
the  treatment  of  dredged  material  through  the  acquisition  of  Consolidated  Technologies  Inc.  (now  Clean  Earth  Dredging 
Technologies). Today, Clean Earth is one of the largest providers of contaminated materials treatment in the East. In addition to 
diversifying the number of contaminated materials it handles, Clean Earth has also significantly expanded its geography. The 
Company now operates permitted facilities from Connecticut  to Florida, and with its recent acquisitions, Clean Earth has expanded 
their footprint of permitted facilities to Kentucky, West Virginia and Alabama.

Industry

Overview 
The U.S. environmental services industry is highly fragmented, with Clean Earth most closely correlated with the remediation 
and hazardous waste management segments of the industry. Historically, growth in these sectors has been primarily driven by 
increasing regulations and growing volume of waste generated, and is now positively affected by increases in waste disposal costs 
and resulting landfill avoidance trends. Other trends driving growth include increasing concern in corporate America regarding 
environmental liabilities and a push by companies to outsource a larger amount of environmental services to a smaller number of 
service providers due to increasing compliance costs. 

Contaminated Materials
Contamination of soils and other materials is prevalent and often caused by the introduction of chemicals, petroleum hydrocarbons, 
solvents, pesticides, lead and other heavy metals into the earth. These contaminants are common in areas of industrialization and 
severely impact the environment as a result of inadequate containment or improper disposal.  As a result of their prevalence and 
impact, these contaminates are subject to ever more stringent environmental regulations which now govern the handling, treatment, 
and disposal of these contaminants. As a result, when soil or other materials are removed from a site, they must be tested. The 
strong likelihood that materials will contain some level of contamination generates consistent demand for treatment and beneficial 
reuse solutions. Contaminated materials are routinely associated with infrastructure, commercial development, and other excavation 
projects, heavy industrial activity, spill clean-up or environmental remediation projects, locations with former manufactured gas 
plants (“MGP”), underground storage tanks (“UST”) or aboveground storage tanks, and a wide variety of increasingly regulated 
waste streams. 

45

   
Dredge Market
Dredging is the act of removing sediment from the bottom of waterways, both inland (rivers and canals) and ocean (floors, harbors, 
channels, etc.), and is performed for both navigational and environmental purposes. Like soil, most dredged material largely 
contains some level of contamination, particularly in current or historically industrially active areas. Accordingly, the Environmental 
Protection Agency (the "EPA") has established regulations that govern the disposal methods of dredged material, including the 
Marine Protection, Research and Sanctuaries Act (“MPRSA”), and the Federal Water Pollution Control Act, or the Clean Water 
Act.

The treatment and beneficial reuse of dredged material began in 1995, when various government entities in New Jersey and New 
York permitted a unique project to demonstrate the feasibility of using treated and processed dredged material to reclaim a former 
landfill and repurpose it for a new building project. Regulations require contaminated dredge spoils to be taken upland for treatment 
or disposal in accordance with Title 33 as administered by the United States Army Corps of Engineers and the EPA. Once treated, 
dredged material is used for structural fill and development purposes. 

Hazardous Waste
The hazardous waste services industry encompasses the generation, collection, treatment, and ultimate disposal of wastes classified 
as hazardous by RCRA. RCRA, the primary law governing the disposal of solid and hazardous waste, was passed by Congress 
in 1976 to address increasing problems associated with growing volumes of municipal and industrial waste.  

Accidents, spills, leaks, and improper handling and disposal of hazardous materials and waste have resulted in the contamination 
of land, water and air in the U.S. The U.S. generated 34 million tons of hazardous waste in 2011, according to the EPA. These 
wastes come primarily from three sources, Superfund sites, routine business and the increasingly expanding waste regulations.

In order to address these environmental hazards, the EPA established a program known as the Superfund, which allows the EPA 
to clean up such sites, or to compel responsible parties to perform clean-ups or reimburse the EPA for its clean-up expenses. This 
includes regulatory requirements that raise both the monetary and reputational costs for non-compliance. The Superfund program 
has identified tens of thousands of sites that require treatment over its more than 20-year history.  

Outside of the known Superfund sites, hazardous waste is also generated during the routine course of business and manufacturing, 
requiring the same care of handling by a specialized treatment facility. The generation of hazardous waste is common throughout 
the chemicals and petrochemical, steel, general manufacturing, government, aerospace and public utilities industries. Within the 
U.S., the Northeast region is one of the most densely concentrated areas for generators of hazardous waste.  

In addition to hazardous waste generated by industrial activity, increasingly complex regulations have expanded the scope of what 
is  considered  hazardous  waste  from  non-traditional  sources,  such  as  retailers  and  households.  For  instance,  environmental 
regulations require large quantity generators such as big box retailers to dispose of all returned or damaged  products that include 
pesticides, aerosols, fertilizers and cleaners through a permitted hazardous waste disposal program. Similarly, household products, 
such as paints, oils, batteries, fluorescent light bulbs and pesticides, which contain potentially hazardous ingredients, require special 
treatment and disposal.

Growing and Increasingly Regulated Waste Streams 
Federal, state and local regulators have continuously expanded legal guidelines to include additional waste streams, becoming 
increasingly vigilant to ensure the proper treatment and disposal of an ever-increasing number of contaminants. Two of the most 
prevalent increasingly regulated waste streams include drill cuttings from natural gas drilling and coal ash, a byproduct of fossil 
fuel power plants.  

Services
Clean Earth provides services to a variety of customers handling numerous unique sites that often require a range of custom 
solutions based upon project-specific factors. Clean Earth provides its core material treatment capabilities and complementary 
services. In addition to its treatment offerings, Clean Earth also provides turnkey services that include proper identification of 
waste services, management of all transportation and logistics, appropriate testing and analytics, manifesting/documentation and 
environmentally compliant placement of treated materials at backend locations. 

Site Planning and Sampling
Before work commences, Clean Earth has the ability to conduct waste characterization services consisting of field sampling, 
contaminated material collection and laboratory analysis. Properly identifying waste contaminants upfront can be important, as 
misclassification  leads  to  mishandling  of  the  waste,  which  can  be  costly  in  terms  of  fines,  penalties,  reduced  recycling  rates 
(increased disposal fees), and lost project time. Results are analyzed to assess time, cost and logistics, which give Clean Earth the 
ability to provide customers with a disposal recommendation and a cost-effective solution. 

46

Testing and Analytics
Clean Earth utilizes internal and external, fully-certified and approved laboratories that perform field sampling and contaminated 
material collection, laboratory analysis, site sampling plans and sampling location diagrams. Laboratory testing is customizable, 
and Clean Earth determines appropriate testing methods to assess the quantity and type of contaminant in the material. Clean Earth 
analyzes the results to determine an appropriate treatment and beneficial reuse plan specific to each material. Clean Earth maintains 
a state-certified hazardous waste laboratory in the New York metropolitan area at its Kearny, New Jersey facility. 

Transportation and Logistics
Clean Earth operates an asset-light business model in which it arranges for transportation of the materials on behalf of its customers 
via pre-qualified independent hauling companies for the vast majority of its volume. Due to Clean Earth’s ability to provide year-
round work for transportation companies and its consistent payment practices, it has developed very strong and long-standing 
relationships with its vendors, providing a large pool of available trucks to complete projects efficiently. 

Manifesting and Documentation
Clean Earth provides uniform manifests for customer projects that can be used throughout its network of facilities. These manifests 
provide tracking of all material moved from a customer site to its facilities and eventually to the final beneficial use site. Furthermore, 
these documents are maintained and submitted to regulatory agencies such as the EPA for their review.  

Treatment
Clean Earth offers several processes to treat, stabilize and/or decharacterize waste material and subsequently avoid costly landfill 
disposal and meet strict regulatory and site-specific requirements before being beneficially reused.  

•  Thermal Desorption 

Primarily used to treat soil with high levels of volatile contaminants by heating it in a rotating dryer to volatilize and then 
subsequently destroy the contaminants
The treated material then enters a soil conditioner (called a pugmill), where it is cooled and rehydrated
Finally,  the  cooled  soil  is  stockpiled,  sampled,  and  tested  by  an  independent  certified  laboratory  to  ensure  effective 
treatment and fulfillment of reuse standards
This treatment method is primarily used for soils that contain high levels of contaminants, such as soil from manufactured 
gas plant sites

• 

Stabilization of Dredged Material

Dredged sediments are screened to remove large objects and excess water
The remaining material is fed through a conveyor belt to a pugmill mixing system, where proprietary reagent admixtures 
are introduced
The resulting material is valued for its geotechnical properties and is beneficially reused as fill material

•  Bioremediation 

Used to treat soil that is  contaminated with petroleum hydrocarbons
Involves inoculating  the contaminated material with  engineered bacteria and nutrients to break down the contaminants
The bacteria consume and process  the nutrients and  the hydrocarbons  thereby remediating the contaminants

•  Chemical Fixation   

Used for light to medium hydrocarbon and/or contaminated material impacted by light or heavy metals
Soil is  screened, and paired with chemical additives to formulate a chemically stable and geotechnically desirable  material 

•  Physical Treatment/Screening  

Special  sizing  and  segregation  processes  remove  unsuitable  materials  from  inbound  materials  to  meet  site-specific 
geotechnical specifications
The segregated material, often rock, can be mixed with other material for reuse or crushed to create aggregate material 
for resale

Placement at Backend Sites
Clean Earth maintains a vast network of permitted, active backend locations owned by third parties that utilize its treated materials 
to achieve site specifications and/or meet regulatory obligations. Clean Earth operates a system in which before accepting any 
material it identifies which specific backend site will accept it and how much it will cost to treat, transport, and place. Its beneficial 
reuse solutions serve as an alternative to permitted landfill disposal and incineration. In order to ensure sufficient capacity for any 
future project, the Clean Earth continuously seeks to add backend sites to its network. 

47

Business Strategies

Growth in Clean Earth’s business is primarily focused in five areas:

Continued participation in large and growing end markets
Within  the  U.S.  environmental  services  market,  Clean  Earth  primarily  operates  within  the  remediation  and  hazardous  waste 
management  segments.  Growth  in  the  industry  will  be  driven  by  numerous  secular  trends,  including  an  increasing  national 
awareness  and  dedication  to  environmental  stewardship,  regulatory  guidelines  for  a  growing  number  of  contaminated  waste 
streams, and increasing prevalence of and preference for cost-effective landfill avoidance and recycling strategies. As a result of 
these market trends, generators or those responsible for contaminated waste streams will likely seek to utilize service providers 
like Clean Earth that can offer environmentally compliant and cost-effective solutions for their treatment and disposal needs.

Contaminated Materials
Clean  Earth’s  operations  are  diversified  across  a  variety  of  stable  end  markets  focused  primarily  in  the  power,  oil  &  gas, 
infrastructure and industrial industries. Clean Earth has also positioned itself to capitalize on future increases in the commercial 
development sector. 

Dredged Material
Clean Earth has maintained a strong position in the New York and New Jersey harbors for its dredged material management and 
recycling services. Demand for Clean Earth’s services has grown such that it constructed a second dredge processing facility in 
2009. Outside of the New York and New Jersey harbors, increased demand for maintenance projects is expected to be driven 
largely by the increasing size of heavy shipping vessels and expansion of the Panama Canal. As waterways are deepened, sediment 
accumulates in greater volume, which must be regularly removed to maintain the new depth. 

Hazardous Waste
Clean Earth maintains unique hazardous waste operations in an active region of the United States. There are significant number 
of hazardous waste generators in the U.S. that are located in New York and New Jersey and Clean Earth operates one the few 
commercial RCRA Part B permitted TSDFs in the New York metro area. Clean Earth is currently able to accept hazardous liquids, 
solids and gasses, as well as a variety of other specialty waste classes, including lab-packs, electronic waste, universal waste, 
wastewater, household hazardous waste, medical waste, used oils and antifreeze. Clean Earth can also accept nonhazardous waste 
at this facility.  In addition to its hazardous waste facility in New Jersey, Clean Earth also operates RCRA Part B facilities in 
Calvert City, KY and Morgantown, WV.

Increasing share in existing markets
Clean Earth has historically increased the volume of materials processed at its existing facilities by expanding the scope of its 
existing permits and developing new treatment and processing techniques. The permitting expertise of its environmental, health, 
and  safety  organization  allows  Clean  Earth  to  be  proactive  in  seeking  additional  waste  streams  and  adaptable  to  changing 
contaminants found in the materials it manages, as well as in newly regulated materials.  

Numerous dynamics have made the market increasingly beneficial for Clean Earth in its core markets. These dynamics include 
stricter regulations, increasing levels of enforcement and a more discerning customer base. 

Accelerating participation in increasingly regulated end markets 
Within its current footprint, there are opportunities for Clean Earth to continue to expand the scope of its service offering by adding 
additional specialty waste streams.   

Continued tuck-in acquisition growth
Since 2011, Clean Earth has expanded its footprint by launching operations in Florida (acquired), the Marcellus Shale (greenfield), 
Georgia (acquired), Kentucky (acquired), West Virginia (acquired), Greater Washington, D.C. region (acquired and repurposed) 
Connecticut (acquired) and Alabama (acquired).

The market for waste management services is highly fragmented, with many companies operating a single facility. Accordingly, 
there are several tuck-in acquisition opportunities in Clean Earth’s marketplace that would enable it to continue growing in existing 
and adjacent markets, as well as in new geographies.  

Platform expansion opportunities
While Clean Earth has historically remained focused on its core markets, many opportunities exist to diversify and augment its 
environmental service offering using Clean Earth as a platform. Clean Earth can acquire select competitors and industrial services 
companies, as well as pursue vertical integration prospects and new treatment technologies. 

48

 
Customers

Clean Earth serves approximately 1,700 customers at more than 6,300 discrete sites. The Company maintains strong relationships 
with customers at various levels of the decision and supply chain, including public and private corporations and property owners, 
as well as environmental consultants, brokers, construction firms, municipalities, and regulatory agencies, among others. 

In 2016, 2015 and 2014, the top 10 customers accounted for approximately 25%, 28% and 45% of net sales, respectively.  While 
Clean Earth works with certain customers that have recurring needs for disposal and recycling solutions, its revenue per customer 
changes frequently. Many of the Clean Earth's customers are long-time customers, but do not generate a consistent amount of 
revenue year in, year out. Consequently, Clean Earth is more focused on winning specific “projects” as opposed to winning the 
business of a particular customer. 

Seasonality

Clean Earth typically has lower earnings in the winter months due to limits on outdoor construction due to colder weather and 
dredging due to environmental restrictions in certain waterways in the Northeastern United States.

Sales and Marketing

Clean Earth’s team is comprised of 28 sales and marketing professionals that are primarily focused on direct selling to customers. 
Clean Earth is focused on servicing customers at various levels of the decision and supply chain, including waste generators, 
environmental service companies, consultants, construction and engineering firms, commercial developers, municipalities and 
government-sponsored  organizations,  and  regulatory  agencies,  among  others.  Clean  Earth  has  spent  years  developing  direct 
relationships with its clients, many of whom routinely generate large volumes of waste and demand treatment and disposal solutions 
at various sites and locations. 

The large dredging contractors manage the vast majority of the dredging activity. Clean Earth has built relationships with these 
contractors to ensure it is well-positioned to serve as many of the large or small dredging projects in the New York/New Jersey 
harbor and surrounding waterways, as possible.  

Clean Earth is a long-standing member of multiple national, regional, and local organizations throughout the U.S. The Company 
also conducts annual customer surveys, manages a focused advertising campaign, participates in trade shows, and has an extensive 
web presence. 

Competition

Competitive Landscape
The environmental services market is highly fragmented with numerous participants. However, a majority of these companies 
specialize in a narrower scope of services or treatment capabilities. Industry competitors relevant to Clean Earth’s served markets 
range from large public companies to small, single-service participants. Competition primarily includes processors of contaminated 
soils, dredging companies (to a limited extent), waste treatment providers and waste management companies. In Clean Earth’s 
core markets, competition tends to be primarily comprised of regional services providers or single-service companies with limited 
scale.  Given  these  dynamics,  we  believe  the  industry  will  likely  favor  players  such  as  Clean  Earth  that  have  large  scale  and 
management teams with many years of experience and extensive familiarity with the regulatory landscape.

Barriers to Entry

•  Permits - Clean Earth maintains an extensive portfolio of regulatory permits, including 107 active permits and 140 permit 
modifications. Each facility maintains various local, state, and federal authorizations for the acceptance, treatment, and 
beneficial reuse of a wide variety of hazardous and nonhazardous materials, as well as all necessary air and water discharge 
permits required for operation. These permits are extremely difficult to obtain due to the complex navigation of multiple 
layers of regulation, lengthy and costly public review periods and typical public NIMBY opposition. Clean Earth maintains 
a large team of environmental, health and safety experts that have developed trusted relationships and credibility with 
local, state and federal regulatory agencies over the last 25 years. 

•  Extensive Network - The Company’s extensive network of 18 permitted facilities is strategically located near major waste 
generation centers with an abundance of regulations governing waste treatment and disposal. Given transportation costs, 
the proximity of Clean Earth’s facilities to key markets and convenient access to rail, barge, and trucking transportation 
are significant competitive advantages that drive profitability. Furthermore, its maintenance of multiple backend beneficial 
reuse  sites  provides  flexibility  to  direct  volume  to  the  most  appropriate  facilities  based  on  available  processing  and 
placement capacity.

49

  
Regulatory Environment

Clean Earth’s facility operations are subject to various local, state, and federal authorizations for the acceptance, treatment, and 
beneficial reuse of a wide variety of hazardous and nonhazardous materials, as well as all necessary air and water discharge permits 
required for operation. These permits are extremely difficult to obtain due to the complex navigation of multiple layers of regulation, 
lengthy  and  costly  public  review  periods,  and  typical  public  NIMBY  opposition.    Clean  Earth  maintains  a  large  team  of 
environmental, health, and safety experts that have developed trusted relationships and credibility with local, state, and federal 
regulatory agencies over the last 25 years. Management believes that Clean Earth is in compliance, in all material respects, with 
applicable environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. 

Employees

Clean Earth is led by a capable management team of industry veterans that possess a balanced combination of industry experience 
and operational expertise. The current senior management team has over 150 years of cumulative experience with an average 
tenure of approximately 10 years at Clean Earth. Current management has implemented numerous operational, strategic, and 
financial initiatives over the past several years.  In addition to the senior management team, there are operational managers that 
hold significant responsibilities across the business and work closely with management on a daily basis. 

Clean Earth employs approximately 434 hourly and salaried employees located throughout the United States.  Clean Earth’s 
employees are compensated at levels commensurate with industry standards, based on their respective position and job grade. 

Clean Earth’s workforce is non-union except for approximately 25 hourly employees at its dredge facilities, who are represented 
by International Union of Operating Engineers Local No. 825 (IUOE Local 825). Clean Earth enjoys good labor relations with 
its employees and union and has a three year contract in place with the IUOE Local 825, which will expire in July 2019. 

Sterno Products 

Overview

Sterno Products, headquartered in Corona, California, is a manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming fuel and creative 
table lighting solutions for the foodservice industry. Sterno Products offers a broad range of wick and gel chafing fuels, butane 
stoves and accessories, liquid wax, traditional wax and flameless candles, catering equipment and lamps.  As the leading supplier 
of canned heat to foodservice distributors and foodservice group purchasing organizations, Sterno Products is always pursuing 
end-user solutions and innovations to strengthen its position in the marketplace.  For over 100 years, the iconic "Sterno" brand 
has been synonymous with quality canned heat. The heritage of reliability and innovation continues today, as Sterno Products 
continues to bring to market new products that give foodservice industry professionals greater control over food quality and décor.    
In January 2016, Sterno Products acquired all of the outstanding stock of  Northern International, Inc. (NII). NII markets and 
manufactures a complete array of outdoor and indoor lighting products aimed at the Home Improvement / Home Decor Market. 
NII’s product offerings includes a full line of innovative patented flameless candles, traditional house and garden lighting including 
path lights, spotlights, bollards, coach and security lights as well as emerging décor categories of illuminated products such as 
post caps, deck, patio and fence lighting and other popular novelty products including stick lights, string lights, baskets and lanterns. 
The flameless candles and novelty lighting are powered by solar or battery power and the more traditional outdoor lighting fixtures 
are driven via solar power or low voltage technologies.  Northern International Inc. (NII) brands include Candle Impressions®, 
Mirage®, Night Splendor® and Inglow® for flameless candles as well as Paradise Garden Lighting®, Manor House®, Style 
Line® and Lumabrite® for outdoor décor and security lighting.

For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 (from the date of acquisition) Sterno 
Products had net sales of approximately $218.8 million, $140.0 million and $36.7 million, respectively, and operating income of 
$18.8 million and $13.2 million in 2016 and 2015, respectively, and an operating loss of $1.8 million in 2014 (from date of 
acquisition).  Sterno Products had total assets of $213.4 million and $174.9 million at December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively.  
Sterno's net sales for the years ended December 31, 2016, December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 (from the date of acquisition) 
represented 22.4%, 19.2% and 5.8% of our consolidated net sales, respectively.  

History of Sterno Products

Sterno Products was formed in 2012 with the merger of two manufacturers and marketers of portable food warming fuel products, 
The Sterno Group LLC and the Candle Lamp Company, LLC.  Sterno’s history dates back to 1893 when S. Sternau & Co. began 
making chafing dishes and coffee percolators in Tenafly, New Jersey.  In 1914, S. Sternau & Co. introduced “canned heat” with 
the launch of its gelled ethanol product under the “Sterno” brand.  Since then, the Sternau and Sterno names have been the most 

50

well-known names in portable food warming fuel.  In 1917, S. Sternau & Co. was renamed The Sterno Corporation.  During World 
War I, Sterno portable stoves were promoted as an essential gift for soldiers going to fight in the trenches of Europe.  Sterno stoves 
heated water and rations, sterilized surgical instruments, and provided light and warmth in bunkers and foxholes.  During World 
War II, Sterno produced ethanol and methanol chafing fuels under contract with the U.S. military.  Sterno's production facilities 
were moved from New Jersey to Texarkana, Texas in the early 1980s. 

The Candle Lamp Company, LLC was founded in Riverside, California in 1978, focusing initially on the liquid wax candle market.  
Over the next several decades, CandleLamp began to supply chafing fuel in addition to lighting products.  The Candle Lamp 
Company operated manufacturing facilities in Riverside, California and Memphis, Tennessee.  In 2012, the Candle Lamp Company 
entered  into  negotiations  to  acquire The  Sterno  Group  LLC,  consummating  a  transaction  in  October  2012,  and  immediately 
rebranded the new company Sterno Products.  Today, Sterno Products operates out of its corporate headquarters in Corona California 
and two manufacturing facilities in Texarkana, Texas and Memphis, Tennessee.

NII was formed in 1997 by its three founding partners who had been in the import and product development business since 1979. 
The success in the outdoor lighting an innovative use of LED technology evolved into the development of patented flameless 
candle product line. NII’s flameless candle evolved the battery operated candle market from a functional safety oriented product 
into an attractive décor piece meant to enhance the beauty of consumer’s homes. 

We purchased Sterno Products on October 10, 2014.

Industry 

Sterno Products competes in the broadly defined U.S. foodservice industry, which is expected to grow to at a 2-3% compounded 
annual rate through 2016. Restaurant, catering and hospitality sales accounted for approximately 67% of the market with the 
remainder comprised of the travel and leisure, education and healthcare related sales. At present, the Sterno Products' sales are 
concentrated in the U.S. foodservice industry; specifically, Sterno Products’ focus is on safe, portable fire solutions for cooking 
and warming, as well as tabletop lighting décor.   

Within the foodservice industry, the catering market represents over $45 billion dollars in sales in 2013, with industry revenues 
doubling over the last 10 years according to the 2013 National Restaurant Association Industry Forecast.  According to an IBISWorld 
November 2014 report, demand for catering will take a positive turn in the next five years, after the recession and low consumer 
sentiment temporarily stifled revenue. A rise in demand from high-income households and businesses will bolster growth, with 
consumers spending more money on parties and other catered functions and corporate budgets loosening in line with stronger 
corporate profit. 

NII competes in the outdoor lighting and home decor industry.  NII's sales are concentrated in the United States and Canada, with 
a small percentage of sales coming through global retailers with locations in Japan, Taiwan, the United Kingdom and Australia.  
Management believes that a rise in demand from high-income households and businesses will bolster growth, with consumers 
spending more money on the cocooning trend and specifically on beautifying their indoor and outdoor home, changing out trendy 
accent items more frequently and investing in more spacious and comfortable outdoor spaces with many equivalent amenities of 
their indoor spaces.

Products and Services

Sterno Products is a “full-line” supplier offering a broad array of portable chafing fuels,  table lighting and outdoor lighting products 
with  approximately  400  SKUs  serving  the  foodservice  and  retail  markets.   The  Company  originally  focused  on  chafing  fuel 
(“canned heat”) products and later expanded its offerings to include table ambiance products such as liquid wax, wax candles and 
votive lamp, as well as outdoor lighting with the acquisition of NII in 2016.  Sterno Products’ products fall into five major categories: 
canned heat, table lighting, flameless candles and outdoor lighting, catering equipment and butane products.

Canned Heat - The canned heat product line is composed of various chafing fuels packaged in small, portable cans. The portable 
warming (canned heat) line is composed of various wick-based and gel-based chafing fuels packaged in steel cans. These products 
are used by foodservice professionals in a variety of food serving and holding applications and are designed to keep food products 
at an optimal food-safe serving temperature of 140-165 Fahrenheit.  The canned heat product line is composed of two subcategories: 
wick chafing fuel and gel chafing fuel. The subcategories are distinguished based on the type of chafing fuel being used; the four 
primary  chafing  fuels  are  diethylene  glycol  (“DEG”),  propylene  glycol,  ethanol  and  methanol.  Each  fuel  contains  unique 
characteristics and properties that allow the Company to offer a broad array of configurations to suit varying user requirements.  

Wick chafing Fuel

The wick chafing fuel line (“Wick”) is composed of either DEG or propylene glycol chafing fuel. DEG and propylene glycol 
chafing fuels with advance wick technology have higher heat output than alternatives such as ethanol and methanol. The liquid 

51

Wick products feature a variety of wick types and burn times to meet the specific needs of the user. Wick fuels are clean burning, 
biodegradable, nonflammable if spilled (will not ignite without a wick) and the can stays cool to the touch when lit.

Gel Chafing Fuel

The gel chafing fuel line (“Gel”) is composed of either gelled ethanol or gelled methanol chafing fuel.  Ethanol chafing fuel has 
a higher heat output than methanol fuel; both ethanol and methanol fuels have lower heat output than some DEG and propylene 
glycol products. The Gel product line tends to have shorter burn times than the Wick product.

For an Environmentally preferred chafing fuel, the Company offers a patented line of “Green” chafing fuels featuring USDA 
Certified Biobased Product formulas that are also endorsed by the Green Restaurant Association. The “Green Heat” and “Green 
Wick” products perform similar to the Wick and Gel chafing fuels, but are made from renewable resources that are biodegradable 
and more environmentally friendly.

Table Lighting - Sterno Products sells a variety of items designed to enhance lighting and ambiance at meal settings which are 
critical to a customer’s experience.  Products include liquid wax, traditional hard wax and flameless electronic candles, as well as 
votive lamps, shaded lamps and accent lamps.

Flameless Candles and Outdoor Lighting - Through the NII subsidiary, Sterno offers a offers a wide selection of lighting for 
your home, garden, patio and yard with over 1000 SKUS available in our retail markets. NII first delved into lighting with lighting 
fixtures for illuminating front and backyard pathways. NII quickly expanded its line to include other types of home lighting 
products, most notably bollards, shepherd hook lights and line voltage powered coach lights and street lights. NII’s 20-year history 
of providing high quality, low cost consumer-directed lighting has cemented it as a top tier supplier in both the flameless candle 
and outdoor lighting categories. All of NII’s products are powered by one of the following:

Solar - solar panel with rechargeable power source - usually a rechargeable battery

• 
•  Battery - battery operated
• 

Plug-in - plugs directly into a regular wall socket either with 2 or 3 prong plug and with or without included and attached 
transformer

•  Low Voltage - part of a set which includes a stand-alone transformer. Fixtures connect through a stand-alone wire via 

clip connectors

•  Line Voltage - hardwired into a home's electrical circuitry
•  Rechargeable - product is recharged when empty usually through a plug in wire and an onboard rechargeable power 

source

Flameless Candles

The flameless candle product line is made up of various types and sizes of candles with all of them sharing the one main attribute: 
their glow is powered by an artificial power source, most often battery. This makes them inherently safer than traditional candles 
as there is no flame or even heat generated to cause any type of accidents. Although pillar type candles are the most common 
shape, NII also designs and manufactures votives, tealights, tapers as well as specialty molded candles. NII was also the first to 
introduce the timer function to their flameless candle line. NII’s candles stand out from the competition as they are the only 
manufacturer that offers the patented black wick.  NII also developed its unique algorithm-based light circuit which gives the 
candle a naturally random flicker and glow.

Landscape Lighting 

The landscape lighting category was NII’s first offering. Starting with simple low voltage path lights, NII quickly expanded its 
offering to reflect the growing needs of the DIY and home décor consumer. Landscape lighting is lighting that promotes and 
accentuates elements of a consumer’s home, yard or garden so its beauty can be enjoyed both in daytime and nighttime. Another 
benefit of landscape lighting is added safety as it is easier to navigate around a home at night when it is reasonably well-lit. 
Landscape lighting was originally most commonly powered through a low voltage setup but as solar technologies have rapidly 
developed, many of these fixtures can achieve their lighting purposes with only a solar panel as power generation. Consumers 
with higher and more consistent lighting requirements most often opt for low voltage kits using wire and transformers to light 
their fixtures. Solar powered fixtures are advantageous for those consumers looking for cheaper and quicker to set up lighting 
solutions even if it often means lesser lumens and light. Another notable technology has been the development of LED lighting. 
LED’s more efficient power generation technology has allowed for advantageous fixture designs and a higher level of power 
generation which were not easy or as cost effective to achieve as with legacy lighting technologies such as incandescent or halogen. 
LEDs also last longer and are generally more robust than older technologies. 

Décor Lighting

Décor lighting is NII’s newest category. Décor lighting has similar functions to landscape lighting but is usually less about safety 
and functionality and more about accenting an area of the outside home with ornamentation of some sort. With a décor piece, the 
52

light the piece gives off and the item itself together become elements of beauty in the setting. Because these items are very trend 
driven, consumers are more apt to switch them out more often therefore increasing repeat purchase potential and other recurrent 
sales opportunities for NII.  Some of the most common categories of décor lighting are lanterns and baskets and string lighting.

Catering Equipment - Catering equipment products are designed to provide a complete commercial catering solution whether 
indoor or outdoor.  Products include chafing dish frames and lids, wind guards and buffet sets.

Butane - Sterno Products produces a full line of professional quality portable butane stoves, ideal for action stations, made-to-
order omelet lines, tableside and off-site cooking, outdoor events and more.  Products also include select butane accessories for 
special culinary applications such as the culinary torch. Sterno Products butane fuel comes with an additional safety feature called 
Countersink Release Vent (CRV) Technology.

Sterno Products sells into FoodService, Retail and OEM markets with foodservice accounts comprising approximately 75% of 
sales and Retail and OEM comprising approximately 25% of sales.

Competitive Strengths 

Leading Brand Recognition & Market Share - Sterno Products is the market share leader in the canned chafing fuel market. 
Management believes Sterno Products enjoys outstanding brand awareness and a reputation for superior quality and performance 
with distributors, caterers, hotels and other end users.  NII offers a wide variety of products to a cross section of North American 
retail and our diversity gives us a unique standing in this marketplace. Most of NII’s competitors specialize in one aspect of 
fulfilling the market. They either only sell to a few retailers or only actively develop few or even only one category of product. 
This exposes them to major financial challenges when they lose that account or when that product is beat out by a competitor or 
starts to wane in the marketplace. 

Low Cost versus Alternatives - Sterno Products’ customers are typically caterers, hotels or restaurants who utilize canned chafing 
fuel to maintain prepared food at a safe and enjoyable serving temperature. The risk of ruining a dining experience and the low 
proportionate cost of canned chafing fuel relative to the cost of a catered event represent significant barriers to customers switching 
out of Sterno Products’ canned chafing fuel products.  Additionally, management believes that there is no other technology available 
today that offers the portability, reliability and low cost of the Sterno Products canned chafing fuel products.     

Business Strategies

Defend Leading Market Position - As a leading supplier of canned fuels , flameless candles and outdoor lighting, Sterno Products’ 
places great value delivering unmatched customer service and product selection.  In a market characterized by fragmented categories 
and competition, Sterno Products will continue to focus on providing the best in class service to its customers.  Sterno Products 
has been the recipient of numerous vendor awards for its high degree of customer service.

Pursue Selective Acquisitions - Sterno Products views acquisitions as a potentially attractive means to expand its product offerings 
in the foodservice and retail channels as well as enter new international markets. 

Expand Retail Distribution - Sterno Products’ management believes that there is an opportunity to leverage the iconic nature of 
the “Sterno Products” brand to expand its retail product offering and to expand distribution into additional retailers. 

Customers and Distribution Channels

Sterno's products are sold primarily through the foodservice and consumer retail channels.  Sterno’s product distribution network 
is comprised of long-standing, entrenched relationships with a diversified set of customers.  Sterno’s top ten customers comprised 
approximately 59% and 69% of gross sales in the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, respectively. 

Foodservice - The foodservice channel consists of multiple layers of distribution comprised of broadline distributors, equipment 
and supply dealers and cash and carry dealers. Within the foodservice channel, Sterno’s products are predominantly used in the 
restaurant, lodging/hospitality and catering markets. 

Retail - The retail channel consists of club stores, mass merchants, specialty retailers, grocers and national and regional DIY 
stores. The Company’s retail products are used in home, camping and emergency applications. The Company’s retail products 
appeal to a wide variety of consumers, from home entertainers to recreational campers and extreme outdoorsmen.  Online retail 
sales are also an important channel for NII.  With an online dynamic, it is also much easier to showcase how NII’s products look 
in actual dark use conditions, directly addressing NII product’s primary merchandising challenge. 

Sterno  Products  had  approximately  $25.3  million  and  $3.6  million  in  firm  backlog  orders  at  December 31,  2016  and  2015, 
respectively, with the increase in 2016 backlog reflecting the acquisition of NII in January 2016.

53

Seasonality

Sterno typically has higher sales in the second and fourth quarter of each year, reflecting the outdoor summer season and the 
holiday season.  

Sales and marketing

Within the foodservice channel, Sterno Products directly employ sales professionals and utilizes a broad network of  independent 
sales  representative  firms  assigned  to  differing  U.S.  territories  managed  by  in-house  sales  management  professionals.  The 
independent sales representatives have long-standing relationships with distributors and end-users and typically represent 10 to 
20 of the best non-food product lines alongside the Company’s products. The independent sales representatives are used primarily 
to manage the day to day order fulfillment and customer relationships.  The independent sales representative firms are paid on a 
commission basis based on customer type and sales territory.

Within the retail channel, Sterno Products directly employ sales professionals and utilizes a network of independent retail sales 
broker firms. The independent retail sales brokers are paid on a commission basis based on customer type and sales territory. 
Sterno Products maintains direct sales relationships with many key customers.  NII also utilizes a  broad network of independent 
sales representative firms and retail-linked agencies. These agents and rep firms are managed by NII’s in-house sales management 
professionals.

Sterno Products has implemented a multi-faceted marketing plan which includes (i) targeted print advertising; (ii) tradeshows; 
(iii) increasing online education through the Sterno Products University and the NII websites; and (iv) social media.

Suppliers

Sterno's  product  manufacturing  is  based  on  a  dual  strategy  of  in-house manufacturing and strategic alliances with select 
vendors. Sterno operates an efficient, low-cost supply chain, sourcing materials and employing contract manufacturers from across 
the Asia-Pacific region and the U.S.

Sterno’s primary raw materials are Diethylene glycol, ethanol, liquid paraffin and steel cans for which it receives multiple shipments 
per month. Sterno Products purchases its materials from a combination of domestic and foreign suppliers. 

NII sources all of their inventory from China.  NII operates an efficient supply chain with emphasis on quality production and low 
cost. NII’s China-based support team in the Yuyao office permits NII to be more hands on in the factories reporting proactively 
on potential issues and working to implement practical solutions when required. 

Intellectual Property 

Sterno Products relies upon a combination of trademarks and patents in order to secure and protect its intellectual property rights.  
Sterno currently owns 44 trademarks and 6 patents in the U.S. and has 1 patent pending application at the U.S. Patent Offices.  
NII currently owns 125 trademarks and 122 patents in the U.S. and has 51 patent pending application at the U.S. Patent Offices.

Regulatory Environment

Sterno Products is proactive regarding regulatory issues and is in compliance with all relevant regulations. Sterno Products maintains 
adequate product liability insurance coverage. Management believes that Sterno is in compliance, in all material respects, with 
applicable environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. 

Employees 

As of December 31, 2016 Sterno Products employed approximately 320 persons in 3 locations, of which approximately 160 were 
temporary employees. None of Sterno Products’ employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements. We believe that Sterno 
Products’ relationship with its employees is good.

ITEM 1A.  RISK FACTORS

Risks Related to Our Business and Structure

Our future success is dependent on the employees of our Manager and the management teams of our businesses, the loss of 
any of whom could materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations.

Our future success depends, to a significant extent, on the continued services of the employees of our Manager, most of whom 
have worked together for a number of years. While our Manager will have employment agreements with certain of its employees, 
including our Chief Financial Officer, these employment agreements may not prevent our Manager’s employees from leaving or 
from competing with us in the future. Our Manager does not have an employment agreement with our Chief Executive Officer.
54

The future success of our businesses also depends on their respective management teams because we operate our businesses on 
a stand-alone basis, primarily relying on existing management teams for management of their day-to-day operations. Consequently, 
their operational success, as well as the success of our internal growth strategy, will be dependent on the continued efforts of the 
management teams of the businesses. We provide such persons with equity incentives in their respective businesses and have 
employment agreements and/or non-competition agreements with certain persons we have identified as key to their businesses. 
However, these measures may not prevent the departure of these managers. The loss of services of one or more members of our 
management team or the management team at one of our businesses could materially adversely affect our financial condition, 
business and results of operations.

We face risks with respect to the evaluation and management of future platform or add-on acquisitions.

A component of our strategy is to continue to acquire additional platform subsidiaries, as well as add-on businesses for our existing 
businesses. Generally, because such acquisition targets are held privately, we may experience difficulty in evaluating potential 
target businesses as the information concerning these businesses is not publicly available. In addition, we and our subsidiary 
companies may have difficulty effectively managing or integrating acquisitions. We may experience greater than expected costs 
or difficulties relating to such acquisition, in which case, we might not achieve the anticipated returns from any particular acquisition, 
which may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, business and results of operations.

We may not be able to successfully fund future acquisitions of new businesses due to the lack of availability of debt or equity 
financing at the Company level on acceptable terms, which could impede the implementation of our acquisition strategy and 
materially adversely impact our financial condition, business and results of operations.

In order to make future acquisitions, we intend to raise capital primarily through debt financing at the Company level, additional 
equity offerings, the sale of stock or assets of our businesses, and by offering equity in the Trust or our businesses to the sellers 
of target businesses or by undertaking a combination of any of the above. Since the timing and size of acquisitions cannot be 
readily predicted, we may need to be able to obtain funding on short notice to benefit fully from attractive acquisition opportunities. 
Such funding may not be available on acceptable terms. In addition, the level of our indebtedness may impact our ability to borrow 
at the Company level. Another source of capital for us may be the sale of additional shares, subject to market conditions and 
investor demand for the shares at prices that we consider to be in the interests of our shareholders. These risks may materially 
adversely affect our ability to pursue our acquisition strategy successfully and materially adversely affect our financial condition, 
business and results of operations.

While we intend to make regular cash distributions to our shareholders, the Company’s board of directors has full authority 
and discretion over the distributions of the Company, other than the profit allocation, and it may decide to reduce or eliminate 
distributions at any time, which may materially adversely affect the market price for our shares.

To date, we have declared and paid quarterly distributions, and although we intend to pursue a policy of paying regular distributions, 
the Company’s board of directors has full authority and discretion to determine whether or not a distribution by the Company 
should be declared and paid to the Trust and in turn to our shareholders, as well as the amount and timing of any distribution. In 
addition, the management fee and profit allocation will be payment obligations of the Company and, as a result, will be paid, along 
with other Company obligations, prior to the payment of distributions to our shareholders. The Company’s board of directors may, 
based on their review of our financial condition and results of operations and pending acquisitions, determine to reduce or eliminate 
distributions, which may have a material adverse effect on the market price of our shares.

We will rely entirely on receipts from our businesses to make distributions to our shareholders.

The Trust’s sole asset is its interest in the Company, which holds controlling interests in our businesses. Therefore, we are dependent 
upon the ability of our businesses to generate earnings and cash flow and distribute them to us in the form of interest and principal 
payments on indebtedness and, from time to time, dividends on equity to enable us, first, to satisfy our financial obligations and 
second to make distributions to our shareholders. This ability may be subject to limitations under laws of the jurisdictions in which 
they are incorporated or organized. If, as a consequence of these various restrictions, we are unable to generate sufficient receipts 
from our businesses, we may not be able to declare, or may have to delay or cancel payment of, distributions to our shareholders.

We do not own 100% of our businesses. While we receive cash payments from our businesses which are in the form of interest 
payments, debt repayment and dividends, if any dividends were to be paid by our businesses, they would be shared pro rata with 
the minority shareholders of our businesses and the amounts of dividends made to minority shareholders would not be available 
to us for any purpose, including Company debt service or distributions to our shareholders. Any proceeds from the sale of a business 
will be allocated among us and the non-controlling shareholders of the business that is sold.

55

The Company’s board of directors has the power to change the terms of our shares in its sole discretion in ways with which 
you may disagree.

As an owner of our shares, you may disagree with changes made to the terms of our shares, and you may disagree with the 
Company’s board of directors’ decision that the changes made to the terms of the shares are not materially adverse to you as a 
shareholder or that they do not alter the characterization of the Trust. Your recourse, if you disagree, will be limited because our 
Trust Agreement gives broad authority and discretion to our board of directors. However, the Trust Agreement does not relieve 
the Company’s board of directors from any fiduciary obligation that is imposed on them pursuant to applicable law. In addition, 
we may change the nature of the shares to be issued to raise additional equity and remain a fixed-investment trust for tax purposes.

Certain provisions of the LLC Agreement of the Company and the Trust Agreement make it difficult for third parties to acquire 
control of the Trust and the Company and could deprive you of the opportunity to obtain a takeover premium for your shares.

The amended and restated LLC Agreement of the Company, which we refer to as the LLC Agreement, and the amended and 
restated Trust Agreement of the Trust, which we refer to as the Trust Agreement, contain a number of provisions that could make 
it more difficult for a third party to acquire, or may discourage a third party from acquiring, control of the Trust and the Company. 
These provisions include, among others:

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 
• 

• 

• 

restrictions on the Company’s ability to enter into certain transactions with our major shareholders, with the exception 
of our Manager, modeled on the limitation contained in Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law, or DGCL;
allowing only the Company’s board of directors to fill newly created directorships, for those directors who are elected 
by our shareholders, and allowing only our Manager, as holder of a portion of the Allocation Interests, to fill vacancies 
with respect to the class of directors appointed by our Manager;
requiring that directors elected by our shareholders be removed, with or without cause, only by a vote of 85% of our 
shareholders;
requiring advance notice for nominations of candidates for election to the Company’s board of directors or for proposing 
matters that can be acted upon by our shareholders at a shareholders’ meeting;
having a substantial number of additional authorized but unissued shares that may be issued without shareholder action;
providing the Company’s board of directors with certain authority to amend the LLC Agreement and the Trust Agreement, 
subject to certain voting and consent rights of the holders of trust interests and Allocation Interests;
providing for a staggered board of directors of the Company, the effect of which could be to deter a proxy contest for 
control of the Company’s board of directors or a hostile takeover; and
limitations regarding calling special meetings and written consents of our shareholders.

These provisions, as well as other provisions in the LLC Agreement and Trust Agreement may delay, defer or prevent a transaction 
or a change in control that might otherwise result in you obtaining a takeover premium for your shares.

We may have conflicts of interest with the noncontrolling shareholders of our businesses.

The boards of directors of our respective businesses have fiduciary duties to all their shareholders, including the Company and 
noncontrolling shareholders. As a result, they may make decisions that are in the best interests of their shareholders generally but 
which are not necessarily in the best interest of the Company or our shareholders. In dealings with the Company, the directors of 
our businesses may have conflicts of interest and decisions may have to be made without the participation of directors appointed 
by the Company, and such decisions may be different from those that we would make.

Our third party credit facility exposes us to additional risks associated with leverage and inhibits our operating flexibility and 
reduces cash flow available for distributions to our shareholders.

At December 31, 2016, we had approximately $565.7 million outstanding under our 2014 Term Loan and 2016 Incremental Term 
Loan Facility and $8.6 million outstanding under our 2014 Revolving Credit Facility (representing the outstanding revolver balance 
and outstanding letters of credit). We expect to increase our level of debt in the future. The terms of our 2014 Revolving Credit 
Facility contains a number of affirmative and restrictive covenants that, among other things, require us to:

•  maintain a minimum level of cash flow;
leverage new businesses we acquire to a minimum specified level at the time of acquisition;
• 
• 
keep our total debt to cash flow at or below a ratio of 3.5 to 1; and
•  make acquisitions that satisfy certain specified minimum criteria.

If we violate any of these covenants, our lender may accelerate the maturity of any debt outstanding and we may be prohibited 
from making any distributions to our shareholders. Such debt is secured by all of our assets, including the stock we own in our 
businesses and the rights we have under the loan agreements with our businesses. Our ability to meet our debt service obligations 

56

may be affected by events beyond our control and will depend primarily upon cash produced by our businesses. Any failure to 
comply with the terms of our indebtedness could materially adversely affect us.

Changes in interest rates could materially adversely affect us.

Our Credit Facility bears interest at floating rates which will generally change as interest rates change. We bear the risk that the 
rates we are charged by our lender will increase faster than the earnings and cash flow of our businesses, which could reduce 
profitability, adversely affect our ability to service our debt, cause us to breach covenants contained in our Revolving Credit Facility 
and reduce cash flow available for distribution, any of which could materially adversely affect us.

We may engage in a business transaction with one or more target businesses that have relationships with our officers, our 
directors, our Manager or CGI, which may create potential conflicts of interest.

We may decide to acquire one or more businesses with which our officers, our directors, our Manager or CGI have a relationship. 
While we might obtain a fairness opinion from an independent investment banking firm, potential conflicts of interest may still 
exist with respect to a particular acquisition, and, as a result, the terms of the acquisition of a target business may not be as 
advantageous to our shareholders as it would have been absent any conflicts of interest.

We are exposed to risks relating to evaluations of controls required by Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

We are required to comply with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. While we have concluded that at December 31, 
2016 that we have no material weaknesses in our internal controls over financial reporting, we cannot assure you that we will not 
have a material weakness in the future. A “material weakness” is a control deficiency, or combination of significant deficiencies 
that results in more than a remote likelihood that a material misstatement of the annual or interim financial statements will not be 
prevented or detected. If we fail to maintain a system of internal controls over financial reporting that meets the requirements of 
Section 404, we might be subject to sanctions or investigation by regulatory authorities such as the SEC or by the New York Stock 
Exchange. Additionally, failure to comply with Section 404 or the report by us of a material weakness may cause investors to lose 
confidence in our financial statements and our stock price may be adversely affected. If we fail to remedy any material weakness, 
our financial statements may be inaccurate, we may not have access to the capital markets, and our stock price may be adversely 
affected.

CGI may exercise significant influence over the Company.

CGI, through a wholly owned subsidiary, owns 7,931,000 or approximately 13.2% of our shares and may have significant influence 
over the election of directors in the future.

We could be negatively impacted by cybersecurity attacks. 

We, and our businesses, use a variety of information technology systems in the ordinary course of business, which are potentially 
vulnerable to unauthorized access, computer viruses and cybersecurity attacks, including cybersecurity attacks to our information 
technology infrastructure and attempts by others to gain access to our propriety or sensitive information, and ranging from individual 
attempts to advanced persistent threats. The procedures and controls we use to monitor these threats and mitigate our exposure 
may not be sufficient to prevent cybersecurity incidents. The results of these incidents could include misstated financial data, theft 
of trade secrets or other intellectual property, liability for disclosure of confidential customer, supplier or employee information, 
increased costs arising from the implementation of additional security protective measures, litigation and reputational damage, 
which could materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations. Any remedial costs or other 
liabilities related to cybersecurity incidents may not be fully insured or indemnified by other means. 

If, in the future, we cease to control and operate our businesses, we may be deemed to be an investment company under the 
Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

Under the terms of the LLC Agreement, we have the latitude to make investments in businesses that we will not operate or control. 
If we make significant investments in businesses that we do not operate or control or cease to operate and control our businesses, 
we may be deemed to be an investment company under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, or the Investment 
Company Act. If we were deemed to be an investment company, we would either have to register as an investment company under 
the Investment Company Act, obtain exemptive relief from the SEC or modify our investments or organizational structure or our 
contract rights to fall outside the definition of an investment company. Registering as an investment company could, among other 
things, materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations, materially limit our ability to borrow 
funds or engage in other transactions involving leverage and require us to add directors who are independent of us or our Manager 
and otherwise will subject us to additional regulation that will be costly and time-consuming.

57

Risks Relating to Our Manager

Our Chief Executive Officer, directors, Manager and management team may allocate some of their time to other businesses, 
thereby causing conflicts of interest in their determination as to how much time to devote to our affairs, which may materially 
adversely affect our operations.

While the members of our management team anticipate devoting a substantial amount of their time to the affairs of the Company, 
only Mr. Ryan Faulkingham, our Chief Financial Officer, devotes substantially all of his time to our affairs. Our Chief Executive 
Officer, directors, Manager and members of our management team may engage in other business activities. This may result in a 
conflict of interest in allocating their time between our operations and our management and operations of other businesses. Their 
other  business  endeavors  may  be  related  to  CGI,  which  will  continue  to  own  several  businesses  that  were  managed  by  our 
management team prior to our initial public offering, or affiliates of CGI as well as other parties. Conflicts of interest that arise 
over the allocation of time may not always be resolved in our favor and may materially adversely affect our operations. See the 
section entitled “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” for the potential conflicts of interest of which you should 
be aware.

Our Manager and its affiliates, including members of our management team, may engage in activities that compete with us 
or our businesses.

While our management team intends to devote a substantial majority of their time to the affairs of the Company, and while our 
Manager and its affiliates currently do not manage any other businesses that are in similar lines of business as our businesses, and 
while our Manager must present all opportunities that meet the Company’s acquisition and disposition criteria to the Company’s 
board of directors, neither our management team nor our Manager is expressly prohibited from investing in or managing other 
entities, including those that are in the same or similar line of business as our businesses. In this regard, the management services 
agreement  and  the  obligation  to  provide  management  services  will  not  create  a  mutually  exclusive  relationship  between  our 
Manager and its affiliates, on the one hand, and the Company, on the other.

Our Manager need not present an acquisition or disposition opportunity to us if our Manager determines on its own that such 
acquisition or disposition opportunity does not meet the Company’s acquisition or disposition criteria.

Our  Manager  will  review  any  acquisition  or  disposition  opportunity  presented  to  the  Manager  to  determine  if  it  satisfies  the 
Company’s acquisition or disposition criteria, as established by the Company’s board of directors from time to time. If our Manager 
determines, in its sole discretion, that an opportunity fits our criteria, our Manager will refer the opportunity to the Company’s 
board of directors for its authorization and approval prior to the consummation thereof; opportunities that our Manager determines 
do not fit our criteria do not need to be presented to the Company’s board of directors for consideration. If such an opportunity is 
ultimately profitable, we will have not participated in such opportunity. Upon a determination by the Company’s board of directors 
not to promptly pursue an opportunity presented to it by our Manager in whole or in part, our Manager will be unrestricted in its 
ability to pursue such opportunity, or any part that we do not promptly pursue, on its own or refer such opportunity to other entities, 
including its affiliates.

We cannot remove our Manager solely for poor performance, which could limit our ability to improve our performance and 
could materially adversely affect the market price of our shares.

Under the terms of the management services agreement, our Manager cannot be removed as a result of under-performance. Instead, 
the Company’s board of directors can only remove our Manager in certain limited circumstances or upon a vote by the majority 
of the Company’s board of directors and the majority of our shareholders to terminate the management services agreement. This 
limitation could materially adversely affect the market price of our shares.

Our Manager can resign on 180 days’ notice and we may not be able to find a suitable replacement within that time, resulting 
in a disruption in our operations that could materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations 
as well as the market price of our shares.

Our Manager has the right, under the management services agreement, to resign at any time on 180 days’ written notice, whether 
we have found a replacement or not. If our Manager resigns, we may not be able to contract with a new manager or hire internal 
management with similar expertise and ability to provide the same or equivalent services on acceptable terms within 90 days, or 
at all, in which case our operations are likely to experience a disruption, our financial condition, business and results of operations 
as well as our ability to pay distributions are likely to be adversely affected and the market price of our shares may decline. In 
addition, the coordination of our internal management, acquisition activities and supervision of our businesses is likely to suffer 
if we are unable to identify and reach an agreement with a single institution or group of executives having the expertise possessed 
by our Manager and its affiliates. Even if we are able to retain comparable management, whether internal or external, the integration 
of such management and their lack of familiarity with our businesses may result in additional costs and time delays that could 
materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations.

58

We must pay our Manager the management fee regardless of our performance.

Our Manager is entitled to receive a management fee that is based on our adjusted consolidated net assets, as defined in the 
management  services  agreement,  regardless  of  the  performance  of  our  businesses. The  calculation  of  the  management  fee  is 
unrelated to the Company’s net income. As a result, the management fee may incentivize our Manager to increase the amount of 
our assets, for example, the acquisition of additional assets or the incurrence of third party debt rather than increase the performance 
of our businesses.

We cannot determine the amount of the management fee that will be paid over time with any certainty.

The management fee paid to CGM for the year ended December 31, 2016 was $29.4 million. The management fee is calculated 
by reference to the Company’s adjusted net assets, which will be impacted by the acquisition or disposition of businesses, which 
can be significantly influenced by our Manager, as well as the performance of our businesses and other businesses we may acquire 
in the future. Changes in adjusted net assets and in the resulting management fee could be significant, resulting in a material 
adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations. In addition, if the performance of the Company declines, assuming adjusted 
net assets remains the same, management fees will increase as a percentage of the Company’s net income.

We cannot determine the amount of profit allocation that will be paid over time with any certainty.

We cannot determine the amount of profit allocation that will be paid over time with any certainty. Such determination would be 
dependent on the potential sale proceeds received for any of our businesses and the performance of the Company and its businesses 
over a multi-year period of time, among other factors that cannot be predicted with certainty at this time. Such factors may have 
a significant impact on the amount of any profit allocation to be paid. Likewise, such determination would be dependent on whether 
certain hurdles were surpassed giving rise to a payment of profit allocation. Any amounts paid in respect of the profit allocation 
are unrelated to the management fee earned for performance of services under the management services agreement.

The fees to be paid to our Manager pursuant to the management services agreement, the offsetting management services 
agreements and integration services agreements and the profit allocation to be paid to certain persons who are employees and 
partners of our Manager, as holders of the Allocation Interests, pursuant to the LLC Agreement may significantly reduce the 
amount of cash available for distribution to our shareholders.

Under the management services agreement, the Company will be obligated to pay a management fee to and, subject to certain 
conditions, reimburse the costs and out-of-pocket expenses of our Manager incurred on behalf of the Company in connection with 
the provision of services to the Company. Similarly, our businesses will be obligated to pay fees to and reimburse the costs and 
expenses of our Manager pursuant to any offsetting management services agreements entered into between our Manager and one 
of our businesses, or any integration services agreements to which such businesses are a party. In addition, Sostratus LLC, as 
holder of the Allocation Interests, will be entitled to receive profit allocations. While it is difficult to quantify with any certainty 
the actual amount of any such payments in the future, we do expect that such amounts could be substantial. See the section entitled 
“Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” for more information about these payment obligations of the Company. 
The management fee and profit allocation will be payment obligations of the Company and, as a result, will be paid, along with 
other Company obligations, prior to the payment of distributions to shareholders. As a result, the payment of these amounts may 
significantly reduce the amount of cash flow available for distribution to our shareholders.

Our Manager’s influence on conducting our operations, including on our conducting of transactions, gives it the ability to 
increase its fees, which may reduce the amount of cash flow available for distribution to our shareholders.

Under the terms of the management services agreement, our Manager is paid a management fee calculated as a percentage of the 
Company’s adjusted net assets for certain items and is unrelated to net income or any other performance base or measure. Our 
Manager, controls, may advise us to consummate transactions, incur third party debt or conduct our operations in a manner that, 
in our Manager’s reasonable discretion, are necessary to the future growth of our businesses and are in the best interests of our 
shareholders. These transactions, however, may increase the amount of fees paid to our Manager. Our Manager’s ability to increase 
its fees, through the influence it has over our operations, may increase the compensation paid by our Manager. Our Manager’s 
ability to influence the management fee paid to it by us could reduce the amount of cash flow available for distribution to our 
shareholders.

Fees paid by the Company and our businesses pursuant to integration services agreements do not offset fees payable under 
the  management  services  agreement  and  will  be  in  addition  to  the  management  fee  payable  by  the  Company  under  the 
management services agreement.

The management services agreement provides that our businesses may enter into integration services agreements with our Manager 
pursuant to which our businesses will pay fees to our Manager for services provided by our Manager relating to the integration 
of a business’s financial reporting, computer systems and decision making and management processes into our operations following 

59

an acquisition of such business. See the section entitled “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” for more information 
about these agreements. Unlike fees paid under the offsetting management services agreements, fees that are paid pursuant to such 
integration services agreements will not reduce the management fee payable by the Company. Therefore, such fees will be in 
excess of the management fee payable by the Company.

The fees to be paid to our Manager pursuant to these integration service agreements will be paid prior to any principal, interest or 
dividend payments to be paid to the Company by our businesses, which will reduce the amount of cash flow available for distributions 
to shareholders.

Our profit allocation may induce our Manager to make suboptimal decisions regarding our operations.

Sostratus LLC, as holder of our Allocation Interests, will receive a profit allocation based on ongoing cash flows and capital gains 
in excess of a hurdle rate. Certain persons who are employees and partners of our Manager are owners of Sostratus LLC. In this 
respect, a calculation and payment of profit allocation may be triggered upon the sale of one of our businesses. As a result, our 
Manager may be incentivized to recommend the sale of one or more of our businesses to the Company’s board of directors at a 
time that may not be optimal for our shareholders.

The obligations to pay the management fee and profit allocation may cause the Company to liquidate assets or incur debt.

If we do not have sufficient liquid assets to pay the management fee and profit allocation when such payments are due, we may 
be required to liquidate assets or incur debt in order to make such payments. This circumstance could materially adversely affect 
our liquidity and ability to make distributions to our shareholders.

Risks Related to Taxation

Our shareholders will be subject to tax on their share of the Company’s taxable income, which taxes or taxable income could 
exceed the cash distributions they receive from the Trust.

For so long as the Company or the Trust (if it is treated as a tax partnership) would not be required to register as an investment 
company under the Investment Company Act of 1940 and at least 90% of our gross income for each taxable year constitutes 
‘‘qualifying income’’ within the meaning of Section 7704(d) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the ‘‘Code’’), 
on a continuing basis, we will be treated, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, as a partnership and not as an association or a 
publicly traded partnership taxable as a corporation. In that case our shareholders will be subject to U.S. federal income tax and, 
possibly, state, local and foreign income tax, on their share of the Company’s taxable income, which taxes or taxable income could 
exceed the cash distributions they receive from the Trust. There is, accordingly, a risk that our shareholders may not receive cash 
distributions equal to their portion of our taxable income or sufficient in amount even to satisfy their personal tax liability those 
results from that income. This may result from gains on the sale or exchange of stock or debt of subsidiaries that will be allocated 
to shareholders who hold (or are deemed to hold) shares on the day such gains were realized if there is no corresponding distribution 
of the proceeds from such sales, or where a shareholder disposes of shares after an allocation of gain but before proceeds (if any) 
are distributed by the Company. Shareholders may also realize income in excess of distributions due to the Company’s use of cash 
from operations or sales proceeds for uses other than to make distributions to shareholders, including funding acquisitions, satisfying 
short- and long-term working capital needs of our businesses, or satisfying known or unknown liabilities. In addition, certain 
financial covenants with the Company’s lenders may limit or prohibit the distribution of cash to shareholders. The Company’s 
board of directors is also free to change the Company’s distribution policy. The Company is under no obligation to make distributions 
to shareholders equal to or in excess of their portion of our taxable income or sufficient in amount even to satisfy the tax liability 
that results from that income.

All of the Company’s income could be subject to an entity-level tax in the United States, which could result in a material 
reduction in cash flow available for distribution to holders of shares of the Trust and thus could result in a substantial reduction 
in the value of the shares.

We do not expect the Company to be characterized as a corporation so long as it would not be required to register as an investment 
company under the Investment Company Act of 1940 and 90% or more of its gross income for each taxable year constitutes 
“qualifying income.” The Company expects to receive more than 90% of its gross income each year from dividends, interest and 
gains on sales of stock or debt instruments, including principally from or with respect to stock or debt of corporations in which 
the Company holds a majority interest. The Company intends to treat all such dividends, interest and gains as “qualifying income.”

If the Company fails to satisfy this “qualifying income” exception, the Company will be treated as a corporation for U.S. federal 
(and certain state and local) income tax purposes, and would be required to pay income tax at regular corporate rates on its income. 
Taxation of the Company as a corporation could result in a material reduction in distributions to our shareholders and after-tax 

60

return and, thus, could likely result in a reduction in the value of, or materially adversely affect the market price of, the shares of 
the Trust.

A shareholder may recognize a greater taxable gain (or a smaller tax loss) on a disposition of shares than expected because of 
the treatment of debt under the partnership tax accounting rules.

We may incur debt for a variety of reasons, including for acquisitions as well as other purposes. Under partnership tax accounting 
principles (which apply to the Company), debt of the Company generally will be allocable to our shareholders, who will realize 
the benefit of including their allocable share of the debt in the tax basis of their investment in shares. At the time a shareholder 
later sells shares, the selling shareholder’s amount realized on the sale will include not only the sales price of the shares but also 
the shareholder’s portion of the Company’s debt allocable to his shares (which is treated as proceeds from the sale of those shares). 
Depending on the nature of the Company’s activities after having incurred the debt, and the utilization of the borrowed funds, a 
later sale of shares could result in a larger taxable gain (or a smaller tax loss) than anticipated.

Our structure involves complex provisions of U.S. federal income tax law for which no clear precedent or authority may be 
available. Our structure also is subject to potential legislative, judicial or administrative change and differing interpretations, 
possibly on a retroactive basis.

The  U.S.  federal  income  tax  treatment  of  holders  of  the  Shares  depends  in  some  instances  on  determinations  of  fact  and 
interpretations of complex provisions of U.S. federal income tax law for which no clear precedent or authority may be available. 
You should be aware that the U.S. federal income tax rules are constantly under review by persons involved in the legislative 
process, the IRS, and the U.S. Treasury Department, frequently resulting in revised interpretations of established concepts, statutory 
changes, revisions to regulations and other modifications and interpretations.  The IRS pays close attention to the proper application 
of tax laws to partnerships. The present U.S. federal income tax treatment of an investment in the Shares may be modified by 
administrative, legislative or judicial interpretation at any time, and any such action may affect investments and commitments 
previously made. For example, changes to the U.S. federal tax laws and interpretations thereof could make it more difficult or 
impossible to meet the qualifying income exception for us to be treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes that 
is not taxable as a corporation, affect or cause us to change our investments and commitments, affect the tax considerations of an 
investment in us and adversely affect an investment in our Shares. Our organizational documents and agreements permit the Board 
of Directors to modify our operating agreement from time to time, without the consent of the holders of Shares, in order to address 
certain changes in U.S. federal income tax regulations, legislation or interpretation. In some circumstances, such revisions could 
have a material adverse impact on some or all of the holders of our Shares. Moreover, we will apply certain assumptions and 
conventions in an attempt to comply with applicable rules and to report income, gain, deduction, loss and credit to holders in a 
manner that reflects such holders’ beneficial ownership of partnership items, taking into account variation in ownership interests 
during each taxable year because of trading activity. However, these assumptions and conventions may not be in compliance with 
all aspects of applicable tax requirements. It is possible that the IRS will assert successfully that the conventions and assumptions 
used by us do not satisfy the technical requirements of the Code and/or Treasury regulations and could require that items of income, 
gain, deductions, loss or credit, including interest deductions, be adjusted, reallocated, or disallowed, in a manner that adversely 
affects holders of the Shares.

Risks Relating Generally to Our Businesses

Impairment of our intangible assets could result in significant charges that would adversely impact our future operating results.

We have significant intangible assets, including goodwill with an indefinite life, which are susceptible to valuation adjustments 
as a result of changes in various factors or conditions. The most significant intangible assets on our balance sheet are goodwill, 
technologies, customer relationships and trademarks we acquired when we acquired our businesses. Customer relationships are 
amortized on a straight line basis based upon the pattern in which the economic benefits of customer relationships are being 
utilized. Other identifiable intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. We assess the 
potential impairment of goodwill and indefinite lived intangible assets on an annual basis, as well as whenever events or changes 
in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable. We assess definite lived intangible assets whenever 
events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable.

Factors that could trigger impairment include the following:

• 
• 
• 
• 

significant under performance relative to historical or projected future operating results;
significant changes in the manner of or use of the acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business;
significant negative industry or economic trends;
significant decline in our stock price for a sustained period;

61

• 

• 

changes in our organization or management reporting structure could result in additional reporting units, which may 
require alternative methods of estimating fair values or greater desegregation or aggregation in our analysis by reporting 
unit; and
a decline in our market capitalization below net book value.

As of December 31, 2016, we had identified indefinite lived intangible assets with a carrying value in our financial statements of 
$72.2 million, and goodwill of $491.6 million.

Our businesses are subject to unplanned business interruptions which may adversely affect our performance.

Operational interruptions and unplanned events at one or more of our production facilities, such as explosions, fires, inclement 
weather,  natural  disasters,  accidents,  transportation  interruptions  and  supply  could  cause  substantial  losses  in  our  production 
capacity. Furthermore, because customers may be dependent on planned deliveries from us, customers that have to reschedule 
their own operations due to our delivery delays may be able to pursue financial claims against us, and we may incur costs to correct 
such problems in addition to any liability resulting from such claims. Such interruptions may also harm our reputation among 
actual and potential customers, potentially resulting in a loss of business. To the extent these losses are not covered by insurance, 
our financial position, results of operations and cash flows may be adversely affected by such events.

Our businesses rely and may rely on their intellectual property and licenses to use others’ intellectual property, for competitive 
advantage. If our businesses are unable to protect their intellectual property, are unable to obtain or retain licenses to use 
other’s intellectual property, or if they infringe upon or are alleged to have infringed upon others’ intellectual property, it could 
have a material adverse effect on their financial condition, business and results of operations.

Each business's success depends in part on their, or licenses to use others’, brand names, proprietary technology and manufacturing 
techniques. These businesses rely on a combination of patents, trademarks, copyrights, trade secrets, confidentiality procedures 
and contractual provisions to protect their intellectual property rights. The steps they have taken to protect their intellectual property 
rights  may  not  prevent  third  parties  from  using  their  intellectual  property  and  other  proprietary  information  without  their 
authorization or independently developing intellectual property and other proprietary information that is similar. In addition, the 
laws of foreign countries may not protect our businesses’ intellectual property rights effectively or to the same extent as the laws 
of the United States.

Stopping unauthorized use of their proprietary information and intellectual property, and defending claims that they have made 
unauthorized use of others’ proprietary information or intellectual property, may be difficult, time-consuming and costly. The use 
of their intellectual property and other proprietary information by others, and the use by others of their intellectual property and 
proprietary information, could reduce or eliminate any competitive advantage they have developed, cause them to lose sales or 
otherwise harm their business.

Our businesses may become involved in legal proceedings and claims in the future either to protect their intellectual property or 
to defend allegations that they have infringed upon others’ intellectual property rights. These claims and any resulting litigation 
could subject them to significant liability for damages and invalidate their property rights. In addition, these lawsuits, regardless 
of their merits, could be time consuming and expensive to resolve and could divert management’s time and attention. The costs 
associated with any of these actions could be substantial and could have a material adverse effect on their financial condition, 
business and results of operations.

The operations and research and development of some of our businesses’ services and technology depend on the collective 
experience of their technical employees. If these employees were to leave our businesses and take this knowledge, our businesses’ 
operations and their ability to compete effectively could be materially adversely impacted.

The future success of some of our businesses depends upon the continued service of their technical personnel who have developed 
and continue to develop their technology and products. If any of these employees leave our businesses, the loss of their technical 
knowledge and experience may materially adversely affect the operations and research and development of current and future 
services. We may also be unable to attract technical individuals with comparable experience because competition for such technical 
personnel is intense. If our businesses are not able to replace their technical personnel with new employees or attract additional 
technical individuals, their operations may suffer as they may be unable to keep up with innovations in their respective industries. 
As a result, their ability to continue to compete effectively and their operations may be materially adversely affected.

62

If our businesses are unable to continue the technological innovation and successful commercial introduction of new products 
and services, their financial condition, business and results of operations could be materially adversely affected.

The industries in which our businesses operate, or may operate, experience periodic technological changes and ongoing product 
improvements. Their results of operations depend significantly on the development of commercially viable new products, product 
grades and applications, as well as production technologies and their ability to integrate new technologies. Our future growth will 
depend on their ability to gauge the direction of the commercial and technological progress in all key end-use markets and upon 
their ability to successfully develop, manufacture and market products in such changing end-use markets. In this regard, they must 
make ongoing capital investments.

In addition, their customers may introduce new generations of their own products, which may require new or increased technological 
and performance specifications, requiring our businesses to develop customized products. Our businesses may not be successful 
in developing new products and technology that satisfy their customers’ demand and their customers may not accept any of their 
new products. If our businesses fail to keep pace with evolving technological innovations or fail to modify their products in 
response to their customers’ needs in a timely manner, then their financial condition, business and results of operations could be 
materially adversely affected as a result of reduced sales of their products and sunk developmental costs. These developments 
may require our personnel staffing business to seek better educated and trained workers, who may not be available in sufficient 
numbers.

Our businesses could experience fluctuations in the costs of raw materials as a result of inflation and other economic conditions, 
which fluctuations could have a material adverse effect on their financial condition, business and results of operations.

Changes  in  inflation  could  materially  adversely  affect  the  costs  and  availability  of  raw  materials  used  in  our  manufacturing 
businesses, and changes in fuel costs likely will affect the costs of transporting materials from our suppliers and shipping goods 
to our customers, as well as the effective areas from which we can recruit temporary staffing personnel. For example, for Advanced 
Circuits, the principal raw materials consist of copper and glass and typically represent approximately 20% of net sales. Prices 
for these key raw materials may fluctuate during periods of high demand. The ability by these businesses to offset the effect of 
increases in raw material prices by increasing their prices is uncertain. If these businesses are unable to cover price increases of 
these raw materials, their financial condition, business and results of operations could be materially adversely affected.

Our businesses do not have and may not have long-term contracts with their customers and clients and the loss of customers 
and clients could materially adversely affect their financial condition, business and results of operations.

Our businesses are and may be, based primarily upon individual orders and sales with their customers and clients. Our businesses 
historically have not entered into long-term supply contracts with their customers and clients. As such, their customers and clients 
could cease using their services or buying their products from them at any time and for any reason. The fact that they do not enter 
into long-term contracts with their customers and clients means that they have no recourse in the event a customer or client no 
longer wants to use their services or purchase products from them. If a significant number of their customers or clients elect not 
to use their services or purchase their products, it could materially adversely affect their financial condition, business and results 
of operations.

Our businesses are and may be subject to federal, state and foreign environmental laws and regulations that expose them to 
potential financial liability. Complying with applicable environmental laws requires significant resources, and if our businesses 
fail to comply, they could be subject to substantial liability.

Some of the facilities and operations of our businesses are and may be subject to a variety of federal, state and foreign environmental 
laws and regulations including laws and regulations pertaining to the handling, storage and transportation of raw materials, products 
and  wastes,  which  require  and  will  continue  to  require  significant  expenditures  to  remain  in  compliance  with  such  laws  and 
regulations currently in place and in the future. Compliance with current and future environmental laws is a major consideration 
for our businesses as any material violations of these laws can lead to substantial liability, revocations of discharge permits, fines 
or penalties. Because some of our businesses use hazardous materials and generate hazardous wastes in their operations, they may 
be subject to potential financial liability for costs associated with the investigation and remediation of their own sites, or sites at 
which they have arranged for the disposal of hazardous wastes, if such sites become contaminated. Even if they fully comply with 
applicable environmental laws and are not directly at fault for the contamination, our businesses may still be liable. Our businesses 
may also be held liable for damages caused by environmental and other conditions that existed prior to our acquisition the assets, 
business or operations involved, whether or not such damages are subject to indemnification from a prior owner.  Costs associated 
with these risks could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, business and results of operations.

63

Defects in the products provided by our companies could result in financial or other damages to their customers, which could 
result in reduced demand for our companies’ products and/or liability claims against our companies.

As manufacturers and distributors of consumer products, certain of our companies are subject to various laws, rules and regulations, 
which may empower governmental agencies and authorities to exclude from the market products that are found to be unsafe or 
hazardous. Under certain circumstances, a governmental authority could require our companies to repurchase or recall one or 
more of their products. Additionally, laws regulating certain consumer products exist in some cities and states, as well as in other 
countries in which they sell their products, where more restrictive laws and regulations exist or may be adopted in the future. Any 
repurchase or recall of such products could be costly and could damage the reputation of our companies. If any of our companies 
were required to remove, or voluntarily remove, their products from the market, their reputation may be tarnished and they may 
have large quantities of finished products that they cannot sell. Additionally, our companies may be subject to regulatory actions 
that could harm their reputations, adversely impact the values of their brands and/or increase the cost of production.

Our companies also face exposure to product liability claims in the event that one of their products is alleged to have resulted in 
property damage, bodily injury or other adverse effects. Defects in products could result in customer dissatisfaction or a reduction 
in, or cancellation of, future purchases or liability claims against our companies. If these defects occur frequently, our reputation 
may be impaired permanently. Defects in products could also result in financial or other damages to customers, for which our 
companies  may  be  asked  or  required  to  compensate  their  customers,  in  the  form  of  substantial  monetary  judgments  or 
otherwise. While our companies take the steps deemed necessary to comply with all laws and regulations, there can be no assurance 
that rapidly changing safety standards will not render unsaleable products that complied with previously-applicable safety standards. 
As  a  result,  these  types  of  claims  could  have  a  material  adverse  effect  on  our  businesses,  results  of  operations  and  financial 
condition.

Some of our businesses are subject to certain risks associated with the movement of businesses offshore.

Some of our businesses are potentially at risk of losing business to competitors operating in lower cost countries. An additional 
risk is the movement offshore of some of our businesses’ customers, leading them to procure products or services from more 
closely located companies. Either of these factors could negatively impact our financial condition, business and results of operations.

Loss of key customers of some of our businesses could negatively impact financial condition.

Some of our businesses have significant exposure to certain key customers, the loss of which could negatively impact our financial 
condition, business and results of operations.

Our  businesses  are  subject  to  certain  risks  associated  with  their  foreign  operations  or  business  they  conduct  in  foreign 
jurisdictions.

Some of our businesses have and may have operations or conduct business outside the United States. Certain risks are inherent 
in  operating  or  conducting  business  in  foreign  jurisdictions,  including  exposure  to  local  economic  conditions;  difficulties  in 
enforcing agreements and collecting receivables through certain foreign legal systems; longer payment cycles for foreign customers; 
adverse currency exchange controls; exposure to risks associated with changes in foreign exchange rates; potential adverse changes 
in political environments; withholding taxes and restrictions on the withdrawal of foreign investments and earnings; export and 
import restrictions; difficulties in enforcing intellectual property rights; and required compliance with a variety of foreign laws 
and regulations. These risks individually and collectively have the potential to negatively impact our financial condition, business 
and results of operations.

Regulations related to conflict minerals may force certain of our businesses to incur additional expenses, may make the supply 
chain of such businesses more complex and may result in damage to the customer relationships of such businesses.

In August 2012, as mandated by the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010, the Securities and 
Exchange Commission promulgated final rules regarding disclosure of the use of certain minerals and their derivatives, including 
tin, tantalum, tungsten and gold, known as “conflict minerals,” if these minerals are necessary to the functionality or production 
of the company’s products. These regulations require such issuers to report annually whether or not such minerals originate from 
the Democratic Republic of Congo (DRC) and adjoining countries and in some cases to perform extensive due diligence on their 
supply chains for such minerals.

Our businesses have incurred and will continue to incur additional costs to comply with the disclosure requirements, including 
costs related to determining the source of any of the relevant minerals used in the products of certain of our businesses. These 
requirements could adversely affect the sourcing, availability and pricing of conflict minerals used in the manufacturing processes 
for certain products of our businesses. We have determined that certain of our subsidiaries’ products contain conflict minerals and 
we have developed a process to identify where such minerals originated. As of the date of our conflict minerals report for the 2015 

64

calendar year, we were unable to determine whether or not such minerals originated in the DRC or its adjoining countries. We 
may continue to face difficulties in gathering this information in the future since the supply chain of certain of our businesses is 
complex, and we may not be able to ascertain the origins for these minerals or determine that these minerals are DRC conflict-
free, which may harm the reputation of some of our businesses.  Our pool of suppliers from which some of our businesses source 
these minerals may be limited, and we may be unable to obtain conflict-free minerals at competitive prices, which could increase 
costs and adversely affect the manufacturing operations and profitability of certain of our businesses. Any one or a combination 
of these various factors could negatively impact our financial condition, business and results of operations.

Risks Related to Advanced Circuits

Unless Advanced Circuits is able to respond to technological change at least as quickly as its competitors, its services could be 
rendered obsolete, which could materially adversely affect its financial condition, business and results of operations.

The market for Advanced Circuits’ services is characterized by rapidly changing technology and continuing process development. 
The future success of its business will depend in large part upon its ability to maintain and enhance its technological capabilities, 
retain  qualified  engineering  and  technical  personnel,  develop  and  market  services  that  meet  evolving  customer  needs  and 
successfully  anticipate  and  respond  to  technological  changes  on  a  cost-effective  and  timely  basis. Advanced  Circuits’  core 
manufacturing capabilities are for 2 to 12 layer printed circuit boards. Trends towards miniaturization and increased performance 
of electronic products are dictating the use of printed circuit boards with increased layer counts. If this trend continues Advanced 
Circuits may not be able to effectively respond to the technological requirements of the changing market. If it determines that new 
technologies  and  equipment  are  required  to  remain  competitive,  the  development,  acquisition  and  implementation  of  these 
technologies may require significant capital investments. It may be unable to obtain capital for these purposes in the future, and 
investments in new technologies may not result in commercially viable technological processes. Any failure to anticipate and 
adapt to its customers’ changing technological needs and requirements or retain qualified engineering and technical personnel 
could materially adversely affect its financial condition, business and results of operations.

Advanced Circuits’ customers operate in industries that experience rapid technological change resulting in short product life 
cycles and as a result, if the product life cycles of its customers slow materially, and research and development expenditures 
are reduced, its financial condition, business and results of operations will be materially adversely affected.

Advanced  Circuits’  customers  compete  in  markets  that  are  characterized  by  rapidly  changing  technology,  evolving  industry 
standards and continuous improvement in products and services. These conditions frequently result in short product life cycles. 
As professionals operating in research and development departments represent the majority of Advanced Circuits’ net sales, the 
rapid development of electronic products is a key driver of Advanced Circuits’ sales and operating performance. Any decline in 
the development and introduction of new electronic products could slow the demand for Advanced Circuits’ services and could 
have a material adverse effect on its financial condition, business and results of operations.

Electronics manufacturing services corporations are increasingly acting as intermediaries, positioning themselves between 
PCB manufacturers and OEMS, which could reduce operating margins.

Advanced Circuits’ OEM customers are increasingly outsourcing the assembly of equipment to third party manufacturers. These 
third party manufacturers typically assemble products for multiple customers and often purchase circuit boards from Advanced 
Circuits in larger quantities than OEM manufacturers. The ability of Advanced Circuits to sell products to these customers at 
margins comparable to historical averages is uncertain. Any material erosion in margins could have a material adverse effect on 
Advanced Circuits’ financial condition, business and results of operations.

Risks Related to Arnold

Changes in the cost and availability of certain rare earth minerals and magnets could materially harm Arnold’s business, 
financial condition and results of operations.

Arnold manufactures precision magnetic assemblies and high-performance rare earth magnets including Samarium Cobalt magnets. 
Arnold is especially susceptible to changes in the price and availability of certain rare earth materials. The price of these materials 
has fluctuated significantly in recent years and we believe price fluctuations are likely to occur in the future. Arnold’s need to 
maintain a continuing supply of rare earth materials makes it difficult to resist price increases and surcharges imposed by its 
suppliers. Arnold’s ability to pass increases in costs for such materials through to its customers by increasing the selling prices of 
its products is an important factor in Arnold’s business. We cannot guarantee that Arnold will be able to maintain an appropriate 
differential at all times. If costs for rare earth materials increase, and if Arnold is unable to pass along, or is delayed in passing 
along, those increases to its customers, Arnold will experience reduced profitability. Rare earth minerals and magnets are available 
from a limited number of suppliers, primarily in China. Political and civil instability and unexpected adverse changes in laws or 
regulatory requirements, including with respect to export duties, quotas or embargoes, may affect the market price and availability 

65

of rare earth materials, particularly from China. If a substantial interruption should occur in the supply of rare earth materials, 
Arnold may not be able to obtain other sources of supply in a timely fashion, at a reasonable price or as would be necessary to 
satisfy its requirements. Accordingly, a change in the supply of, or price for, rare earth minerals and magnets could materially 
harm Arnold’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

Risks Related to Clean Earth 

If Clean Earth is unable to renew its operating permits or lease agreements with regulatory bodies, its business would be 
adversely affected. 

Clean Earth’s facilities operate using permits and licenses issued by various regulatory bodies at various local, state and federal 
government levels. Failure to renew its permits and licenses necessary to operate Clean Earth’s facilities on a timely basis or failure 
to renew or maintain compliance with its permits and site lease agreements on a timely basis could prevent or restrict its ability 
to provide certain services, resulting in a material adverse effect on its business. There can be no assurance that Clean Earth will 
continue to be successful in obtaining timely permit or license applications approval, maintaining compliance with its permits and 
lease agreements and obtaining timely lease renewals. 

Clean Earth operates eighteen facilities that accept, process and/or treat materials provided by its customers.  These facilities 
may be inherently dangerous workplaces. If Clean Earth fails to maintain safe worksites, it may be subject to significant 
operating risks and hazards that could result in injury or death to persons, which could result in losses or liabilities to it.

Clean Earth’s safety record is an important consideration for it and its customers. If serious accidents or fatalities occur or its safety 
record was to deteriorate, it may be ineligible to bid on certain work, and existing service arrangements could be terminated. 
Further, regulatory changes implemented by OSHA could impose additional costs on Clean Earth. Adverse experience with hazards 
and claims could have a negative effect on Clean Earth’s reputation with its existing or potential new customers and its prospects 
for future work.

If Clean Earth fails to comply with applicable environmental laws and regulations, its business could be adversely affected. 

The changing regulatory framework governing Clean Earth’s business creates significant risks. Clean Earth could be held liable 
if its operations cause contamination of air, groundwater or soil or expose its employees or the public to contamination. Under 
current law, Clean Earth may be held liable for damage caused by conditions that existed before it acquired the assets, business 
or operations involved. Also, it may be liable if it arranges for the transportation, disposal or treatment of hazardous substances 
that cause environmental contamination at facilities operated by others, or if a predecessor made such arrangements and Clean 
Earth is a successor. Liability for environmental damage could have a material adverse effect on Clean Earth’s financial condition, 
results of operations and cash flows. 

Stringent regulations of federal, state or provincial governments have a substantial impact on Clean Earth’s contaminated soil, 
dredge material and solid and hazardous waste treatment, storage, disposal and beneficial use activities. Local government controls 
may also apply. Many complex laws, rules, orders and regulatory interpretations govern environmental protection, health, safety, 
noise, visual impact, odor, land use, zoning, transportation and related matters. Clean Earth also may be subject to laws concerning 
the protection of certain marine and bird species, their habitats, and wetlands. It may incur substantial costs in order to conduct 
its operations in compliance with these environmental laws and regulations. Changes in environmental laws or regulations or 
changes in the enforcement or interpretation of existing laws, regulations or permitted activities may require Clean Earth to make 
significant capital or other expenditures, to modify existing operating licenses or permits, or obtain additional approvals or limit 
operations. New environmental laws or regulations that raise compliance standards or require changes in operating practices or 
technology may impose significant costs and/or limit Clean Earth’s operations. 

Clean  Earth’s  revenue  is  primarily  generated  as  a  result  of  requirements  imposed  on  our  customers  under  federal,  state,  and 
provincial laws and regulations to protect public health and the environment. If requirements to comply with laws and regulations 
governing management of contaminated soils, dredge material, and hazardous wastes were relaxed or less vigorously enforced, 
demand for Clean Earth’s services could materially decrease and its revenues and earnings could be significantly reduced. 

Risks Related to Liberty Safe

A limited number of customers in the retail segment account for a large amount of Liberty's non-dealer sales, and Liberty's 
operations may be adversely affected by the loss of one of these customers.

During the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, sales to Liberty's two largest customers accounted for approximately 36% 
and 37%, respectively, of Liberty's total sales.  The loss of either of these retail customers could have an adverse effect on on its 
business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows.  

66

Risks Related to Manitoba Harvest

Reduced availability of raw materials and other inputs, as well as increased costs for our raw materials and other inputs, could 
adversely affect us. 

Manitoba Harvest's business depends heavily on raw materials and other inputs used in the production of our products, particularly 
raw hemp seeds and organic raw hemp seeds.  The raw materials are generally sourced from third-party farmers, and we are not 
assured of continued supply or pricing.  In addition, a substantial portion of our raw materials are agricultural products, which are 
vulnerable to adverse weather conditions and natural disasters, such as severe rains, floods, droughts, frost, earthquakes, and 
pestilence. Adverse weather conditions and natural disasters also can lower hemp seeds crop yields and reduce supplies of this 
ingredient or increase its prices. Incremental costs, including transportation, may also be incurred if we need to find alternate 
short-term supplies of hemp seeds from other growers. These factors can increase costs, decrease revenues and lead to additional 
charges to earnings, which may have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

Cost increases in raw materials and other inputs could cause our profits to decrease significantly compared to prior periods, as we 
may be unable to increase our prices to offset the increased cost of these raw materials and other inputs. If we are unable to obtain 
raw materials and other inputs for our products or offset any increased costs for such raw materials and inputs, our business could 
be negatively affected.

The loss of a significant customer could negatively impact our sales and profitability.

Manitoba Harvest’s three largest customers account for approximately 47% of their total sales.  The loss of any large customer, 
the reduction of purchasing levels or the cancellation of any business from a large customer for an extended length of time could 
negatively impact our sales and  may have a material adverse effect on its business, results of operations, financial conditions and 
cash flows.

Risks Related to Sterno Products

Sterno's products operate at high temperatures and use flammable fuels, each of which could subject our business to product 
liability claims.  

Sterno products expose it to potential product liability claims typical of fuel based heating products.  The fuels Sterno Products 
uses in its products are flammable and may be toxic if ingested.  Although Sterno products have comprehensive labeling and it 
follows government and third party based standards and protocols, it cannot guarantee there will not be accidents due to misuse 
or otherwise.  Accidents involving Sterno products may have an adverse effect on its reputation and reduce demand for its products.  
In addition, Sterno Products may be held responsible for damages beyond its insurance coverage and there can be no guarantee 
that it will be able to produce adequate insurance coverage in the future.  

ITEM 1B.  UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

NONE

ITEM 2.  PROPERTIES

Our corporate offices are located in Westport, Connecticut, where we lease approximately 1,500 square feet from our Manager.  
The following is a summary as of December 31, 2016 of the properties owned or leased by our business.

5.11 

5.11 is headquartered in Irvine, California and leases offices and warehouse space in locations worldwide.  The summary below 
outlines 5.11's leased offices and warehouse space.

Location

Square Feet

Use

Lathrop, CA

221,893

Warehouse

67

Modesto, CA

Irvine, CA

Irvine, CA

Irvine, CA

Manteca, CA

Penrose Place, CO

Seattle, WA

Mexico City, Mexico

Bankstown, Australia

Malmo, Sweden

Kowloon Bay, Hong Kong

Dubai, UAE

66,545

Warehouse/Office

21,807

Office

1,073

4,381

Office

Office

400,000

Warehouse

1,100

Office

11,340

Office

2,583

Office

10,387

Office

6,049

Office

13,613

Office

1,951

Office

In addition, at December 31, 2016, 5.11 leased space for 10 retail stores, ranging in size from 3,250 square feet to 8,375 square 
feet.

Ergobaby

Ergobaby is headquartered in Los Angeles, California and has four other office locations worldwide.  The summary below outlines 
Ergobaby's property locations.  All locations are leased.

Location

Square Feet

Ergobaby - Corporate

Los Angeles, CA

Ergobaby - Office

Los Angeles, CA

Ergobaby - Office

Salt Lake City, Utah

Ergobaby

Pukalani, HI

Ergobaby Europe

Hamburg, Germany

Ergobaby France

Paris, France

Ergobaby UK

Surrey, United Kingdom

Tula

Tula

San Diego, CA

Bialystok, Poland

16,378

3,292

3,550

2,907

2,410

4,680

251

6,221

9,688

Liberty Safe

Liberty Safe leases offices and warehouse facilities at two locations in Payson, Utah, where it is headquartered. The corporate 
headquarters and manufacturing facility are located in a 314,000 square foot building. Liberty leases an additional warehouse 
facility totaling approximately 11,000 square feet.

Manitoba Harvest

Manitoba Harvest leases office and warehouse facilities at two locations in a connected building in Winnipeg, Manitoba. The 
corporate headquarters and manufacturing and warehouse facility are located in a facility totaling approximately 14,700 square 
feet, and its customer experience center and additional warehouse space are located in a facility that total approximately 11,000 
square feet.  Manitoba Harvest's subsidiary, HOCI, owns a recently built facility on seven acres of land in St. Agathe, Manitoba.  
The facility is approximately 35,000 square feet and comprises manufacturing, warehouse and office space.  

Advanced Circuits

Advanced Circuits' operations are located in an 113,000 square foot building in Aurora, Colorado, a 30,000 square foot building 
in Tempe, Arizona, and a 50,000 square foot building in Maple Grove, Minnesota. These facilities are leased and comprise both 
the factory and office space. The lease terms are for approximately 15 years with a renewal option at the Aurora, Colorado location 
for an additional 10 years.

68

Arnold

Arnold is headquartered in Rochester, New York and has nine manufacturing facilities. The summary below outlines Arnold’s 
property locations. Arnold owns the Ogallala, Nebraska location and the other locations are leased.

Location
Marengo, IL

Marietta, OH

Marietta, OH

Marengo, IL

Norfolk, NE

Rochester, NY

Ogallala, NE

Guangdong Province, China

Sheffield, England

Lupfig, Switzerland

Hanau, Germany

Crolles, France

Sq. Ft.

Use

94,220

Office/Warehouse

81,000

Office/Warehouse

22,646 Warehouse

55,200

Office/Warehouse

109,000

Office/Warehouse

73,000

Office/Warehouse

25,000

Office/Warehouse

154,210

Office/Warehouse

25,000

Office/Warehouse

58,405

Office/Warehouse

1,092

215

Office

Office

Clean Earth

Clean Earth is headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania and has eighteen permitted facilities as well as several offices.  The summary 
below outlines Clean Earth's property locations.

Location (County, State)

Operation

Size

Leased or Owned

Dredged Material Processing and Beneficial Reuse

~ 7 acres

RCRA TSDF

~ 14.5 acres

Owned/ Leased

Montgomery, PA

Corporate Headquarters

Offices

Fixed Base Remediation

Butler, PA

Middlesex, NJ

Hudson, NJ

Hudson, NJ

Hudson, NJ

Dredging Services and Beneficial Reuse

Philadelphia, PA

Med. Temperature Thermal Desorption

Bucks, PA

Lycoming, PA

Med. Temperature Thermal Desorption

Drill Cuttings Stabilization

New Castle, DE

Med. Temperature Thermal Desorption

Prince Georges, MD

Chemical Stabilization

Washington, MD

Chemical Stabilization

Glades, FL

Camden, GA

Marshall, KY

Med. Temperature Thermal Desorption

Med. Temperature Thermal Desorption

RCRA TSDF

Monongalia, WV

RCRA TSDF - Aerosol Recycling

Butler, PA

Transportation facility

Newport News, VA

Office & Warehouse

Hartford, CT

Etowah, AL

Thermal Desorption

RCRA Part B Permitted Hazardous Waste TSDF

69

16,669 sq. ft.

7,525 sq. ft.

~ 16 acres

Leased

Leased

Leased

Leased

~ 20 acres

8.5 acres

7.8 acres

~ 2 acres

7.6 acres

42.49 acres

13.67 acres

11.29 acres

2.92 acres

~ 25.2 acres

~ 1 acres

1,500 sq. ft.

3,200 sq, ft.

16 acres

42 acres

Lease

Owned

Owned

Leased

Leased

Owned

Owned

Owned

Owned

Owned

Owned

Leased

Leased

Owned

Owned

Sterno Products

Sterno Products is headquartered in Corona, California.  Sterno Products owns a 103,500 square foot manufacturing and production 
facility in Memphis, Tennessee, and a 214,000 square foot manufacturing and production facility in Texarkana, Texas.  All other 
properties are leased. 

Location

Square Feet

Use

Corona, CA

Memphis, TN

Texarkana, TX

Texarkana, TX

Des Plaines, IL

Toronto, Canada

Vancouver, Canada

Vancouver, CA

Montreal, CA

Montreal, Canada

Atlanta, GA

Las Vegas, NV

Yuyao, China

Yuyao, China

Shunde, China

12,330

Corporate Office

103,500

Manufacturing

214,000

Manufacturing

16,000 Warehouse

11,400

Office (subleased)

13,867

Office

50,372

Office

33,711 Warehouse

2,100 Warehouse

12,500

Office

1,235

Showroom

342

Showroom

2,982

Office

323

343

Office

Office

Our corporate offices are located in Westport, Connecticut, where we lease approximately 1,500 square feet from our Manager.

We believe that our properties and the terms of their leases at each of our businesses are sufficient to meet our present needs and 
we do not anticipate any difficulty in securing additional space, as needed, on acceptable terms.

ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

In the normal course of business, we are involved in various claims and legal proceedings. While the ultimate resolution of these 
matters has yet to be determined, we do not believe that their outcome will have a material adverse effect on our financial position 
or results of operations.

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES

Not Applicable.

70

PART II

Item 5.  MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER 
PURCHASES OF SECURITIES

Market Information

Our Trust stock has traded on the New York Stock Exchange (the “NYSE”) under the symbol “CODI” since November 1, 2011. 
Previously, our stock was traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “CODI.” The following table sets forth 
the intraday high and low sales prices per share as reported on the NYSE for the periods indicated:

Quarter Ended

December 31, 2016

September 30, 2016

June 30, 2016

March 31, 2016

December 31, 2015

September 30, 2015

June 30, 2015

March 31, 2015

Common Stock Holders

High

Low

Distribution
Declared

$

19.50

$

16.95

$

17.58

17.00

16.09

17.25

17.14

17.53

16.01

16.51

15.41

13.65

15.10

9.70

15.90

17.24

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

On December 31, 2016 there were 15 registered holders of our common stock. The number of registered holders includes banks 
and brokers who act as nominees, each of whom may represent more than one shareholder.

Securities Authorized for Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans 

There are no securities currently authorized for issuance under an equity compensation plan. 

COMPARATIVE PERFORMANCE OF SHARES OF TRUST STOCK

The performance graph shown below compares the change in cumulative total shareholder return on shares of Trust stock 
with the NASDAQ Stock Market Index, the NASDAQ Other Finance Index, the NYSE Composite Index and the NYSE Financial 
Sector Index for the previous five years, through the quarter ended December 31, 2016. The graph sets the beginning value of 
shares of Trust stock and the indices at $100, and assumes that all quarterly dividends were reinvested at the time of payment. 
This graph does not forecast future performance of shares of Trust stock.

71

Data

Compass Diversified Holdings

NASDAQ Stock Market Index

NASDAQ Other Finance Index

NYSE Financial Sector Index

NYSE Composite Index

Data

Compass Diversified Holdings

NASDAQ Stock Market Index

NASDAQ Other Finance Index

NYSE Financial Sector Index

NYSE Composite Index

March 31,
2012

June 30,
2012

September 30,
2012

December 31,
2012

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

153.56

138.69

83.12

55.18

97.85

March 31,
2013

174.98

146.58

98.41

63.14

108.58

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

147.20

131.67

80.69

51.30

93.02

June 30,
2013

195.86

152.67

102.70

65.10

108.65

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

158.36

139.80

83.59

54.71

98.37

September 30,
2013

201.45

169.19

106.62

68.66

114.71

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

159.96

135.46

83.87

58.85

100.67

December 31,
2013

224.45

187.36

117.93

73.10

124.00

72

Data

Compass Diversified Holdings

NASDAQ Stock Market Index

NASDAQ Other Finance Index

NYSE Financial Sector Index

NYSE Composite Index

Data

Compass Diversified Holdings

NASDAQ Stock Market Index

NASDAQ Other Finance Index

NYSE Financial Sector Index

NYSE Composite Index

Data

Compass Diversified Holdings

NASDAQ Stock Market Index

NASDAQ Other Finance Index

NYSE Financial Sector Index

NYSE Composite Index

Distributions

March 31,
2014

June 30,
2014

September 30,
2014

December 31,
2014

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

218.56

188.37

115.15

73.30

125.52

March 31,
2015

206.87

219.86

121.74

75.83

129.94

March 31,
2016

198.47

218.46

114.3

68.25

121.7

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

212.14

197.75

114.94

75.02

130.90

June 30,
2015

200.67

223.71

121.61

76.67

128.82

June 30,
2016

$225.44

$238.30

$123.62

$71.76

$127.83

206.95

201.58

113.84

74.39

127.60

September 30,
2015

199.51

207.26

112.03

70.13

116.84

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

194.20

212.46

117.29

77.17

129.23

December 31,
2015

198.94

224.64

115.43

72.55

120.93

September 30,
2016

December 31,
2016

$198.47

$218.46

$114.30

$68.25

$121.70

$225.44

$238.30

$123.62

$71.76

$127.83

For the years 2016, 2015 and 2014, we have declared and paid quarterly cash distributions to holders of record as follows:

Quarter Ended
December 31, 2016

September 30, 2016

June 30, 2016

March 31, 2016

December 31, 2015

September 30, 2015

June 30, 2015

March 31, 2015

December 31, 2014

September 30, 2014

June 30, 2014

March 31, 2014

Declaration Date

Payment Date

Distribution Per Share

January 5, 2017

October 6, 2016

July 7, 2016

April 7, 2016

January 7, 2016

October 7, 2015

July 9, 2015

April 9, 2015

January 8, 2015

October 7, 2014

July 10, 2014

April 10, 2014

January 26, 2017

October 27, 2016

July 28, 2016

April 28, 2016

January 28, 2016

October 29, 2015

July 29, 2015

April 29, 2015

January 28, 2015

October 30, 2014

July 30, 2014

April 30, 2014

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

0.36

We currently intend to continue to declare and pay regular quarterly cash distributions on all outstanding shares through fiscal 
2017. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital 
Resources” in Part II, Item 7.

Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities

None.

Purchases of Equity Securities by Issuer and Affiliated Partners

None.

73

 
ITEM 6. – SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

The following table sets forth selected historical and other data of the Company and should be read in conjunction with the more 
detailed consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this Annual Report. Selected financial data below includes the 
results of operations, cash flow and balance sheet data of the Company for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015, 2014, 2013, 
and 2012. 

The Company sold 5,800,238 shares of FOX during FOX's initial public offering in August 2013, and an additional 4,466,569 
shares during a FOX secondary offering in July 2014, resulting in the Company holding approximately 41% ownership interest 
in FOX at December 31, 2015 and 2014.  Effective July 11, 2014, the date that the Company's ownership interest in FOX fell 
below 50%, the Company began accounting for the investment in FOX as an equity method investment at fair value.  FOX's results 
of operations and cash flows are included in the consolidated results of operations and cash flows of the Company from the date 
of acquisition through July 10, 2014, the date at which the Company began accounting for the investment in FOX using the equity 
method of accounting.  On November 16, 2016, our ownership interest in FOX fell below 20%.  We use the fair value option to 
account for the FOX investment whereby gains or losses resulting from changes in the fair value of the investment are recorded 
through the statement of operations.  Therefore, despite the decrease in the ownership interest in FOX below 20%, changes in the 
fair value of the investment will continue to be recorded in our net income (loss) for the period.

The operating results for Tridien  are reflected as discontinued operations in each of the years presented in the table below and 
are not included in continuing operations.  The operating results of  CamelBak and American Furniture in 2015, 2014, 2013 and 
2012 and HALO in 2012 are reflected as discontinued operations and are not included in the continuing operations data below.  
Data included below only includes activity in our operating subsidiaries from their respective dates of acquisition.

Statements of Operations Data:

Net sales

Cost of sales

Gross profit

Operating expenses:

Selling, general and administrative

Supplemental put expense (reversal)

Management fees

Amortization expense

Impairment expense/ loss on disposal of assets

Operating income

Gain on deconsolidation of subsidiary

Gain on equity method investment

Income (loss) from continuing operations

Income and gain from discontinued operations

Net income

Net income from continuing operations—noncontrolling
interest

Net income (loss) from discontinued operations—
noncontrolling interest

Net income (loss) attributable to Holdings

Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share
attributable to Holdings:

Continuing operations

Discontinued operations

Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share attributable to
Holdings

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

2013

2012

$ 978,309

$ 727,978

$ 636,675

$ 680,639

$ 579,778

651,739

487,242

431,658

457,913

392,881

326,570

240,736

205,017

222,726

186,897

217,830

136,399

128,190

116,549

108,418

—

29,406

35,069

25,204

19,061

—

74,490

53,749

—

25,658

28,761

—

—

(45,995)

21,872

23,063

—

17,782

19,350

—

15,995

16,783

19,532

—

49,918

31,892

115,040

26,169

—

264,325

4,533

8,991

11,029

270,077

2,781

156,779

21,078

56,530

165,770

291,155

—

—

71,052

7,764

78,816

—

—

(15,745)

20,085

4,340

1,961

5,133

11,661

12,124

7,232

(116)

(1,201)

659

(1,372)

1,050

$

54,685

$ 161,838

$ 278,835

$

68,064

$

(3,942)

0.46

$

(0.30) $

4.98

$

0.86

$

(0.48)

0.05

2.91

0.40

0.19

0.40

0.51

$

2.61

$

5.38

$

1.05

$

(0.08)

$

$

74

Cash distribution declared per share

$

1.44

$

1.44

$

1.44

$

1.44

$

1.44

Cash Flow Data:

Cash provided by operating activities

Cash (used in) provided by investing activities

Cash provided by (used in)  financing activities

Foreign currency impact on cash

$ 111,372

$

84,548

$

70,695

$

72,374

$

52,566

(363,021)

233,880

(424,753)

66,286

(84,426)

208,726

(254,357)

265,487

(44,122)

(82,232)

(3,174)

(1,905)

(955)

450

(37)

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

$

(46,097) $

62,166

$

(89,526) $

94,988

$ (114,129)

Balance Sheet Data:

Current assets

Total assets

Current liabilities

Long-term debt

Total liabilities

Noncontrolling interests

Shareholders’ equity attributable to Holdings

2016

2015

2014

2013

2012

December 31,

$ 452,819

$ 291,363

$ 320,799

$ 399,133

$ 267,659

1,777,155

1,421,042

1,547,430

1,044,913

955,201

202,521

116,479

141,231

130,130

113,799

551,652

308,639

485,547

280,389

267,008

882,611

547,823

739,096

475,978

498,989

38,139

47,135

40,903

95,550

41,584

856,405

826,084

767,431

473,385

414,628

75

ITEM 7.  MANAGEMENT’S  DISCUSSION  AND  ANALYSIS  OF  FINANCIAL  CONDITION  AND  RESULTS  OF 
OPERATIONS

This Item 7 contains forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements in this Annual Report on Form 10-K are subject 
to a number of risks and uncertainties, some of which are beyond our control. Our actual results, performance, prospects or 
opportunities could differ materially from those expressed in or implied by the forward-looking statements.  Additional risks 
of which we are not currently aware or which we currently deem immaterial could also cause our actual results to differ, 
including those discussed in the sections entitled “Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors” included elsewhere in 
this Annual Report.

Overview

Compass Diversified Holdings, a Delaware statutory trust, was incorporated in Delaware on November 18, 2005. Compass Group 
Diversified Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability Company, was also formed on November 18, 2005. In accordance with 
the Trust Agreement, the Trust is sole owner of 100% of the Trust Interests (as defined in the LLC Agreement) of the Company 
and, pursuant to the LLC Agreement, the Company has outstanding, the identical number of Trust Interests as the number of 
outstanding shares of the Trust. Sostratus LLC owns all of our Allocation Interests. The Company is the operating entity with a 
board of directors and other corporate governance responsibilities, similar to that of a Delaware corporation.

The Trust and the Company were formed to acquire and manage a group of small and middle-market businesses headquartered 
in North America. We characterize small and middle market businesses as those that generate annual cash flows of up to $60 
million. We focus on companies of this size because we believe that these companies are more able to achieve growth rates above 
those of their relevant industries and are also frequently more susceptible to efforts to improve earnings and cash flow.

In pursuing new acquisitions, we seek businesses with the following characteristics:

stable and growing earnings and cash flow;

•  North American base of operations;
• 
•  maintains a significant market share in defensible industry niche (i.e., has a “reason to exist”);
• 
• 
• 

solid and proven management team with meaningful incentives;
low technological and/or product obsolescence risk; and
a diversified customer and supplier base.

Our management team’s strategy for our subsidiaries involves:

• 

• 

• 

• 
• 

utilizing structured incentive compensation programs tailored to each business in order to attract, recruit and retain talented 
managers to operate our businesses;
regularly  monitoring  financial  and  operational  performance,  instilling  consistent  financial  discipline,  and  supporting 
management in the development and implementation of information systems to effectively achieve these goals;
assisting management in their analysis and pursuit of prudent organic cash flow growth strategies (both revenue and cost 
related);
identifying and working with management to execute attractive external growth and acquisition opportunities; and
forming strong subsidiary level boards of directors, including independent directors, to supplement management in their 
development and implementation of strategic goals and objectives.

Based on the experience of our management team and its ability to identify and negotiate acquisitions, we believe we are well- 
positioned to acquire additional attractive businesses. Our management team has a large network of approximately 2,000 deal 
intermediaries to whom it actively markets and who we expect to expose us to potential acquisitions. Through this network, as 
well as our management team’s active proprietary transaction sourcing efforts, we typically have a substantial pipeline of potential 
acquisition  targets.  In  consummating  transactions,  our  management  team  has,  in  the  past,  been  able  to  successfully  navigate 
complex situations surrounding acquisitions, including corporate spin-offs, transitions of family-owned businesses, management 
buy-outs and reorganizations. We believe the flexibility, creativity, experience and expertise of our management team in structuring 
transactions provides us with a strategic advantage by allowing us to consider non-traditional and complex transactions tailored 
to fit a specific acquisition target.

In addition, because we intend to fund acquisitions through the utilization of our Revolving Credit Facility, we do not expect to 
be subject to delays in or conditions by closing acquisitions that would be typically associated with transaction specific financing, 
as is typically the case in such acquisitions. We believe this advantage is a powerful one and is highly unusual in the marketplace 
for acquisitions in which we operate.

76

Initial public offering and Company formation

On May 16, 2006, we completed our initial public offering of 13,500,000 shares of the Trust at an offering price of $15.00 per 
share (the “IPO”). Subsequent to the IPO the Company’s board of directors engaged our Manager to externally manage the day-
to-day operations and affairs of the Company, oversee the management and operations of the businesses and to perform those 
services customarily performed by executive officers of a public company.

From May 16, 2006 through December 31, 2016, we purchased seventeen businesses (each of our businesses is treated as a separate 
operating segment) and disposed of seven businesses.  The tables below reflect summarized information relating to our  acquisitions  
and dispositions from the date of our IPO through December 31, 2016 (in thousands):

Acquisitions

Business

Acquisition Date

CBS Holdings (Staffmark) (1)

Crosman
Advanced Circuits (3)

Silvue
Tridien (3)

Aeroglide

Halo

American Furniture
FOX (2)
Liberty Safe (3)
Ergobaby (3)

CamelBak

Arnold Magnetics
Clean Earth (3)
Sterno Products (3)
Manitoba Harvest (3)

5.11

May 16, 2006

May 16, 2006

May 16, 2006

May 16, 2006

August 1, 2006

February 28, 2007

February 28, 2007

August 31, 2007

January 4, 2008

March 31, 2010

September 16, 2010

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

August 24, 2011 $

March 5, 2012

August 7, 2014

October 10, 2014

July 10, 2015

August 31, 2016

$

$

$

$

$

CODI Purchase
Price

183,200

72,600

81,000

36,000

31,000

58,200

62,300

97,000

80,400

70,200

85,200

251,400

128,800

251,400

160,000

100.0%

102,700

408,200

76.6%

97.5%

Ownership Interest -
December 31, 2016

Primary

Diluted

N/a

N/a

N/a

N/a

69.4%

69.3%

N/a

N/a

N/a

N/a

N/a

14.0%

88.6%

83.5%

N/a

96.7%

97.5%

N/a

N/a

N/a

N/a

N/a

N/a

84.7%

76.9%

N/a

84.7%

79.8%

89.5%

65.6%

85.1%

(1) The total purchase price for CBS Holdings includes the acquisition of Staffmark Investment LLC on January 21, 2008 for a 
purchase price of $128.6 million.  The Company renamed its CBS Personnel business to Staffmark subsequent to the acquisition.  

(2)  FOX completed an IPO of its common stock in August 2013 in which we sold a 22% interest in FOX, reducing our ownership 
interest to 53%.  In July 2014, FOX completed a secondary offering in which we sold a 12% interest in FOX, reducing our 
ownership interest to 41% and resulting in the deconsolidation of FOX from our financial results.  We now hold an ownership 
interest in FOX of approximately 14%.  We have recognized total net proceeds from the sale of our FOX shares of approximately 
$328.9 million.  

(3)  The total purchase price does not reflect add-on acquisitions made by our businesses subsequent to their purchase by CODI.

77

Dispositions

Business

Date of Disposition

Sale Price

CODI Proceeds from 
Disposition (1)

Gain (loss)
recognized

Crosman

Aeroglide

Silvue

Staffmark

Halo

CamelBak

American Furniture

Tridien

January 5, 2007

June 24, 2008

June 25, 2008

$

$

$

October 17, 2011 $

May 1, 2012

August 3, 2015

October 5, 2015

September 21, 2016

$

$

$

$

143,000

95,000

95,000

295,000

76,500

412,500

24,100

25,000

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

109,600

78,500

63,600

216,000

66,500

367,800

23,500

22,700

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

35,800

34,000

39,400

88,600

(500)

164,000

(14,300)

1,680

(1)  CODI  portion  of  the  net  proceeds  from  disposition  includes  debt  and  equity  proceeds  and  reflects  the  accounting  for  the 
redemption of the sold business's minority shareholders and transaction expenses.

We are dependent on the earnings of, and cash receipts from, the businesses that we own in order to meet our corporate overhead 
and management fee expenses and to pay distributions. The earnings and distributions of our businesses are generally lowest in 
the first quarter, and strongest in the third and fourth quarter, of each fiscal year.  These earnings and distributions, net of any non-
controlling interest in these businesses, are available to:

•  meet capital expenditure requirements, management fees and corporate overhead charges;
• 
• 

fund distributions from the businesses to the Company; and
be distributed by the Trust to shareholders.

2016 Highlights

Acquisitions

Platform Acquisition

5.11 

On August 31, 2016, we closed on the acquisition of 5.11, a leading provider of purpose-built tactical apparel and gear for law 
enforcement, firefighters, EMS, and military special operations as well as outdoor and adventure enthusiasts.  The purchase price 
for 5.11, net of transaction costs of $2.1 million was $408.2 million.  We funded the acquisition through an Incremental Facility 
Amendment to the 2014 Credit Agreement.  The Incremental Facility Amendment provided an increase to the 2014 Revolving 
Credit Facility of $150.0 million, and an advance under the 2016 Incremental Term Loan in the amount of $250.0 million. 

Add-ons

Acquisition of Baby Tula

On May 11, 2016, the Company's Ergobaby subsidiary, acquired all of the outstanding membership interests in New Baby Tula 
LLC ("Baby Tula"), a maker of premium baby carriers, toddler carriers, slings, blankets and wraps.  The purchase price was $73.8 
million, net of transaction costs, plus a potential earn-out of $8.2 million based on 2017 financial performance.  Ergobaby paid 
$0.8 million in transaction costs in connection with the acquisition.  Ergobaby funded the acquisition and payment of related 
transaction costs through the issuance of an additional $68.2 million in intercompany loans with the Company, and the issuance 
of $8.2 million in Ergobaby shares to the selling shareholders. 

Acquisitions of EWS and Phoenix Soil

On June 1, 2016, the Company's Clean Earth subsidiary acquired certain of the assets and liabilities of EWS Alabama, Inc. ("EWS".)   
Clean Earth funded the acquisition and the related transaction costs through the issuance of additional intercompany debt with the 
Company.  Based in Glencoe, Alabama, EWS  provides a range of hazardous and non-hazardous waste management services from 
a fully permitted hazardous waste RCRA Part B facility. 

On April 15, 2016, Clean Earth acquired certain assets and liabilities of Phoenix Soil, LLC ("Phoenix Soil") and WIC, LLC 
(together with Phoenix Soil, the "Sellers").  Clean Earth funded the acquisition and the related transaction costs through the issuance 
78

of additional intercompany debt with the Company.  Phoenix Soil is based in Plainville, CT and provides environmental services 
for nonhazardous contaminated soil materials with a primary focus on soil.  Phoenix Soil recently completed its transition to a 
new 58,000 square foot thermal desorption facility owned by WIC, LLC.  The acquisition increased Clean Earth's soil treatment 
capabilities and expand its geographic footprint into New England. 

Acquisition of Northern International, Inc.

On January 22, 2016,  Sterno Products, a wholly owned subsidiary of the company, acquired all of the outstanding stock of  Northern 
International, Inc. (NII), for a purchase price of approximately $35.8 million (C$50.6 million).  The purchase price includes an 
earn-out payable over two years of up to a maximum amount of $1.8 million (C$2.5 million).  Headquartered in Coquitlam, British 
Columbia, Canada, NII sells flameless candles and outdoor lighting products through the retail segment.  Sterno Products financed 
the acquisition and payment of the related transaction costs through the issuance of an additional $37.0 million in intercompany 
loans with the Company.  

Dispositions

Disposition of Tridien Medical

On September 21, 2016, a subsidiary of Hill-Rom Holdings, Inc. acquired our Tridien subsidiary, based on an enterprise value of 
$25 million.  After the allocation of the sales price to non-controlling equity holders and the payment of transaction expenses, the 
Company received approximately $22.7 million in net proceeds related to the sale.  We recognized a gain of $1.7 million on the 
sale of Tridien during the year ended December 31, 2016.

Partial Divestiture of FOX shares

In November 2016, FOX closed on a secondary offering of 3,500,000 shares of FOX common stock held by the Company, for 
total net proceeds of $71.8 million. This sale of the portion of our FOX shares in November 2016 qualified as a Sale Event under 
the Company's LLC Agreement.  Our board of directors declared a distribution to the Holders of the Allocation Interests of $13.4 
million in connection with the Sale Event in the fourth quarter of 2016.  The profit allocation payment was made during the first 
quarter of 2017.  As a result of the November 2016 sale of FOX shares, our ownership interest in FOX was reduced to approximately 
14%.  We continue to evaluate opportunities to divest the remainder of our FOX shares.

On August 12, 2016, FOX, closed on a secondary public offering of 4,025,000 shares held by certain FOX shareholders, including 
the Company.  The Company sold a total of 3,500,000 shares of FOX common stock in this offering, for total net proceeds of 
$63.0 million.  Upon completion of the offering, our ownership of FOX decreased from approximately 33% to approximately 
23%.   This sale of the portion of our FOX shares in August 2016 qualified as a Sale Event under the Company's LLC Agreement.  
Our board of directors declared a distribution to the Holders of the Allocation Interests of $11.6 million in connection with the 
Sale Event of FOX in August 2016.  The profit allocation payment, offset by the negative profit allocation resulting from the 
disposition of Tridien, was made during the quarter ended December 31, 2016.  

During the first quarter of 2016, FOX closed on a secondary public offering of 2,500,000 shares of FOX common shares held by 
the Company.  Concurrently with the closing of the offering, FOX repurchased 500,000 shares of FOX common stock held by the 
Company.  As a result of the sale of shares through the offering and the repurchase of shares by FOX, we sold a total of 3,000,000 
shares of FOX common stock, with total net proceeds of approximately $47.7 million.  Upon completion of the offering and 
repurchase of shares by FOX, our ownership interest in FOX was reduced from approximately 41% to 33%.  This sale of the 
portion of our FOX shares in March 2016 qualified as a Sale Event under the Company's LLC Agreement.  During the second 
quarter, our board of directors declared a distribution to the Holders of the Allocation Interests of $8.6 million in connection with 
the Sale Event of FOX.  The profit allocation payment was made during the quarter ended June 30, 2016.  

Sale of Trust Common Shares

In December 2016, the Company completed an offering of 5,600,000 Trust common shares at an offering price of $18.65 per 
share.  The net proceeds to the Company, after deducting the underwriter's discount and offering costs, totaled approximately 
$99.4 million.

Ergobaby Share Repurchase

In June 2016, Ergobaby repurchased 77,425 shares of Ergobaby common stock from certain noncontrolling interest shareholders 
for a total purchase price of $15.4 million.  Ergobaby financed the repurchase of shares with an increase to the intercompany debt 
facility with the Company.  Subsequent to the repurchase, the noncontrolling interest in Ergobaby is 83.9% on a primary basis 
and  76.2% on a fully diluted basis.  The shares have been accounted for as treasury shares by Ergobaby.

79

2016 Distributions

For the 2016 fiscal year we declared distributions to our shareholders totaling $1.44 per share.

2017 Outlook

Middle market deal flow remained steady in 2016 relative to 2015, in part due to continued attractive valuations for sellers.  High 
valuation levels continue to be driven by the availability of debt capital with favorable terms and financial and strategic buyers 
seeking to deploy available equity capital.

We remain focused on marketing the Company’s attractive ownership and management attributes to potential sellers of middle 
market businesses and intermediaries.  In addition, we continue to pursue opportunities for add-on acquisitions by certain of our 
existing subsidiary companies, which can be particularly attractive from a strategic perspective.

The areas of focus for 2017, which are generally applicable to each of our businesses, include:

•  Achieving sales growth through a combination of new product development, increasing distribution and international 

expansion; 

•  Taking market share, where possible, in each of our niche market leading companies, generally at the expense of less 

well capitalized competitors;
Striving for excellence in supply chain management, manufacturing and technological capabilities;

• 
•  Continuing to pursue expense reduction and cost savings in lower margin business lines or in response to lower production 

volume;

•  Continuing to grow through disciplined, strategic acquisitions and rigorous integration processes; and
•  Driving free cash flow through increased net income and effective working capital management, enabling continued 

investment in our businesses, strategic acquisitions, and distributions to our shareholders.

80

Results of Operations

We were formed on November 18, 2005 and acquired our existing businesses (segments) as follows:

May 16, 2006
Advanced Circuits

August 26, 2014
Clean Earth

March 31, 2010

September 16, 2010

March 5, 2012

Liberty Safe

Ergobaby

Arnold

October 10, 2014

July 10, 2015

August 31, 2016

Sterno Products

Manitoba Harvest

5.11

Fiscal 2016, 2015 and 2014 each represent a full year of operating results included in our consolidated results of operations for 
four of our businesses. We acquired 5.11 in August 2016, Manitoba Harvest in July 2015, and Clean Earth and Sterno Products 
in August 2014 and October 2014, respectively.  Additionally, on July 10, 2014, our ownership interest in FOX decreased below 
50% and as a result, beginning July 10, 2014, FOX no longer met the requirements for inclusion in our consolidated results of 
operations.  In the following results of operations, we provide (i) our actual Consolidated Results of Operations for the years ended 
December 31,  2016,  2015  and  2014,  which  includes  the  historical  results  of  operations  of  each  of  our  businesses  (operating 
segments) from the date of acquisition and (ii) comparative historical results of operations for each of our businesses on a stand-
alone basis (“Results of Operations – Our Businesses”), for each of the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, where 
all years presented include relevant pro-forma adjustments for pre-acquisition periods and explanations where applicable.

Consolidated Results of Operations — Compass Diversified Holdings

(in thousands)

Net revenues

Cost of sales

Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expense

Management fees

Amortization of intangibles

Impairment expense

Loss on disposal of assets

Operating income

$

$

Year Ended

December 31, 2016

December 31, 2015

978,309

$

651,739

326,570

217,830

29,406

35,069

16,000

9,204

19,061

$

727,978

487,242

240,736

136,399

25,658

28,761

—

—

49,918

(in thousands)

Net revenues

Cost of sales

Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expense

Management fees

Amortization of intangibles

Operating income

Year Ended December 31, 2014

Consolidated Results
of Operations

Less: FOX

Consolidated Results
less FOX

636,675

$

149,995

$

431,658

205,017

128,190

21,872

23,063

103,701

46,294

25,780

—

3,220

31,892

$

17,294

$

486,680

327,957

158,723

102,410

21,872

19,843

14,598

$

$

81

Year Ended December 31, 2016 compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2015

Net sales

On a consolidated basis, net sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 increased by approximately $250.3 million or 34.4%
compared to the corresponding period in 2015.  5.11 sales since the date of acquisition were $109.8 million, while  $41.9 million
of the increase reflects a full year of net sales at Manitoba Harvest in 2016 as compared to 2015.  The remaining amount of the 
increase was primarily due to add-on acquisitions made during 2016, specifically the Ergobaby acquisition of Baby Tula in May 
2016 ($16.3 million in net sales from date of acquisition), and the Sterno acquisition of NII in January 2016 ($77.9 million in net 
sales from the date of acquisition). Refer to "Results of Operations - Our Businesses" for a more detailed analysis of net sales by 
business segment.

We do not generate any revenues apart from those generated by the businesses we own. We may generate interest income on the 
investment of available funds, but expect such earnings to be minimal. Our investment in our businesses is typically in the form 
of loans from the Company to such businesses, as well as equity interests in those businesses. Cash flows coming to the Trust and 
the Company are the result of interest payments on those loans, amortization of those loans and, in some cases, dividends on our 
equity ownership. However, on a consolidated basis these items will be eliminated.

Cost of sales

On a consolidated basis, cost of sales increased approximately $164.5 million during the year ended December 31, 2016, compared 
to the corresponding period in 2015. 5.11 cost of sales since the date of acquisition were $78.8 million, while $20.9 million  of 
the increase reflects a full year of cost of sales at Manitoba Harvest in 2016 as compared to 2015.  The remaining amount of the 
increase was primarily due to add-on acquisitions made during 2016, specifically the Ergobaby acquisition of Baby Tula in May 
2016 ($4.7 million in cost of sales from date of acquisition), and the Sterno acquisition of NII in January 2016 ($58.1 million in 
net sales from the date of acquisition).  Gross profit as a percentage of sales was approximately 33.4% in year ended December 
31, 2016 compared to 33.1% in 2015.  Refer to "Results of Operations - Our Businesses" for a more detailed analysis of cost of 
sales by business segment.

Selling, general and administrative expense

On a consolidated basis, selling, general and administrative expense increased approximately $81.4 million during the year ended 
December  31,  2016,  compared  to  the  corresponding  period  in  2015. The  increase  in  expenses  in  2016  compared  to  2015  is 
principally the result of the acquisition of 5.11 in August 2016 ($38.1 million in selling, general and administrative expenses, 
including $2.1 million in acquisition costs), a full year of expense related to our 2015 acquisition, Manitoba Harvest, ($11.5 
million), and the add on acquisitions of Baby Tula by Ergobaby and NII by Sterno Products ($3.9 million and $18.6 million, 
respectively, in selling, general and administrative expense).  Refer to "Results of Operations - Our Businesses" for a more detailed 
analysis of selling, general and administrative expense by business segment.  At the corporate level, general and administrative 
expense increased from $10.6 million in 2015 to $12.3 million in 2016.

Fees to manager

Pursuant to the Management Services Agreement, we pay CGM a quarterly management fee equal to 0.5% (2.0% annually) of 
our consolidated adjusted net assets. We accrue for the management fee on a quarterly basis. For the year ended December 31, 
2016, we incurred approximately $29.4 million in expense for these fees compared to $25.7 million for the corresponding period 
in 2015.  The $3.8 million increase in the year ended December 31, 2016 is principally due to the increase in consolidated net 
assets resulting from the acquisition of 5.11 in August 2016, and the add-on acquisitions by our businesses that occurred throughout 
2016.

Impairment expense

The Company performed interim goodwill impairment testing on the three reporting units of Arnold as of December 31, 2016.  
The results of the impairment test (Step 1) indicated that the goodwill associated with the PMAG reporting unit was impaired.  
The Company developed an estimated range of the potential goodwill impairment at PMAG of between $14 million and $19 
million, and has recorded impairment expense of $16 million at December 31, 2016.  The result of the Step 2 analysis is expected 
to be recorded in the first quarter of 2017.

82

Loss on disposal of assets

Both the Ergobaby and Clean Earth businesses recognized losses on disposal of assets during 2016.  Ergobaby recorded a $5.9 
million loss on disposal of assets during the year ended December 31, 2016 related to its decision to dispose of the Orbit Baby 
product line.  The loss is comprised of the write-off of intangible assets of $5.5 million, property, plant and equipment of $0.4 
million, and other assets of $1.0 million.  In October 2016, Ergobaby sold a majority of the Orbit Baby intellectual property and 
tooling assets.  The proceeds of the sale reduced the loss recorded on disposal of assets by approximately $1.0 million in the fourth 
quarter of 2016.  Clean Earth recognized a loss on disposal of assets of $3.3 million during the fourth quarter of 2016 related to 
the closure of the Company’s Williamsport, Pennsylvania site which processed drill cuttings.  The loss was comprised of intangible 
assets specific to the Williamsport location, as well as equipment that could not be repurposed to other sites at the time of the 
closing of the facility.  

Year Ended December 31, 2015 compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2014

Net sales

On a consolidated basis, net of FOX, net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 increased by approximately $241.3 million
or 49.6% compared to the corresponding period in 2014.   Our acquisitions of Clean Earth and Sterno Products in August and 
October 2014, respectively, contributed $210.2  million of the total increase, and the acquisition of Manitoba Harvest in July 2015 
contributed an additional $17.4 million.  During the year ended December 31, 2015 compared to 2014, we also saw notable sales 
increases at Ergobaby ($4.3 million) and Liberty ($11.0 million), offset in part by decreased sales at Arnold Magnetics ($3.2 
million).  Refer to "Results of Operations - Our Businesses" for a more detailed analysis of net sales by business segment.

Cost of sales

On a consolidated basis, net of FOX, cost of sales increased approximately $159.3 million during the year ended December 31, 
2015, compared to the corresponding period in 2014.  The 2014 acquisitions ($150.7 million) and Manitoba Harvest ($11.9 million 
of the increase, including the amortization of the step up in fair value of inventory associated with the purchase price allocation 
of $3.1 million) were the primary drivers of the increase in cost of sales during the year ended December 31, 2015.  Gross profit 
as a percentage of sales was approximately 33.1% in year ended December 31, 2015 compared to 32.6% in 2014.  Refer to "Results 
of Operations - Our Businesses" for a more detailed analysis of cost of sales by business segment.

Selling, general and administrative expense

On a consolidated basis, net of FOX, selling, general and administrative expense increased approximately $34.0 million during 
the year ended December 31, 2015, compared to the corresponding period in 2014. The increase in expenses in 2015 compared 
to 2014 is principally the result of including a full year of expenses from our 2014 acquisitions (an increase of $24.1 million), as 
well as the expenses from Manitoba Harvest ($9.8 million, including acquisition costs).  Refer to "Results of Operations - Our 
Businesses" for a more detailed analysis of selling, general and administrative expense by business segment.  At the corporate 
level, general and administrative expense decreased from $11.2 million in 2014 to $10.6 million in 2015.

Fees to manager

Pursuant to the Management Services Agreement, we pay CGM a quarterly management fee equal to 0.5% (2.0% annually) of 
our consolidated adjusted net assets. We accrue for the management fee on a quarterly basis. For the year ended December 31, 
2015, we incurred approximately $25.7 million in expense for these fees compared to $21.9 million for the corresponding period 
in 2014.  The $3.8 million increase in the year ended December 31, 2015 is principally due to the increase in consolidated net 
assets resulting from the 2014 acquisitions during the third and fourth quarter of 2014, respectively, and Manitoba Harvest in the 
third quarter of 2015, and the timing of the dispositions of CamelBak and American Furniture during the latter half of 2015. 

Amortization expense

Amortization expense increased $8.9 million, from $19.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2014 to $28.8 million for the 
year  ended  December  31,  2015.   The  increase  primarily  relates  to  a  full  year  of  amortization  expense  in  2015  for  our  2014 
acquisitions (resulting in an increase of $11.1 million), offset by a decrease in amortization at our Liberty Safe business related 
to certain intangibles that were fully amortized in 2014.  

83

 
Results of Operations — Our Businesses

As  previously  discussed,  we  acquired  our  businesses  on  various  acquisition  dates  beginning  May 16,  2006. As  a  result,  our 
consolidated operating results only include the results of operations since the acquisition date associated with each of our businesses 
in accordance with Generally Accepted Accounting Principles. The following discussion reflects a comparison of the historical 
results of operations for each of our businesses (segments) for the complete fiscal years ending December 31, 2016, 2015 and 
2014.  For 5.11, which we acquired in August 2016, the following discussion reflects the comparative pro forma results of operations 
for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 as if we had acquired the business on January 1, 2014.  For Manitoba 
Harvest, which was acquired in July 2015, the following discussion reflects the historical operations for the year ended December 
31, 2016, and comparative pro forma results of operation for the entire fiscal years ending December 31, 2015 and 2014 as if we 
had acquired the business January 1, 2014.  For the 2014 acquisitions, the following discussion reflects  historical operations for 
the year ending December 31, 2016 and 2015, and comparative pro forma results of operations for the entire fiscal year ending 
December 31, 2014, as if we had acquired the businesses on January 1, 2014. Where appropriate, relevant pro forma adjustments 
are reflected as part of the historical operating results.  We believe this presentation enhances the discussion and provides a more 
meaningful comparison of operating results. The following operating results of our businesses are not necessarily indicative of 
the results to be expected for a full year, going forward.

We categorize the businesses we own into two separate groups of businesses (i) branded consumer businesses, and (ii) niche 
industrial businesses. Branded consumer businesses are characterized as those businesses that we believe capitalize on a valuable 
brand name in their respective market sector. We believe that our branded consumer businesses are leaders in their particular 
category. Niche industrial businesses are characterized as those businesses that focus on manufacturing and selling particular 
products or services within a specific market sector. We believe that our niche industrial businesses are leaders in their specific 
market sector.

Branded Consumer Businesses

5.11 

Overview

5.11 is a leading provider of purpose-built tactical apparel and gear for law enforcement, firefighters, EMS, and military special 
operations as well as outdoor and adventure enthusiasts.  5.11 is a brand known for innovation and authenticity, and works directly 
with end users to create purpose-built apparel and gear designed to enhance the safety, accuracy, speed and performance of tactical 
professionals and enthusiasts worldwide.   Headquartered in Irvine, California, 5.11 operates sales offices and distribution centers 
globally, and 5.11 products are widely distributed in uniform stores, military exchanges, outdoor retail stores, its own retail stores 
and on 511tactical.com.

We made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in 5.11 for a net purchase price of $408.2 million in August 2016, representing 
approximately 97.5% of the initial outstanding equity of 5.11 ABR Corp.  

Results of Operations

The table below summarizes the pro forma results of operations for 5.11 for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.  
We acquired 5.11 on August 31, 2016.  The following results are reported as if we had acquired 5.11 on January 1, 2014.

(in thousands)

Net sales

Cost of sales (a)

Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expenses (b)

Management fees (c)

Amortization of intangibles (d)

(Loss) income from operations

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

(Pro forma)

(Pro forma)

(Pro forma)

$

295,256

$

284,471

$

182,456

112,800

107,149

1,000

8,503

161,785

122,686

97,953

1,000

8,189

$

(3,852) $

15,544

$

278,852

156,693

122,159

98,370

1,000

8,189

14,600

84

Pro forma results of operations for 5.11 for the annual periods ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 include the following 
pro forma adjustments applied to historical results:

(a)  The purchase price allocation for 5.11 included a step-up in the value of inventory of $39.1 million which is being recognized through cost 
of sales over the inventory turns of 5.11 of approximately 1.3x annually.  $17.4 million in expense was recognized from the date of acquisition 
through December 31, 2016, and the remaining amount of inventory step-up will be recognized through cost of sales in the first and second 
quarter of 2017.  

(b)  Selling, general and administrative expenses were increased by approximately $0.9 million, $1.1 million and $0.7 million in the years ended 
December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively, as a result of stock compensation expense related to stock options that have been granted to 
5.11 employees as a result of the acquisition.  

(c)  Represents management fees that would have been payable to the Manager in each period presented.

(d)  Represents amortization of intangible assets in the three years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively, for amortization 
expense associated with the allocation of the fair value of intangible assets resulting from the final purchase price allocation in connection with 
our acquisition.   

Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2016 compared to the Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2015

Net sales

Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 were $295.3 million, an increase of $10.8 million, or 3.8%, compared to the same 
period in 2015.  Base revenues, which are considered all revenues outside of direct-to-agency business, increased $15.8 million, 
or 6% over the comparable period.  This increase was driven primarily by growing demand in the consumer wholesale channel, 
which increased 11% due to strong sell-through in the outdoor and sporting goods accounts.  Retail and e-commerce revenues 
grew 131% and 20%, respectively.  Retail revenues grew due to six new store openings since January 2015 (bringing the total 
store count to ten as of December 31, 2016), and a comparable store sales increase of 16%.  Direct-to-agency sales decreased $5.7 
million in fiscal 2016 compared to 2015, primarily as a result of a significant contract that shipped in the third quarter of 2015 but 
did not recur in 2016.

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 were $182.5 million compared to $161.8 million for the year ended December 
31, 2015.  Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased from 43.1% in the year ended December 31, 2015 to 38.2% in the year 
ended December 31, 2016.  Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 includes $17.4 million in expense related to a 
$39.1 million inventory step-up resulting from the acquisition purchase price allocation.  The total inventory step-up amount of 
$39.1 million will be expensed to cost of goods sold over the expected turns of 5.11's inventory, with the remaining amount of 
$21.7 million at December 31, 2016 recognized during the first half of 2017.  Excluding the effect of $17.4 million of expense 
associated with the inventory step-up, gross profit as a percentage of sales increased from 43.1% for the year ended December 
31, 2015 to 44.1% for the year ended December 31, 2016.  The gross profit as a percentage of sales increased 100 bps due to lower 
discounts and promotional activity and a larger proportion of revenues from the higher margin retail and e-commerce distribution 
channels as compared to the prior year period.  During the year ended December 31, 2015, 5.11 incurred unusually high levels of 
discounts  and  promotional  activity  caused  by  the West  Coast  Port  slowdown.   These  unusually  high  levels  of  discounts  and 
promotional activity did not recur in the year ended December 31, 2016.

Selling, general and administrative expenses

Selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended December 31, 2016 increased to $107.1 million or 36.3% of net 
sales compared to $98.0 million or 34.4% of net sales in the same period in 2015.  This increase in selling, general and administrative 
expenses was primarily attributable to increases in employee related costs including wage increases and slightly increased staffing 
levels, as well as six new retail stores that were not open in the prior year comparable period.  Selling, general and administrative 
expense for the year ended December 31, 2016 also includes $1.2 million in integration fees paid to CGM and $2.1 million in 
one-time buyer transaction costs incurred in August 2016 related to the 5.11 acquisition by the Company.  

(Loss) income from operations

Loss from operations for the year ended December 31, 2016 was $3.9 million, a decrease of $19.4 million when compared to the 
same period in 2015, primarily due to the amortization of the inventory step-up resulting from the purchase price allocation, 
transaction related costs resulting from the acquisition, as well as the other factors noted above.  

85

Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2015 compared to the Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2014

Net sales

Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 were $284.5 million, an increase of $5.6 million, or 2.0%, compared to the same 
period in 2014.  Base revenues, which are considered all revenues outside of direct-to-agency business increased 7% over the 
comparable period.  This increase was driven primarily by growing demand in the domestic and international professional channel.  
In addition, 5.11 experienced 11% growth in the consumer wholesale channel due to strong sell-through in outdoor and sporting 
goods accounts.  Retail and e-commerce revenues grew 118% and 16%, respectively.  Retail revenues grew due to three new store 
openings since January of 2014 (bringing the total store count to four as of December 31, 2015).  Direct-to-agency sales decreased 
$11.6 million in fiscal 2015 compared to 2014, primarily as a result of a certain contracts that shipped in 2014 that did not recur 
in 2015.

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 were $161.8 million compared to $156.7 million for the year ended December 
31, 2014.  Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased from 43.8% in the year ended December 31, 2014 to 43.1% in the year 
ended December 31, 2015.  During the year ended December 31, 2015, the Company incurred unusually high levels of discounts 
and promotional activity caused by the West Coast Port slowdown. These unusually high levels of discounts and promotional 
activity did not occur in the year ended December 31, 2014 as there were no significant port issues during that year. 

Selling, general and administrative expenses

Selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended December 31, 2015 were $98.0 million or 34.4% of net sales 
compared to $98.4 million or 35.3% of net sales in the same period in 2014.  This decrease in selling, general and administrative 
expenses as a percentage of net sales was primarily attributable to leveraging fixed costs over a higher revenue base.  

Income from operations

Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2015 was $15.5 million, an increase of $0.9 million when compared to 
the same period in 2014, based on the factors noted above.  

Ergobaby

Overview
Ergobaby,  headquartered  in  Los Angeles,  California,  is  a  designer,  marketer  and  distributor  of  wearable  baby  carriers  and 
accessories, blankets and swaddlers, nursing pillows, and related products.  Ergobaby primarily sells its Ergobaby and Baby Tula 
branded products through brick-and-mortar retailers, national chain stores, online retailers, its own websites and distributors and 
derives approximately 56% of its sales from outside of the United States.

We made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Ergobaby on September 16, 2010, for approximately $85.2 million, 
representing approximately 84% of the equity in Ergobaby.  

On November 18, 2011 Ergobaby acquired Orbit Baby for approximately $17.5 million. Founded in 2004 and based in Newark, 
California, Orbit Baby produced and marketed a luxury line of strollers and car seats that utilized a patented hub ring to allow 
parents to easily move car seats from car seat bases to stroller frames in an instant without the need for any additional components. 
During the second quarter of 2016, Ergobaby's board of directors approved a plan to dispose of the Orbit Baby product line and 
in the fourth quarter of 2016, most of the Orbit Baby tooling and intellectual property was sold to Orbit Baby’s Korean distributor.   
Ergobaby recognized a net loss on the disposal of the Orbit Baby assets of $5.9 million during 2016.

On May 12, 2016, Ergobaby acquired membership interests of New Baby Tula LLC (“Baby Tula”) for approximately $73.8 million, 
excluding a potential earn-out payment.  Baby Tula designs, markets and distributes baby carriers and accessories.  The results of 
operations of Baby Tula are included from the date of acquisition through December 31, 2016.

86

Results of Operations

The table below summarizes the results of operations for Ergobaby for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014. 

(in thousands)

Net sales

Cost of sales

Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expenses

Management fees

Amortization of intangibles

Loss on disposal of assets

Income from operations

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

103,348

$

86,506

$

39,962

63,386

37,703

500

2,133

5,899

30,070

56,436

31,296

500

2,483

—

82,255

29,740

52,515

30,891

500

2,977

—

$

17,151

$

22,157

$

18,147

Year Ended December 31, 2016 compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2015

Net sales
Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 were $103.3 million, an increase of $16.8 million or 19.5% compared to the same 
period in 2015.  Net sales for Baby Tula subsequent to the acquisition were $16.3 million.  During the year ended December 31, 
2016, international sales were approximately $57.4 million, representing an increase of $9.2 million over the corresponding period 
in 2015.  International sales of baby carriers, accessories and product adjacencies (sleep and nursing) increased by approximately 
$10.7 million and international sales of infant travel systems decreased by approximately $1.5 million during the year ended 
December 31, 2016 as compared to the year ended December 31, 2015.  Baby Tula international sales represent an increase of 
$5.2 million.  During 2016, Ergobaby moved to a direct sales model from a distributor model in Canada, the United Kingdom and 
Switzerland, which negatively impacted the year-over-year international sales comparison.  Domestic sales were $45.9 million 
during the year ended December 31, 2016, reflecting an increase of $7.7 million compared to the corresponding period in 2015.  
Domestic sales of baby carriers, accessories and product adjacencies (sleep and nursing) increased $10.3 million and domestic 
sales of infant travel systems and accessories decreased $2.6 million during the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to the 
same period in 2015.  Baby Tula domestic sales represent an increase of $11.1  million.  The decrease in domestic infant travel 
systems and accessories was primarily attributable to lower demand of travel systems and the decision to exit the Orbit Baby 
brand.  Baby carriers, accessories and product adjacencies (sleep and nursing) represented 93% of sales in the year ended December 
31, 2016 compared to 87% in the same period in 2015.

Cost of sales

Cost of sales was approximately $40.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2016 as compared to $30.1 million for the year 
ended December 31, 2015.  Cost of sales for Baby Tula were approximately $10.1 million, and includes $4.7 million in expense 
associated with the inventory step-up recorded in connection with the purchase price allocation for Baby Tula.  The increase in 
cost of sales was primarily attributable to higher sales compared to the prior period.  Gross profit as a percentage of sales was 
61.3% for the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to 65.2% for the same period in 2015.  Excluding the impact of the 
inventory step-up expense on cost of sales, gross profit as a percentage of sales was 65.9% for the year ended December 31, 2016.

Selling, general and administrative expenses
Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2016 increased to approximately $37.7 million or 
36.5% of net sales compared to $31.3 million or 36.2% of net sales for the same period of 2015.  The $6.4 million increase in the 
year  ended  December  31,  2016  compared  to  the  same  period  in  2015  was  primarily  attributable  to  the  acquisition  costs  and 
additional selling, general and administrative expenses related to Baby Tula, higher marketing spend, increases in employee related 
costs due to increased staffing levels, and increased legal fees, partially offset by decreased variable expenses, such as distribution 
and fulfillment and commissions.

Loss on disposal of assets

Ergobaby recorded a $5.9 million loss on disposal of assets during the year ended December 31, 2016 related to its decision to 
dispose of the Orbit Baby product line.  The loss is comprised of the write-off of intangible assets of $5.5 million, property, plant 
and equipment of $0.4 million, and other assets of $1.0 million.  In October 2016, Ergobaby sold a majority of the Orbit Baby 

87

intellectual property and tooling assets.  The proceeds of the sale reduced  the loss recorded on disposal of assets by approximately 
$1.0 million in the fourth quarter of 2016.

Income from operations

Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2016 decreased $5.0 million, to $17.2 million, compared to $22.2 million
for the same period of 2015, primarily as a result of the loss on disposal of assets.

Year Ended December 31, 2015 compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2014

Net sales
Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 were $86.5 million, an increase of $4.3 million or 5.2% compared to the same 
period in 2014.  During the year ended December 31, 2015, international sales were approximately $48.2 million, representing 
an increase of $1.5 million over the corresponding period in 2014. International baby carrier and accessory sales increased by 
approximately $1.8 million, offset by a decrease in international infant travel systems sales by approximately $0.3 million during 
2015 as compared to 2014.   Domestic sales were $38.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2015, reflecting an increase 
of $2.7 million over the corresponding period in 2014.   The growth in domestic sales during 2015 compared to 2014 is attributable 
to increased sales of baby carriers and accessories ($4.8 million) to national and specialty retail accounts, offset by a decrease in 
domestic revenues for infant travel systems and accessories ($2.1 million).  The increase in baby carrier sales was attributable to 
the demand for the Ergobaby’s 360 four position carrier, which was domestically available late in the second quarter of 2014.  The 
decrease in infant travel systems and accessories sales was primarily attributable to higher revenues during 2014 when Ergobaby 
launched the new Orbit Baby G3 infant travel system, which includes stroller bases, various seats and accessories, into the domestic 
market.   Baby carriers and accessories represented 86.5% of sales in the year ended December 31, 2015 compared to 83.0% in 
the same period in 2014.

Cost of sales

Cost of sales was approximately $30.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2015 as compared to $29.7 million for the year 
ended December 31, 2014.  The increase in cost of sales was primarily attributable to higher sales volume compared to the prior 
period.  Gross profit as a percentage of sales was 65.2% for the year ended December 31, 2015 compared to 63.8% for the same 
period in 2014.  The 140 basis point increase is primarily attributable to product sales mix, with a larger percentage of higher 
margin baby carrier sales as compared to the prior period.   

Selling, general and administrative expenses

Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2015 increased to approximately $31.3 million or 
36.2% of net sales compared to $30.9 million or 37.6% of net sales for the same period of 2014.  The $0.4 million increase in the 
year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the same period in 2014 was primarily attributable to higher personnel costs due to 
increased staffing levels; higher marketing spending to support sales growth and consumer engagement activities; increased variable 
expenses, such as distribution and fulfillment and commission, due to the increase in domestic sales; partially offset by lower 
foreign currency translation costs in the period.

Income from operations

Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2015 increased $4.0 million, to $22.2 million, compared to $18.1 million 
for the same period of 2014, based on the factors described above.

Liberty Safe

Overview

Based in Payson, Utah and founded in 1988, Liberty Safe is the premier designer, manufacturer and marketer of home, office and 
gun safes in North America. From its over 314,000 square foot manufacturing facility, Liberty Safe produces a wide range of 
home, office and gun safe models in a broad assortment of sizes, features and styles ranging from an entry level product to good, 
better and best products. Products are marketed under the Liberty brand, as well as a portfolio of licensed and private label brands, 
including Cabela’s, Case IH and John Deere.  Liberty Safe’s products are the market share leader and are sold through an independent 
dealer network (“Dealer sales”) in addition to various sporting goods, farm and fleet and home improvement retail outlets (“Non-
Dealer Sales”). Liberty has the largest independent dealer network in the industry.  Historically, approximately 55% of Liberty 
Safe’s net sales are Non-Dealer sales and 45% are Dealer sales.

We made loans to, and purchased a controlling interest in, Liberty Safe for approximately $70.2 million in March 2010, representing 
approximately 96% of the equity in Liberty.

88

   
Results of Operations

The table below summarizes the results of operations for Liberty Safe for the full fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, and 2015 
and 2014. 

(in thousands)

Net sales

Cost of sales

Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expenses

Management fees

Amortization of intangibles

Income (loss) from operations

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

103,812

$

101,146

$

74,305

29,507

14,737

500

1,036

73,935

27,211

13,081

500

1,772

90,149

76,889

13,260

11,591

500

3,886

$

13,234

$

11,858

$

(2,717)

Year Ended December 31, 2016 compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2015

Net sales
Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 increased approximately $2.7 million or 2.6%, to $103.8 million, compared to 
the corresponding period ended December 31, 2015.  Non-Dealer sales were approximately $52.5 million in 2016 compared to 
$55.2 million in 2015, representing a decrease of $2.7 million or 5.0%.  Dealer sales totaled approximately $51.3 million in the 
year ended December 31, 2016 compared to $45.9 million in the same period in 2015, representing an increase of $5.4 million 
or 11.8 %. The increase in sales is attributable to good overall market demand during the year, particularly in the first quarter of 
2016, and Liberty’s increased ability to meet that demand with pre-built inventory and increased production capacity.  2016 also 
saw significant growth in Liberty's handgun vault business.  Liberty Safe’s sales backlog was approximately $8.4 million at 
December 31, 2016 compared to approximately $7.1 million at December 31, 2015.

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 increased approximately $0.4 million when compared to the same period in 
2015.  Gross profit as a percentage of net sales totaled approximately 28.4% in 2016 compared to 26.9% in 2015.  The increase 
in gross profit as a percentage of sales during the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to the same period in 2015 is attributable 
primarily to favorable material costs related to the cost of steel, which is Liberty's primary raw material.  Liberty expects to see 
the cost of steel returning to more normal levels beginning in the first quarter of 2017.

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2016 increased to approximately $14.7 million or 
14.2% of net sales compared to $13.1 million or 12.9% of net sales for the same period of 2015.  The $1.7 million increase is 
primarily attributable to increased spending on radio and other advertising media, higher sales commission expense, and additional 
expenses related to accelerated vesting of employee stock options and legal fees associated with the recapitalization of Liberty in 
March 2016.

Income from operations
Income from operations increased $1.4 million during the year ended December 31, 2016 to $13.2 million compared to income 
from operations of $11.9 million during the same period in 2015, principally as a result of the increase in sales and gross profit, 
as described above.

Year Ended December 31, 2015 compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2014

Net sales
Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 increased approximately $11.0 million or 12.2%, to $101.1 million, compared to 
the corresponding period ended December 31, 2014.  Non-Dealer sales were approximately $55.2 million in 2015 compared to 
$50.4 million in 2014, representing an increase of $4.8 million or 9.6%.  Dealer sales totaled approximately $45.9 million in the 
year ended December 31, 2015 compared to $39.7 million in the same period in 2014, representing an increase of $6.2 million or 
15.7%.  Higher production output coupled with the increase in market demand, as well as a price increase to some of Liberty's 
customers in 2015, has facilitated the year over year sales growth.  In addition, the increase in 2015 sales is attributable to a return 

89

to a strong level of market demand following the abnormal industry cycle in 2013 and 2014, particularly the market softening 
experienced  during  2014.    Liberty  Safe’s  sales  backlog  was  approximately  $7.1  million  at  December  31,  2015  compared  to 
approximately $9.5 million at December 31, 2014.

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 decreased approximately $3.0 million when compared to the same period in 
2014.  Gross profit as a percentage of net sales totaled approximately 26.9% in 2015 compared to 14.7%  in 2014.  The significant 
increase in gross profit as a percentage of sales during the year ended December 31, 2015 compared to the same period in 2014 
is attributable to favorable cost variances as a result of improved manufacturing efficiencies due to greater volume output and 
favorable material costs, and discounted sales prices for import safes sold in 2014 that negatively impacted gross margins.

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2015 increased to approximately $13.1 million or 
12.9% of net sales compared to $11.6 million or 12.9% of net sales for the same period of 2014.  The $1.5 million increase is 
primarily attributable to a higher level of dealer co-op advertising, higher sales commission expense, and an increased annual 
advertising allowance for national account customers.

Income (loss) from operations

Income from operations increased $14.6 million during the year ended December 31, 2015 to $11.9 million compared to a loss 
from operations of $2.7 million during the same period in 2014, principally as a result of the increase in sales and gross profit, as 
described above.

Manitoba Harvest

Overview

Headquartered in Winnipeg, Manitoba, Manitoba Harvest is a pioneer and leader in branded, hemp-based foods. Manitoba Harvest’s 
products, which management believes are one of the fastest growing in the hemp food market and among the fastest growing in 
the natural foods industry, are currently carried in approximately 13,000 retail stores across the U.S. and Canada. The Company’s 
hemp-exclusive, consumer-facing 100% all-natural product lineup includes hemp hearts, protein powder, hemp oil and snacks.

We  made  loans  to  and  purchased  a  controlling  interest  in  Manitoba  Harvest  for  approximately  $102.7  million  in  July  2015 
representing approximately 87% of the equity in Manitoba Harvest.  On December 15, 2015, Manitoba Harvest acquired all of 
the outstanding stock of Hemp Oil Canada Inc. (“HOCI”) for approximately $32.7 million.  HOCI is a wholesale supplier and a 
private label packager of hemp food products and ingredients.  

Results of Operations

The table below summarizes the results of operations for Manitoba Harvest for the year ended December 31, 2016, and the pro 
forma results of operations for Manitoba Harvest for the full fiscal years ended December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014.  

(in thousands)

Net sales

Cost of sales (a)

Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expense (b)

Fees to manager (c)

Amortization of intangibles (d)

Income (loss) from operations

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

(Pro forma)

(Pro forma)

$

59,323

$

40,586

$

32,818

26,505

21,326

350

4,508

20,268

20,318

19,425

350

3,676

35,535

19,306

16,229

13,702

350

4,248

$

321

$

(3,133) $

(2,071)

90

 
Pro forma results of operations of Manitoba Harvest for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014 include the following pro 
forma adjustments, applied to historical results as if we had acquired Manitoba Harvest January 1, 2014:

(a)  The purchase price allocation for Manitoba Harvest included an inventory step-up of $3.1 million, which was charged to cost of sales over 
the estimated turns of Manitoba Harvest during 2015. 

(b)  Selling, general and administrative expenses were increased by $0.6 million and $1.0 million in the year ended December 31, 2015 and 
2014, respectively, to reflect stock compensation expense for stock options granted to Manitoba Harvest employees as of the date of acquisition.  

(c)  Represents Management fees that would have been payable to the Manager in each of the periods presented.

(d) Represents an increase in amortization expense totaling approximately $2.0 million and $4.2 million in the years ended December 31, 2015 
and 2014, respectively, for amortization expense associated with the allocation of the purchase price for Manitoba Harvest to definite lived 
intangible assets.

Year Ended December 31, 2016 compared to the Pro forma Year Ended December 31, 2015

Net sales

Net  sales  for  the  year  ended  December  31,  2016  were  approximately  $59.3  million,  an  increase  of  $18.7  million,  or  46.2%, 
compared to the same period in 2015. Net sales of HOCI for the year ended December 31, 2016 were $20.7 million.  Manitoba 
Harvest on a stand-alone basis had a decrease in net sales of $2.2 million, or an increase of $0.9 million on a constant currency 
basis, primarily due to a shift in product sales mix, increases in sales discounts and promotion expenses, the lack of availability 
of organic hemp seed during most of  2016, and a decrease in private label sales for the first quarter of 2016 versus the comparable 
prior year period.  In the first quarter of 2015, one of Manitoba Harvest's private label customers expanded distribution into 
additional stores, resulting in a higher level of private label sales versus the current period.

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 were approximately $32.8 million compared to approximately $20.3 million
for the year ended December 31, 2015.  Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased to 44.7% for the year ended December 31, 
2016 from 50.1% for the year ended December 31, 2015,  primarily as a result of the gross margins at HOCI, which are historically 
lower since HOCI is a wholesale provider of ingredients.  After removing the effect of HOCI from gross margins, Manitoba 
Harvest's gross margin at 45.7% is down 4% compared to the prior year, primarily as a result of the lack of availability of organic 
hemp seed, which has higher gross margins, sales deduction, additional reserves recorded for slow moving inventory, and higher 
discounts and promotions expense in the current year as compared to 2015.

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2016 increased to approximately $21.3 million or 
35.9% of net sales compared to $19.4 million or 47.9% of net sales for the same period of 2015.  The $1.9 million increase in 
2016 compared to 2015 is primarily due to additional selling and administrative expenses attributable to HOCI ($2.0 million), 
increases  in  employee  related  costs  due  to  increased  headcount,  and  higher  expenses  to  support  retail  advertising,  product 
demonstrations, marketing expenditures, as well as costs associated with the integration of HOCI post-acquisition.  The 2015 costs 
include one-time buyer transaction costs incurred in July 2015 related to the acquisition of Manitoba Harvest, and December 2015 
related to the acquisition of HOCI ($1.5 million). 

Income (loss) from operations

Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2016 was approximately $0.3 million, as compared to a loss of $3.1 
million for the same period in 2015, based on the factors described above.  

Pro forma Year Ended December 31, 2015 compared to the Pro forma Year Ended December 31, 2014

Net sales

Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 were approximately $40.6 million, an increase of $5.1 million, or 14.2%, compared 
to the same period in 2014.  On a constant currency basis, net sales increased 32.0%.  The increase in net sales is a result of 
increased sell-through of existing products, new product introductions and expanded retail distribution during 2015.

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 were approximately $20.3 million compared to approximately $19.3 million 
for the year ended December 31, 2014.  Gross profit as a percentage of sales increased to 50.1%  for the year ended December 
31, 2015 from 45.7% for the year ended December 31, 2014.  The increase in gross profit as a percentage of sales is principally 

91

attributable  to  reduced  direct  labor  costs  due  to  increased  manufacturing  efficiencies,  and  reduced  material  costs  due  to  the 
insourcing of a portion of the production process which was temporarily outsourced for a part of 2014 while the company completed 
the expansion of its manufacturing facility.

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2015 increased to approximately $19.4 million or 
47.9% of net sales compared to $13.7 million or 38.6% of net sales for the same period of 2014.  The $5.7 million increase in 
2015 compared to 2014 was primarily attributable to increases in employee related costs due to increased headcount, increases in 
marketing expenditures, integration service fees payable to CGM ($0.5 million), and one-time buyer transaction costs incurred in 
July 2015 related to the acquisition of Manitoba Harvest, and December 2015 related to the acquisition of HOCI ($1.5 million). 

Loss from operations

Loss from operations for the year ended December 31, 2015 was approximately $3.1 million, as compared to a loss of $2.1 million 
for the same period in 2014, based on the factors described above.  

Niche Industrial Businesses

Advanced Circuits

Overview

Advanced Circuits is a provider of small-run, quick-turn and volume production PCBs to customers throughout the United States. 
Historically, small-run and quick-turn PCBs have represented approximately 54% of Advanced Circuits’ gross revenues. Small-
run and quick-turn PCBs typically command higher margins than volume production PCBs given that customers require high 
levels of responsiveness, technical support and timely delivery of small-run and quick-turn PCBs and are willing to pay a premium 
for them. Advanced Circuits is able to meet its customers’ demands by manufacturing custom PCBs in as little as 24 hours, while 
maintaining over 98.0% error-free production rates and real-time customer service and product tracking 24 hours per day.

We purchased a controlling interest in Advanced Circuits on May 16, 2006.

Results of Operations

The table below summarizes the statement of operations for Advanced Circuits for the fiscal years ending December 31, 2016, 
2015 and 2014.

(in thousands)

Net sales

Cost of sales

Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expenses

Management fees

Amortization of intangibles

Income from operations

Year Ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

86,041

$

87,532

$

47,997

38,044

13,579

500

1,247

48,201

39,331

13,636

500

1,051

$

22,718

$

24,144

$

85,918

46,801

39,117

13,598

500

2,564

22,455

Year Ended December 31, 2016 compared to Year Ended December 31, 2015

Net sales

Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 were approximately $86.0 million compared to approximately $87.5 million  for 
the same period in 2015, a decrease of approximately $1.5 million or 1.7%.  The decrease in net sales was due to decreased sales 
in Long-Lead Time PCBs by approximately $3.5 million, and Quick-Turn Small-Run PCBs by approximately $1.0 million. This 
was  partially  offset  by  increases  in  Quick-Turn  Production  PCBs  sales  by  approximately  $0.3  million, Assembly  sales  by 
approximately $2.0 million, Subcontract sales by approximately $0.6 million, and decreased promotion expense by approximately 
$0.1 million. On a consolidated basis, Quick-Turn Small-Run comprised approximately 21.8% of gross sales and Quick-Turn 
Production PCBs represented approximately 31.8% of gross sales for the twelve months ended December 31, 2016.  Quick-Turn 

92

Small-Run comprised approximately 22.5% of gross sales and Quick-Turn Production PCBs represented approximately 31.0% 
of gross sales for the twelve months ended December 31, 2015.  

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 decreased approximately $0.2 million compared to the comparable period in 
2015.   Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased 70 basis points during the year ended December 31, 2016 (44.2% in 2016 
compared to 44.9% in 2015) primarily as a result of sales mix.

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expenses were approximately $13.6 million in both the year ended December 31, 2016 and 
2015.  Selling, general and administrative expenses represented 15.8% of net sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 compared 
to 15.6% of net sales in 2015. 

Income from operations

Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2016 was approximately $22.7 million compared to $24.1 million in 
the same period in 2015, a decrease of approximately $1.4 million, as a result of the factors described above.

Year Ended December 31, 2015 compared to Year Ended December 31, 2014

Net sales

Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 increased approximately $1.6 million to $87.5 million as compared to the year 
ended December 31, 2014. During the year ended December 31, 2015, gross sales increased in Long-Lead Time PCBs by $1.0 
million, Assembly sales increased by $0.9 million, and Quick-Turn Production and Small-Run PCBs decreased by $0.2 million 
when compared to the same period in 2014.  Sales from Quick-Turn production and Small-Run PCBs represented approximately 
53.5% of gross sales in 2015 compared to 54.8% during 2014.

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 increased approximately $1.4 million compared to the comparable period in 
2014.   Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased 60 basis points during the year ended December 31, 2015 (44.9% in 2015 
compared to 45.5% in 2014) primarily as a result of sales mix.

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expenses were approximately $13.6 million in both the year ended December 31, 2015 and 
2014.  Selling, general and administrative expenses represented 15.6% of net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 compared 
to 15.8% of net sales in 2014. 

Income from operations

Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2015 was approximately $24.1 million compared to $22.5 million in 
the same period in 2014, an increase of approximately $1.7 million, principally as a result of the factors described above, as well 
as a decrease in amortization expense of $1.5 million as a result of certain intangible assets being fully amortized during the prior 
year.

Arnold

Overview

Founded  in  1895  and  headquartered  in  Rochester,  New York, Arnold  Magnetics  ("Arnold")  is  a  manufacturer  of  engineered, 
application specific permanent magnets. Arnold products are used in applications such as general industrial, reprographic systems, 
aerospace and defense, advertising and promotional, consumer and appliance, energy, automotive and medical technology. Arnold 
is the largest U.S. manufacturer of engineered magnets as well as only one of two domestic producers to design, engineer and 
manufacture rare earth magnetic solutions. Arnold operates a 70,000 square foot manufacturing assembly and distribution facility 
in Rochester, New York with nine additional facilities worldwide, in countries including the United Kingdom, Switzerland and 
China. Arnold serves customers via three primary product sectors:

93

• 

• 

• 

Permanent Magnet and Assemblies and Reprographics (“PMAG”) (approximately 72% of sales) – High performance 
magnets for precision motor/generator sensors as well as beam focusing applications and reprographic applications;
Flexmag  (approximately  20%  of  net  sales)  –  Flexible  bonded  magnets  for  advertising,  consumer  and  industrial 
applications; and
Precision Thin  Metals  (approximately  8%  of  net  sales)  –  Ultra  thin  metal  foil  products  utilizing  magnetic  and  non- 
magnetic alloys.

Arnold is also a 50% partner in a China rare earth mine-to-magnet joint venture. Arnold accounts for its activity in the joint venture 
utilizing  the  equity  method  of  accounting.  Gains  and  losses  from  the  joint  venture  are  not  material  during  the  years  ended 
December 31, 2016, 2015, or 2014.

On March 5, 2012, we made loans to, and purchased a controlling interest in, Arnold for a net purchase price of approximately 
$128.8 million, representing approximately 96.6% of the equity in Arnold Magnetics.

Results of Operations

The table below summarizes the results of operations for Arnold for the fiscal years ending December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014. 

(in thousands)

Net sales

Cost of sales 

Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expenses

Management fees

Amortization of intangibles

Impairment expense

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

108,179

$

119,994

$

123,205

84,475

23,704

16,602

500

3,523

16,000

93,559

26,435

14,828

500

3,523

—

95,640

27,565

16,456

500

3,514

—

7,095

(Loss) income from operations

$

(12,921) $

7,584

$

Year Ended December 31, 2016 compared to Year Ended December 31, 2015

Net sales
Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 were approximately $108.2 million, a decrease of $11.8 million compared to the 
same period in 2015.  The decrease in net sales is a result of decreases in the PMAG ($7.9 million), Precision Thin Metals ($2.4 
million) and Flexmag ($1.5 million) product sectors.  PMAG sales represented 72% of net sales for the year ended December 31, 
2016, compared to 71% for the year ended December 31, 2015.    The decrease in PMAG sales is mainly attributable to weakness 
in the oil and gas sector and lower sales of reprographic products. The decrease in Precision Thin Metals and Flexmag sales during 
the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to the same period in 2015 is largely due to decreased customer demand.  International 
sales were $42.0 million during the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to $44.2 million during the same period in 2015, a 
decrease of $2.2 million or 4.9%.  The decrease in international sales is due to a decrease in sales in the PMAG sector as noted 
above.

Cost of sales
Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 were approximately $84.5 million compared to approximately $93.6 million
in the same period of 2015.  Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased from 22.0% in 2015 to 21.9% in 2016.  The decrease 
is principally attributable to a slight decrease in the PMAG sector due to volume reductions and customer mix, partially offset by 
an increase in margin in the Precision Thin Metals sector due to customer mix.  Flexmag margin in 2016 was consistent with 2015.

Selling, general and administrative expense
Selling, general and administrative expense in the year ended December 31, 2016 was $16.6 million as compared to approximately 
$14.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2015.  The increase in expense is primarily attributable to severance related to 
changes within management and a one-time expense related to the Swiss pension.

94

Impairment expense

The Company performed interim goodwill impairment testing on the three reporting units of Arnold as of December 31, 2016.  
The results of the impairment test (step 1) indicated that the goodwill associated with the PMAG reporting unit was impaired.  
The Company developed an estimated range of the potential goodwill impairment at PMAG of between $14 million and $19 
million, and has recorded impairment expense of $16 million at December 31, 2016.  The result of the step 2 analysis is expected 
to be recorded in the first quarter of 2017.

(Loss) income from operations

Arnold had a loss from operations for the year ended December 31, 2016 of approximately $12.9 million, as compared to income 
from operations of $7.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2015.  This decrease of $20.5 million  is primarily the result of 
the impairment expense as well as the overall decrease in net sales, as described above.

Year Ended December 31, 2015 compared to Year Ended December 31, 2014

Net sales

Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 were approximately $120.0 million, a decrease of $3.2 million compared to the 
same period in 2014.  The decrease in net sales is a result of a decrease in sales in the PMAG product sector ($5.9 million) and 
Flexible product sector ($0.3 million), offset by an increase in net sales in the Precision Thin Metals sector ($3.0 million).   PMAG 
sales represented approximately 71% of net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 compared to 75% for the year ended 
December 31, 2014.  The decrease in PMAG sales during 2015 compared to 2014 is principally attributable to lower sales of the 
reprographic application of the PMAG division, as well as weaker economic conditions in Europe, primarily in the oil and gas 
sector, which is a component of PMAG.  The decrease in Flexmag sales is the result of decreased customer demand.  The increase 
in Precision Thin Metals sales is attributable to positive steps taken over the last year by management to identify new customers 
and applications.

International sales were $44.2 million during the year ended December 31, 2015 compared to $55.6 million during the same period 
in 2014, a decrease of $11.4 million or 20.5%.  The decrease in international sales is due to a decrease in sales in the PMAG sector 
as noted above.

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 were approximately $93.6 million compared to approximately $95.6 million 
in the same period of 2014.  Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased from 22.4% in 2014 to 22.0% in 2015.  The decrease 
is principally attributable to a slight decrease in the PMAG sector due to volume reductions and customer mix, partially offset by 
a slight increase in margin in the Precision Thin Metals sector due to volume.  Flexmag margin in 2015 was consistent with 2014 
due to successful cost saving initiatives.

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expense in the year ended December 31, 2015 was $14.8 million as compared to approximately 
$16.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2014.  The decrease in expense is primarily attributable to headcount reduction in 
Switzerland and China, and overall reduced spending.

Income from operations

Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2015 was approximately $7.6 million, an increase of $0.5 million when 
compared to the same period in 2014, principally as a result of the factors described above.

Clean Earth

Overview

Founded in 1990 and headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania, Clean Earth is a provider of environmental services for a variety 
of contaminated materials. Clean Earth provides a one-stop shop solution that analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste 
streams  generated  in  multiple  end-markets  such  as  power,  construction,  commercial  development,  oil  and  gas,  medical, 
infrastructure, industrial and dredging.  Historically, the majority of Clean Earth’s revenues have been generated by contaminated 
soils, which includes environmentally impacted soils, drill cuttings and other materials which are treated at one of its nine permitted 
soil treatment facilities. Clean Earth also operates four RCRA Part B hazardous waste facilities.  The remaining revenue has been 
generated by dredge material,  which consists of sediment removed from the floor of a body of water for navigational purposes 
95

and/or environmental remediation of contaminated waterways and is treated at one of its two permitted dredge processing facilities. 
Approximately 98% of the material processed by Clean Earth is beneficially reused for such purposes as daily landfill cover, 
industrial and brownfield redevelopment projects.

On August 26, 2014, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Clean Earth for approximately $251.4 million, 
representing approximately 98% of the equity in Clean Earth.  Clean Earth completed an add-on acquisition in December 2014, 
AES Environmental Services, and two add-on acquisitions during the second quarter of 2016, Phoenix Soil and EWS.  The results 
of operations for the add-on acquisitions have been included in Clean Earth's results from the date of acquisition through the end 
of the reporting period.  

Results of Operations

The table below summarizes the results of operations for Clean Earth for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the 
pro forma results of operations for Clean Earth for the full fiscal year ended December 31, 2014.  We acquired Clean Earth on 
August 26, 2014.  The following results of operations are reported as if we acquired Clean Earth on January 1, 2014. 

(in thousands)

Net service revenues

Cost of services (a)

      Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expenses (b)

Management fees (c)

Amortization of intangibles (d)

Loss on disposal of assets

     Income from operations

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

(Pro forma)

$

188,997

$

175,386

$

134,667

125,178

54,330

30,018

500

12,578

3,305

50,208

26,512

500

12,183

—

164,536

112,636

51,900

27,034

500

11,524

—

$

7,929

$

11,013

$

12,842

Pro forma results of operations for Clean Earth for the annual period ended December 31, 2014 includes the following pro forma 
adjustments applied to historical results:

(a)  Cost of services decreased $1.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2014 for a reduction in depreciation expense associated with the 
extension of the estimated useful lives of the property, plant and equipment resulting from the purchase price allocation in connection with our 
acquisition.

(b)  Selling, general and administrative costs were reduced by approximately $13.7 million in the year ended December 31, 2014 representing 
an adjustment for one-time seller’s transaction costs incurred as a result of our purchase, offset by approximately $1.0 million in additional 
expense related to stock options issued to management.  

(c)  Represents management fees that would have been payable to the Manager.

(d)  Represents an increase in amortization of intangible assets totaling $5.6 million in the year ended December 31, 2014 for additional amortization 
expense associated with the fair value step up of intangible assets resulting from the purchase price allocation in connection with our acquisition.

Year Ended December 31, 2016 compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2015

Service revenues
Service revenues for the year ended December 31, 2016 were approximately $189.0 million, an increase of $13.6 million or 7.8% 
compared to the same period in 2015.  The increase in service revenues is principally due to two acquisitions in 2016.  For the 
year ended December 31, 2016, contaminated soil volumes increased 4% as compared to the same period last year principally 
attributable to commercial development activity in the New York City area, and its acquisition of Phoenix Soil in April 2016. 
Revenue from dredged material decreased during 2016 as compared to 2015 due to the timing and flow of new maintenance 
contracts in our core markets.  Contaminated soils represented approximately 55% and 58%, respectively, of net sales for  the 
years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015.

96

Cost of services

Cost of services for the year ended December 31, 2016 were approximately $134.7 million compared to approximately $125.2 
million in the same period of 2015, an increase of $9.5 million, primarily as a result of the two acquisitions made in 2016.   Gross 
profit as a percentage of sales increased from 28.6% for the year ended December 31, 2015 to 28.7% for the year ended December 
31, 2016. 

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2016 increased to approximately $30.0 million or 
15.9% of service revenues compared to $26.5 million or 15.1% of service revenues for the same period in 2015.  The $3.5 million
increase in selling, general and administrative expenses in the year ended December 31, 2016 compared to 2015 is primarily 
attributable to Clean Earth's recent acquisitions.  

Amortization expense
Amortization expense for the year ended December 31, 2016 was $12.6 million, an increase of $0.4 million compared to 2015.  
The increase is due to additional amortization expense in 2016 from the amortization of airspace, which is recognized based on 
usage rather than over the estimated useful life of the asset.  

Loss on disposal of assets

Clean Earth recognized a loss on disposal of assets of $3.3 million during the fourth quarter of 2016 related to the closure of the 
Company’s Williamsport, Pennsylvania site which processed drill cuttings.  The loss was comprised of intangible assets specific 
to the Williamsport location, as well as equipment that could not be repurposed to other sites at the time of the closing of the 
facility.  

Income from operations

Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2016 was approximately $7.9 million as compared to income from 
operations of $11.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2015, a decrease of $3.1 million, primarily as a result of the loss on 
disposal of assets related to the closure of Clean Earth's Williamsport site.  

Year Ended December 31, 2015 compared to the Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2014

Service revenues

Service revenues for the year ended December 31, 2015 were approximately $175.4 million, an increase of $10.9 million or 6.6% 
compared to the same period in 2014.  The increase in service revenues is principally the result of the Clean Earth’s December 
2014 acquisition of all of the assets of American Environmental Services, Inc. ("AES") which operates two RCRA Part B hazardous 
waste facilities.   For the year ended December 31, 2015, contaminated soil volumes increased 2% as compared to the same period 
last year principally attributable to commercial development activity in the New York City and Greater Washington, D. C. areas.  
Hazardous waste volume increased 46%, primarily as a result of the AES acquisition.   Revenue from dredged material decreased 
during 2015 as compared to 2014 due to the timing and flow of new maintenance contracts in our core markets.  Contaminated 
soils represented approximately 58% of net sales for each of the years ended December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014.   

Cost of services

Cost of services for the year ended December 31, 2015 were approximately $125.2 million compared to approximately $112.6 
million in the same period of 2014.   Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased from 31.5% for the year ended December 31, 
2014 to 28.6% for the year ended December 31, 2015.  The 290 basis points decrease in gross margin during the year ended 
December 31, 2015 was primarily due to the mix of services provided during 2015 as compared to 2014, as well as decreased 
margins from contaminated soils due to increased equipment rental expense and increased beneficial reuse costs at some of the 
contaminated soil facilities.

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2015 decreased to approximately $26.5 million or 
15.1% of service revenues compared to $27.0 million or 16.4% of service revenues for the same period in 2014.  The $0.5 million 
decrease in selling, general and administrative expenses in the year ended December 31, 2015 compared to 2014 is primarily 
attributable to costs associated with the acquisition of Clean Earth in 2014, partially offset by reductions in professional fees, 
employee compensation and bad debt expenses.  

97

Amortization expense
Amortization expense for the year ended December 31, 2015 was $12.2 million, an increase of $0.7 million compared to 2014.  
The increase is due to additional amortization expense in 2015 from the AES acquisition ($0.6 million) and an increase in the 
amortization of airspace, which is recognized based on usage rather than over the estimated useful life of the asset.  

Income from operations

Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2015 was approximately $11.0 million as compared to income from 
operations of $12.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, a decrease of $1.8 million, primarily as a result of those factors 
described above.

Sterno Products

Overview

Sterno Products, headquartered in Corona, California, is a manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming fuel and creative 
table lighting solutions for the food service industry.  Sterno Products offers a broad range of wick and gel chafing fuels, butane 
stoves and accessories, liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and lamps.  Sterno Products was formed in 2012 
with the merger of two manufacturers and marketers of portable food warming fuel products, The Sterno Products Group LLC 
and the Candle Lamp Company, LLC.  

On October 10, 2014, we made loans to and purchased all of the equity of Sterno Products for approximately $160.0 million.  On 
January 22, 2016, Sterno Products acquired Northern International, Inc. ("NII"), which  sells flameless candles and outdoor lighting 
products through the retail segment. 

Results of Operations 

The table below summarizes the results of operations for Sterno Products for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, 
and the pro forma results of operations for Sterno Products for the full fiscal year ended December 31, 2014.  We acquired 
Sterno Products on October 10, 2014.  The following results of operations are reported as if we acquired Sterno Products on 
January 1, 2014. 

(in thousands)

Net sales

Cost of sales (a)

      Gross profit

Selling, general and administrative expenses (b)

Management fee (c)

Amortization of intangibles (d)

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

(Pro forma)

$

218,817

$

139,991

$

158,722

104,372

60,095

34,362

500

6,434

35,619

16,596

500

5,323

140,858

111,344

29,514

17,150

500

6,014

5,850

      Income (loss) from operations

$

18,799

$

13,200

$

Pro forma results of operations for Sterno Products for the annual period ended December 31, 2014 include the following pro 
forma adjustments applied to historical results:

(a)  The purchase price allocation for Sterno included an inventory step up of $2.0 million, which was recognized to cost of sales during the 
estimated turns of Sterno's inventory in 2014 and 2015.

(b)  Selling, general and administrative costs were reduced by approximately $10.8 million in the year ended December 31, 2014 representing 
an adjustment for one-time seller’s transaction costs incurred as a result of our purchase. 

(c)  Represents management fees that would have been payable to the Manager.

(d)  Represents an increase in amortization of intangible assets totaling $2.3 million in the year ended December 31, 2014 for additional amortization 
expense associated the fair value step up of intangible assets resulting from the purchase price allocation in connection with our acquisition.

98

Net sales

Year Ended December 31, 2016 compared to the Year ended December 31, 2015

Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 were approximately $218.8 million, an increase of $78.8 million or 56.3% 
compared to the same period in 2015.  The increase in net sales is a result of the acquisition of NII in January 2016 ($74.6 million 
in net sales), offset by the timing of stocking programs of key Sterno customers.  

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2016 were approximately $158.7 million compared to approximately $104.4 million 
in the same period of 2015.  The increase in cost of sales was primarily due to the acquisition of NII.  Gross profit as a percentage 
of sales increased from 25.4% for the year ended December 31, 2015 to 27.5% for the same period ended December 31, 2016.  
The increase in gross margin during the year ended December 31, 2016 primarily reflects a favorable margin mix with the acquisition 
of NII, manufacturing efficiencies resulting from investment in automation and favorable trends in global commodity prices.  

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015 was approximately $34.4 million
and $16.6 million, respectively.  Selling, general and administrative expense represented 15.7% of net sales for the year ended 
December 31, 2016 as compared to 11.9% of net sales for the same period in 2015.  The increase in selling, general and administrative 
expenses during the year ended December 31, 2016 reflects the acquisition of NII, which has historically had a higher selling, 
general and administrative expense as a percentage of revenue, as well as an increase in staffing to strengthen sales and marketing, 
and increased professional service costs associated with the acquisition of NII. 

Income from operations

Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2016 was approximately $18.8 million, an increase of $5.6 million when 
compared to the same period in 2015, due to those factors described above.

Year Ended December 31, 2015 compared to the Pro Forma Year ended December 31, 2014

Net sales

Net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 were approximately $140.0 million, a decrease of $0.9 million or 0.6% compared 
to the same period in 2014.  The decrease in net sales is primarily a result of the timing of orders from two of Sterno Products' 
larger customers. 

Cost of sales

Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 were approximately $104.4 million compared to approximately $111.3 million 
in the same period of 2014.  Gross profit as a percentage of sales increased from 21.0% for the year ended December 31, 2014 to 
25.4% for the same period ended December 31, 2015.  The increase in gross margin during the year ended December 31, 2015 
primarily reflects greater labor and manufacturing efficiencies during 2015 as compared to the 2014 as Sterno Products continued 
to integrate the acquisition of Sterno by CandleLamp during 2014, and favorable material costs reflecting lower commodity prices 
and material savings programs.

Selling, general and administrative expense

Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2015 and 2014 was approximately $16.6 million 
and $17.2 million, respectively.  The decrease is primarily a result of acquisition related costs in the prior year of $2.8 million, 
offset in part by integration services fees incurred during the first nine months of  2015.  Selling, general and administrative expense 
represented 11.9% of net sales for the year ended December 31, 2015 as compared to 12.2% of net sales for the same period in 
2014.  

Income from operations
Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2015 was approximately $13.2 million, an increase of $7.4 million when 
compared to the same period in 2014, due to those factors described above, as well as a decrease in amortization expense as a 
result of the finalization of the purchase price allocation for Sterno Products in the three months ended March 31, 2015.

99

Liquidity and Capital Resources

The change in cash and cash equivalents is as follows:

(in thousands)

Cash provided by operations

Cash (used in) provided by investing activities

Cash provided by (used in) financing activities

Effect of exchange rates on cash and cash equivalents

(Decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

$

111,372

$

84,548

$

(363,021)

208,726

(3,174)

233,880

(254,357)

(1,905)

(46,097) $

62,166

$

70,695

(424,753)

265,487

(955)

(89,526)

Cash Flow from Operating Activities

2016
For  the  year  ended  December  31,  2016,  cash  flows  provided  by  operating  activities  (from  both  continuing  and  discontinued 
operations) totaled approximately $111.4 million, which represents a $26.8 million increase compared to cash flow from operating 
activities of $84.5 million during the year ended December 31, 2015.  Net cash provided by discontinued operations totaled $3.7 
million in 2016 as compared to $15.5 million in 2015, with the decrease due to the number of dispositions reflected in each year 
as well as the timing of the dispositions.  The increase in net cash provided by operating activities of continuing operations of  
$38.7 million, which is principally the result of higher net income in 2016 and changes in cash provided by working capital in the 
year ended December 31, 2016 as compared to the same period in 2015 (an increase of $13.2 million), as a result of the acquisitions 
completed during 2016. 

2015

For the year ended December 31, 2015, on a consolidated basis, cash flows provided by operating activities (from both continuing 
and discontinued operations) totaled $84.5 million, which represents a $13.9 million increase compared to the year-ended December 
31, 2014.  Cash from operating activities of continuing operations was $69.0 million in 2015 compared to $36.2 million in 2014.  
Cash from operating activities of discontinued operations was $15.5 million in 2015 compared to $34.4 million in 2014.  The 
increase in cash from operating activity of continuing activities is principally the result of changes in working capital primarily 
resulting from our 2014 acquisitions of Clean Earth and Sterno Products in the third and fourth quarter of 2014, respectively, and 
the acquisition of Manitoba Harvest in July 2015, and the increased operating income year over year as a result of these acquisitions.  

2014

For the year ended December 31, 2014, on a consolidated basis, cash flows provided by operating activities totaled $70.7 million, 
which represents a $1.7 million decrease compared to the year ended December 31, 2013.  Cash from operating activities of 
continuing operations was $36.2 million in 2014 compared to $35.5 million in 2013.   Cash from operating activities of discontinued 
operations was $34.4million in 2014 compared to $33.2 million in 2013.  The decrease in cash from operating activity of continuing 
activities  is  principally  the  result  of  changes  in  working  capital  primarily  resulting  from  our  2014  acquisitions  from  date  of 
acquisition through year-end, as well as the effect on working capital of the deconsolidation of our FOX business in July 2014.

Cash Flow from Investing Activities

2016

Cash flows used in investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2016 totaled approximately $363.0 million, compared to 
$233.9 million provided by investing activities in the same period of 2015.  The 2016 investing activities primarily reflect the 
acquisition of 5.11 in the third quarter and the add-on acquisition of NII, Baby Tula, Phoenix Soil and EWS ($536.2 million) and 
net proceeds from the sale of Tridien in September 2016 ($11.2 million in net proceeds). Capital expenditures from continuing 
operations in the year ended December 31, 2016 increased approximately $8.3 million, from $15.7 million in 2015 to $24.0 million
in 2016.  The increase in capital expenditures is attributable to our acquisition of 5.11 in August 2016, and additional investment 
in Sterno, Advanced Circuits and Liberty during 2016 compared to the prior year.  We expect capital expenditures for fiscal 2017 
to be approximately $35 million to $45 million.  The 2016 investing activities also reflect proceeds from the sale of FOX shares 
during the year of $182.5 million.

100

2015

Cash flows provided by investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2015 was $233.9 million compared to $424.8 million
used in investing activities in the same period of 2014.  The 2015 investing activities reflect the acquisition of Manitoba Harvest 
in the third quarter and the add-on acquisition of HOCI in the fourth quarter of 2015 ($130.3 million) and net proceeds from the 
sale of CamelBak in August 2015 and American Furniture in October 2015 ($385.5 million in the aggregate).  Capital expenditures 
from continuing operations in the year ended December 31, 2015 increased approximately $5.7 million, from $10.0 million in 
2014 to $15.7 million in 2015, with the increase primarily due to capital expenditures at our 2014 acquisitions, Clean Earth and 
Sterno Products. 

2014

Cash flows used in investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2014 was $424.8 million.  This amount reflects the 
Company's  purchase of our 2014 Acquisitions, Clean Earth ($250.4 million) and Sterno Products ($165.3 million), as well as an 
add-on acquisition at Clean Earth ($15.9 million) and an acquisition by FOX prior to deconsolidation ($41.0 million), cash used 
for the purchase of capital expenditures ($10.0 million) and fixed cash payments on our interest rate swap ($2.0 million), offset 
in part by proceeds from the sale of FOX common stock ($65.5 million). 

Cash Flow from Financing Activities

2016

Cash flows provided by financing activities totaled approximately $208.7 million during the year ended December 31, 2016 
principally reflecting the following:

•  The payments of our shareholder distributions of $78.2 million in the year ended December 31, 2016 and 2015; 
•  Distributions  of  $23.6  million  paid  during  2016  to  noncontrolling  shareholders  as  a  result  of  the  Liberty  and ACI 

recapitalizations;

•  Net borrowings during the year ended December 31, 2016 under our 2014 Credit Facility totaled $248.1 million, including 
borrowings under our 2016 Incremental Term Loan, which was used to fund the acquisitions of 5.11 during the third 
quarter, EWS and Baby Tula during the second quarter, and the repurchase of Ergobaby common stock from noncontrolling 
shareholders during the third quarter;

•  Distributions of $23.8 million to the Holders of the allocation interest related to Sale Events (March and August Offerings 

of FOX, and September Disposition of Tridien) and a Holding Event (ACI); and
Issuance of Trust common shares for net proceeds of $99.4 million.

• 

2015

Cash flows used in financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2015 was $254.4 million, principally reflecting:

• 
• 
• 

payment of our shareholder distribution ($78.2 million);
the payment of profit allocation to our Allocation Interest Holders of $17.7 million; and
the repayment of our 2014 Revolving Credit Facility using the net proceeds from the sale of CamelBak in the third quarter 
of 2015. 

2014
Cash flows provided by financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2014 was $265.5 million, principally reflecting:

• 

• 
• 
• 

net borrowings under our 2011 and 2014 Credit Facilities ($206.3 million) which was used to fund our 2014 acquisitions 
and net borrowings under the FOX credit facility prior to deconsolidation ($37.1 million); 
proceeds from a secondary offering that we completed during the fourth quarter of 2014 ($99.9 million);
stock option proceeds received from minority shareholders ($4.0 million); and
excess tax benefit at FOX ($1.7 million) offset in part by  the payment of quarterly distributions to our shareholders 
($69.6 million) and a profit allocation payment to our Allocation Interest Holders ($11.9 million).

At December 31, 2016, we had approximately $39.8 million of cash and cash equivalents on hand. The majority of the cash held 
at corporate is invested in short-term securities and corporate debt securities and is maintained in accordance with the Company’s 
investment policy, which identifies allowable investments and specifies credit quality standards. The primary objective of our 
investment activities is the preservation of principal and minimizing risk. We do not hold any investments for trading purposes.

101

On January 26, 2017, we paid our fourth quarter 2016 distribution to our shareholders of $21.6 million.   

Total Liabilities and Intercompany loans to our businesses

The following table summarizes the total liabilities and intercompany debt of our business as of December 31, 2016:

(in thousands)

5.11

Ergobaby

Liberty

Manitoba Harvest

Advanced Circuits

Arnold

Clean Earth

Sterno Products

  Total

Corporate and eliminations

Intercompany
Loans

Total Liabilities

$

174,661

$

83,925

51,200

46,157

104,855

68,315

169,683

84,678

229,403

108,680

63,796

73,227

129,598

93,433

249,139

128,927

$

$

783,474

$

1,076,203

(783,474)

— $

(193,592)

882,611

Each loan has a scheduled maturity and each business is entitled to repay all or a portion of the principal amount of the outstanding 
loans,  without  penalty,  prior  to  maturity.   A  component  of  our  acquisition  financing  strategy  that  we  utilize  in  acquiring  the 
businesses we own and manage is to provide both equity capital and debt capital, raised at the parent level through our existing 
credit facility.  Our strategy of providing intercompany debt financing within the capital structure of the businesses that we acquire 
and manage allows us the ability to distribute cash to the parent company through monthly interest payments and amortization of 
the principle on these intercompany loans.  Each loan to our businesses has a scheduled maturity and each business is entitled to 
repay all or a portion of the principal amount of the outstanding loans, without penalty, prior to maturity.  Certain of our businesses 
have paid down their respective intercompany debt balances through the cash flow generated by these businesses and we have 
recapitalized, and expect to continue to recapitalize, these businesses in the normal course of our business.  The recapitalization 
process involves funding the intercompany debt using either cash on hand at the parent or our revolving credit facility, and serves 
the purpose of optimizing the capital structure at our subsidiaries and providing the noncontrolling shareholders with a distribution 
on their ownership interest in a cash flow positive business.  

During the second quarter of 2016, we completed a recapitalization at Advanced Circuits whereby the Company entered into an 
amendment to the intercompany loan agreement with Advanced Circuits (the "ACI Loan Agreement").  The ACI loan agreement 
was amended to provide for additional term loan borrowings of $60.1 million and to extend the maturity date for the term loans.   
The ACI noncontrolling shareholders received approximately $18.6 million in distributions as a result of the recapitalization.  

During  the  first  quarter  of  2016,  we  completed  a  recapitalization  at  Liberty  whereby  we  entered  into  an  amendment  to  the 
intercompany loan agreement with Liberty (the “Liberty Loan Agreement”). The Liberty Loan Agreement was amended to (i) 
provide for term loan borrowings of $38.0 million and revolving credit facility borrowings of $5.0 million to fund cash distributions 
totaling $35.3 million to its shareholders, including the Company, and (ii) extend the maturity dates of the term loans and revolving 
credit  facility.    Liberty’s  noncontrolling  shareholders  received  approximately  $5.3  million  in  distributions  as  a  result  of  the 
recapitalization.      Certain members of Liberty's management also exercised stock option immediately prior to the recapitalization, 
resulting in net proceeds from stock options at Liberty of $3.8 million.  The Company then purchased $1.5 million in shares from 
members of Liberty management, resulting in Liberty's noncontrolling shareholders holding 11.4% of Liberty's outstanding shares 
subsequent to the recapitalization.  

As of June 30, 2016, Manitoba Harvest was in default of certain financial covenants under the intercompany loan agreement with 
the Company.  The Company waived the default by amending its intercompany loan agreement with Manitoba Harvest.  The 
amendment includes certain provisions that provide relief of Manitoba Harvest’s financial covenants through June 30, 2017.  All 
of our businesses except as noted above are in compliance with their financial covenants with us at December 31, 2016.  

102

Our primary source of cash is from the receipt of interest and principal on our outstanding loans to our businesses. Accordingly, 
we are dependent upon the earnings and cash flow of these businesses, which are available for (i) operating expenses; (ii) payment 
of principal and interest under our Credit Facility; (iii) payments to CGM due or potentially due pursuant to the revised MSA and 
the LLC Agreement; (iv) cash distributions to our shareholders; and (v) investments in future acquisitions. Payments made under 
(i) through (iii) above are required to be paid before distributions to shareholders and may be significant and exceed the funds 
held by us, which may require us to dispose of assets or incur debt to fund such expenditures.

Credit Facility

On June 6, 2014 we entered in a new credit facility, the 2014 Credit Facility, which replaced our then existing 2011 Credit Facility 
entered  into  in  October  2011.    On August  31,  2016,  we  entered  into  an  Incremental  Facility Amendment  to  the  2014  Credit 
Agreement.  The Incremental Facility Amendment provided an increase to the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility of $150.0 million, 
and the 2016 Incremental Term Loan in the amount of $250.0 million.  The 2014 Credit Facility now provides for (i) revolving 
loans, swing line loans and letters of credit up to a maximum aggregate amount of $550 million and matures in June 2019,  (ii) a 
$325 million term loan, and (iii) a $250 million incremental term loan.  Our 2014 Term Loan requires quarterly payments with a 
final payment of the outstanding principal balance due in June 2021.  (Refer to Note J - Debt in the consolidated financial statements 
for a complete description of our 2014 Credit Facility.)   

In connection with the 2016 Incremental Facility Amendment, we incurred $5.9 million in additional debt issuance costs which 
will be recognized as expense during the remaining term of the related 2014 Revolving Credit Facility and 2014 Term Loan and 
the 2016 Incremental Term Loan.  The Incremental Facility Amendment did not change the due dates or applicable interest rates 
of the 2014 Credit Agreement.  The quarterly payments for the term loan advances under the 2014 Credit Facility increased to 
approximately $1.4 million per quarter.  We used the proceeds from the Incremental Facility Amendment to fund the acquisition 
of 5.11 Tactical. 

The 2014 Credit Facility was also amended in June 2015, primarily to allow for intercompany loans to, and the acquisition of, 
Canadian-based companies on an unsecured basis, and to modify provisions that would allow for early termination of a "Leverage 
Increase Period," thereby providing additional flexibility as to the timing of subsequent acquisitions.

At December 31, 2016, we had Letters of Credit totaling $4.2 million outstanding under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility.  We 
had approximately $541.2 million in borrowing base availability under this facility at December 31, 2016. 

The  following  table  reflects  required  and  actual  financial  ratios  as  of  December 31,  2016  included  as  part  of  the  affirmative 
covenants in our 2014 Credit Facility:

Description of Required Covenant Ratio
Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio

Total Debt to EBITDA Ratio

Covenant Ratio Requirement

greater than or equal to 1.5:1.0

less than or equal to 4.25:1.0

Actual Ratio

4.24:1.00

2.88:1.00

We intend to use the availability under our Credit Facility and cash on hand to pursue acquisitions of additional businesses, to 
fund distributions and to provide for other working capital needs. We have considered the impact of recent market instability and 
credit availability in assessing the adequacy of our liquidity and capital resources.

On September 12, 2014, we purchased an interest rate swap (“New Swap”) with a notional amount of $220 million effective April 
1, 2016 through June 6, 2021.  The agreement requires us to pay interest on the notional amount at the rate of 2.97% in exchange 
for the three-month LIBOR rate.  At December 31, 2016, the New Swap had a fair value loss of  $10.7 million, principally reflecting 
the present value of future payments and receipts under the agreement.  $4.0 million of New Swap is reflected as a component of  
current liabilities and $6.7 million is reflected as a component of noncurrent liabilities in the consolidated balance sheet  at December 
31, 2016. 

Investment in FOX 

FOX is a designer, manufacturer and marketer of high performance suspension products used primarily on mountain bikes, off-
road vehicles and trucks, snowmobiles and motorcycles.  We purchased a controlling interest in FOX on January 4, 2008 for 
approximately $80.4 million.  In August 2013, FOX completed an initial public offering of its common stock.  FOX trades on the 
NASDAQ stock market under the ticker “FOXF”.  We retained approximately 53% of the outstanding shares of FOX immediately 
subsequent to their initial public offering.  After our sale of FOX common shares through an additional secondary offerings of 
FOX  in  July  2014,  our  ownership  interest  in  FOX  decreased  to  41%. As  a  result  of  the  decrease  in  ownership  interest,  we 
deconsolidated FOX and we began accounting for the investment in FOX at fair value using the equity method of accounting, 

103

with unrealized investment gains and losses reported in the consolidated statement of operations as gain (loss) from equity method 
investment.  We sold additional common shares of FOX through FOX secondary offerings in March, August and November 2016.  
Subsequent to the November 2016 secondary offering, our ownership in FOX decreased to approximately 14%, and we no longer 
account for the investment in FOX as an equity method investment.  We recorded an unrealized gain on the equity method investment 
of $74.5 million for the the year ended December 31, 2016.  We account for our remaining 14% equity interest in FOX using the 
fair value method and gains or losses resulting from changes in the fair value of the FOX investment are recorded in our consolidated 
statement of operations.  We continue to evaluate opportunities to divest the remainder of our FOX shares.  The investment in 
FOX had a fair value of $141.8 million at December 31, 2016.  

We believe that we currently have sufficient liquidity and capital resources, which include amounts available under our 2014 
Revolving Credit Facility, to meet our existing obligations, including quarterly distributions to our shareholders, as approved by 
our board of directors, over the next twelve months.

Interest Expense

We incurred interest expense totaling $24.7 million in the year ended December 31, 2016, as compared to $25.9 million in the 
year ended December 31, 2015 and $27.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2014. The components of interest expense in 
each of the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 are as follows (in thousands):

Interest on credit facilities

Unused fee on Revolving Credit Facility

Amortization of original issue discount
Unrealized losses on interest rate derivatives (1)

Letter of credit fees

Other

Interest expense

Average daily balance of debt outstanding

Effective interest rate

Years ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

19,861

$

17,590

$

16,392

1,947

802

1,539

108

415

1,612

671

5,662

121

286

1,914

882

7,709

62

138

$

$

24,672

477,656

$

$

25,942

443,348

$

$

27,097

379,034

5.2%

5.9%

7.2%

(1) On September 14, 2014, we purchased an interest rate swap (the “New Swap”) with a notional amount of $220 million effective 
April 1, 2016 through June 6, 2021.  The agreement requires us to pay interest on the notional amount at the rate of 2.97% in 
exchange for the three-month LIBOR rate.  At December 31, 2016 and 2015, this New Swap had a fair value of negative $10.7 
million and $13.0 million, respectively, essentially reflecting the present value of future payments and receipts under the agreement 
and is reflected as a component of interest expense and other non-current liabilities.  In the above table, we provide the effective 
interest rate on outstanding debt, which includes the mark-to-market loss on the New Swap. Refer to Note K - Derivatives and 
Hedging Activities of the consolidated financial statements.

Income Taxes

We incurred income tax expense of $9.5 million with an annual effective rate of 15.0% during the year ended December 31, 2016, 
$15.0 million in income tax expense with an annual effective tax rate of 62.5% during the year ended December 31, 2015, and 
$5.0 million with an effective tax rate of 1.8% during the year ended December 31, 2014.  Our gains and losses incurred at the 
Company, which is an LLC, are not tax deductible at the corporate level as those costs are passed through to the shareholders. 
During 2015, the effective rate is therefore increased as a result of the gain on sale of businesses.  During 2014, the effect of the 
gain on the deconsolidation of FOX incurred at the corporate level decreased the effective income tax rate by 30.8 %. 

The components of income tax expense as a percentage of income from continuing operations before income taxes for the years 
ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 are as follows:

104

United States Federal Statutory Rate

State income taxes (net of Federal benefits)

Foreign income taxes

Expenses of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC
representing a pass through to shareholders (1)
Effect of deconsolidation of subsidiary (2)

Effect of gain on investment in FOX

Impact of subsidiary employee stock options

Domestic production activities deduction

Non-deductible acquisition costs
Effect of undistributed foreign earnings (3)

Non-recognition of NOL carryforwards at subsidiaries

Other

Effective income tax rate

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

35.0%

35.0%

0.6

1.5

3.6

—

(41.2)

1.3

(0.9)

1.9

4.2

3.6

5.4

15.0%

6.5

1.2

29.1

—

(6.6)

1.3

(3.2)

—

—

(6.1)

5.3

62.5%

35.0%

(1.0)

(0.3)

2.3

(33.6)

(1.4)

—

(0.3)

0.1

—

0.5

0.5

1.8%

(1)  The effective income tax rate for each of the years presented includes losses at the Company’s parent, which is taxed as a partnership.
(2)  The effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2014 includes a significant gain at the Company's parent related to the 

deconsolidation of FOX in July 2014.

(3)  During the quarter ended September 30, 2016, management changed the previously asserted position that Arnold planned to permanently 
reinvest foreign earnings of controlled foreign corporations.  The principal reason for changing our position is management's plan to repatriate 
excess foreign cash at Arnold to pay down intercompany debt at the Company.   

Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures

From time to time we may publicly disclose certain “non-GAAP” financial measures in the course of our investor presentations, 
earnings releases, earnings conference calls or other venues. A non-GAAP financial measure is a numerical measure of historical 
or future performance, financial position or cash flow that excludes amounts, or is subject to adjustments that effectively exclude 
amounts, included in the most directly comparable measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP in our financial 
statements, and vice versa for measures that include amounts, or are subject to adjustments that effectively include amounts, that 
are excluded from the most directly comparable measure as calculated and presented. GAAP refers to generally accepted accounting 
principles in the United States.

Non-GAAP financial measures are provided as additional information to investors in order to provide them with an alternative 
method for assessing our financial condition and operating results. These measures are not meant to be a substitute for GAAP, 
and may be different from or otherwise inconsistent with non-GAAP financial measures used by other companies.

The tables below reconcile the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures to EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Cash 
Flow Available for Distribution and Reinvestment (“CAD”).

Reconciliation of Net income (loss) to EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA

EBITDA – Earnings before Interest, Income Taxes, Depreciation and Amortization (“EBITDA”) is calculated as net income (loss) 
before interest expense, income tax expense (benefit), depreciation expense and amortization expense. Amortization expenses 
consist of amortization of intangibles and debt charges, including debt issuance costs, discounts, etc.

Adjusted EBITDA – Is calculated utilizing the same calculation as described above in arriving at EBITDA further adjusted by: 
(i) non-controlling  stockholder  compensation,  which  generally  consists  of  non-cash  stock  option  expense;  (ii) successful 
acquisition  costs,  which  consist  of  transaction  costs  (legal,  accounting  ,  due  diligences,  etc.)  incurred  in  connection  with  the 
successful acquisition of a business expensed during the period in compliance with ASC 805; (iii) management fees, which reflect 
fees due quarterly to our Manager in connection with our MSA; (iv) impairment charges, which reflect write downs to goodwill 
or other intangible assets; (v) the gain related to the deconsolidation of FOX during the year ended December 31, 2014; (vi) gains 
or losses recorded in connection with changes in the fair value of our investment in FOX; (viii) gains or losses recorded in connection 
with the sale of fixed assets; and (vii) gains or losses recognized upon the sale of a business.

105

We believe that EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA provide useful information to investors and reflect important financial measures 
as they exclude the effects of items which reflect the impact of long-term investment decisions, rather than the performance of 
near term operations. When compared to net income (loss) these financial measures are limited in that they do not reflect the 
periodic costs of certain capital assets used in generating revenues of our businesses or the non-cash charges associated with 
impairments. This presentation also allows investors to view the performance of our businesses in a manner similar to the methods 
used by us and the management of our businesses, provides additional insight into our operating results and provides a measure 
for evaluating targeted businesses for acquisition.

We believe these measurements are also useful in measuring our ability to service debt and other payment obligations. EBITDA
and Adjusted EBITDA are not meant to be a substitute for GAAP, and may be different from or otherwise inconsistent with non-
GAAP financial measures used by other companies.

The following tables reconcile EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA to net income (loss), which we consider to be the most comparable 
GAAP financial measure (in thousands):

106

I

A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

d
e
t
a
d

i
l

o
s
n
o
C

o
n
r
e
t
S

n
a
e
l
C

h
t
r
a
E

l

d
o
n
r
A

s
c
i
t
e
n
g
a
M

d
e
c
n
a
v
d
A

s
t
i
u
c
r
i
C

a
b
o
t
i
n
a
M

t
s
e
v
r
a
H

y
t
r
e
b
L

i

y
b
a
b
o
g
r
E

1
1
.
5

e
t
a
r
o
p
r
o
C

8
5
0
,
6
5

$

1
1
4
,
6

$

)
8
5
1
,
3
(

$

)
2
8
7
,
2
2
(

$

4
9
2
,
9

$

)
2
7
9
,
4
(

$

9
0
4
,
5

$

6
1
9
,
5

$

)
1
4
4
,
0
1
(

$

1
8
3
,
0
7

$

6
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
d
e
d
n
e

r
a
e
Y

)
1
(

)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

t
e
N

:
r
o
f

d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

3
5
4
,
3

)
2
8
7
,
2
(

1
6
7
,
2

0
2
0
,
5

)
2
8
6
,
1
(

9
4
4
,
3

0
4
4
,
4

)
0
9
1
,
5
(

—

s
e
x
a
t

e
m
o
c
n

i

r
o
f

)
t
i
f
e
n
e
b
(

i

i

n
o
s
v
o
r
P

9
6
4
,
9

2
5
6
,
4
2

—

0
7
1
,
9
8

2
1

2
9
3
,
7

9
8
5
,
2
1

0
6
4

7
3
4
,
2
1

0
4
6
,
1
2

—

1
2
7
,
6

1
2
4
,
9

—

0
1
8
,
7

8
3
9
,
3

)
8
0
3
,
2
(

—

7
4
6
,
1

0
8
3
,
4

7
8
8
,
3

4
9
3

4
0
2
,
5
2

)
0
9
4
,
4
7
(

)
7
2
3
,
1
(

7
6
6
,
1

6
0
4
,
9
2

1
6
6

9
8
1

—

—

4
9
3

—

—

0
0
5

—

4
8
4

0
4
2
,
1

8
3
7

5
0
3
,
3

—

—

—

—

—

5

—

4
8
1

0
0
0
,
6
1

—

—

—

—

—

)
0
1
(

3
2

—

—

—

—

—

—

0
0
5

0
0
5

0
0
5

9
4
3
,
9
7
1

7
5
8
,
9
2

7
9
5
,
8
2

)
9
7
8
,
3
(

2
6
0
,
6
2

9

5
6
0
,
4

7
8
4
,
6

7
0
9
,
3

—

0
8
7

0
2
1
,
1

—

—

—

—

—

0
0
5

0
5
3

—

3
0
2
,
4

6
5
9
,
2

—

4
3
1
,
5

0
5
3
,
9

4
9
5
,
3
2

)
5
0
8
(

0
4

1
3
1
,
4
2

7
4
8
,
4

)
9
0
6
,
2
5
(

n
o
i
t
a
z
i
t
r
o
m
a

d
n
a

i

n
o
i
t
a
c
e
r
p
e
D

t
e
n

,
e
s
n
e
p
x
e

t
s
e
r
e
n

t

I

t
s
e
r
e
t
n

i

y
n
a
p
m
o
c
r
e
n

t

I

7
1
0
,
6
1

0
4
8
,
4
2

0
5
8
,
2
1

8
9
0
,
1
4

A
D
T
B
E

I

—

8
4

2
4
3

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

7
7
6

9
9
7

9
9
8
,
5

—

—

—

—

0
0
5

0
0
5

—

—

3
7
4

3
6
0
,
2

—

—

—

—

3
3
3

7
6
1
,
1

)
8
0
3
,
2
(

s
n
o
i
t
a
r
e
p
o

d
e
u
n
i
t
n
o
c
s
d

i

f
o

l

e
a
s

n
o

i

n
a
G

—

—

8
9

—

—

)
0
9
4
,
4
7
(

)
7
2
3
,
1
(

—

3
2
7
,
5
2

n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c

l

r
e
d
o
h
e
r
a
h
s

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
-
n
o
N

s
t
e
s
s
a

f
o

l

a
s
o
p
s
d

i

n
o

s
s
o
L

/
t
n
e
m

r
i
a
p
m

I

t
n
e
m
t
s
e
v
n

i

d
o
h
t
e
m
y
t
i
u
q
e

n
o

i

n
a
G

s
e
s
n
e
p
x
e

n
o
i
t
i
s
u
q
c
A

i

i

i

n
o
s
v
o
r
p

t
u
o
n
r
a
e

o
t

t
n
e
m
t
s
u
d
A

j

n
o
i
t
c
a
s
n
a
r
t

y
c
n
e
r
r
u
c

i

n
g
e
r
o
f

n
o

s
s
o

l

i

)
n
a
G

(

e
e
f

i

s
e
c
v
r
e
s

n
o
i
t
a
r
g
e
n

t

I

s
e
e
f

t
n
e
m
e
g
a
n
a
M

r
e
h
t
o

d
n
a

s
t
e
s
s
a

d
e
x
i
f

f
o

l

e
a
s

n
o

s
s
o

l

i

)
n
a
G

(

9
0
8
,
7
6
1

$

1
0
6
,
1
3

$

4
6
8
,
4
3

$

0
1
8
,
2
1

$

5
7
5
,
6
2

$

7
5
6
,
6

$

7
0
9
,
6
1
$

5
1
7
,
2
3

$

6
8
8
,
6
1

$

)
6
0
2
,
1
1
(

$

)
2
(

I

A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

.
6
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
d
e
d
n
e

r
a
e
y

e
h
t

r
o
f

s
n
o
i
t
a
r
e
p
o

d
e
u
n
i
t
n
o
c
s
d
m
o
r
f

i

)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

e
d
u
c
n

l

i

t

o
n

s
e
o
d

)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

t
e
N

)
1
(

i

.
n
e
d
i
r
T
m
o
r
f

I

A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

f
o

n
o

i
l
l
i

m
0
.
4
$

e
d
u
c
n

l

i

t
o
n

I

s
e
o
d
A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

,
6
1
0
2

r
e
b
m
e
p
e
S
n

t

i

i

n
e
d
i
r
T

f

o

l

e
a
s

e
h

t

f

o

t
l
u
s
e
r

a

s
A

)
2
(

7
0
1

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
I

A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

d
e
t
a
d

i
l

o
s
n
o
C

o
n
r
e
t
S

n
a
e
l
C

h
t
r
a
E

l

d
o
n
r
A

s
c
i
t
e
n
g
a
M

d
e
c
n
a
v
d
A

s
t
i
u
c
r
i
C

a
b
o
t
i
n
a
M

t
s
e
v
r
a
H

y
t
r
e
b
L

i

y
b
a
b
o
g
r
E

1
1
.
5

e
t
a
r
o
p
r
o
C

9
8
7
,
8
5
1

$

9
7
7
,
3

$

)
1
8
1
,
1
(

$

3
0
8

$

8
6
8
,
1
1

$

)
7
1
9
,
5
(

$

6
5
9
,
4

$

8
9
7
,
1
1

$

3
8
6
,
2
3
1

$

5
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
d
e
d
n
e

r
a
e
Y

)
1
(

)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

t
e
N

:
r
o

f

d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

1
0
0
,
5
1

4
2
9
,
5
2

—

0
9
2
,
5
5

—

0
5
3
,
2

8
4
8
,
6

6
8
1
,
8

)
3
1
7
(

9
6
3

9
2
8
,
1
1

8
9
8
,
0
2

)
2
1
4
(

3
1

6
9
9
,
6

4
1
1
,
9

5
8
2
,
6

)
8
8
2
,
1
(

5
1
4
,
2

)
1
(

1
8
5
,
5

7
6
3
,
3

7

9
4
9

1
3
2
,
5

—

9
1
3
,
4

1
0
7
,
3

0
5
6
,
6

—

6
2
7
,
3

4
9
7
,
3

4
0
0
,
5
5
2

3
6
1
,
1
2

2
0
2
,
1
3

4
1
5
,
6
1

0
0
1
,
7
2

)
8
1
0
,
1
(

1
9
3
,
5
1

8
6
9
,
5
2

3
4
1

0
7
1
,
3

6
2
8
,
1

—

)
3
3
5
,
4
(

0
0
5
,
3

8
5
6
,
5
2

)
8
9
7
,
9
4
1
(

—

—

9
1
5

5
8
2

—

—

0
0
5

5
2
1
,
1

—

0
8
2

5
4
1
,
1

—

—

—

0
0
5

5
7
8
,
1

—

)
5
6
1
(

6
3
1

—

—

—

0
0
5

—

—

3
2

—

—

—

—

0
0
5

—

3

9
1
4

1
4
5
,
1

—

—

0
0
5

5
7
1

—

5
2

0
0
2

—

—

—

—

—

—

8
2
7

—

—

—

—

0
0
5

0
0
5

t
o
N

l

e
b
a
c

i
l

p
p
A

)
6
8
2
(

6
3
5
,
5
2

)
8
4
2
,
0
4
(

9
9
9

4
8
6
,
8
1
1

)
8
9
7
,
9
4
1
(

—

—

—

—

)
3
3
5
,
4
(

—

3
8
4
,
2
2

s
e
x
a
t

e
m
o
c
n

i

r
o
f

)
t
i
f
e
n
e
b
(

i

i

n
o
s
v
o
r
P

s
n
o
i
t
a
r
e
p
o

d
e
u
n
i
t
n
o
c
s
d

i

f
o

l

e
a
s

n
o

i

n
a
G

A
D
T
B
E

I

n
o
i
t
a
z
i
t
r
o
m
a

d
n
a

i

n
o
i
t
a
c
e
r
p
e
D

t
e
n

,
e
s
n
e
p
x
e

t
s
e
r
e
n

t

I

t
s
e
r
e
t
n

i

y
n
a
p
m
o
c
r
e
n

t

I

s
t
e
s
s
a

d
e
x
i
f

f
o

l

e
a
s

n
o

s
s
o

l

i

)
n
a
G

(

n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c

l

r
e
d
o
h
e
r
a
h
s

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
-
n
o
N

s
e
s
n
e
p
x
e

n
o
i
t
i
s
u
q
c
A

i

t
n
e
m
t
s
e
v
n

i

d
o
h
t
e
m
y
t
i
u
q
e

n
o

i

n
a
G

e
e
f

i

s
e
c
v
r
e
s

n
o
i
t

a
r
g
e
n

t

I

s
e
e
f

t
n
e
m
e
g
a
n
a
M

e
s
n
e
p
x
e

t
n
e
m

r
i
a
p
m

I

e
d
u
c
n

l

i

t
o
n
s
e
o
d
A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A

I

j

,
6
1
0
2
r
e
b
m
e
t
p
e
S
n

i

i

n
e
d
i
r
T

l

f
o
e
a
s
e
h
t
d
n
a
,
y
e
v
i
t
c
e
p
s
e
r

l

,
5
1
0
2
r
e
b
o
t
c
O
d
n
a
t
s
u
g
u
A
n

i

i

i

s
e
i
r
a
d
s
b
u
s
M
F
A
d
n
a
k
a
B
e
m
a
C

l

r
u
o

f

l

o
e
a
s
e
h

t

f

o

t
l

u
s
e
r
a
s
A

)
2
(

0
7
9
,
4
3
1

$

2
9
5
,
3
2

$

2
0
0
,
5
3

$

5
8
9
,
6
1

$

3
2
6
,
7
2

$

0
2
6
,
1

$

6
1
1
,
6
1

$

6
9
1
,
7
2

$

)
4
6
1
,
3
1
(

$

)
2
(

I

A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

.
5
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
d
e
d
n
e

r
a
e
y

e
h
t

r
o
f

s
n
o
i
t
a
r
e
p
o

d
e
u
n
i
t
n
o
c
s
d
m
o
r
f

i

)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

e
d
u
c
n

l

i

t

o
n

s
e
o
d

)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

t
e
N

)
1
(

.
n
o

i
l
l
i

m
6
.
1
3
$

8
0
1

f
o

i

,
n
e
d
i
r
T
d
n
a

,
s
e
a
s

l

f
o

s
e
t
a
d

e
h
t

h
g
u
o
r
h
t

5
1
0
2

,
1

y
r
a
u
n
a
J

d
o
i
r
e
p

e
h
t

r
o
f

M
F
A
d
n
a

l

k
a
B
e
m
a
C
m
o
r
f

I

A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
I

A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

d
e
t
a
d

i
l

o
s
n
o
C

o
n
r
e
t
S

h
t
r
a
E
n
a
e
l
C

l

d
o
n
r
A

s
c
i
t
e
n
g
a
M

d
e
c
n
a
v
d
A

s
t
i
u
c
r
i
C

a
b
o
t
i
n
a
M

t
s
e
v
r
a
H

y
t
r
e
b
L

i

y
b
a
b
o
g
r
E

1
1
.
5

e
t
a
r
o
p
r
o
C

9
2
0
,
5
5
2

$

)
8
0
0
,
2
(

$

)
7
1
3
,
1
(

$

9
2
2

$

1
0
1
,
1
1

$

)
8
8
4
,
4
(

$

9
5
1
,
8

$

3
5
3
,
3
4
2

$

4
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
d
e
d
n
e

r
a
e
Y

)
1
(

)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

t
e
N

:
r
o

f

d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

8
8
0
,
3

1
8
6
,
6
2

—

5
2
1
,
7
3

3
4
1
,
2

6
6
0
,
4
2
3

6
5
3

7
3
7
,
1

4
4
8
,
4

)
5
2
3
,
4
6
2
(

)
9
2
0
,
1
1
(

0
0
0
,
1

2
7
8
,
1
2

1
2
5
,
8
7

)
7
3
5
,
1
(

—

5
4
6
,
1

7
0
7
,
4

—

7
0
8
,
2

—

4
2
1

)
5
7
2
(

1
5
1

—

7
9
9
,
3

6
7
7
,
6

2
3
3
,
9

9

4
2
4

—

—

5
7
3

5
2
1

—

—

5
2
6

5
2
1

5
6
7
,
2

3
8
9
,
1

)
2
(

)
6
6
9
(

—

9
1
2
,
7

4
8
8
,
8

)
2
(

6
0
4
,
4

—

1
6
5
,
6

7
7
9
,
4

4
6
3
,
5
1

3
4
0
,
7
2

4
2
3

4
3
1

—

—

—

0
0
5

6

3
2

—

—

—

—

0
0
5

t
o
N

l

e
b
a
c

i
l

p
p
A

)
4
8
0
,
3
(

—

2
7
5
,
4

8
3
5
,
6

—

8
3
5
,
3

7
1

1
7
3

6
9

—

—

—

0
0
5

5
3
7
,
4

5
2

7
1
9
,
4

9
5
1
,
4

—

5
9
9
,
1
2

—

1
6
6

—

—

—

0
0
5

t
o
N

l

e
b
a
c

i
l

p
p
A

)
1
9
1
(

9
0
5
,
6
2

)
1
1
9
,
8
2
(

4
8
0
,
1

3
4
1
,
2

7
8
9
,
3
4
2

—

—

—

)
5
2
3
,
4
6
2
(

)
9
2
0
,
1
1
(

—

2
2
6
,
9
1

s
e
x
a
t

e
m
o
c
n

i

r
o
f

)
t
i
f
e
n
e
b
(

i

i

n
o
s
v
o
r
P

t
e
n

,
e
s
n
e
p
x
e

t
s
e
r
e
n

t

I

t
s
e
r
e
t
n

i

y
n
a
p
m
o
c
r
e
n

t

I

n
o
i
t
a
z
i
t
r
o
m
a

d
n
a

n
o

i
t

i

a
c
e
r
p
e
D

n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c

l

r
e
d
o
h
e
r
a
h
s

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
-
n
o
N

i

y
r
a
d
s
b
u
s

i

f
o

n
o
i
t
a
d

i
l

o
s
n
o
c
e
d

n
o

i

n
a
G

t
n
e
m
t
s
e
v
n

i

d
o
h
t
e
m
y
t
i
u
q
e

n
o

i

n
a
G

s
e
s
n
e
p
x
e

n
o

i

i
t
i
s
u
q
c
A

t
n
e
m
h
s
u
g
n
i
t
x
e

i

t

b
e
d

n
o

s
s
o
L

s
t
e
s
s
a

d
e
x
i
f

f
o

l

e
a
s

n
o

s
s
o
L

A
D
T
B
E

I

e
e
f

i

s
e
c
v
r
e
s

n
o

i
t

a
r
g
e
n

t

I

s
e
e
f

t

n
e
m
e
g
a
n
a
M

$

6
9
1
,
6

$

8
9
4
,
2
1

$

2
2
3
,
6
1

$

2
7
5
,
7
2

$

2
2
5
,
4

$

6
5
1
,
3
2

$

)
5
4
7
,
1
1
(

$

)
2
(

I

A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

d
o
i
r
e
p

e
h
t

r
o
f

n
o

i
l
l
i

m
0
.
5
1
$

f
o
X
O
F
m
o
r
f

e
m
o
c
n
.

t
e
n

e
d
u
c
n

l

i

t
o
n

s
e
o
d

l

e
u
d
e
h
c
s

e
v
o
b
a

e
h
t

n

i

)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

t
e
n

,
4
1
0
2

l

y
u
J

n

i

i

i

y
r
a
d
s
b
u
s
X
O
F
r
u
o

f

o

n
o

i
t

a
d

i
l

o
s
n
o
c
e
d

e
h

t

f

o

t
l

u
s
e
r

a

s
A

)
1
(

t
o
n

s
e
o
d
A
D
T
B
E

I

d
e
t
s
u
d
A

j

,
6
1
0
2

r
e
b
m
e
t
p
e
S

n

i

i

n
e
d
i
r
T

f
o

l

e
a
s

e
h
t

d
n
a

l

,
y
e
v
i
t
c
e
p
s
e
r

,
5
1
0
2

r
e
b
o
t
c
O
d
n
a

t
s
u
g
u
A
n

i

i

i

s
e
i
r
a
d
s
b
u
s
M
F
A
d
n
a

l

k
a
B
e
m
a
C

r
u
o

f

o

s
e
a
s

l

e
h

t

f

o

t
l

u
s
e
r

a

s
A

)
2
(

.
4
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
d
e
d
n
e

r
a
e
y

e
h
t

r
o
f

s
n
o
i
t
a
r
e
p
o

d
e
u
n
i
t
n
o
c
s
d
m
o
r
f

i

)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

e
d
u
c
n

l

i

t

o
n

s
e
o
d

o
s
a

l

)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

.
n
o

i
l
l
i

m
2
.
2
4
$

9
0
1

f
o

i

n
e
d
i
r
T
d
n
a
M
F
A

l

,
k
a
B
e
m
a
C
m
o
r
f

4
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
g
n
d
n
e

i

r
a
e
y

e
h

t

r
o

f

I

A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A
e
d
u
c
n

j

l

i

t
e
N

.
4
1
0
2

,
0
1

l

y
u
J

h
g
u
o
r
h
t

4
1
0
2

,
1

y
r
a
u
n
a
J

d
o
i
r
e
p

e
h
t

r
o
f

X
O
F
r
o
f

n
o

i
l
l
i

m
1
.
5
2
$

I

f
o
A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A
e
d
u
c
n

l

j

i

t
o
n

I

s
e
o
d
A
D
T
B
E
d
e
t
s
u
d
A
d
n
a

j

,

4
1
0
2

,

0
1

l

y
u
J

h
g
u
o
r
h

t

4
1
0
2

,

1

y
r
a
u
n
a
J

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash Flow Available for Distribution and Reinvestment 

The table below details cash receipts and payments that are not reflected on our income statement in order to provide an additional 
measure of management’s estimate of cash CAD. CAD is a non-GAAP measure that we believe provides additional information 
to our shareholders in order to enable them to evaluate our ability to make anticipated quarterly distributions. Because other entities 
do not necessarily calculate CAD the same way we do, our presentation of CAD may not be comparable to similarly titled measures 
provided by other entities. We believe that our historic and future CAD, together with our cash balances and access to cash via 
our debt facilities, will be sufficient to meet our anticipated distributions over the next twelve months. The table below reconciles 
CAD to net income and to cash flow provided by operating activities, which we consider to be the most directly comparable 
financial measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP.

(in thousands)

Net income

Adjustment to reconcile net income to cash provided by
operating activities:

Depreciation and amortization

Impairment expense/ Loss on disposal of assets

Gain on sale of businesses

Amortization of debt issuance costs and original issue
discount

Unrealized loss on interest rate hedges

Loss on debt repayment
Excess tax benefit from subsidiary stock option exercise 

Gain on deconsolidation of subsidiary

Gain on equity method investment

Noncontrolling stockholders charges

Deferred taxes

Other

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

Net cash provided by operating activities

Plus:

Unused fee on revolving credit facility

Excess tax benefit from subsidiary stock option exercise

Successful acquisition expense
Integration services agreement (1)
Realized loss from foreign currency effect (2)
Earnout provision adjustment (3)

Other

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

Less:

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

Payment on interest rate swap
Realized gain from foreign currency effect (2)

Other
Maintenance capital expenditures: (4)

Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC

5.11

Advanced Circuits

American Furniture (divested October 2015)

110

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

56,530

$

165,770

$

291,155

87,405

25,204

(2,308)

3,565

1,539

—

(1,163)

—

(74,490)

4,382

(9,669)

1,893

18,484

111,372

1,947

1,163

3,888

1,667

—

394

421

—

18,484

4,303

1,327

—

—

1,838

2,931

—

63,072

9,165

(149,798)

2,883

5,662

—

—

—

(4,533)

3,737

(3,131)

34

(8,313)

84,548

1,612

—

1,826

3,500

2,561

—

200

8,313

—

2,007

—

—

—

—

1,525

311

55,696

—

—

3,125

7,722

2,143

(1,662)

(264,325)

(11,029)

4,744

(8,601)

1,442

(9,715)

70,695

1,914

1,662

4,844

1,000

—

—

51

9,715

—

2,008

—

528

—

—

568

504

Arnold

CamelBak (divested August 2015)

Clean Earth

ERGObaby

FOX

Liberty

Manitoba Harvest

Sterno Products

Tridien (divested September 2016)
FOX CAD (5)

Estimated cash flow available for distribution and reinvestment $
Distribution paid in April 2016/2015/2014

$

Distribution paid in July 2016/2015/2014

Distribution paid in October 2016/2015/2014

Distribution paid in January 2017/2016/2015

3,801

—

6,202

826

—

1,098

1,495

1,787

385

—

2,618

1,295

6,295

1,543

—

1,158

594

1,928

927

—

76,375

$

(19,548) $

(19,548)

(19,548)

(21,564)

82,359

$

(19,548) $

(19,548)

(19,548)

(19,548)

$

(80,208) $

(78,192) $

3,078

2,492

1,944

912

2,381

848

—

126

784

15,716

57,992

(17,388)

(17,388)

(17,388)

(19,548)

(71,712)

(1)  Represents fees paid by newly acquired companies to the Manager for integration services performed during the first year of 

ownership, payable quarterly.

(2)  Represents the foreign currency transaction gain or loss resulting from the Canadian dollar intercompany loans issued to 

Manitoba Harvest.  

(3)  Earnout provision adjustment related to the change in estimate of contingent consideration that was recorded in the consolidated 

statement of operations.

(4)  Represents  maintenance  capital  expenditures  that  were  funded  from  operating  cash  flow  and  excludes  growth  capital 
expenditures of approximately $3.4 million, $1.0 million and $1.6 million incurred during the years ended December 31, 
2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

(5)  Represents FOX CAD subsequent to the IPO date. For the year ended December 31, 2014, the amount includes $24.2 million 
of EBITDA, less: $3.8 million of cash taxes, $1.9 million of management fees, $2.4 million of maintenance capital expenditures 
and $0.4 million of interest expense.

Earnings of certain of our businesses are seasonal in nature. Earnings from Liberty are typically lowest in the second quarter due 
to lower demand for safes at the onset of summer.  Earnings from Clean Earth are typically lower during the winter months due 
to the limits on outdoor construction and dredging because of the colder weather in the Northeastern United States.  Sterno Products 
typically has higher sales in the second and fourth quarter of each year, reflecting the outdoor summer season and the holiday 
season.  

Related Party Transactions and Certain Transactions Involving our Businesses

We have entered into the following related party transactions with our Manager, CGM:

•  Management Services Agreement
•  LLC Agreement
• 
Integration Services Agreement
•  Cost Reimbursement and Fees

Management Services Agreement

We entered into the MSA with CGM effective May 16, 2006. The MSA provides for, among other things, CGM to perform services 
for us in exchange for a management fee paid quarterly and equal to 0.5% of our adjusted net assets. The management fee is 
required to be paid prior to the payment of any distributions to shareholders. For the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015, and 
2014, we incurred $29.4 million, $28.8 million, and $21.9 million, respectively, in management fees to CGM (excludes offsetting 
fees paid by CamelBak and Tridien).

111

Pursuant to the MSA, CGM is entitled to enter into off-setting management service agreements with each of our segments. The 
amount of the fee is negotiated between CGM and the operating management of each segment and is based upon the value of the 
services to be provided. The fees paid directly to CGM by the segments offset on a dollar for dollar basis the amount due to CGM 
by the Company under the MSA.

On October 7, 2014 and effective as of September 30, 2014, the Company and CGM amended the MSA, to provide for certain 
modifications related to FOX no longer being a consolidated subsidiary.  

LLC Agreement

As distinguished from its provision of providing management services to us, pursuant to the amended MSA, members of CGM 
are owners of 60.4% of the Allocation Interests in us through their ownership in Sostratus LLC. The LLC agreement gives the 
holders of Allocation Interests the right to distributions pursuant to a profit allocation formula upon the occurrence of a Sale Event 
or a Holding Event. The Allocation Interest Holders are entitled to receive and as such can elect to receive the positive contribution-
based profit allocation payment for each of the business acquisitions during the 30-day period following the fifth anniversary of 
the date upon which we acquired a controlling interest in that business (Holding Event) and upon the sale of the business (Sale 
Event).  During the year ended December 31, 2016, Holders received $23.8 million in total distributions related to Sale Events of 
FOX shares in March and August 2016, a fifth year anniversary Holding Event of our ACI business, and the sale of Tridien in 
September 2016.  During the year ended December 31, 2016, Holders were paid $14.6 million related to the sale of CamelBak 
and American Furniture (Sale Events) and $3.1 million related to the five year holding event for Ergobaby (Holding Event).  During 
the year ended December 31, 2014, we paid $11.9 million to holders of the Allocation interests  related to a FOX secondary offering 
(Sale Event).  At December 31, 2016, we accrued a distribution payable to the Allocation Interest Holders of $13.4 million related 
to our November 2016 sale of FOX shares.  This distribution was paid in the first quarter of 2017.  

Certain persons who are employees and partners of the Manager, including the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief 
Financial Officer, beneficially own 60.4% of the Allocation Interests, through Sostratus LLC, at December 31, 2016, and 58.8% 
at December 31, 2015.   Of the remaining 39.6% non-voting ownership of the Allocation Interests, 5.0% is held by CGI Diversified 
Holdings LP, 5.0% is held by the Chairman of the Company’s Board of Directors, and the remaining 29.6% is held by the former 
founding partner of the Manager.

Integration Services Agreement

5.11, which was acquired in 2016, Manitoba Harvest, which was acquired in 2015, and the 2014 acquisitions entered into Integration 
Services Agreements ("ISA") with CGM.  The ISA provides for CGM to provide services for new platform acquisitions to, amongst 
other things, assist the management at the acquired entities in establishing a corporate governance program, including the retention 
of independent board members to serve on their board of directors, implement compliance and reporting requirements of the 
Sarbanes-Oxley Act and align the acquired entity's policies and procedures with our other subsidiaries.  Each ISA is for the twelve 
month period subsequent to the acquisition and is payable quarterly.  Manitoba Harvest paid CGM $1.0 million in integration 
services fees, Clean Earth paid CGM $2.5 million and Sterno Products paid CGM $1.5 million under the agreements.  5.11 will 
pay CGM $3.5 million under the agreement.  During the year ended December 31, 2016, 5.11incurred $1.2 million in integration 
service fees, with the remaining $2.3 million to be paid in 2017. 

Cost Reimbursement and Fees

We reimbursed CGM approximately $3.8 million, $3.5 million, and $4.5 million, principally for occupancy and staffing costs 
incurred by CGM on our behalf during the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

Investment in FOX

As of July 10, 2014, our ownership interest in FOX decreased from 53% to approximately 41% after we sold shares in a secondary 
offering by FOX.  Since we no longer held a majority interest in FOX, we began accounting for our investment in FOX at fair 
value utilizing the equity method of accounting. We elected to measure our investment in FOX using the fair value option fair 
value, with unrealized gains and losses reflected in the consolidated statement of operations as income (loss).  In November 2016, 
our ownership interest in FOX decreased to approximately 14%, and we continue to account for changes in the fair value of the 
investment in FOX as gain/loss on investment through the consolidated statement of operations.

112

The following table reflects the 2016 and 2015 activity from our investment in FOX (in thousands):

Balance January 1st

Proceeds from sale of FOX shares, net - March 2016

Proceeds from sale of FOX shares, net - August 2016

Proceeds from sale of FOX shares, net - November 2016
Mark-to-market adjustment - investment (1)

Balance December 31st

$

$

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

249,747

$

245,214

(47,685)

(63,000)

(71,785)

74,490

141,767

$

—

—

—

4,533

249,747

(1)  The mark-to-market adjustment represents the change in the fair value of the FOX common shares for the period indicated.  

The Company and its businesses have the following significant related party transactions:

FOX

In September 2014, the Company and FOX entered into an agreement for the provision of services to FOX for assistance in 
complying the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, as amended (the “Services Agreement”). The Services Agreement can be terminated 
by either party at any time, or will terminate on March 31, 2016. A statement of work was agreed to in connection with the Service 
Agreement, which provides that the Company’s internal audit team will assist FOX with various tasks, including, but not limited 
to, the development of internal control policies and procedures, risk and control matrices and the evaluation of internal controls. 
Services provided in accordance with the Services Agreement are billed on a time and materials basis. Fees paid for services 
provided in 2016 and 2015 were approximately $72,000 and $135,000, respectively  

5.11

Related Party Vendor Purchases - 5.11 purchases inventory from a vendor who is a related party to 5.11 through one of the executive 
officers of 5.11 via the executive's 40% ownership interest in the vendor.   During the year ended December 31, 2016 (from the 
date of acquisition) 5.11 purchased approximately $2.3 million in inventory from the vendor.  

ACI 

Recapitalization - During the second quarter of 2016, the Company completed a recapitalization at ACI whereby the Company 
entered into an amendment to the intercompany debt agreement with ACI (the "ACI Loan Agreement").  The ACI loan agreement 
was amended to  provide for additional term loan borrowings of $61.0 million to fund a cash distribution to shareholders totaling 
$60.1 million.  Minority interest shareholders of Advanced Circuits, including certain members of management at Advanced 
Circuits, received total distribution proceeds of $18.4 million.  The Company used cash on hand to fund the distribution to minority 
shareholders.  

Liberty

Recapitalization - During the first quarter of 2016, we completed a recapitalization at Liberty whereby we entered into an amendment 
to the intercompany loan agreement with Liberty (the “Liberty Loan Agreement”). The Liberty Loan Agreement was amended to 
(i)  provide  for  term  loan  borrowings  of  $38.0  million  and  revolving  credit  facility  borrowings  of  $5.0  million  to  fund  cash 
distributions totaling $35.3 million to its shareholders, including the Company, and (ii) extend the maturity dates of the term loans 
and revolving credit facility.  Liberty’s noncontrolling shareholders received approximately $5.3 million in distributions as a result 
of the recapitalization.  Immediately prior to the recapitalization, management exercised stock options for 75,095 shares of Liberty 
common  shares,  resulting  in  net  proceeds  from  stock  options  at  Liberty  of  $3.8  million.    Liberty  recognized  $0.3  million  in 
compensation expense related to the accelerated vesting of a portion of management's stock options at the time of exercise.  We 
then purchased $1.5 million in Liberty common shares from members of Liberty management, resulting in Liberty's noncontrolling 
shareholders holding 11.4% of Liberty's outstanding shares subsequent to the recapitalization.  The purchase of the Liberty common 
stock  from  noncontrolling  shareholders  and  issuance  of  Liberty  common  stock  related  to  the  exercise  of  stock  options  by 
noncontrolling  shareholders  were  at  fair  value  and  resulted  in  no  change  in  control  of  Liberty.   The  difference  between  the 
consideration paid for the noncontrolling interest and the adjustment to the carrying amount of our noncontrolling interest in 

113

Liberty was recognized in our equity.  Subsequent to the purchase of Liberty common shares and the exercise of the options, we 
own 88.6% of Liberty on a primary basis and 84.7% on a fully diluted basis.  

Liberty Related Party Vendor Purchases - Liberty purchases inventory raw materials from two vendors who are related parties to 
Liberty through two of the executive officers of Liberty via the employment of family members at the vendors.   During the years 
ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, Liberty purchased approximately $2.5 million and $3.3 million, respectively, in raw materials 
from the two vendors.  During 2014, Liberty purchased $0.3 million in raw materials from one of these vendors.  The related party 
relationship at the other vendor did not exist in 2014 because the executive was not employed at Liberty during 2014. 

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

We have no special purpose entities or off balance sheet arrangements, other than operating leases entered into in the ordinary 
course of business.

Contractual Obligations

Long-term contractual obligations, except for our long-term debt obligations, are generally not recognized in our consolidated 
balance  sheet.  Non-cancelable  purchase  obligations  are  obligations  we  incur  during  the  normal  course  of  business,  based  on 
projected needs.

The table below summarizes the payment schedule of our contractual obligations at December 31, 2016 (in thousands):

Long-term debt obligations (a)
Operating lease obligations (b)
Purchase obligations (c)

Total (d)

Total

Less than 
1 Year

1-3 Years

3-5 Years

More than
5 Years

$

864,696

$

10,129

$

77,366

$

239,719

$

537,482

95,892

374,372

15,003

222,150

24,864

86,722

17,489

65,500

38,536

—

$

1,334,960

$

247,282

$

188,952

$

322,708

$

576,018

(a)  Reflects commitment fees and letter of credit fees under our Revolving Credit Facility and amounts due, together with 

interest on our Revolving Credit Facility and Term Loan Facility.

(b)  Reflects various operating leases for office space, manufacturing facilities and equipment from third parties.
(c)  Reflects non-cancelable commitments as of December 31, 2016, including: (i) shareholder distributions of $86.3 million; 
(ii) estimated management fees of $32.8 million per year over the next five years: and (iii) other obligations, including 
amounts due under employment agreements. Distributions to our shareholders are approved by our board of directors each 
fiscal quarter. The amount approved for future quarters may differ from the amount included in this schedule.

(d)  The contractual obligation table does not include approximately $10.5 million in liabilities associated with unrecognized 
tax benefits as of December 31, 2016 as the timing of the recognition of this liability is not certain. The amount of the 
liability is not expected to significantly change in the next twelve months. 

Critical Accounting Estimates

The  following  discussion  relates  to  critical  accounting  estimates  for  the  Company,  the  Trust  and  each  of  our  businesses  at 
December 31, 2016.

The preparation of our financial statements in conformity with GAAP will require management to adopt accounting policies and 
make estimates and judgments that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results 
could differ from these estimates under different assumptions and judgments and uncertainties, and potentially could result in 
materially  different  results  under  different  conditions.  Our  critical  accounting  estimates  are  discussed  below.  These  critical 
accounting estimates are reviewed by our independent auditors and the audit committee of our board of directors.

Revenue Recognition

We recognize revenue when it is realized or realizable and earned. We consider revenue realized or realizable and earned when it 
has persuasive evidence of an arrangement, the product has been shipped or the services have been provided to the customer, the 
sales price is fixed or determinable and collectability is reasonably assured. Provisions for customer returns and other allowances 
based on historical experience are recognized at the time the related sale is recognized. Revenue from the Company's Clean Earth 

114

business is recognized as services are rendered, generally when material is received at Clean Earth's facilities, and is recorded as 
"service revenue" in the accompanying consolidated statement of operations.

Business Combinations

The acquisitions of our businesses are accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting. The amounts assigned to the 
identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed in connection with acquisitions are based on estimated fair values as of the 
date  of  the  acquisition,  with  the  remainder,  if  any,  to  be  recorded  as  identifiable  intangibles  or  goodwill. The  fair  values  are 
determined by our management team, taking into consideration information supplied by the management of the acquired entities 
and  other relevant information. Such information  typically includes valuations supplied by independent  appraisal experts for 
significant business combinations. The valuations are generally based upon future cash flow projections for the acquired assets, 
discounted to present value. The determination of fair values requires significant judgment both by our management team and by 
outside experts engaged to assist in this process. This judgment could result in either a higher or lower value assigned to amortizable 
or depreciable assets. The impact could result in either higher or lower amortization and/or depreciation expense.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the assets acquired. We are required to perform impairment 
reviews  at  least  annually  and  more  frequently  in  certain  circumstances.  The  estimates  of  future  earnings  and  other  market 
assumptions used to derive and test the fair value at each of our reporting units requires judgment on the part of management. 
Even minor adjustments to those values used and assumptions made can lead to significantly different results.

Annual goodwill and indefinite lived intangible assets impairment testing

Goodwill represents the excess amount of the purchase price over the fair value of the assets acquired.  Our goodwill and indefinite 
lived intangible assets are tested for impairment on an annual basis as of March 31st, and if current events or circumstances require, 
on an interim basis. Goodwill is allocated to various reporting units, which are generally an operating segment or one level below 
the operating segment.  Each of our businesses represents a reporting unit except Arnold, which is comprised of three reporting 
units, and each reporting unit was included in our annual impairment test at March 31, 2016.

We use a qualitative approach to test goodwill for impairment by first assessing qualitative factors to determine whether it is more-
likely than-not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount as a basis for determining whether it is necessary 
to  perform  the  two-step  goodwill  impairment  testing.    The  qualitative  factors  we  consider  include,  in  part,  the  general 
macroeconomic environment, industry and market specific conditions for each reporting unit, financial performance including 
actual versus planned results and results of relevant prior periods for operating income, net income and adjusted EBITDA, operating 
costs and cost impacts, as well as issues or events specific to the reporting unit.  At March 31, 2016, we determined that the Tridien 
reporting unit, which we sold in September 2016 and is presented as a discontinued operation, required further quantitative testing 
(step 1) because we could not conclude that the fair value of the reporting unit exceeds its carrying value based on qualitative 
factors alone.  For the reporting units that were tested qualitatively, the  results of the qualitative analysis indicated that the fair 
value of those reporting units exceeded their carrying value. 

At December 31, 2016, as a result of decreases in forecasted revenue, operating income and cash flows at Arnold, as well as a 
shortfall in revenue and operating income during the latter half of 2016 as compared to budgeted amounts, we determined that it 
was necessary to perform interim goodwill impairment testing on each of the three reporting units at Arnold.  In the first step of 
the goodwill impairment test, we compare the fair value of each reporting unit to its carrying amount.  We estimate the fair value 
of our reporting units using either an income approach or a market approach, or, where applicable, a weighting of the two methods.    
Under the income approach, we estimate the fair value of a reporting unit based on the present value of future cash flows.  Cash 
flow projections are based on Management's estimate of revenue growth rates and operating margins and take into consideration 
industry and market conditions as well as company specific economic factors.   The discount rate used is based on the weighted 
average  cost  of  capital  adjusted  for  the  relevant  risk  associated  with  the  business  specific  characteristics  and  the  uncertainty 
associated with the reporting unit's ability to execute on the projected cash flows.  Under the market approach, we estimate fair 
value based on market multiples of revenue and earnings derived from comparable public companies with operating and investment 
characteristics that are similar to the report unit.  We weigh the fair value derived from the market approach depending on the 
level of comparability of these public companies to the reporting unit.  When market comparables are not meaningful or available,  
we estimate the fair value of the reporting unit using only the income approach.  For purposes of the Step 1 for the Arnold reporting 
units, we estimated the fair value of the reporting unit using only an income approach, whereby we estimate the fair value of a 
reporting unit based on the present value of future cash flows.   We do not believe that the market approach results in relevant data 
points for market multiples or comparative data from comparable public companies since most of Arnold's competitors are privately 

115

held and do not publish data that can be used in a market approach.  In the income approach, we used a weighted average cost of 
capital of 12.5% for PMAG, 12.0% for FlexMag, and 13.0% for PTM.  Results of the Step 1 testing for Arnold's FlexMag and 
PTM reporting units indicated that the fair value of these reporting units exceeded their carrying value by 34% and 38%, respectively.  
The results of the Step 1 test for the PMAG unit indicated a potential impairment of goodwill and the Company performed the 
second step of goodwill impairment testing (Step 2) to determine the amount of impairment of the PMAG reporting unit.

We have not completed the Step 2 testing for PMAG, and as a result, we have estimated a range of impairment loss as of December 
31, 2016 of $14 million to $19 million based on the value of the total invested capital of the PMAG unit as well as the results of 
the Step 1 testing of the fair value of PMAG.  We recorded an estimated impairment loss for PMAG of $16 million at December 
31, 2016.  The Step 2 test for PMAG is expected to be completed during the first quarter of 2017 and the Company will record 
any necessary adjustments to the impairment loss estimate based on the results of the final testing.

In connection with the annual goodwill impairment testing, we test other indefinite-lived intangible assets (trade names) at our 
reporting units. We are permitted to make a qualitative assessment of whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of an 
individual reporting unit's indefinite lived assets exceeds its carrying amount before applying a quantitative analysis. If a company 
concludes that it is not more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit’s indefinite-lived assets exceeds its carrying 
amount it is not required to perform a quantitative test for that reporting unit.  At March 31, 2016, we elected to use the qualitative 
assessment alternative to test indefinite-lived assets for impairment for each of our reporting units that record indefinite lived 
assets.  At that time, it was determined that the fair value of indefinite lived assets at each of our reporting units exceeded its 
carrying amount. 

Long-lived  intangible  assets  subject  to  amortization,  including  customer  relationships,  non-compete  agreements,  permits  and 
technology are amortized using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the intangible assets, which we determine 
based on the consideration of several factors including the period of time the asset is expected to remain in service. We evaluate 
long-lived assets for potential impairment whenever events occur or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of the assets 
may not be recoverable. The carrying amount of a long-lived asset is not recoverable if it exceeds the sum of the undiscounted 
cash flows expected to result from the use and eventual disposition of the asset. If the carrying amount of a long-lived asset is not 
recoverable and is greater than its fair value, the asset is impaired and an impairment loss must be recognized.  Both the Ergobaby 
and Clean Earth businesses recognized losses on disposal of assets during 2016.  Ergobaby recorded a $5.9 million loss on disposal 
of assets during the year ended December 31, 2016 related to its decision to dispose of the Orbit Baby product line.  The loss is 
comprised of the write-off of intangible assets of $5.5 million, property, plant and equipment of $0.4 million, and other assets of 
$1.0 million.  In October 2016, Ergobaby sold a majority of the Orbit Baby intellectual property and tooling assets.  The proceeds 
of the sale reduced  the loss recorded on disposal of assets by approximately $1.0 million in the fourth quarter of 2016.  Clean 
Earth recognized a loss on disposal of assets of $3.3 million during the fourth quarter of 2016 related to the closure of the Company’s 
Williamsport,  Pennsylvania  site  which  processed  drill  cuttings.    The  loss  was  comprised  of  intangible  assets  specific  to  the 
Williamsport location, as well as equipment that could not be repurposed to other sites at the time of the closing of the facility.  

The determination of fair values and estimated useful lives requires significant judgment both by our management team and by 
outside experts engaged to assist in this process. This judgment could result in either a higher or lower value assigned to our 
reporting units and intangible assets. The impact could result in either higher or lower amortization and/or the incurrence of an 
impairment charge.

Allowance for Doubtful Accounts

We record an allowance for doubtful accounts on an entity-by-entity basis with consideration for historical loss experience, customer 
payment patterns and current economic trends. The Company reviews the adequacy of the allowance for doubtful accounts on a 
periodic basis and adjusts the balance, if necessary. The determination of the adequacy of the allowance for doubtful accounts 
requires significant judgment by management. The impact of either over or under estimating the allowance could have a material 
effect on future operating results. The consolidated allowance for doubtful accounts is approximately $5.5 million at December 31, 
2016.

Deferred Tax Assets

Several of our majority owned subsidiaries have deferred tax assets recorded at December 31, 2016 which in total amount to 
approximately $45.4 million. This deferred tax asset is net of $7.3 million of valuation allowance primarily associated with 5.11 
and Arnold related to an expected inability to utilize foreign tax credits. These deferred tax assets are comprised primarily of 
reserves not currently deductible for tax purposes. The temporary differences that have resulted in the recording of these tax assets 
may be used to offset taxable income in future periods, reducing the amount of taxes we might otherwise be required to pay. 
Realization of the deferred tax assets is dependent on generating sufficient future taxable income. Based upon the expected future 

116

results of operations, we believe it is more likely than not that we will generate sufficient future taxable income to realize the 
benefit of existing temporary differences, although there can be no assurance of this. The impact of not realizing these deferred 
tax assets would result in an increase in income tax expense for such period when the determination was made that the assets are 
not realizable. (Refer to Note L – “Income taxes" in the notes to consolidated financial statements.)

Profit Allocation Interests

At the time of our Initial Public Offering, we issued Allocation Interests governed by our LLC agreement that entitle the holders 
(the "Holders") to receive distributions pursuant to a profit allocation formula upon the occurrence of certain events.  The Holders 
are entitled to receive and as such can elect to receive the positive contribution based profit allocation payment for each of the 
business acquisitions during the 30-day period following the fifth anniversary of the date upon which we acquired a controlling 
interest in that business (Holding Event) and upon the sale of that business (Sale Event).  

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

Refer to "Note B - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies" to our consolidated financial statements.

ITEM 7A. – Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

Interest Rate Sensitivity

At December 31, 2016, we were exposed to interest rate risk primarily through borrowings under our 2014 Credit Facility because 
borrowings under this agreement are subject to variable interest rates. We had $565.7 million outstanding under the 2014 Term 
Loan Facility and 2016 Incremental Term Loan at December 31, 2016.  We have entered into an interest rate swap as of December 
31, 2016.  On September 16, 2014, we purchased an interest rate swap with a notional amount of $220 million.  This swap is 
effective April 1, 2016 through June 6, 2021, the termination date of our 2014 Term Loan, and requires us to pay interest at rates 
on the notional amount at 2.97% in exchange for the three-month LIBOR rate.

Interest on our Term Loan is subject to a LIBOR floor of 1.0% and three-month LIBOR is approximately 100 basis points at 
December 31, 2016. We currently estimate that a 100 basis point increase in LIBOR would not have a material impact on our 
results of operations, cash flows or financial condition.  

We expect to borrow under our Revolving Credit Facility in the future in order to finance our short term working capital needs 
and future acquisitions. These borrowings will be subject to variable interest rates.

Foreign Exchange Rate Sensitivity

During fiscal 2015, we acquired a Canadian subsidiary, Manitoba Harvest, and we are exposed to transactional foreign currency 
exposure related to the issuance of intercompany loans in the Canadian dollar, the functional currency of Manitoba Harvest.  At 
December 31, 2016, the outstanding amount of intercompany loans with Manitoba Harvest was $46.2 million (C$61.2 million).   
We recognized foreign exchange losses of approximately $1.3 million during 2016 related to changes in the Canadian dollar.  A 
10% decrease/ increase in the exchange rate would result in approximately $5.5 million additional expense/ income based on our 
current amount of intercompany loans outstanding.  We also have translation exposure resulting from translating the financial 
statements of  Manitoba Harvest into the U.S. Dollar.  

Credit Risk

We are exposed to credit risk associated with cash equivalents, investments, and trade receivables. We do not believe that our cash 
equivalents or investments present significant credit risks because the counterparties to the instruments consist of major financial 
institutions and we manage the notional amount of contracts entered into with any one counterparty. Our cash and cash equivalents 
at December 31, 2016 consists principally of (i) treasury backed securities, (ii) insured prime money market funds, (iii) FDIC 
insured Certificates of Deposit, and (iv) cash balances in several non-interest bearing checking accounts. Substantially all trade 
receivable balances of our businesses are unsecured. The concentration of credit risk with respect to trade receivables is limited 
by the large number of customers in our customer base and their dispersion across various industries and geographic areas. Although 
we have a large number of customers who are dispersed across different industries and geographic areas, a prolonged economic 
downturn  could  increase  our  exposure  to  credit  risk  on  our  trade  receivables. We  perform  ongoing  credit  evaluations  of  our 
customers and maintain an allowance for potential credit losses.

117

Investment in FOX

We account for our investment in FOX using the fair value method therefore our investment in FOX  is subject to changes in the 
stock price of FOX.  FOX trades on the NASDAQ stock market under the ticker “FOXF”.  

118

ITEM 8.  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

The consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedules referred to in the index contained on page F-1 of this 
report are incorporated herein by reference.

119

ITEM 9.  CHANGES AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL 
DISCLOSURE

NONE

120

ITEM 9A.  CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

Disclosure Controls and Procedures

(a) Management’s Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

The Company’s management, with the participation of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, has 
evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as such term is defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 
15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”)) as of the end of the period covered by 
this report. Based on such evaluation, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that, 
as of December 31, 2016, the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective in recording, processing, summarizing 
and reporting, on a timely basis, information required to be disclosed by the Company in the reports that it files or submits under 
the Exchange Act and in ensuring that information required to be disclosed by the Company in such reports is accumulated and 
communicated to the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate 
to allow timely discussions regarding required disclosure.

(b) Information with respect to Report of Management on Internal Control over Financial Reporting 

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in 
Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) of the Exchange Act.  Our management assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over 
financial  reporting  as  of  December 31,  2016.    In  making  this  assessment,  our  management  used  the  criteria  set  forth  by  the 
Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”) in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013 
framework). Based on our assessment under the framework in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013 framework), our 
management concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2016. 

The audited financial statements of the Company included in this annual report on 10-K include the results of acquisitions from 
their respective dates of acquisition.  Management's assessment of internal control over financial reporting for the year ended 
December 31, 2016 does not include an assessment of 5.11 ABR Corp., a majority owned subsidiary of the Company that was 
acquired during the year ended December 31, 2016.  The financial statements of 5.11 ABR Corp. reflect total assets and revenues 
constituting 25% and 11%, respectively, of the related consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended 
December 31, 2016.  Refer to "Note C - Acquisition of Businesses" for a description of the acquisition of 5.11 ABR Corp. ("5.11").

The effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016 has been audited by Grant Thornton 
LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report that is included herein.

(c) Information with respect to Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Internal Control over Financial 
Reporting is contained on page F- 3 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K and is incorporated herein by reference. 

(d) Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting

There have not been any changes in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting (as such term is defined in Rules 
13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) during our fourth fiscal quarter to which this Annual Report on Form 10-K 
relates that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial 
reporting.

ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION

None

121

PART III

ITEM 10.  DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Information concerning our executive officers is incorporated herein by reference to information included in the Proxy Statement 
for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders.

Information with respect to our directors and the nomination process is incorporated herein by reference to information included 
in the Proxy Statement for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders.

Information  regarding  our  audit  committee  and  our  audit  committee  financial  experts  is  incorporated  herein  by  reference  to 
information included in the Proxy Statement for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders.

Information required by Item 405 of Regulation S-K is incorporated herein by reference to information included in the Proxy 
Statement for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders.

ITEM 11.  EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

Information with respect to executive compensation is incorporated herein by reference to information included in the Proxy 
Statement for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders.

ITEM 12.  SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND 
RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

Information with respect to security ownership of certain beneficial owners and management is incorporated herein by reference 
to information included in the Proxy Statement for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders.

ITEM 13.  CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR 
INDEPENDENCE

Information with respect to such contractual relationships and independence is incorporated herein by reference to the information 
in the Proxy Statement for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders.

ITEM 14.  PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

Information with respect to principal accounting fees and services and pre-approval policies are incorporated herein by reference 
to information included in the Proxy Statement for our 2017 Annual Meeting of Shareholders.

122

ITEM 15.  EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

PART IV

1.  Financial Statements

For the Registrant, see “Index to Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplemental Data” set forth on page 
F-1.

For 50%-or-less owned persons, the consolidated financial statements of FOX (14%-owned at November 16, 
2016 through December 30, 2016) are incorporated by reference in Exhibit 99.14 of this Annual Report pursuant 
to Rule 3-09 of Regulation S-X. Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting of FOX 
is not included as part of Exhibit 99.14. 

2.  Financial Statement schedule

For the Registrant, see “Index to Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplemental Data” set forth on page 
F-1.

For 50%-or-less owned persons, the consolidated financial statements of FOX (14%-owned at November 16, 
2016 through December 30, 2016) are incorporated by reference in Exhibit 99.14 of this Annual Report pursuant 
to Rule 3-09 of Regulation S-X. Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting of FOX 
is not included as part of Exhibit 99.14. 

3.  Exhibits

For the Registrant, see “Index to Exhibits” set forth on page E-1.

123

Exhibit
Number
2.1

2.2

2.3

2.4

3.1

3.2

3.3

3.4

3.5

3.6

3.7

3.8

3.9

3.10

3.11

3.12

3.13

4.1

INDEX TO EXHIBITS

Description

Stock and Note Purchase Agreement dated as of July 31, 2006, among Compass Group Diversified Holdings
LLC, Compass Group Investments, Inc. and Compass Medical Mattress Partners, LP (incorporated by reference
to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2006 (File No. 000-51937)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated June 24, 2008, among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC and the other
shareholders party thereto, Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sellers’ Representative, Aeroglide
Holdings, Inc. and Bühler AG (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on June 26, 2008
(File No. 000-51937)).

Stock Purchase Agreement, dated October 17, 2011, by and among Recruit Co., LTD. and RGF Staffing USA,
Inc., as Buyers, the shareholders of Staffmark Holdings, Inc., as Sellers, Staffmark Holdings, Inc. and Compass
Group Diversified Holdings LLC as Seller Representative (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form
8-K filed on October 18, 2011 (File No. 001-34927)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated May 1, 2012, among Candlelight Investment Holdings, Inc., Halo Holding
Corporation, Halo Lee Wayne, LLC and each of the holders of equity interests of Halo Lee Wayne, LLC listed
on Exhibit A thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 2, 2012 (File No.
001-34927)).

Certificate of Trust of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form S-1 filed
on December 14, 2005 (File No. 333-130326)).

Certificate of Amendment to Certificate of Trust of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to
Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 8-K filed on September 13, 2007 (File No. 000-51937)).

Certificate of Formation of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.3
of the Form S-1 filed on December 14, 2005 (File No. 333-130326)).

Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.5
of the Amendment No. 4 to the Form S-1 filed on April 26, 2006 (File No. 333-130326)).

Amendment No. 1 to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006, of Compass
Diversified Trust among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of New York
(Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit
4.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 29, 2007 (File No. 000-51937)).

Second Amendment to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006, as amended on
May 23, 2007, of Compass Diversified Trust among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The
Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by
reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Form 8-K filed on September 13, 2007 (File No. 000-51937)).

Third Amendment to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement dated as of April 25, 2006, as amended on
May 25, 2007 and September 14, 2007, of Compass Diversified Holdings among Compass Group Diversified
Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees
named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Form 8-K filed on December 21, 2007 (File No.
000-51937)).

Fourth Amendment dated as of November 1, 2010 to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, as amended
effective November 1, 2010, of Compass Diversified Holdings, originally effective as of April 25, 2006, by and
among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware
Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 10-Q filed
on November 8, 2010 (File No. 001-34927)).
Second Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of the Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the
Form 8-K filed on December 7, 2016 (File No. 001-34927)).
Second Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC dated
January 9, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on January 10, 2007, (File No.
000-51937)).

Third Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC dated
November 1, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Form 10-Q filed on November 8, 2010 (File
No. 001-34927)).

Fourth Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, dated
January 1, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 10-Q filed on May 7, 2013 (File No.
001-34927)).

Fifth Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of
the Form 8-K filed on December 7, 2016 (File No. 001-34927)).

Specimen Certificate evidencing a share of trust of Compass Diversified Holdings (incorporated by reference to
Exhibit 4.1 of the Form S-3 filed on November 7, 2007 (File No. 333-147218)).

124

4.2

10.1

10.2

10.3†

10.4

10.5

10.6

10.7

10.8

10.9

10.10

10.11

10.12

10.13*

10.14

10.15†

10.16

10.17

10.18

Specimen LLC Interest Certificate evidencing an interest of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit A of Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on January 10, 2007 (File No.
000-51937)).

Form of Registration Rights Agreement by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass
Diversified Trust and Certain Shareholders (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Amendment No. 5
to the Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File No. 333-130326)).

Form of Supplemental Put Agreement by and between Compass Group Management LLC and Compass Group
Diversified Holdings LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 of the Amendment No. 4 to the Form S-1
filed on April 26, 2006 (File No. 333-130326)).

Amended and Restated Employment Agreement dated as of December 1, 2008 by and between James J.
Bottiglieri and Compass Group Management LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-K
filed on December 3, 2008 (File No. 000-51937)).

Form of Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass
Diversified Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of the
Amendment No. 5 to the Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File No. 333-130326)).

Form of Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass
Diversified Trust and Pharos I LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 of the Amendment No. 5 to the
Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File No. 333-130326)).

Amended and Restated Management Services Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified
Holdings LLC, and Compass Group Management LLC, dated as of December 20, 2011 and originally effective
as of May 16, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.06 of the Form 10-K filed on March 7, 2012 (File
No. 001-34927)).

Registration Rights Agreement by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified
Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP, dated as of April 3, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of
the Amendment No. 1 to the Form S-1 filed on April 20, 2007 (File No. 333-141856)).

Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified
Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP, dated as of April 3, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.16
of the Amendment No. 1 to the Form S-1 filed on April 20, 2007 (File No. 333-141856)).

Subscription Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC,
Compass Diversified Holdings and CGI Magyar Holdings, LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of
the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011 (File No. 001-34927)).

Registration Rights Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings
LLC, Compass Diversified Holdings and CGI Magyar Holdings, LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit
10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011 (File No. 001-34927)).

Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, the financial institutions party thereto
and Bank of America, N.A., dated as of June 6, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the 8-K filed
on June 9, 2014 (File No. 001-34927)).

First Amendment to Credit Agreement dated June 29, 2015, by and among Compass Group Diversified
Holdings LLC, the Lenders signatory thereto, U.S. Bank National Association and Bank of America, N.A.
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the 8-K filed on July 2, 2015 (File No. 001-34927)).

Second Amendment to Credit Agreement dated December 15, 2015, by and among Compass Group Diversified
Holdings LLC, the Lenders signatory thereto, U.S. Bank National Association and Bank of America, N.A.

Sixth Amended and Restated Management Service Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified
Holdings LLC, and Compass Group Management LLC, dated as of September 30, 2014 and originally effective
as of May 16, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on October 7, 2014 (File
No. 001-34927)).
Employment Agreement dated July 11, 2013, between Compass Group Management LLC and Ryan J.
Faulkingham (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on July 11, 2013 (File No.
001-34927)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of July 24, 2015, by and among Vista Outdoor Inc., CBAC Holdings, LLC
and CamelBak Acquisition Corp. (incorporated by reference to exhibit 99.1 to the Company’s Current Report
on Form 8-K filed on July 27, 2015 (File No. 001-34927)).
Commitment Letter, dated August 1, 2016, from Bank of America, N.A. Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2016 (File No.
001-34927)).
Third Amendment to the Credit Agreement, dated August 15, 2016, by and among Compass Diversified
Holdings LLC, Bank of America, N.A., and the lenders thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the
Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2016 (File No. 001-34927)).

125

10.19

12.1*

21.1*

23.1*

23.2*

31.1*

31.2*
32.1*+
32.2*+
99.1

99.4

99.5

99.6

99.7

99.8

99.9

99.10

99.11

99.12

99.13

99.14

First Incremental Facility Amendment, dated August 31, 2016, by and among Compass Diversified Holdings
LLC, Bank of America, N.A., and the lenders thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-
K filed on August 1, 2016 (File No. 001-34927)).
Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Combined Fixed Charges and Preferred Distributions
List of Subsidiaries

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm with respect to the Registrant's consolidated
financial statements

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm with respect to the consolidated financial
statements of Fox Factory Holding Corp.

Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certification of Chief Executive Officer of Registrant

Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certification of Chief Financial Officer of Registrant

Section 1350 Certification of Chief Executive Officer of Registrant

Section 1350 Certification of Chief Financial Officer of Registrant

Note Purchase and Sale Agreement dated as of July 31, 2006 among Compass Group Diversified Holdings
LLC, Compass Group Investments, Inc. and Compass Medical Mattress Partners, LP (incorporated by
reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2006 (File No. 000-51937)).

Share Purchase Agreement dated January 4, 2008, among Fox Factory Holding Corp., Fox Factory, Inc. and
Robert C. Fox, Jr. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on January 8, 2008 (File No.
000-51937)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated May 8, 2008, among Mitsui Chemicals, Inc., Silvue Technologies Group, Inc.,
the stockholders of Silvue Technologies Group, Inc. and the holders of Options listed on the signature pages
thereto, and Compass Group Management LLC, as the Stockholders Representative (incorporated by reference
to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 9, 2008 (File No. 000-51937)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated March 31, 2010 by and among Gable 5, Inc., Liberty Safe and Security
Products, LLC and Liberty Safe Holding Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-
K filed on April 1, 2010 (File No. 000-51937)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated September 16, 2010, by and among ERGO Baby Intermediate Holding
Corporation, The ERGO Baby Carrier, Inc., Karin A. Frost, in her individual capacity and as Trustee of the
Revocable Trust of Karin A. Frost dated February 22, 2008 and as Trustee of the Karin A. Frost 2009 Qualified
Annuity Trust u/a/d 12/21/2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on
September 17, 2010 (File No. 000-51937)).

Securities Purchase Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among CBK Holdings, LLC, CamelBak
Products, LLC, CamelBak Acquisition Corp., for purposes of Section 6.15 and Articles 10 only, Compass
Group Diversified Holdings LLC, and for purposes of Section 6.13 and Article 10 only, IPC/CamelBak LLC
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011 (File No. 001-34927)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of March 5, 2012, by and among Arnold Magnetic Technologies Holdings
Corporation, Arnold Magnetic Technologies, LLC and AMT Acquisition Corp. (incorporated by reference to
Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on March 6, 2012 (File No. 001-34927)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of August 7, 2014, by and among CEHI Acquisition Corporation, Clean
Earth Holdings, Inc., the holders of stock and options in Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. and Littlejohn Fund III,
L.P. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the 8-K filed on August 11, 2014 (File No. 001-34927)).

Membership Interest Purchase Agreement dated as of October 10, 2014, by and among Candle Lamp Holdings,
LLC, Candle Lamp Company, LLC and Sternocandlelamp Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit
99.1 of the Form 8-K filed October 10, 2014 (File No. 001-34927)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of June 5, 2015, by and among Fresh Hemp Foods Ltd., 1037270 B.C.
Ltd., 1037269 B.C. Ltd., the Stockholders’ Representative and the Signing Stockholders (incorporated by
reference to exhibit 99.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 8, 2015 (File No.
001-34927)).
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of July 29, 2016, by and among 5.11 ABR Corp., 5.11 ABR Merger
Corp., 5.11 Acquisition Corp., TA Associates Management, L.P., as the agent and attorney in fact of the holders
of stock and options in 5.11 Acquisition Corp. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed
on August 1, 2016 (File No. 001-34927)).

Consolidated financial statements of Fox Factory Holding Corp. (incorporated by reference to the consolidated
financial statements of FOX included in FOX’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 30,
2016 filed on March 1, 2017 (File No. 001-36040).

126

101.INS*

XBRL Instance Document

101.SCH*

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document

101.CAL*

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document

101.DEF*

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document

101.LAB*

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document

101.PRE*

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document

*

†

+

Filed herewith.

Denotes management contracts and compensatory plans or arrangements.

In accordance with Item 601(b)(32)(ii) of Regulation S-K and SEC Release Nos. 33-8238 and 34-47986, Final Rule: 
Management's Reports on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting and Certification of Disclosure in Exchange Act 
Periodic Reports, the certifications furnished in Exhibit 32.1 and 32.2 hereto are deemed to accompany this Form 10-K 
and will not be deemed “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Exchange Act. Such certifications will not be deemed to 
be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, except to the extent that the 
registrant specifically incorporates it by reference.

127

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this 
to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

SIGNATURE

Date: 3/1/2017

COMPASS GROUP DIVERSIFIED HOLDINGS LLC

By:

/s/ Alan B. Offenberg

Alan B. Offenberg
Chief Executive Officer

KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Alan 
B. Offenberg and Ryan J. Faulkingham, and each of them, as his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full 
power of substitution for him or her, and in his or her name in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments to this Annual 
Report on Form 10-K, and to file the same, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the U.S. 
Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority 
to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done therewith, as fully to all intents and purposes 
as he or she might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and either of 
them, his or her substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following 
persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

Signature

/s/ Alan B. Offenberg
Alan B. Offenberg

/s/ Ryan J. Faulkingham

Ryan J. Faulkingham

/s/ C. Sean Day

C. Sean Day

/s/ D. Eugene Ewing

D. Eugene Ewing

/s/ Harold S. Edwards

Harold S. Edwards

/s/ Gordon Burns
Gordon Burns

/s/ James J. Bottiglieri

James Bottiglieri

/s/ Sarah G. McCoy
Sarah G. McCoy

Title

Chief Executive Officer

(Principal Executive Officer)
and Director

Date

March 1, 2017

Chief Financial Officer

March 1, 2017

(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

March 1, 2017

March 1, 2017

March 1, 2017

March 1, 2017

March 1, 2017

March 1, 2017

Director

Director

Director

Director

Director

Director

128

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this 
report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

SIGNATURE

Date: 3/1/2017

COMPASS DIVERSIFIED HOLDINGS

By:

/s/ Ryan J. Faulkingham

Ryan J. Faulkingham

Regular Trustee

129

Compass Diversified Holdings

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
AND SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL DATA

Historical Financial Statements:
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for the Years Ended December  31, 2016, 2015 and 2014

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Supplemental Financial Data:
The following supplementary financial data of the registrant and its subsidiaries required to be included in Item 15
(a) (2) of Form 10-K are listed below:
Schedule II – Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

All other schedules not listed above have been omitted as not applicable or because the required information is
included in the Consolidated Financial Statements or in the notes thereto.

Page
Numbers

F-2
F-3

F-4

F-5
F-6

F-7

F-9
F-11

S-1

F-1

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Board of Directors and Shareholders
Compass Diversified Holdings

We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Compass Diversified Holdings (a Delaware Trust) and 
subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2016, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control-
Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). 
The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for 
its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Report 
of Management on Internal Control over Financial Reporting (“Management’s Report”). Our responsibility is to express 
an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. Our audit of, and opinion 
on, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting does not include the internal control over financial reporting 
of 5.11 ABR Corp. (“5.11”). 5.11 is a majority owned subsidiary, whose financial statements reflect total assets and 
revenues constituting 25.4 and 11.2 percent, respectively, of the related consolidated financial statement amounts as 
of and for the year ended December 31, 2016.  As indicated in Management’s Report, 5.11 was acquired during 2016. 
Management’s  assertion  on  the  effectiveness  of  the  Company’s  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  excluded 
internal control over financial reporting of 5.11.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United 
States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether 
effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining 
an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing 
and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing 
such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable 
basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding 
the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance 
with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those 
policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly 
reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions 
are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting 
principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations 
of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely 
detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on 
the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. 
Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become 
inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may 
deteriorate.

In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as 
of December 31, 2016, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by 
COSO.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United 
States), the consolidated financial statements of the Company as of and for the year ended December 31, 2016, and 
our report dated March 1, 2017 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.

/s/ GRANT THORNTON LLP 

New York, New York
March 1, 2017 

F-2

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Board of Directors and Shareholders
Compass Diversified Holdings

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Compass Diversified Holdings (a Delaware Trust) 
and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the related consolidated statements of 
operations, comprehensive income, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended 
December 31, 2016. Our audits of the basic consolidated financial statements included the financial statement schedule 
listed in the index appearing under Item 15(a)(2). These financial statements and financial statement schedule are the 
responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements 
and financial statement schedule based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United 
States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the 
financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting 
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles 
used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. 
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In  our  opinion,  the  consolidated  financial  statements  referred  to  above  present  fairly,  in  all  material  respects,  the 
financial position of Compass Diversified Holdings and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, and the results 
of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2016 in conformity 
with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the related financial 
statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents 
fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United 
States), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2016, based on criteria established 
in the 2013 Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the 
Treadway Commission (COSO), and our report dated March 1, 2017 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

/s/ GRANT THORNTON LLP 

New York, New York
March 1, 2017

F-3

Compass Diversified Holdings
Consolidated Balance Sheets

(in thousands)

Assets

Current assets:

Cash and cash equivalents

Accounts receivable, net

Inventories

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

Current assets of discontinued operations

Total current assets

Property, plant and equipment, net

Investment in FOX (refer to Note F)

Goodwill

Intangible assets, net

Other non-current assets

Non-current assets of discontinued operations

Total assets

Liabilities and stockholders’ equity

Current liabilities:

Accounts payable

Accrued expenses

Due to related parties (refer to Note R)

Current portion, long-term debt

Other current liabilities

Current liabilities of discontinued operations

Total current liabilities

Deferred income taxes

Long-term debt

Other non-current liabilities

Non-current liabilities of discontinued operations

Total liabilities

Stockholders’ equity

Trust common shares, no par value, 500,000 authorized; 59,900 shares issued and outstanding at
December 31, 2016 and 54,300 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2015

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

Accumulated earnings (deficit)

Total stockholders’ equity attributable to Holdings

Noncontrolling interest

Noncontrolling interest of discontinued operations

Total stockholders’ equity

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-4

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

$

39,772

$

181,191

212,984

18,872

—

452,819

142,370

141,767

491,637

539,211

9,351

—

85,240

105,910

59,905

21,536

18,772

291,363

115,948

249,747

390,655

350,687

9,819

12,823

$

$

1,777,155

$

1,421,042

61,512

$

91,041

20,848

5,685

23,435

—

202,521

110,838

551,652

17,600

—

882,611

924,680

(9,515)

(58,760)

856,405

38,139

—

894,544

46,140

43,767

5,863

3,250

9,004

8,455

116,479

103,635

308,639

18,960

110

547,823

825,321

(9,804)

10,567

826,084

46,219

916

873,219

$

1,777,155

$

1,421,042

Compass Diversified Holdings
Consolidated Statements of Operations

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

789,312

$

552,592

$

(in thousands, except per share data)

Net sales

Service revenues

Total net revenues

Cost of sales

Cost of service revenues

Gross profit

Operating expenses:

Selling, general and administrative expense

Management fees

Amortization expense

Impairment expense

Loss on disposal of assets

Operating income

Other income (expense):

Interest expense, net

Gain on investment (refer to Note F)

Gain on deconsolidation of subsidiary (refer to Note F)

Amortization of debt issuance costs

Loss on debt extinguishment

Other expense, net

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

Provision for income taxes

Income from continuing operations

Income from discontinued operations, net of income tax

Gain on sale of discontinued operations, net of income tax

Net income

Less: Income from continuing operations attributable to noncontrolling interest

Less: Income (loss) from discontinued operations attributable to noncontrolling
interest

Net income attributable to Holdings

Amounts attributable to Holdings:

Income from continuing operations

Income from discontinued operations, net of income tax

Gain on sale of discontinued operations, net of income tax

Net income attributable to Holdings

Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share attributable to Holdings (refer to
Note N)

Continuing operations

Discontinued operations

Weighted average number of shares outstanding - basic and fully diluted

Cash distribution declared per share (refer to Note N)

188,997

978,309

517,072

134,667

326,570

217,830

29,406

35,069

16,000

9,204

19,061

(24,651)

74,490

—

(2,763)

—

(2,919)

63,218

9,469

53,749

473

2,308

56,530

1,961

175,386

727,978

362,064

125,178

240,736

136,399

25,658

28,761

—

—

568,235

68,440

636,675

382,905

48,753

205,017

128,190

21,872

23,063

—

—

49,918

31,892

(25,924)

4,533

—

(2,212)

—

(2,323)

23,992

15,001

8,991

6,981

149,798

165,770

5,133

(27,060)

11,029

264,325

(2,243)

(2,143)

(677)

275,123

5,046

270,077

21,078

—

291,155

11,661

(116)

(1,201)

659

54,685

$

161,838

$

278,835

51,788

$

3,858

$

589

2,308

8,182

149,798

258,416

20,419

—

54,685

$

161,838

$

278,835

0.46

$

0.05

0.51

$

(0.30) $

2.91

2.61

$

4.98

0.40

5.38

54,591

54,300

49,089

1.44

$

1.44

$

1.44

$

$

$

$

$

$

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-5

Compass Diversified Holdings
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income

(in thousands)

Net income

Other comprehensive income (loss)

Foreign currency translation adjustments

Pension benefit liability, net

Total comprehensive income, net of tax

Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

Less: Other comprehensive income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling interests

Year ended December 31,
2015

2014

2016

$

56,530

$

165,770

$

291,155

615

(326)

56,819

1,845

516

(7,733)

471

158,508

3,932

(1,624)

(1,959)

(1,276)

287,920

12,320

(107)

Total comprehensive income attributable to Holdings, net of tax

$

54,458

$

156,200

$

275,707

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-6

l
a
t
o
T

l

’
s
r
e
d
o
h
k
c
o
t
S

y
t
i
u
q
E

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
-
n
o
N

.
c
s
i
D

f
o
t
s
e
r
e
t
n

I

.
s
p
O

-
n
o
N

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
C

t
s
e
r
e
t
n

I

l

’
s
r
e
d
o
h
k
c
o
t
S

y
t
i
u
q
E

o
t

.

b
i
r
t
t

A

i

s
g
n
d
o
H

l

s
g
n
i
d
l
o
H
d
e
i
f
i
s
r
e
v
i
D
s
s
a
p
m
o
C

y
t
i
u
q
E

’
s
r
e
d
l
o
h
k
c
o
t
S
f
o
s
t
n
e
m
e
t
a
t
S
d
e
t
a
d
i
l
o
s
n
o
C

r
e
h
t
O

.

m
u
c
c
A

e
v

i

s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
C

)
s
s
o
L
(

e
m
o
c
n

I

l

d
e
t
a
u
m
u
c
c
A

t
i

c

i
f
e
D

t
n
u
o
m
A

f
o
r
e
b
m
u
N

n
o
m
m
o
C

s
e
r
a
h
S

5
5
1
,
1
9
2

9
5
6

1
6
6
,
1
1

5
3
8
,
8
7
2

—

5
3
8
,
8
7
2

)
5
3
2
,
3
(

8
6
8
,
9
9

)
7
8
2
,
7
7
(

5
7
2
,
2

)
0
7
8
,
1
1
(

—

5
4
0
,
8

)
2
5
5
,
9
6
(

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

5
6
9

)
8
2
9
,
6
7
(

)
9
5
3
(

—

—

)
5
3
2
,
3
(

8
6
8
,
9
9

—

5
7
2
,
2

)
9
5
3
(

0
8
0
,
7

—

—

)
0
7
8
,
1
1
(

—

9
5
3

)
2
5
5
,
9
6
(

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

)
5
3
2
,
3
(

—

—

—

)
9
5
3
(

—

9
5
3

)
0
7
8
,
1
1
(

)
2
5
5
,
9
6
(

—

—

—

—

8
6
8
,
9
9

0
0
0
,
6

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

5
3
9
,
8
6
5

$

2
1
3
,
6
1

$

8
3
2
,
9
7

$

5
8
3
,
3
7
4

$

3
9
6

$

)
1
6
7
,
2
5
2
(

$

3
5
4
,
5
2
7

$

0
0
3
,
8
4

4
3
3
,
8
0
8

$

6
3
9
,
7
1

$

7
6
9
,
2
2

$

1
3
4
,
7
6
7

$

)
2
4
5
,
2
(

$

)
8
4
3
,
5
5
(

$

1
2
3
,
5
2
8

$

0
0
3
,
4
5

)
2
6
2
,
7
(

0
7
7
,
5
6
1

6
3
7
,
3

0
0
5

8
3
6
,
7

)
4
8
2
(

1
1
8
,
6

)
1
0
1
,
6
1
(

)
1
3
7
,
7
1
(

)
2
9
1
,
8
7
(

—

6
6
5

—

—

)
1
0
2
,
1
(

)
4
8
2
(

)
1
0
1
,
6
1
(

—

—

—

—

3
3
1
,
5

0
7
1
,
3

0
0
5

8
3
6
,
7

—

—

—

—

1
1
8
,
6

8
3
8
,
1
6
1

—

8
3
8
,
1
6
1

—

—

—

—

—

—

)
1
3
7
,
7
1
(

)
2
9
1
,
8
7
(

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

)
2
6
2
,
7
(

)
2
6
2
,
7
(

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

)
1
3
7
,
7
1
(

)
2
9
1
,
8
7
(

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

9
1
2
,
3
7
8

$

6
1
9

$

9
1
2
,
6
4

$

4
8
0
,
6
2
8

$

)
4
0
8
,
9
(

$

7
6
5
,
0
1

$

1
2
3
,
5
2
8

$

0
0
3
,
4
5

7
-
F

s
t
s
o
c

g
n
i
r
e
f
f
o

f
o

t
e
n

,
s
e
r
a
h
s

n
o
m
m
o
c

t
s
u
r
T

f
o

e
c
n
a
u
s
s
I

t
e
n

,
)
s
s
o
l
(

e
m
o
c
n

i

i

e
v
s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
c

l

a
t
o
T

4
1
0
2

,
1

y
r
a
u
n
a
J
—
e
c
n
a
l
a
B

e
m
o
c
n

i

t
e
N

)
s
d
n
a
s
u
o
h
t

n
i
(

s
r
e
d
o
h

l

t
s
e
r
e
t
n

i

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
n
o
n

)
F
e
t
o
N
o
t

r
e
f
e
r
(

i

y
r
a
d
s
b
u
s

i

f
o

n
o
i
t
a
d

i
l

o
s
n
o
c
e
d

f
o

t
c
e
f
f

E

h
t
r
a
E
n
a
e
C
m
o
r
f

l

s
d
e
e
c
o
r
P

)

N
e
t
o
N
o
t

r
e
f
e
r
(

s
r
e
d
o
h

l

t
s
e
r
e
t
n
I

n
o
i
t
a
c
o

l
l

A
o
t

n
o
i
t
u
b
i
r
t
s
D

i

l

s
r
e
d
o
h
e
r
a
h
s

l

s
r
e
d
o
h
e
r
a
h
s

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
n
o
n

o
t

l

e
b
a
t
u
b
i
r
t
t
a

y
t
i
v
i
t
c
a

n
o
i
t
p
O

i

e
s
c
r
e
x
e

n
o
i
t
p
o

k
c
o
t
s

i

y
r
a
d
s
b
u
s

i

f
o

t
c
e
f
f

E

4
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
—
e
c
n
a
l
a
B

e
m
o
c
n

i

t
e
N

t
e
n

,
s
s
o

l

i

e
v
s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
c

l

a
t
o
T

i

d
a
p

s
n
o
i
t
u
b
i
r
t
s
D

i

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
n
o
n

o
t

l

e
b
a
t
u
b
i
r
t
t
a

y
t
i
v
i
t
c
a

n
o
i
t
p
O

i

e
s
c
r
e
x
e

n
o
i
t
p
o

k
c
o
t
s

i

y
r
a
d
s
b
u
s

i

f
o

t
c
e
f
f

E

I

C
O
H

-

l

s
r
e
d
o
h
e
r
a
h
s

l

s
r
e
d
o
h
e
r
a
h
s

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
n
o
n

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
n
o
n

t
s
e
v
r
a
H
a
b
o
t
i
n
a
M
m
o
r
f

s
d
e
e
c
o
r
P

l

k
a
B
e
m
a
C

f
o

n
o
i
t
i
s
o
p
s
D

i

e
r
u
t
i
n
r
u
F
n
a
c
i
r
e
m
A

f
o

n
o
i
t
i
s
o
p
s
D

i

t
s
e
v
r
a
H
a
b
o
t
i
n
a
M
m
o
r
f

s
d
e
e
c
o
r
P

)

N
e
t
o
N
o
t

r
e
f
e
r
(

s
r
e
d
o
h

l

t
s
e
r
e
t
n
I

n
o
i
t
a
c
o

l
l

A
o
t

n
o
i
t
u
b
i
r
t
s
D

i

5
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
—
e
c
n
a
l
a
B

i

d
a
p

s
n
o
i
t
u
b
i
r
t
s
D

i

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
s
g
n
i
d
l
o
H
d
e
i
f
i
s
r
e
v
i
D
s
s
a
p
m
o
C

y
t
i
u
q
E

’
s
r
e
d
l
o
h
k
c
o
t
S
f
o
s
t
n
e
m
e
t
a
t
S
d
e
t
a
d
i
l
o
s
n
o
C

9
1
2
,
3
7
8

$

6
1
9

$

9
1
2
,
6
4

$

4
8
0
,
6
2
8

$

)
4
0
8
,
9
(

$

7
6
5
,
0
1

$

1
2
3
,
5
2
8

$

0
0
3
,
4
5

)
d
e
u
n
i
t
n
o
c
(

5
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
—
e
c
n
a
l
a
B

9
8
2

0
3
5
,
6
5

9
5
3
,
9
9

2
8
3
,
4

5
5
7
,
3

3
6
1
,
1

1
0
2
,
8

)
0
4
8
,
6
1
(

)
6
7
4
,
1
(

)
3
5
2
,
5
(

)
7
7
3
,
8
1
(

)
1
0
8
(

8
1
7
,
5

)
9
7
7
,
3
2
(

)
4
5
3
,
3
1
(

)
2
9
1
,
8
7
(

4
4
5
,
4
9
8

$

—

—

1

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

)
6
1
1
(

—

—

—

—

)
1
0
8
(

—

—

1
6
9
,
1

1
8
3
,
4

3
3
3
,
4

3
6
1
,
1

2
9
3
3

,

)
9
2
9
,
4
(

)
9
6
4
(

)
3
5
2
,
5
(

)
7
7
3
,
8
1
(

8
1
7
,
5

—

—

—

5
8
6
,
4
5

9
8
2

9
5
3
,
9
9

—

—

)
8
7
5
(

9
0
8
,
4

)
1
1
9
,
1
1
(

)
7
0
0
,
1
(

—

—

—

—

)
9
7
7
,
3
2
(

)
4
5
3

,

3
1
(

)
2
9
1
,
8
7
(

—

9
8
2

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

5
8
6
,
4
5

—

)
8
7
5
(

9
0
8
,
4

)
1
1
9
,
1
1
(

)
7
0
0
,
1
(

—

—

—

)
9
7
7
,
3
2
(

)
4
5
3
,
3
1
(

)
2
9
1
,
8
7
(

—

—

—

—

9
5
3
,
9
9

0
0
6
,
5

s
t
s
o
c

g
n
i
r
e
f
f
o

f
o

t
e
n

,
s
e
r
a
h
s

n
o
m
m
o
c

t
s
u
r
T

f
o

e
c
n
a
u
s
s
I

t
e
n

,
e
m
o
c
n

i

i

e
v
s
n
e
h
e
r
p
m
o
c

l

a
t
o
T

e
m
o
c
n

i

t
e
N

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

)

N
e
t
o
N
o
t

r
e
f
e
r
(

s
r
e
d
o
H

l

t
s
e
r
e
t
n
I

n
o
i
t
a
c
o

l
l

A
o
t

l

e
b
a
y
a
p

s
n
o
i
t
u
b
i
r
t
s
D

i

i

d
a
p

s
n
o
i
t
u
b
i
r
t
s
D

i

)

N
e
t
o
N
o
t

r
e
f
e
r
(

s
r
e
d
o
H

l

t
s
e
r
e
t
n
I

n
o
i
t
a
c
o

l
l

A
o
t

n
o
i
t
u
b
i
r
t
s
D

i

i

n
e
d
i
r
T

f
o

n
o
i
t
i
s
o
p
s
D

i

1
1
.
5

f
o

n
o
i
t
i
s
u
q
c
A

i

y
t
r
e
b
L

i

I

C
A

-

-

l

s
r
e
d
o
h
e
r
a
h
s

l

s
r
e
d
o
h
e
r
a
h
s

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
n
o
n

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
n
o
n

o
t

s
n
o
i
t
u
b
i
r
t
s
D

i

o
t

s
n
o
i
t
u
b
i
r
t
s
D

i

l

s
r
e
d
o
h
e
r
a
h
s

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
n
o
n

o
t

l

e
b
a
t
u
b
i
r
t
t
a

y
t
i
v
i
t
c
a

n
o
i
t
p
O

i

e
s
c
r
e
x
e

n
o
i
t
p
o

k
c
o
t
s

i

y
r
a
d
s
b
u
s

i

f
o

t
c
e
f
f

E

n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c

k
c
o
t
s

n
o

t
i
f
e
n
e
b

x
a
t

s
s
e
c
x
E

o
g
r
E

-

s
e
r
a
h
s

i

y
r
a
d
s
b
u
s

i

f
o

e
s
a
h
c
r
u
p
e
R

o
g
r
E

-

s
e
r
a
h
s

i

y
r
a
d
s
b
u
s

i

f
o

e
c
n
a
u
s
s
I

y
t
r
e
b
L

i

-

t
s
e
r
e
t
n

i

g
n

i
l
l

o
r
t
n
o
c
n
o
n

f
o

e
s
a
h
c
r
u
P

8
-
F

.
s
t
n
e
m
e
t
a
t
s

l
a
i
c
n
a
n
i
f

d
e
t
a
d
i
l
o
s
n
o
c

o
t

s
e
t
o
n

e
e
S

$

9
3
1
,
8
3

$

5
0
4
,
6
5
8

$

)
5
1
5
,
9
(

$

)
0
6
7
,
8
5
(

$

0
8
6
,
4
2
9

$

0
0
9
,
9
5

6
1
0
2

,
1
3

r
e
b
m
e
c
e
D
—
e
c
n
a
l
a
B

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Compass Diversified Holdings
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(in thousands)

Cash flows from operating activities:

Net income

Income from discontinued operations

Gain on sale of discontinued operations

Net income from continuing operations

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating
activities:

Depreciation expense

Amortization expense

Amortization of debt issuance costs and original issue discount

Impairment expense

Loss on disposal of assets

Loss on debt extinguishment

Unrealized loss on interest rate swap

Noncontrolling stockholder stock based compensation

Net gain on deconsolidation of subsidiary - FOX

Gain on equity method investment

Excess tax benefit from subsidiary stock options exercised

Deferred taxes

Other

Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of acquisitions:

(Increase) decrease in accounts receivable

(Increase) decrease in inventories

Decrease in prepaid expenses and other current assets

Increase (decrease) in accounts payable and accrued expenses

Net cash provided by operating activities - continuing operations

Net cash provided by operating activities - discontinued operations

Net cash provided by operations

Cash flows from investing activities:

Acquisitions, net of cash acquired

Purchases of property and equipment

Proceeds from the FOX stock offering

Proceeds from sale of businesses

Purchase of noncontrolling interest

Payment of interest rate swap

Other investing activities

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

56,530

$

165,770

$

473

2,308

53,749

26,853

58,752

3,565

16,000

9,204

—

1,539

4,382

—

(74,490)

(1,163)

(9,868)

1,868

(15,596)

2,893

4,850

25,148

107,686

3,686

111,372

(536,175)

(23,969)

182,470

11,249

(1,475)

(4,303)

(10)

6,981

149,798

8,991

21,231

31,844

2,883

—

—

—

5,662

3,171

—

(4,533)

—

(4,333)

(44)

13,243

(1,810)

805

(8,108)

69,002

15,546

84,548

(130,292)

(15,661)

—

385,510

—

(2,007)

(104)

291,155

21,078

—

270,077

14,644

25,107

3,125

—

—

2,143

7,722

3,779

(264,325)

(11,029)

(1,662)

(10,124)

1,365

(10,675)

14,859

190

(8,948)

36,248

34,447

70,695

(474,657)

(10,015)

65,528

2,001

—

(2,008)

(381)

Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities - continuing
operations
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities - discontinued
operations

Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities

(372,213)

237,446

(419,532)

9,192

(363,021)

(3,566)

233,880

(5,221)

(424,753)

F-9

Compass Diversified Holdings
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Cash flows from financing activities:

Proceeds from the issuance of Trust common shares, net

Borrowings under credit facility

Repayments under credit facility

Distributions paid

Net proceeds provided by noncontrolling shareholders

Distributions paid to noncontrolling shareholders

Distributions paid to noncontrolling shareholders - Allocation Interests

Repurchase of subsidiary stock

Debt issuance costs

Excess tax benefit on stock-based compensation

Other

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

Foreign currency impact on cash

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents — beginning of period (1)

Cash and cash equivalents — end of period

99,359

671,298

(423,240)

(78,192)

8,887

(23,630)

(23,779)

(15,407)

(5,986)

1,163

(1,747)

208,726

(3,174)

(46,097)

85,869

—

197,000

(369,975)

(78,192)

14,949

—

(17,731)

—

(440)

—

32

(254,357)

(1,905)

62,166

23,703

$

39,772

$

85,869

$

99,868

677,000

(426,275)

(69,552)

4,025

—

(11,870)

—

(7,370)

1,662

(2,001)

265,487

(955)

(89,526)

113,229

23,703

(1) Includes cash from discontinued operations of $0.6 million at January 1, 2016, $1.8 million at January 1, 2015, and $2.8 
million at January 1, 2014.  

See notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-10

Compass Diversified Holdings
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
December 31, 2016 

Note A — Organization and Business Operations

Compass Diversified Holdings, a Delaware statutory trust (“the Trust”), was incorporated in Delaware on November 18, 2005. 
Compass  Group  Diversified  Holdings,  LLC,  a  Delaware  limited  liability  Company  (the  “Company”),  was  also  formed  on 
November 18, 2005 with equity interests which were subsequently reclassified as the “Allocation Interests”. The Trust and the 
Company were formed to acquire and manage a group of small and middle-market businesses headquartered in North America. 
In accordance with the amended and restated Trust Agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006 (the “Trust Agreement”), the Trust is 
sole owner of 100% of the Trust Interests (as defined in the Company’s amended and restated operating agreement, dated as of 
April 25, 2006 (as amended and restated, the “LLC Agreement”)) of the Company and, pursuant to the LLC Agreement, the 
Company has, outstanding, the identical number of Trust Interests as the number of outstanding common shares of the Trust. 
Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company is the operating entity with a board of directors 
and other corporate governance responsibilities, similar to that of a Delaware corporation.

The Company is a controlling owner of eight businesses, or operating segments at December 31, 2016. The segments are as follows: 
5.11 Acquisition Corp. ("5.11" or "5.11 Tactical"), The Ergo Baby Carrier, Inc. (“Ergobaby”), Liberty Safe and Security Products, 
Inc. (“Liberty Safe” or “Liberty”), Fresh Hemp Foods Ltd. ("Manitoba Harvest"), Compass AC Holdings, Inc. (“ACI” or “Advanced 
Circuits”), AMT Acquisition Corporation (“Arnold” or “Arnold Magnetics”), Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. ("Clean Earth"), and 
Sterno Products, LLC (“Sterno” or "Sterno Products"). The segments are referred to interchangeably as “businesses”, “operating 
segments” or “subsidiaries” throughout the financial statements. Refer to Note E - "Operating Segment Data" for further discussion 
of the operating segments. The Company also owns a non-controlling interest of approximately 14% in Fox Factory Holding Corp. 
(“FOX”).  Compass Group Management LLC, a Delaware limited liability Company (“CGM” or the “Manager”), manages the 
day to day operations of the Company and oversees the management and operations of our businesses pursuant to a management 
services agreement (“MSA”).

Note B — Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Accounting principles

The Company’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the 
United States of America (US GAAP).

Basis of presentation

The results of operations for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 represent the results of operations of the Company’s 
acquired businesses from the date of their acquisition by the Company, and therefore are not indicative of the results to be expected 
for the full year.

Principles of consolidation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Trust and the Company, as well as the businesses acquired as 
of their respective acquisition date. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. 
Discontinued operating entities are reflected as discontinued operations in the Company’s results of operations and statements of 
financial position.

The acquisition of businesses that the Company owns or controls more than a 50% share of the voting interest are accounted for 
under the acquisition method of accounting. The amount assigned to the identifiable assets acquired and the liabilities assumed is 
based on the estimated fair values as of the date of acquisition, with the remainder, if any, recorded as goodwill.  

Discontinued Operations

The Company completed the sale of its majority owned subsidiary, Tridien Medical, Inc. ("Tridien") during the third quarter of 
2016, the sale of its majority owned subsidiary CamelBak Products, LLC ("CamelBak") in the third quarter of 2015 and the sale 
of its majority owned subsidiary, American Furniture Manufacturing, Inc. ("AFM" or "American Furniture"), during the fourth 
quarter of 2015.  The results of operations of Tridien are presented as discontinued operations in the consolidated statements of 
operations for all periods presented.  The results of operations of CamelBak and American Furniture are presented as discontinued 

F-11

operations in the consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014.  In addition, the assets 
and liabilities associated with  Tridien have been reclassified as discontinued operations in the consolidated balance sheets as of 
December 31, 2015.  Refer to "Note D - Discontinued Operations" for additional information.  Unless otherwise indicated, the 
disclosures accompanying the consolidated financial statements reflect the Company's continuing operations.  

Use of estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with US GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions 
that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial 
statements  and  the  reported  amounts  of  revenues  and  expenses  during  the  reporting  period.  These  estimates  are  based  on 
management’s best knowledge of current events and actions the Company may undertake in the future. It is possible that in 2017 
actual conditions could be better or worse than anticipated when the Company developed the estimates and assumptions, which 
could materially affect the results of operations and financial position in the future. Such changes could result in future impairment 
of goodwill, intangibles and long-lived assets, inventory obsolescence, establishment of valuation allowances on deferred tax 
assets and increased tax liabilities, among other things. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Profit Allocation Interests

At the time of the Company's Initial Public Offering, the Company issued Allocation Interests governed by the LLC agreement 
that entitle the holders (the "Holders") to receive distributions pursuant to a profit allocation formula upon the occurrence of certain 
events.  The Holders are entitled to receive and as such can elect to receive the positive contribution based profit allocation payment 
for each of the business acquisitions during the 30-day period following the fifth anniversary of the date upon which the Company 
acquired a controlling interest in that business (Holding Event) and upon the sale of that business (Sale Event).  Payments of profit 
allocation to the Holders are accounted for as dividends declared on Allocation Interests and recorded in stockholders' equity once 
they are approved by our Board of Directors.  

Revenue recognition

The Company records revenue for goods and services when persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery of the product 
or performance of services has occurred, and collectability of the fixed or determinable sales price is reasonably assured.  Revenue 
is  recognized  upon  shipment  of  product  to  the  customer  or  performance  of  services  for  a  customer,  net  of  sales  returns  and 
allowances. Appropriate reserves are established for anticipated returns and allowances based on historical experience.  Shipping 
and handling costs are charged to operations when incurred and are generally classified as a component of cost of sales.  Taxes 
collected from customers and remitted to governmental authorities are presented on a net basis in the accompanying Consolidated 
Statements of Operations. Revenue is typically recorded at F.O.B. shipping point for all of our businesses.  

Service revenue

Revenue from the Company's Clean Earth business is recognized as services are rendered, generally when material is received at 
Clean Earth's facilities.  

Cash equivalents

The Company considers all highly liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less to be cash equivalents.  At 
December 31, 2016 and 2015, the amount of cash and cash equivalents held by our subsidiaries in foreign bank accounts was 
$16.7 million and $10.9 million, respectively.   

Allowance for doubtful accounts

The Company uses estimates to determine the amount of the allowance for doubtful accounts in order to reduce accounts receivable 
to their estimated net realizable value. The Company estimates the amount of the required allowance by reviewing the status of 
past-due receivables and analyzing historical bad debt trends. The Company’s estimate also includes analyzing existing economic 
conditions. When the Company becomes aware of circumstances that may impair a specific customer’s ability to meet its financial 
obligations subsequent to the original sale, the Company will record an allowance against amounts due, and thereby reduce the 
net receivable to the amount it reasonably believes will be collectible.  Balances that remain outstanding after the Company has 
used reasonable collection efforts are written off through a charge to the valuation allowance and a credit to accounts receivable.  

F-12

Inventories

Inventories consist of raw materials, work-in-process, manufactured goods and purchased goods acquired for resale. Inventories 
are stated at the lower of cost or market, determined on the first-in, first-out method. Cost includes raw materials, direct labor, 
manufacturing overhead and indirect overhead. Market value is based on current replacement cost for raw materials and supplies 
and on net realizable value for finished goods.

Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment is recorded at cost. The cost of major additions or betterments is capitalized, while maintenance 
and repairs that do not improve or extend the useful lives of the related assets are expensed as incurred.

Depreciation is provided principally on the straight-line method over estimated useful lives. Leasehold improvements are amortized 
over the life of the lease or the life of the improvement, whichever is shorter.

The ranges of useful lives are as follows:

Buildings and improvements

Machinery and equipment

Office furniture, computers and software

Leasehold improvements

15 to 25 years

2 to 20 years

2 to 8 years

Shorter of useful life or lease term

Property, plant and equipment and other long-lived assets that have definitive lives are evaluated for impairment when events or 
changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of the assets may not be recoverable (‘triggering event’). Upon the 
occurrence of a triggering event, the asset is reviewed to assess whether the estimated undiscounted cash flows expected from the 
use of the asset plus residual value from the ultimate disposal exceeds the carrying value of the asset. If the carrying value exceeds 
the estimated recoverable amounts, the asset is written down to its fair value.

Fair value of financial instruments

The carrying value of the Company’s financial instruments, including cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable and accounts 
payable approximate their fair value due to their short term nature. Term Debt with a carrying value of $561.0 million, net of 
original issue discount, at December 31, 2016 approximated fair value. The fair value is based on interest rates that are currently 
available to the Company for issuance of debt with similar terms and remaining maturities. If measured at fair value in the financial 
statements, the Term Debt would be classified as Level 2 in the fair value hierarchy.

Business combinations

The Company allocates the amount it pays for each acquisition to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on their fair 
values at the date of acquisition, including identifiable intangible assets which arise from a contractual or legal right or are separable 
from goodwill. The Company bases the fair value of identifiable intangible assets acquired in a business combination on detailed 
valuations that use information and assumptions provided by management, which consider management’s best estimates of inputs 
and assumptions that a market participant would use. The Company allocates any excess purchase price that exceeds the fair value 
of the net tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired to goodwill. The use of alternative valuation assumptions, including 
estimated growth rates, cash flows, discount rates and estimated useful lives could result in different purchase price allocations 
and  amortization  expense  in  current  and  future  periods. Transaction  costs  associated  with  these  acquisitions  are  expensed  as 
incurred through selling, general and administrative expense on the consolidated statement of operations.  In those circumstances 
where an acquisition involves a contingent consideration arrangement, the Company recognizes a liability equal to the fair value 
of the contingent payments expected to be made as of the acquisition date.  The Company re-measures this liability each reporting 
period and records changes in the fair value through a separate line item within the consolidated statements of operations.

Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed. The Company 
is required to perform impairment reviews at each of its reporting units annually and more frequently in certain circumstances.

In accordance with accounting guidelines, the Company is able to make a qualitative assessment of whether it is more likely than 
not that a reporting unit’s fair value is less than its carrying amount before applying the two-step goodwill impairment test. If a 

F-13

company concludes that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is not less than its carrying amount it is not 
required to perform the two-step impairment test for that reporting unit.

The first step of the process after the qualitative assessment fails is estimating the fair value of each of its reporting units based 
on a discounted cash flow (“DCF”) model using revenue and profit forecast and a market approach which compares peer data and 
earnings multiples. The Company then compares those estimated fair values with the carrying values, which include allocated 
goodwill. If the estimated fair value is less than the carrying value, a second step is performed to compute the amount of the 
impairment by determining an “implied fair value” of goodwill. The determination of a reporting unit’s “implied fair value” of 
goodwill requires the allocation of the estimated fair value of the reporting unit to the assets and liabilities of the reporting unit. 
Any unallocated fair value represents the “implied fair value” of goodwill, which is then compared to its corresponding carrying 
value. The Company cannot predict the occurrence of certain future events that might adversely affect the implied value of goodwill 
and/or the fair value of intangible assets. Such events include, but are not limited to, strategic decisions made in response to 
economic and competitive conditions, the impact of the economic environment on its customer base, and material adverse effects 
in relationships with significant customers.

The impact of over-estimating or under-estimating the implied fair value of goodwill at any of the reporting units could have a 
material effect on the results of operations and financial position. In addition, the value of the implied goodwill is subject to the 
volatility of the Company’s operations which may result in significant fluctuation in the value assigned at any point in time.

Refer to "Note H - Goodwill and Intangible Assets" for the results of the annual impairment tests.

Deferred debt issuance costs

Deferred debt issuance costs represent the costs associated with the issuance of debt instruments and are amortized over the life 
of the related debt instrument.  The Company adopted new guidance effective January 1, 2016 that requires debt issuance costs 
to be presented in the balance sheet as a deduction from the carrying value of the associated debt liability rather than as an asset. 

Product Warranty Costs

The Company recognizes warranty costs based on an estimate of the amounts required to meet future warranty obligations.  The 
Company accrues an estimated liability for exposure to warranty claims at the time of a product sale based on both current and 
historical claim trends and warranty costs incurred.  Warranty reserves are included within "Accrued expenses" in the Company's 
consolidated balance sheets.

Foreign currency

Certain of the Company’s segments have operations outside the United States, and the local currency is typically the functional 
currency.  The financial statements are translated into U.S. dollars using exchange rates in effect at year-end for assets and liabilities 
and average exchange rates during the year for results of operations. The resulting translation gain or loss is included in stockholder’s 
equity as other comprehensive income or loss.

In 2015, the Company acquired a Canadian subsidiary, Manitoba Harvest, and is exposed to transactional foreign currency gains 
and losses related to the issuance of intercompany loans in the Canadian dollar, the functional currency of Manitoba Harvest. 
Foreign currency transactional gains and losses are included in the results of operations and are generally classified as Other 
Income (Expense). 

Derivatives and hedging

The Company utilizes interest rate swaps (derivative) to manage risks related to interest rates on the term loan portion of their 
Credit Facility.  The Company has not elected hedge accounting treatment for the existing interest rate derivatives entered into as 
part of the Credit Facility. Refer to "Note J - Debt" for more information on the Company’s Credit Facility.

Noncontrolling interest

Noncontrolling  interest  represents  the  portion  of  a  majority-owned  subsidiary’s  net  income  that  is  owned  by  noncontrolling 
shareholders.  Noncontrolling interest on the balance sheet represents the portion of equity in a consolidated subsidiary owned by 
noncontrolling shareholders.

F-14

Deferred income taxes

Deferred income taxes are calculated under the asset and liability method. Deferred income taxes are provided for the differences 
between the basis of assets and liabilities for financial reporting and income tax purposes at the enacted tax rates. A valuation 
allowance is established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount that is expected to more likely than not be 
realized. Several of the Company’s majority owned subsidiaries have deferred tax assets recorded at December 31, 2016 which 
in total amount to approximately $45.4 million. This deferred tax asset is net of $7.3 million of valuation allowance primarily 
associated with net operating losses and foreign tax credits at Arnold and 5.11.  These deferred tax assets are comprised primarily 
of reserves not currently deductible for tax purposes. The temporary differences that have resulted in the recording of these tax 
assets may be used to offset taxable income in future periods, reducing the amount of taxes required to be paid. Realization of the 
deferred tax assets is dependent on generating sufficient future taxable income at those subsidiaries with deferred tax assets. Based 
upon the expected future results of operations, the Company believes it is more likely than not that those subsidiaries with deferred 
tax assets will generate sufficient future taxable income to realize the benefit of existing temporary differences, although there 
can be no assurance of this. The impact of not realizing these deferred tax assets would result in an increase in income tax expense 
for such period when the determination was made that the assets are not realizable.

Earnings per share

Basic and fully diluted earnings per share is computed using the two-class method which requires companies to allocate participating 
securities that have rights to earnings that otherwise would have been available only to common shareholders as a separate class 
of securities in calculating earnings per share. The Company has granted Allocation Interests that contain participating rights to 
receive profit allocations upon the occurrence of a Holding Event or a Sale Event.

The calculation of basic and fully diluted earnings per share reflects the effect of dividends that were declared and paid to the 
Holders subsequent to the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement and the incremental increase in the profit allocation 
distribution to the Holders related to Holding Events during the period. 

 The weighted average number of Trust common shares outstanding for fiscal 2016 was computed based on 54,300,000 shares 
outstanding for the period from January 1st through December 13th and 5,600,000 additional shares outstanding for the period from 
December 13th through December 31st.  The weighted average number of Trust common shares outstanding for 2015 was computed 
based on 54,300,000 shares outstanding for the period from January 1st through December 31st.  The weighted average number of 
Trust common shares outstanding for fiscal 2014 was computed based on 48,300,000 shares outstanding for the period from 
January 1st through November 14th  and 6,000,000 additional shares outstanding from November 14th through December 31st 
issued in connection with a public share offering. 

The Company did not have any stock option plans or any other potentially dilutive securities outstanding during the years ended 
December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

Advertising costs

Advertising costs are expensed as incurred and included in selling, general and administrative expense in the consolidated statements 
of operations.  Advertising costs were $15.6 million, $11.8 million and $11.0 million during the years ended December 31, 2016, 
2015 and 2014, respectively.

Research and development

Research and development costs are expensed as incurred and included in selling, general and administrative expense in the 
consolidated statements of operations. The Company incurred research and development expense of $1.7 million, $2.1 million
and $9.5 million during the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

Employee retirement plans

The  Company  and  many  of  its  segments  sponsor  defined  contribution  retirement  plans,  such  as  401(k)  plans.  Employee 
contributions to the plan are subject to regulatory limitations and the specific plan provisions. The Company and its segments may 
match these contributions up to levels specified in the plans and may make additional discretionary contributions as determined 
by management. The total employer contributions to these plans were $2.2 million, $1.8 million and $1.1 million for the years 
ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

F-15

The Company’s Arnold Magnetics subsidiary maintains a defined benefit plan for certain of its employees which is more fully 
described in "Note M - Defined Benefit Plan".  Accounting guidelines require employers to recognize the overfunded or underfunded 
status of defined benefit pension and postretirement plans as assets or liabilities in their consolidated balance sheets and to recognize 
changes in that funded status in the year in which the changes occur as a component of comprehensive income.

Seasonality

Earnings of certain of the Company’s operating segments are seasonal in nature.  Earnings from Liberty are typically lowest in 
the second quarter due to lower demand for safes at the onset of summer.  Earnings from Clean Earth  are typically lower in the 
winter months due to lower levels of construction and development activity in the Northeastern United States.  Sterno Products 
typically has higher sales in the second and fourth quarter of each year, reflecting the outdoor summer season and the holiday 
season.  

Stock based compensation

The Company does not have a stock based compensation plan; however, all of the Company’s subsidiaries maintain stock based 
compensation plans.  During the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, $4.4 million, $3.2 million, and $3.8 million of 
stock based compensation expense was recorded to each expense category that included related salary expense in the consolidated 
statements of operations. As of December 31, 2016, the amount to be recorded for stock-based compensation expense in future 
years for unvested options is approximately $25.5 million.

New Accounting Pronouncements

Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements

In November 2015, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued an accounting standard update to simplify the 
presentation of deferred taxes by requiring companies to classify all deferred tax assets and liabilities, along with any related 
valuation allowances, as noncurrent on the balance sheet.  Adoption of this standard is required for annual periods beginning after 
December 15, 2016 and early adoption is permitted.  The Company adopted this guidance early, effective as of January 1, 2016, 
on a prospective basis, which is permitted under the standard.  At January 1, 2016, the Company had $6.1 million classified as 
current deferred tax assets which was reclassified to long-term deferred tax assets, and no amount classified as current deferred 
tax liabilities.

In September  2015, the FASB issued an accounting standard to simplify the accounting for measurement period adjustments in 
connection  with  business  combinations  by  requiring  that  an  acquirer  recognize  adjustments  to  provisional  amounts  that  are 
identified during the measurement period in the reporting period in which the adjustment amounts are determined. The standard 
update is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2015 and interim periods within those fiscal years. The standard 
update is to be applied prospectively to adjustments of provisional amounts that occur after the effective date with earlier application 
permitted for financial statements that have not been issued.  The adoption of this standard did not have a significant impact on 
our condensed consolidated financial statements.  The amendment was effective for the Company on January 1, 2016. 

In April 2015, the FASB issued an accounting standard update intended to simplify the presentation of debt issuance costs in the 
balance sheet.  The new guidance requires debt issuance costs to be presented in the balance sheet as a direct deduction from the 
carrying value of the associated debt liability, consistent with the presentation of a debt discount. Prior to the issuance of the 
standard, debt issuance costs were required to be presented in the balance sheet as an asset. In August 2015, the FASB issued 
additional  guidance  which  addresses  the  Security  and  Exchange  Commission's  ("SEC")  comments  related  to  the  absence  of 
authoritative guidance within the accounting standard update related to line-of-credit arrangements.  The SEC  would not object 
to an entity deferring and presenting debt issuance costs as an asset and subsequently amortizing the deferred debt issuance cost 
ratably over the term of the line-of-credit arrangement, regardless of whether there are any outstanding borrowings under the line 
of credit arrangement.  The guidance is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 
15, 2015.  Retrospective adoption is required.  The Company adopted this guidance on January 1, 2016 and has reclassified debt 
issuance costs associated with the Company's term debt of $4.6 million as of December 31, 2015, from long-term assets to long-
term debt.  Deferred debt issuance costs incurred in connection with the Company's revolving credit facility of $4.9 million at  
December 31, 2015 continues to be classified as a long-term asset.  

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

In January 2017, the FASB issued new accounting guidance to simplify the accounting for goodwill impairment.  The guidance 
removes  Step  two  of  the  goodwill  impairment  test,  which  requires  a  hypothetical  purchase  price  allocation.    Under  the  new 
guidance, a goodwill impairment will now be the amount by which a reporting unit's carrying value exceeds its fair value, not to 

F-16

exceed the carrying amount of goodwill.  All other goodwill impairment guidance will remain largely unchanged.  Entities will 
continue to have the option to perform a qualitative test to determine if a quantitative test is necessary.  The guidance is effective 
for annual and interim periods in fiscal years beginning after December 31, 2019 with early adoption permitted for any goodwill 
impairment tests performed after January 1, 2017 and will be applied prospectively.  

In August 2016, the FASB issued an accounting standard update which updates the guidance as to how certain cash receipts and 
cash payments should be presented and classified within the statement of cash flows.  The amended guidance is effective for fiscal 
years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2017, with early adoption permitted, including adoption 
in an interim period.  

In February 2016, the FASB issued an accounting standard update related to the accounting for leases which will require an entity 
to recognize right-of-use assets and lease liabilities on its balance sheet and disclose key information about leasing arrangements.  
The standard update offers specific accounting guidance for a lessee, a lessor and sale and leaseback transactions.  Lessees and 
lessors are required to disclose qualitative and quantitative information about leasing arrangements to enable a user of financial 
statements to assess the amount, timing and uncertainty of cash flows arising from leases.  For public companies, the new standard 
is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2018, including interim periods within that reporting period, 
and requires modified retrospective adoption, with early adoption permitted.  Accordingly, this standard is effective for the Company 
on January 1, 2019.  The Company is currently assessing the impact of the new standard on our consolidated financial statements.  

In July 2015, the FASB issued an accounting standard update intended to simplify the subsequent measurement of inventory by 
requiring inventory to be measured at the lower of cost and net realizable value.  The new guidance applies only to inventory that 
is determined by methods other than last-in-first-out and the retail inventory method.  The Company does not believe that the 
adoption of this new accounting guidance will have a significant impact on its consolidated financial statements.  The guidance 
is effective for public companies for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2016, and interim periods within those 
fiscal years.  Early adoption of the guidance is permitted.  

In May 2014, the FASB issued a comprehensive new revenue recognition standard. The new standard outlines a new, single 
comprehensive model for entities to use in accounting for revenue arising from contracts with customers and supersedes most 
current revenue recognition guidance, including industry-specific guidance.  The core principle of the revenue model is that an 
entity should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the 
consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services.  In addition, the standard requires 
disclosure of the nature, amount, timing and uncertainty of revenue and cash flows arising from contracts with customers.  The 
standard is designed to create greater comparability for financial statement users across industries, jurisdictions and capital markets 
and also requires enhanced disclosures.  The new standard will be effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2018.  The 
guidance permits two methods of adoption: retrospectively to each prior reporting period presented (full retrospective method), 
or retrospectively with the cumulative effect of initially applying the guidance recognized at the date of initial application (the 
cumulative catch-up transition method).  The Company currently anticipates adopting the standard using the cumulative catch-up 
transition method.  The Company has commenced its initial assessment to assess the impact, if any, the new revenue standard will 
have on the Company’s consolidated financial statements. During this initial assessment, the Company has identified certain 
differences that will likely have the most impact; however, how significant of an impact cannot be determined during this phase 
of the Company’s implementation process.  These differences relate to the new concepts of variable consideration, consideration 
payable and the focus on control to determine when and how revenue should be recognized (i.e. point in time versus over time). 
The  Company  expects  to  complete  its  initial  assessment  by  the  end  of  the  third  quarter  of  2017  and  expects  to  finalize  its 
implementation process prior to the adoption of the new revenue standard on January 1, 2018.  The Company will also continue 
to monitor for any additional implementation or other guidance that may be issued in 2017 with respect to the new revenue standard 
and adjust its assessment and implementation plans accordingly.    

Note C — Acquisition of Businesses

Acquisition of 5.11 Tactical

On August 31, 2016, 5.11 ABR Merger Corp. ("Merger Sub"), a wholly owned subsidiary of 5.11 ABR Corp. ("Parent"), which 
in turn is a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, merged with and into 5.11 Tactical, with 5.11 Tactical as the surviving entity, 
pursuant to an agreement and plan of merger among Merger Sub, Parent, 5.11 Tactical, and TA Associates Management L.P. entered 
into on July 29, 2016.

5.11 Tactical is a is a leading provider of purpose-built tactical apparel and gear for law enforcement, firefighters, EMS, and 
military special operations as well as outdoor and adventure enthusiasts.  5.11 is a brand known for innovation and authenticity, 
and works directly with end users to create purpose-built apparel and gear designed to enhance the safety, accuracy, speed and 
performance of tactical professionals and enthusiasts worldwide.   Headquartered in Irvine, California, 5.11 operates sales offices 
F-17

and distribution centers globally, and 5.11 products are widely distributed in uniform stores, military exchanges, outdoor retail 
stores, its own retail stores and on 511tactical.com. 

The Company made loans to, and purchased a 97.5% controlling interest in 5.11 ABR Corp..  The purchase price, including 
proceeds from noncontrolling interest and net of transaction costs, was approximately $408.2 million after final settlement of the 
working capital in the fourth quarter of 2016.  The Company funded its portion of the acquisition through an amendment to the 
2014 Credit Facility that allowed for an increase in the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility and the 2016 Incremental Term Loan (refer 
to Note J - Debt).  5.11 management invested in the transaction along with the Company, representing approximately 2.5% initial 
noncontrolling interest on a primary and fully diluted basis.  The fair value of the noncontrolling interest was determined based 
on the enterprise value of the acquired entity multiplied by the ratio of the number of shares acquired by the minority holders to 
total shares.  The transaction was accounted for as a business combination.  CGM acted as an advisor to the Company in the 
acquisition and will continue to provide integration services during the first year of the Company's ownership of 5.11.  CGM will 
receive integration service fees of $3.5 million payable quarterly over a twelve month period as services are rendered beginning 
in the quarter ended December 31, 2016.  

The results of operations of 5.11 have been included in the consolidated results of operations since the date of acquisition.  5.11's 
results of operations are reported as a separate operating segment.  The table below provides the recording of assets acquired and 
liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date.  

F-18

5.11 Tactical

(in thousands)

Amounts Recognized as of Acquisition Date

Assets:

Cash
Accounts receivable (1)
Inventory (2)
Property, plant and equipment (3)

Intangible assets

Goodwill

Other current and noncurrent assets

      Total assets

Liabilities and noncontrolling interest:

Current liabilities

Other liabilities

Deferred tax liabilities

Noncontrolling interest

      Total liabilities and noncontrolling interest

Net assets acquired

Noncontrolling interest

Intercompany loans to business

Acquisition Consideration

Purchase price

Working capital adjustment

Cash

Total purchase consideration

Less: Transaction costs

Purchase price, net

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

12,581

38,323

160,304

22,723

127,890

92,966

4,884

459,671

38,229

180,231

10,163

5,568

234,191

225,480

5,568

179,237

410,285

400,000

(2,296)

12,581

410,285

2,063

408,222

(1) Includes $40.1 million of gross contractual accounts receivable of which $1.7 million was not expected to be collected.  The 
fair value of accounts receivable approximated book value acquired.

(2)  Includes $39.1 million in inventory basis step-up, which will be charged to cost of goods sold over the inventory turns of the 
acquired entity.

(3) Includes $7.6 million of property, plant and equipment basis step-up.   

The Company incurred $2.1 million of transaction costs in conjunction with the 5.11 acquisition, which was included in selling, 
general and administrative expense in the consolidated statements of operations in the year of acquisition.  The allocation of the 
purchase price presented above is based upon management's estimate of the fair values using valuation techniques including 
income, cost and market approaches.  In estimating the fair value of the acquired assets and assumed liabilities, the fair value 
estimates are based on, but not limited to, expected future revenue and cash flows, expected future growth rates and estimated 
discount rates.  Current and noncurrent assets and current and other liabilities are estimated at their historical carrying values.  
Property, plant and equipment is valued through a purchase price appraisal and will be depreciated on a straight-line basis over 
the respective remaining useful lives.  Goodwill is calculated as the excess of the consideration transferred over the fair value of 
the identifiable net assets and represents the future economic benefits expected to arise from other intangible assets acquired that 
do not qualify for separate recognition, including assembled workforce and non-contractual relationships, as well as expected 
future synergies.  The goodwill of $93.0 million reflects the strategic fit of 5.11 in the Company's branded products business and 
is not expected to be deductible for income tax purposes.  The purchase accounting for 5.11 was finalized during the fourth quarter 

F-19

of 2016, with the changes from the provisional purchase price allocation related to the settlement of working capital and the 
recording of a change in the deferred taxes related to a reduction of net operating loss carryforwards.

The intangible assets recorded related to the 5.11 acquisition are as follows (in thousands):

Intangible assets

Amount

Trade name

Customer relationships

Technology

$

$

48,665

75,218

4,007

127,890

Estimated Useful
Life

15 years

15 years

10 years

The customer relationships intangible asset was valued at $75.2 million using an excess earnings methodology, in which an asset 
is valuable to the extent it enables its owners to earn a return in excess of the required returns on and of the other assets utilized 
in the business.  Customer relationships intangible asset was derived using a risk-adjusted discount rate. The tradename intangible 
asset and the design patent technology asset were valued using a royalty savings methodology, in which an asset is valuable to 
the extent that the ownership of the asset relieves the company from the obligation of paying royalties for the benefits generated 
by the asset.  

Acquisition of Manitoba Harvest

On July 10, 2015, FHF Holdings Ltd., a majority owned subsidiary of the Company, and 1037269 B.C. Ltd., a wholly owned 
subsidiary of FHF Holdings Ltd. (together, the "Buyer"), closed on the acquisition of all the issued and outstanding capital stock 
of  Fresh  Hemp  Foods  Ltd.  ("Manitoba  Harvest")  pursuant  to  a  stock  purchase  agreement  (the  "Manitoba  Harvest  Purchase 
Agreement") among the Buyer, Manitoba Harvest, Mike Fata, as the Stockholders’ Representative and the Signing Stockholders 
(as such term is defined in the Manitoba Harvest Purchase Agreement), entered into previously on June 5, 2015.  Subsequent to 
the closing, 1037269 B.C. Ltd. merged with and into Manitoba Harvest.

Headquartered in Winnipeg, Manitoba, Manitoba Harvest is a branded, hemp-based food seller. Manitoba Harvest’s products are 
currently carried in approximately 7,000 retail stores across the U.S. and Canada. The Company’s hemp-exclusive, 100% all-
natural product lineup includes hemp hearts, hemp oil and protein powder.

The Company made loans to and purchased an 87% controlling interest in Manitoba Harvest.  The purchase price, including 
proceeds from noncontrolling interest, was approximately $102.7 million (C$130.3 million).  The Company funded its portion of 
the acquisition price through drawings on its 2014 Revolving Credit Facility.  Manitoba Harvest management and a minority 
shareholder invested in the transaction along with the Company representing approximately 13% initial noncontrolling interest 
on a primary basis.  The fair value of the noncontrolling interest was determined based on enterprise value of the acquired entity 
multiplied by the ratio number of shares acquired by the minority shareholders to total shares.  The transaction was accounted for 
as a business combination.  CGM acted as an advisor to the Company in the acquisition and will continue to provide integration 
services during the first year of the Company's ownership of Manitoba Harvest.  CGM received integration services fees of $1.0 
million which was payable quarterly during the twelve month period subsequent to acquisition as services were rendered.  

The results of operations of Manitoba Harvest have been included in the consolidated results of operations since the date of 
acquisition.  Manitoba Harvest's results of operations are reported as a separate operating segment.  The table below provides the 
recording of assets acquired and liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date. 

F-20

Manitoba Harvest

(in thousands)

Amounts Recognized as of Acquisition Date

Assets:

Cash

Accounts receivable
Inventory (1)

Property, plant and equipment

Goodwill

Intangible assets

Other current and noncurrent assets

      Total assets

Liabilities and noncontrolling interest:

Current liabilities

Deferred tax liabilities

Other liabilities

Noncontrolling interest

      Total liabilities and noncontrolling interest

Net assets acquired

Noncontrolling interest

Intercompany loans to business

Acquisition Consideration

Purchase price

Working capital adjustment

Total purchase consideration

Less: Transaction costs

Purchase price, net

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

$

164

3,787

8,743

8,203

37,882

63,687

986

123,452

3,267

16,593

23,332

7,638

50,830

72,622

7,638

23,593

103,853

104,437

(584)

103,853

(1,145)

102,708

(1) Includes $3.1 million of step-up in the basis of inventory, which was charged to cost of goods sold during 2015.

The Company incurred $1.1 million of transaction costs in conjunction with the acquisition of Manitoba Harvest during the year 
ended December 31, 2015 which are included in selling, general and administrative expenses in the consolidated statements of 
operations.  The goodwill of $37.9 million, which is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes, reflects the strategic fit of 
Manitoba Harvest into the Company's branded products businesses.

The values assigned to the identified intangible assets were determined by discounting estimated future cash flows associated with 
these assets to their present value.  The intangible assets recorded in connection with the Manitoba Harvest acquisition are as 
follows (in thousands): 

Intangible assets

Tradename

Technology and processes

Customer relationships

Amount

Estimated Useful
Life

13,005

9,616

41,066

63,687

Indefinite

10 years

15 years

$

$

F-21

Unaudited pro forma information

The following unaudited pro forma data for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015 gives effect to the acquisition  of 5.11 
Tactical and Manitoba Harvest, as described above, as if the acquisitions had been completed as of January 1, 2015, and the sale 
of Tridien, CamelBak and AFM as if the dispositions had been completed as of January 1, 2015.  The pro forma data gives effect 
to historical operating results with adjustments to interest expense, amortization and depreciation expense, management fees and 
related tax effects.  The information is provided for illustrative purposes only and is not necessarily indicative of the operating 
results that would have occurred if the transaction had been consummated on the date indicated, nor is it necessarily indicative of 
future operating results of the consolidated companies, and should not be construed as representing results for any future period.  

(in thousands)

Net revenues

Gross profit

Operating income

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

Net income (loss) from continuing operations attributable to Holdings

Basic and fully diluted net loss per share attributable to Holdings

Year Ended December 31,

2016

2015

$

1,163,773

$

1,035,612

408,369

375,019

20,028

43,973

42,013

0.28

56,711

(5,000)

(10,275)

(0.57)

Other acquisitions

Ergobaby

On May 11, 2016, the Company's Ergobaby subsidiary acquired all of the outstanding membership interests in New Baby Tula 
LLC ("Baby Tula"), a maker of premium baby carriers, toddler carriers, slings, blankets and wraps.  The purchase price was $73.8 
million, net of transaction costs, plus a potential earn-out of $8.2 million based on 2017 financial performance.  Ergobaby paid 
$0.8 million in transaction costs in connection with the acquisition.  Ergobaby funded the acquisition and payment of related 
transaction costs through the issuance of an additional $68.2 million in intercompany loans with the Company, and the issuance 
of    $8.2  million  in  Ergobaby  shares  to  the  selling  shareholders.   The  fair  value  of  the  Ergobaby  shares  issued  to  the  selling 
shareholders was determined based on a model that multiplies the trailing twelve months earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation 
and amortization by an estimated enterprise value multiple to determine an estimated fair value.  The fair value calculation assumes 
proceeds from the conversion of outstanding stock options, deducts the carrying value of debt at Ergobaby and estimated selling 
costs of the entity, and divides the resulting amount by the total number of outstanding shares, including converted stock options, 
to determine a per share value for the stock issued.  The Company funded the additional intercompany loans used for the acquisition 
with available cash on the balance sheet and a draw on the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility.  Ergobaby recorded a purchase price 
allocation of $13.2 million  in goodwill, which is expected to be deductible for income tax purposes, $55.3 million in intangible 
assets comprised of $52.9 million in finite lived tradenames, $1.7 million in non-compete agreements; and $0.7 million in customer 
relationships, and $4.8 million in inventory step-up. The inventory step-up has been charged to cost of goods sold during the third 
and fourth quarters of 2016.  In addition, the earn-out provision of the purchase price was allocated a fair value of $3.8 million.  
The remainder of the purchase consideration was allocated to net assets acquired.  The Company finalized the purchase accounting 
for the Baby Tula acquisition during the fourth quarter of 2016.

Clean Earth 

On June 1, 2016, the Company's Clean Earth subsidiary acquired certain of the assets and liabilities of EWS Alabama, Inc. ("EWS").  
Clean Earth funded the acquisition and the related transaction costs through the issuance of additional intercompany debt with the 
Company.  Based in Glencoe, Alabama, EWS provides a range of hazardous and non-hazardous waste management services from 
a fully permitted hazardous waste RCRA Part B facility.  The Company funded the additional intercompany loans with Clean 
Earth through a draw on its 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. In connection with the acquisition, Clean Earth recorded a purchase 
price allocation of $3.6 million in goodwill and $12.1 million in intangible assets.  The Company finalized the purchase price 
during the fourth quarter of 2016.

On April 15, 2016, Clean Earth acquired certain assets of Phoenix Soil, LLC ("Phoenix Soil") and WIC, LLC (together with 
Phoenix  Soil,  the  "Sellers").    Phoenix  Soil  is  based  in  Plainville,  CT  and  provides  environmental  services  for  nonhazardous 

F-22

contaminated soil materials with a primary focus on soil.  Phoenix Soil recently completed its transition to a new 58,000 square 
foot thermal desorption facility owned by WIC, LLC.  The acquisition increases Clean Earth's soil treatment capabilities and 
expand its geographic footprint into New England.  Clean Earth financed the acquisition and payment of related transaction costs 
through the issuance of additional intercompany loans with the Company.  The Company used cash on hand to fund the purchase 
price of Phoenix Soil.  In connection with the acquisition, Clean Earth recorded a purchase price allocation of $3.2 million in 
goodwill and $5.6 million in intangible assets in the second quarter of 2016.  The Company finalized the purchase price during 
the fourth quarter of 2016.

Sterno Products

On January 22, 2016,  Sterno Products, a wholly owned subsidiary of the company, acquired all of the outstanding stock of  Northern 
International, Inc. (NII), for a total purchase price of approximately $35.8 million (C$50.6 million), plus a potential earn-out 
opportunity payable over the next two years up to a maximum amount of $1.8 million (C$2.5 million).  The contingent consideration 
was fair valued at $1.5 million, based on probability weighted models of the achievement of certain performance based financial 
targets.  Refer to Note I - "Fair Value Measurements" for a description of the valuation technique used to fair value the contingent 
consideration.  Headquartered in Coquitlam, British Columbia, Canada, NII sells flameless candles and outdoor lighting products 
through the retail segment.   Sterno Products financed the acquisition and payment of the related transaction costs through the 
issuance of an additional $37.0 million in intercompany loans with the Company.  

In connection with the acquisition, Sterno recorded a purchase price allocation of $6.0 million of goodwill, which is not expected 
to be deductible for income tax purposes, $12.7 million in intangible assets and $1.2 million in inventory step-up.  In addition, 
the earn-out provision of the purchase price was allocated a fair value of $1.5 million.  The remainder of the purchase consideration 
was allocated to net assets acquired.   Sterno Products incurred $0.4 million in acquisition related costs in connection with the NII 
acquisition. 

Manitoba Harvest

On December 15, 2015, the Company's Manitoba Harvest subsidiary completed the acquisition of Hemp Oil Canada, Inc. (HOCI), 
for a purchase price of $30.8 million (C$42.0 million).  The final purchase price was reduced by $0.4 million (C$0.5 million) after 
the settlement of the working capital adjustment during the second quarter of 2016. HOCI is a bulk wholesale producer, private 
label packager and custom processor of hemp food product ingredients, located in Ste. Agathe, Manitoba.  Manitoba Harvest 
incurred $0.4 million (C$0.5 million) of acquisition related costs for the HOCI acquisition which are recorded in selling, general 
and administrative expenses in the consolidated results of operation for the year ending December 31, 2015.  In connection with 
the acquisition of HOCI, certain of the selling shareholders of HOCI invested $3.4 million (C$9.3 million) in Manitoba Harvest 
in exchange for approximately 11% noncontrolling interest in Manitoba Harvest. 

Manitoba Harvest recorded a purchase price allocation of $7.3 million in goodwill, which is expected to be deductible for income 
tax purposes, $10.8 million of intangible assets, and $0.3 million in inventory step-up.  The remainder of the purchase consideration 
was allocated to net assets acquired. 

Note D — Discontinued Operations

Sale of Tridien

On September 21, 2016, the Company sold its majority owned subsidiary, Tridien, based on an enterprise value of $25 million.  
After the allocation of sale proceeds to non-controlling interest holders and the payment of transaction expenses, the Company 
received approximately $22.7 million in net proceeds related to its debt and equity interests in Tridien.  The Company recognized 
a gain of $1.7 million in September 2016 as a result of the sale of Tridien.  Approximately $1.6 million of the proceeds received 
by the Company from the sale of Tridien have been reserved as support for the Company's indemnification obligations for future 
claims against Tridien that the Company may be liable for under the terms of the Tridien sale agreement.

F-23

Summarized operating results for Tridien for the previous years through the date of disposition were as follows (in thousands):

(in thousands)

Net sales

Gross profit

Operating income

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

Provision for income taxes
Income from discontinued operations (1)

For the period
January 1, 2016
through
disposition

Year ended
December 31, 2015

Year ended
December 31, 2014

45,951

7,917

437

488

15

473

77,406

13,137

(8,703)

(8,696)

(27)

(8,669)

67,254

14,165

2,191

2,274

47

2,227

(1) The results of operations for the period from January 1, 2016 through the date of disposition, and for the years ended December 
31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 exclude $1.1 million, $1.1 million and $1.2 million, respectively, of intercompany interest 
expense.

The following table presents summary balance sheet information of the Tridien businesses as of December 31, 2015 (in thousands):

Assets:

Cash

Accounts receivable, net

Inventories

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

Current assets held for sale

Property, plant and equipment, net

Goodwill

Intangible assets, net

Other non-current assets

Noncurrent assets held for sale

Liabilities:

Accounts payable

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

Current liabilities held for sale

Deferred income taxes

Other noncurrent liabilities

Noncurrent liabilities held for sale

Noncontrolling interest of discontinued operations

$

$

$

$

$

$

Tridien

629

8,411

8,465

1,267

18,772

2,102

7,834

2,717

170

12,823

4,264

4,191

8,455

110

—

110

916

Sale of CamelBak

On August 3, 2015, the Company sold its majority owned subsidiary, CamelBak, based on a total enterprise value of $412.5 million.  
The CamelBak purchase agreement contains customary representations, warranties, covenants and indemnification provisions, 
and the transaction is subject to customary working capital adjustments.

The Company received approximately $367.8 million in cash related to its debt and equity interests in CamelBak after payments 
to noncontrolling shareholders and payment of all transaction expenses.  Under the terms of the LLC agreement, the Allocation 
Member has the right to defer a portion of the distribution for the CamelBak sale.  The Allocation member deferred the profit 
allocation from the sale of CamelBak and the loss from the sale of American Furniture was used to net the calculation of the high 

F-24

water mark from the Camelback sale.  The result was a net distribution of $14.6 million that was paid during the fourth quarter 
of 2015.  (Refer to "Note N - Stockholders' Equity" for a discussion of the profit allocation paid as a result of the sale of CamelBak.)  
The Company recognized a gain of $164.0 million, net of tax, during 2015 as a result of the sale of CamelBak, which was subject 
to final settlement during 2016.  During the third quarter of 2016, the Company, settled the outstanding working capital adjustments 
related to CamelBak, resulting in the recognition of additional gain on the sale of business of $0.6 million during the quarter ended 
September 30, 2016.  

Summarized operating results for CamelBak for the previous years through the date of disposition were as follows (in thousands):

(in thousands)

Net sales

Gross profit

Operating income

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

Provision for income taxes

Income from discontinued operations (1)

For the period
January 1, 2015
through disposition

Year ended
December 31, 2014

$

$

96,519

$

148,675

41,415

14,348

16,607

5,010

11,597

$

62,672

17,913

18,266

3,144

15,122

(1)  The results for the periods from January 1, 2015 through disposition and the year ended December 31, 2014 exclude $5.4 
million and $10.5 million, respectively, of intercompany interest expense.

Sale of AFM

On October 5, 2015, the Company sold its majority owned subsidiary, American Furniture, for a sale price of $24.1 million.  The 
Company received approximately $23.5 million in net proceeds related to its debt and equity interests in American Furniture after 
payment of all transaction expenses. The Company recognized a loss on the sale of American Furniture of $14.3 million.  This 
loss was recognized during the quarter ended September 30, 2015 based on the initial write-down of American Furniture's carrying 
amounts to fair value. 

Summarized operating results for American Furniture for the previous years through the date of disposition were as follows (in 
thousands):

(in thousands)

Net sales

Gross profit

Operating income

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

Provision for income taxes
Income from discontinued operations (1)

For the period
January 1, 2015
through
disposition

Year ended
December 31, 2014

$

$

122,420

$

11,613

4,126

4,134

81

4,053

$

129,696

11,817

3,661

3,757

28

3,729

(1) The results for the periods from January 1, 2015 through disposition and the year ended December 31, 2014 exclude $1.5 million, 
and $2.2 million, respectively, of intercompany interest expense.

Note E — Operating Segment Data

At December 31, 2016, the Company had eight reportable operating segments. Each operating segment represents a platform 
acquisition. The Company’s operating segments are strategic business units that offer different products and services. They are 
managed separately because each business requires different technology and marketing strategies. A description of each of the 
reportable segments and the types of products from which each segment derives its revenues is as follows:

F-25

• 

5.11 is a is a leading provider of purpose-built tactical apparel and gear for law enforcement, firefighters, EMS, and 
military special operations as well as outdoor and adventure enthusiasts.  5.11 is a brand known for innovation and 
authenticity, and works directly with end users to create purpose-built apparel and gear designed to enhance the safety, 
accuracy, speed and performance of tactical professionals and enthusiasts worldwide.   Headquartered in Irvine, California, 
5.11 operates sales offices and distribution centers globally, and 5.11 products are widely distributed in uniform stores, 
military exchanges, outdoor retail stores, its own retail stores and on 511tactical.com. 

•  Ergobaby, headquartered in Los Angeles, California, is a designer, marketer and distributor of wearable baby carriers and 
accessories, blankets and swaddlers, nursing pillows, and related products.  Ergobaby primarily sells its Ergobaby and 
Baby Tula branded products through brick-and-mortar retailers, national chain stores, online retailers, its own websites 
and distributors and derives approximately 56% of its sales from outside of the United States.

•  Liberty Safe is a designer, manufacturer and marketer of premium home, office and gun safes in North America. From 
its over 300,000 square foot manufacturing facility, Liberty produces a wide range of home and gun safe models in a 
broad assortment of sizes, features and styles. Liberty is headquartered in Payson, Utah.

•  Manitoba Harvest is a pioneer and leader in the manufacture and distribution of branded, hemp-based food products.  
Manitoba Harvest’s products, which include Hemp Hearts™, Hemp Heart Bites™, Hemp Heart Bars™, and Hemp protein 
powders, are currently carried in over 7,000 retail stores across the U.S. and Canada.  Manitoba Harvest is headquartered 
in Winnipeg, Manitoba.

•  Advanced Circuits, an electronic components manufacturing company, is a provider of small-run, quick-turn and volume 
production  rigid  printed  circuit  boards.   ACI  manufactures  and  delivers  custom  printed  circuit  boards  to  customers 
primarily in North America. ACI is headquartered in Aurora, Colorado.

•  Arnold Magnetics is a global manufacturer of engineered magnetic solutions for a wide range of specialty applications 
and  end-markets,  including  energy,  medical,  aerospace  and  defense,  consumer  electronics,  general  industrial  and 
automotive. Arnold Magnetics produces high performance permanent magnets (PMAG), flexible magnets (FlexMag) 
and precision foil products (Precision Thin Metals) that are mission critical in motors, generators, sensors and other 
systems and components. Based on its long-term relationships, the company has built a diverse and blue-chip customer 
base totaling more than 2,000 clients worldwide. Arnold Magnetics is headquartered in Rochester, New York.

•  Clean Earth provides environmental services for a variety of contaminated materials including soils dredged materials, 
hazardous waste and drill cuttings.  Clean Earth analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste streams generated in 
multiple end markets such as power, construction, oil and gas, medical, infrastructure, industrial and dredging.  Clean 
Earth is headquartered in Hatsboro, Pennsylvania and operates 18 facilities in the eastern United States.  

• 

Sterno Products is a manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming fuel and creative table lighting solutions for 
the food service industry and flameless candles and outdoor lighting products for consumers.  Sterno's products include 
wick and gel chafing fuels, butane stoves and accessories, liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and 
lamps.  Sterno Products is headquartered in Corona, California. 

The  tabular  information  that  follows  shows  data  for  each  of  the  operating  segments  reconciled  to  amounts  reflected  in  the 
consolidated financial statements. The operations of each of the operating segments are included in consolidated operating results 
as of their date of acquisition.  FOX was an operating segment of the Company until July 10, 2014, when FOX was deconsolidated 
due to the Company's ownership interest falling below 50%.  The results of operations of FOX are included in the disaggregated 
revenue and other financial data presented for the year ending December 31, 2014 for the period from January 1, 2014 through 
July 10, 2014.  Segment profit is determined based on internal performance measures used by the Chief Executive Officer to assess 
the performance of each business. All our operating segments are deemed reporting units for purposes of annual or event-driven 
goodwill impairment testing, with the exception of Arnold Magnetics which has three reporting units (PMAG, FlexMag and 
Precision Thin Metals). Segment profit excludes certain charges from the acquisitions of the Company’s initial businesses not 
pushed down to the segments which are reflected in the Corporate and other line item. There were no significant inter-segment 
transactions.  

F-26

A disaggregation of the Company’s consolidated revenue and other financial data for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 
and 2014 is presented below (in thousands):

Net sales of operating segments

Year ended December 31,
2015

2014

2016

5.11

Ergobaby

FOX

Liberty

Manitoba Harvest

ACI

Arnold Magnetics

Clean Earth

Sterno Products

Total

$

109,792

$

— $

103,348

—

103,812

59,323

86,041

108,179

188,997

218,817

978,309

86,506

—

101,146

17,423

87,532

119,994

175,386

139,991

727,978

—

82,255

149,995

90,149

—

85,918

123,205

68,440

36,713

636,675

Reconciliation of segment revenues to consolidated revenues:

Corporate and other

Total consolidated revenues

—

—

—

$

978,309

$

727,978

$

636,675

Geographic Information

International Revenues

Revenues from geographic locations outside the United States were material for the following segments: 5.11 Tactical, Ergobaby, 
Manitoba Harvest, Arnold and Sterno Products, in each of the periods presented.  Revenue attributable to Canada represented 
approximately 24.0% of total international revenue in 2016 and 14.6% of total international revenue in 2015.  Revenue attributable 
to any other individual foreign country was not material in 2016 or 2015.  Revenue attributable to any individual foreign countries 
was not material in 2014.  The international revenues from FOX in 2014 are for the period from January 1, 2014 through July 10, 
2014, the date of deconsolidation.  There were no significant inter-segment transactions.

International revenues

5.11

Ergobaby

FOX

Manitoba Harvest

Arnold Magnetics

Sterno Products

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

30,363

$

— $

57,431

—

30,418

42,019

19,407

48,237

—

8,733

44,187

3,575

—

46,702

79,306

—

55,591

2,137

      Total international revenues

$

179,638

$

104,732

$

183,736

Identifiable Assets

The acquisition of Manitoba Harvest in July 2015 and HOCI in December 2015 resulted in identifiable assets located internationally 
in Canada.  In addition, several of the Company's subsidiaries have foreign locations with assets located outside of the United 
States.  At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Company had $266.0 million and $177.8 million in assets held in foreign locations.  
Of the amount of assets held in foreign locations at December 31, 2016 and 2015, 74% and 82%, respectively, were located in 
Canada. 

F-27

Profit (loss) of operating segments (1)
5.11 (2)

Ergobaby

FOX

Liberty
Manitoba Harvest (3)
ACI 
Arnold Magnetics (4)
Clean Earth (5)
Sterno Products (6)

Total

Reconciliation of segment profit to consolidated income (loss) from
continuing operations before income taxes:

Interest expense, net

Other income (expense), net

Gain on equity method investment
Corporate and other (7)

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

(10,153) $

— $

17,151

—

13,234

321

22,718

(12,921)

7,929

18,799

57,078

(24,651)

(2,919)

74,490

(40,780)

22,157

—

11,858

(6,150)

24,144

7,584

11,013

13,200

83,806

(25,924)

(2,323)

4,533

(36,100)

—

18,147

17,292

(2,717)

—

22,455

7,095

2,737

(1,810)

63,199

(27,060)

(593)

11,029

228,548

Total consolidated income (loss) from continuing operations before
income taxes

$

63,218

$

23,992

$

275,123

(1)  Segment profit (loss) represents operating income (loss).
(2)  The year ended December 31, 2016 includes $2.1 million of acquisition related costs incurred in connection with the acquisition of 5.11, 
$17.4 million of cost of goods sold expense related to the amortization of the step-up in inventory basis resulting from the purchase price 
allocation of 5.11, and $1.2 million in integration services fees paid to CGM.  

(3)  Results from the year ended December 31, 2015 include $1.1 million of acquisition related costs in connection with the acquisition of 
Manitoba Harvest, $0.4 million acquisition related costs in connection with Manitoba Harvest's acquisition of HOCI, $3.1 million of cost 
of goods sold expense related to the amortization of the step-up in inventory basis resulting from the purchase price allocation of Manitoba 
Harvest, and $0.5 million in integration service fees paid to CGM.  The year ended December 31, 2015 includes $0.5 million in integration 
services fees paid to CGM.

(4)  Operating loss from Arnold Magnetics for the year ended December 31, 2016 includes $16.0 million in goodwill impairment expense related 

to the PMAG reporting unit.  Refer to "Note H - Goodwill and Intangible Assets." 

(5)  The year ended December 31, 2014 includes $1.9 million of acquisition related costs incurred in connection with the acquisition of Clean 
Earth, and $0.6 million in integration service fees paid to CGM.  The year ended December 31, 2015 includes $1.9 million in integration 
service fees paid to CGM.

(6)  The year ended December 31, 2014 includes $2.8 million  of acquisition related costs incurred in connection with the acquisition of Sterno, 
$2.0 million of cost of goods sold expense related to the amortization of the step-up in inventory basis resulting from the purchase price 
allocation of Sterno, and $0.4 million in integration service fees paid to CGM.  The year ended December 31, 2015 includes $1.1 million
in integration service fees paid to CGM.  

(7)  Primarily relates to the gain on the deconsolidation of FOX during 2014, and management fees expensed and payable to CGM.

F-28

5.11

Ergobaby

FOX

Liberty

Manitoba Harvest

ACI

Arnold Magnetics

Clean Earth

Sterno Products

Allowance for doubtful accounts

Total

Reconciliation of segment to consolidated totals:

Corporate and other identifiable assets

Assets of discontinued operations

Amortization of debt issuance costs and original
issue discount

Accounts Receivable

Identifiable Assets

Depreciation and Amortization

December 31,

December 31

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2016 (1)

2015 (1)

2016

2015

2014

— $ 311,560

$

— $

23,414

$

— $

—

8,076

113,814

62,436

49,653

11,018

—

—

13,077

12,941

6,468

6,686

15,195

45,619

38,986

5,512

5,946

15,083

42,291

19,508

—

26,344

97,977

16,541

64,209

—

31,395

88,541

17,275

72,310

193,250

185,087

134,661

121,910

7,769

—

2,758

6,403

3,476

9,079

21,157

11,549

—

3,475

—

3,518

5,192

2,996

8,766

20,410

7,963

—

3,832

4,785

6,250

—

4,606

8,528

6,605

4,643

—

(5,511)

(3,447)

—

—

181,191

105,910

958,356

578,954

85,605

52,320

39,249

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

145,971

313,929

31,595

—

—

755

—

501

—

—

3,565

2,883

3,125

Total

$ 181,191

$ 105,910

$ 1,104,327

$ 924,478

$

89,170

$

55,958

$

42,875

(1)  Does not include goodwill balances - refer to "Note H - Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets" for a schedule of goodwill by 

segment.

Note F —  Investment

Deconsolidation of FOX

On August 13, 2013, the Company's FOX operating segment completed an initial public offering (the "FOX IPO") of its common 
stock pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-1 with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC"). In the FOX 
IPO, FOX sold 2,857,143 shares and certain of its shareholders sold 7,000,000 shares (including 5,800,238 shares held by the 
Company) at an initial offering price of $15.00 per share. FOX trades on the NASDAQ stock market under the ticker “FOXF”. 
The Company received approximately $80.9 million in net proceeds from the sale of their shares. The Company’s ownership 
interest in FOX was reduced from 75.8% to 53.9% on a primary basis and from 70.6% to 49.8% on a fully diluted basis as a result 
of the FOX IPO. 

On July 10, 2014, FOX filed a registration statement on Form S-1 with the SEC for a public offering of its common stock (the 
"FOX Secondary Offering") held by certain stockholders (the "Selling Stockholders").  The Selling Stockholders sold 5,750,000
shares of FOX common stock in the FOX Secondary Offering, which included an underwriters' option to purchase an additional 
750,000 shares, at an offering price of $15.50 per share.  The Company sold 4,466,569 shares of FOX common stock, including 
633,955 shares sold in connection with the underwriters' exercise of their full option to purchase additional shares of common 
stock, and received net proceeds from the sale of approximately $65.5 million.  As a result of the sale of the shares by the Company 
in the FOX Secondary Offering, the Company's ownership interest in FOX decreased to approximately 41%, which resulted in 
the deconsolidation of the FOX operating segment in the Company's consolidated financial statements effective as of the date of 
the FOX Secondary Offering.  

As a result of the deconsolidation of FOX subsequent to the FOX Secondary Offering, the Company recognized a total gain of 
approximately $264.3 million.  The $264.3 million gain on the deconsolidation of FOX was comprised of a gain related to the 
retained  interest  in  FOX  of  $188.0  million  that  was  calculated  based  on  the  fair  value  of  the  Company's  retained  interest  of 
approximately 41% in FOX less the retained interest in the net assets of FOX as of the date of consolidation, and $76.2 million
related to the sold interest in FOX.  Subsequent to the sale of the shares in the FOX Secondary Offering, the Company owned 
approximately 15.1 million shares of FOX common stock.  The Company has made an irrevocable election to account for the 
investment in FOX at fair value, with changes in fair value reported in earnings.  The Company elected to apply fair value accounting 
to these investments because it believes that fair value is the most relevant measurement attribute for these investments.

F-29

Investment in FOX

In March 2016, FOX closed on a secondary public offering of 2,500,000 shares of FOX common shares held by the Company.  
Concurrently with the closing of the March Offering, FOX repurchased 500,000 shares of FOX common stock held by the Company.  
As a result of the sale of shares through the March Offering and the repurchase of shares by FOX, the Company sold a total of 
3,000,000 shares of FOX common stock, with total net proceeds of approximately $47.7 million.  Upon completion of the March 
Offering and repurchase of shares by FOX, the Company's ownership interest in FOX was reduced from approximately 41% to 
33%.  

In August 2016,  FOX closed on a secondary public offering of 4,025,000 shares held by certain FOX shareholders, including the 
Company.  The Company sold a total of 3,500,000 shares of FOX common stock in the August Offering, for total net proceeds of 
$63.0 million.  Upon completion of the August offering, our ownership of FOX decreased from approximately 33% to approximately 
23%.   

In November 2016, FOX closed on a secondary offering of 3,500,000 shares of FOX common stock held by the Company, for 
total net proceeds of $71.8 million.  Upon completion of the August offering, our ownership of FOX decreased from approximately 
23% to approximately 14%. 

The Company accounted for its investment in FOX after its ownership interest fell below 50% on July 10, 2014 using the fair 
value option for equity method investment.  The Company uses the equity method of accounting when it has the ability to exercise 
significant influence, but not control, over the operating and financial policies of the investee.  After the offering of FOX shares 
in November 2016, the Company's ownership interest was reduced to 14.0% and the Company's investment no longer qualified 
for the equity method of accounting for investments since the Company no longer had the ability to exercise significant influence.   
Since the Company chose to use the fair value option to account for the FOX investment, changes in the fair value of the investment 
will continue to be recorded through the consolidated statement of operations.

The sale of a portion of the Company's FOX shares in March 2016, August 2016 and November 2016 qualified as a Sale Event 
under the Company's LLC Agreement.  During the second quarter, the Company's board of directors declared a distribution to the 
Holders of the Allocation Interests of $8.6 million in connection with the sale of FOX shares in March 2016.  The profit allocation 
payment was made during the quarter ended June 30, 2016.  The Company's board of directors declared a distribution to the 
Holders of the Allocation Interests of $11.6 million in connection with the sale of FOX shares in August 2016.  That payment was 
made, offset by negative profit allocation related to the Sale Event from the Tridien disposition, in the fourth quarter of 2016.  The 
Company's board of directors declared a distribution to the Holders of the Allocation Interests of $13.4 million related to the 
November 2016 sale of FOX shares in the fourth quarter of 2016.  The amount of the distribution was accrued at December 31, 
2016 in the line Due to Related Party in the consolidated Balance Sheet, and paid in January 2017.  

The following table reflects the year to date activity from our investment in FOX for 2016 and 2015:

Balance January 1st

Proceeds from sale of FOX shares, net - March 2016

Proceeds from sale of FOX shares, net - August 2016

Proceeds from sale of FOX shares, net - November 2016
Mark to market adjustment on investment (1)

Balance December 31st

$

$

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

249,747

$

245,214

(47,685)

(63,000)

(71,785)

74,490

141,767

$

—

—

—

4,533

249,747

(1) The mark-to-market adjustment is the result of the fair value changes of the FOX investment during the year. 

The Company evaluates its equity method investment to determine if it is significant as defined in the regulation promulgated by 
the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.  As of and for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, the investment 
in FOX did not meet the significance criteria.  As such, the Company was not required to present separate financial statements for 
FOX.  As of November 16, 2016, the date that the Company’s ownership interest in FOX was reduced to 14%, and the Company 
ceased accounting for FOX as an equity method investment, the investment did meet the significance criteria and the Company 
has incorporated by reference into the Company’s Form 10-K for the year ending December 31, 2016, the financial statements of 
FOX as of December 30, 2016 and December 31, 2015, which includes the consolidated balance sheets of FOX as of December 
30, 2016 and December 31, 2015, and the consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, stockholders’ equity, and 
cash flows of FOX for each of the three years in the period ended December 30, 2016.

F-30

The following table summarizes FOX's results of operations that are included in the Company's consolidated results of operations 
for the period from January 1, 2014 through July 10, 2014, the date of deconsolidation (in thousands):

Net revenue

Gross profit

Operating income

Net income

Year ended December 31,

2014

$

$

149,995

46,294

17,294

15,047

Arnold Magnetics Joint Venture

Arnold Magnetics is a 50% partner in a China rare earth mine-to-magnet joint venture. Arnold Magnetics accounts for its activity 
in the joint venture utilizing the equity method of accounting. Gains and losses from the joint venture were not material for the 
years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

Note G - Property, Plant, Equipment and Inventory

Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment is comprised of the following (in thousands):

Machinery and equipment

Office furniture, computers and software

Leasehold improvements

Construction in process

Buildings and land

Less: accumulated depreciation

Total

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

$

155,591

$

126,850

13,737

14,156

8,308

35,392

227,184

(84,814)

$

142,370

$

8,771

7,582

1,612

30,244

175,059

(59,111)

115,948

Depreciation expense was approximately $26.9 million, $21.2 million and $14.6 million for the years ended December 31, 
2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

Inventory

Inventory is comprised of the following (in thousands):

Raw materials and supplies

Work-in-process

Finished goods

Less: obsolescence reserve

Total

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

$

$

29,708

$

8,281

182,886

(7,891)

212,984

$

23,604

8,763

31,196

(3,658)

59,905

Note H — Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

Goodwill represents the difference between purchase cost and the fair value of net assets acquired in business acquisitions. Indefinite 
lived intangible assets, representing trademarks and trade names, are not amortized unless their useful life is determined to be 
finite.  Long-lived  intangible  assets  are  subject  to  amortization  using  the  straight-line  method.  Goodwill  and  indefinite  lived 
intangible assets are tested for impairment annually as of March 31st of each year and more often if a triggering event occurs, by 

F-31

comparing the fair value of each reporting unit to its carrying value. Each of the Company’s businesses represents a reporting unit 
except Arnold, which is comprised of three reporting units.

2016 Interim goodwill impairment testing

Arnold

As a result of decreases in forecasted revenue, operating income and cash flows at Arnold, as well as a shortfall in revenue and 
operating income during the latter half of 2016 as compared to budgeted amounts, the Company determined that it was necessary 
to perform interim goodwill impairment testing on each of the three reporting units at Arnold.  The Company performed the first 
step ("Step 1") of the goodwill impairment assessment at December 31, 2016.  In Step 1 of the goodwill impairment test, the 
Company compared the fair value of the reporting units to the carrying amount.  Based on the results of the valuation, the fair 
value of the FlexMag and PTM reporting units exceeded the carrying amount, therefore no additional goodwill testing was required.  
The results of the Step 1 test for the PMAG unit indicated a potential impairment of goodwill and the Company performed the 
second step of goodwill impairment testing (Step 2) to determine the amount of impairment of the PMAG reporting unit.

In the first test of goodwill impairment testing, we compare the fair value of each reporting unit to its carrying amount.  For 
purposes of the Step 1 for the Arnold reporting units, we estimated the fair value of the reporting unit using an income approach, 
whereby we estimate the fair value of a reporting unit based on the present value of future cash flows.  Cash flow projections are 
based on Management's estimate of revenue growth rates and operating margins and take into consideration industry and market 
conditions as well as company and reporting unit specific economic factors.  The discount rate used is based on the weighted 
average  cost  of  capital  adjusted  for  the  relevant  risk  associated  with  the  business  specific  characteristics  and  the  uncertainty 
associated with the reporting unit's ability to execute on the projected cash flows.  For the step 1 quantitative impairment testing 
for Arnold's  reporting  units,  we  used  only  an  income  approach  because  we  determined  that  the  guideline  public  company 
comparables  for  PMAG,  FlexMag  and  PTM  were  not  representative  of  these  reporting  three  reporting  units.    In  the  income 
approach, we used a weighted average cost of capital of 12.5% for PMAG, 12.0% for Flexmag and 13% for PTM.

The Step 2 goodwill impairment test of the PMAG reporting unit has not been completed.  The Company has estimated a range 
of impairment loss of $14 million to $19 million based on the value of the total invested capital of the PMAG unit as well as the 
results of the Step 1 testing of the fair value of PMAG.  The Company recorded an estimated impairment loss for PMAG of $16 
million at December 31, 2016.  The Step 2 test for PMAG is expected to be completed during the first quarter of 2017 and the 
Company will record any necessary adjustments to the impairment loss estimate based on the results of the final testing.

2016 Annual goodwill impairment testing

The Company uses a qualitative approach to test goodwill for impairment by first assessing qualitative factors to determine whether 
it is more-likely-than-not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount as a basis for determining whether 
it is necessary to perform the two-step goodwill impairment testing.  The qualitative factors we consider include, in part, the general 
macroeconomic environment, industry and market specific conditions for each reporting unit, financial performance including 
actual versus planned results and results of relevant prior periods, operating costs and cost impacts, as well as issues or events 
specific to the reporting unit.  At March 31, 2016, we determined that the Tridien reporting unit (which is reported as a discontinued 
operations  in  the  accompanying  financial  statements  after  the  sale  of  the  reporting  unit  in  September  2016)  required  further 
quantitative testing (Step 1) because we could not conclude that the fair value of the reporting unit exceeds its carrying value based 
on qualitative factors alone.  Results of the Step 1 quantitative testing of Tridien indicated that the fair value of Tridien exceeded 
its carrying value.  For the reporting units that were tested qualitatively, the results of the qualitative analysis indicated that the 
fair value of those reporting units exceeded their carrying value. 

2016 Indefinite Lived Intangible Asset Impairment Testing

The Company uses a qualitative approach to test indefinite lived intangible assets for impairment by first assessing qualitative 
factors to determine whether it is more-likely-than-not that the fair value of an indefinite lived intangible asset is impaired as a 
basis for determining whether it is necessary to perform quantitative impairment testing.  The Company evaluated the qualitative 
factors of each reporting unit that maintains indefinite lived intangible assets in connection with the annual impairment testing 
for 2016.  Our indefinite-lived intangible assets consist of trade names with a carrying value of approximately $72.2 million at 
December 31, 2016.  The results of the qualitative analysis of our indefinite lived intangible assets, which we completed during 
the quarter ended June 30, 2016,  indicated that the fair value of the indefinite lived intangible assets exceeded their carrying value. 

F-32

2015 Annual goodwill impairment testing

The Company used a qualitative approach to test goodwill for impairment for the 2015 annual impairment test.  At March 31, 
2015, we determined that Liberty and two of the three reporting units at Arnold, PMAG and Flexmag , required further quantitative 
testing (step 1) because we could not conclude that the fair value of the reporting units exceeds their carrying value based on 
qualitative factors alone.  For the reporting units that were tested qualitatively, the  results of the qualitative analysis indicated that 
the fair value of those reporting units exceeded their carrying value. 

In the first step of the goodwill impairment test, we compare the fair value of each reporting unit to its carrying amount.  We 
estimate  the  fair  value  of  our  reporting  units  using  either  an  income  approach  or  a  market  approach,  or,  where  applicable,  a 
weighting of the two methods.  Under the income approach, we estimate the fair value of a reporting unit based on the present 
value of future cash flows.  Cash flow projections are based on Management's estimate of revenue growth rates and operating 
margins and take into consideration industry and market conditions as well as company specific economic factors.   The discount 
rate used is based on the weighted average cost of capital adjusted for the relevant risk associated with the business specific 
characteristics and the uncertainty associated with the reporting unit's ability to execute on the projected cash flows.  Under the 
market approach, we estimate fair value based on market multiples of revenue and earnings derived from comparable public 
companies with operating and investment characteristics that are similar to the reporting unit.  We weigh the fair value derived 
from the market approach depending on the level of comparability of these public companies to the reporting unit.  When market 
comparables are not meaningful or available,  we estimate the fair value of the reporting unit using only the income approach.   
For the step 1 quantitative impairment test at Liberty, we utilized both the income approach and the market approach, with a 50% 
weighting assigned to each method.  The weighted average cost of capital used in the income approach at Liberty was 13.8%.  For 
the step 1 quantitative impairment test at the PMAG and Flexmag reporting units of Arnold, we used only an income approach as 
we determined that the guideline public company comparables for both units were not representative of these reporting units' 
markets.  In the income approach, we used a weighted average cost of capital of 13.6% for PMAG and 14.6% for Flexmag.  Results 
of the quantitative testing of the Liberty reporting unit and Arnold's PMAG and Flexmag reporting units indicated that the fair 
value of these reporting units exceeded their carrying value.

2015 Indefinite Lived Intangible Asset Impairment Testing

We use a qualitative approach to test indefinite lived intangible assets for impairment by first assessing qualitative factors to 
determine whether it is more-likely-than-not that the fair value of an indefinite lived intangible asset is impaired as a basis for 
determining whether it is necessary to perform quantitative impairment testing.  Our indefinite-lived intangible assets consist of 
trade names with a carrying value of approximately $72.3 million at December 31, 2015.  Results of the qualitative analysis 
indicate that the carrying value of the Company’s indefinite lived intangible assets did not exceed their fair value. 

2014 Annual Goodwill Impairment Testing

At March 31, 2014, the Company elected to use the qualitative assessment alternative to test goodwill for impairment for each of 
the reporting units that maintain a goodwill carrying value. The Company determined that two of Arnold’s three reporting units 
required further quantitative testing (Step 1) since the Company could not conclude that the fair value of Arnold’s reporting units 
exceeded their carrying values based solely on qualitative factors. Results of the quantitative analysis indicated that the fair value 
of these reporting units exceeds their carrying value. The fair value of the reporting unit was determined utilizing a discounted 
cash flow methodology ("DCF") on both an income and market approach for the Flexmag reporting unit and the income approach 
for Precision Thin Metals reporting unit.  A representative market does not exist for Precision Thin metals.  The DCF utilized a 
weighted average cost of capital of 12.5% for Flexmag and 14.5% for Precision Thin Metals.  Results of the quantitative analysis 
indicated that the fair value of these reporting units exceeds their carrying value at March 31, 2014.

2014 Indefinite Lived Intangible Asset Impairment Testing

At March 31, 2014, the Company elected to use the qualitative assessment alternative to test indefinite lived intangible assets for 
impairment for each of the reporting units that maintain indefinite lived intangible assets.  The optional qualitative assessment 
permits an entity to consider events and circumstances that could affect the fair value of the indefinite-lived intangible asset and 
avoid the quantitative test if the entity is able to support a conclusion that the indefinite-lived intangible asset is not impaired. The 
Company’s indefinite-lived intangible assets consisted of trade names with a carrying value of approximately $147.6 million at 
March 31, 2014.  Results of the qualitative analysis indicate that the fair value of the Company’s indefinite-lived intangible assets 
exceeded their carrying value. 

F-33

Long lived assets

Orbit Baby

During the second quarter of 2016, Ergobaby's board of directors approved a plan to dispose of the Orbit Baby product line.  
Ergobaby determined at the time the plan was approved that the carrying value of the long lived assets associated with the Orbit 
Baby product line was not recoverable, and therefore, Ergobaby recorded a loss on disposal of assets of $5.9 million related to 
the write off of the long-lived assets of Orbit Baby.  The loss is comprised of the write-off of intangible assets of $5.5 million, 
property, plant and equipment of $0.4 million.  Ergobaby received approximately $1.0 million during the fourth quarter of 2016 
related to the sale of certain assets of the Orbit Baby product line, which reduced the loss on disposal.  

Clean Earth

Clean Earth recognized a loss on disposal of assets of $3.3 million during the fourth quarter of 2016 related to the closure of the 
Clean Earth’s Williamsport, Pennsylvania site which processed drill cuttings.  The loss was comprised of intangible assets specific 
to the Williamsport location ($1.9 million), as well as equipment ($1.4 million) that could not be repurposed to other sites at the 
time of the closing of the facility.  

The following is a summary of the net carrying amount of goodwill at December 31, 2016 and 2015 (in thousands):

December 31, 2016

December 31, 2015

Goodwill - gross carrying amount

Accumulated impairment losses

Goodwill - net carrying amount

$

$

507,637

$

(16,000)

491,637

$

390,655

—

390,655

A reconciliation of the change in the carrying value of goodwill for the years ended December 31, 2016 and 2015 are as follows 
(in thousands):

Balance at January 1, 2015

Acquisition of businesses (3)

Purchase accounting
adjustments

Foreign currency translation

Balance as of December 31,
2015

Acquisition of businesses (4)

Purchase accounting
adjustments

Impairment loss

Foreign currency translation

Balance as of December 31,
2016

Corporate (1)

5.11

Ergobaby

Liberty

Manitoba
Harvest

ACI

Arnold (2)

Clean
Earth

Sterno

Total

$

8,649

$

— $

41,664

$ 32,828

$

— $ 57,615

$

51,767

$110,633

$ 33,716

$ 336,872

—

—

—

8,649

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

—

92,966

—

—

—

—

—

—

41,664

19,367

—

—

—

—

55,805

404

—

(3,132)

—

—

—

—

—

—

706

—

—

—

—

32,828

52,673

58,019

51,767

111,339

33,716

—

—

—

—

—

(10,579)

—

2,077

—

—

—

—

—

—

(16,000)

—

6,885

6,266

—

—

—

—

—

—

56,209

706

(3,132)

390,655

125,484

(10,579)

(16,000)

2,077

$

8,649

$ 92,966

$

61,031

$ 32,828

$ 44,171

$ 58,019

$

35,767

$118,224

$ 39,982

$ 491,637

(1)  Represents goodwill resulting from purchase accounting adjustments not “pushed down” to the ACI segment. This amount is allocated 

back to the ACI segment for purposes of goodwill impairment testing. 

(2)  Arnold Magnetics has three reporting units PMAG, FlexMag and Precision Thin Metals with goodwill balances of $24.4 million, $4.8 

million and $6.5 million, respectively.

(3)  Acquisition of businesses during the year ended December 31, 2015 includes both the acquisition of Manitoba Harvest in July 2015 ($37.9 
million) and the Manitoba Harvest add-on acquisition of HOCI in December 2015 ($17.9 million).  The amount allocated to goodwill for 
HOCI was finalized during 2016.  

(4)  Acquisition of businesses during the year ended December 31, 2016 includes the acquisition of 5.11 by the Company in August 2016, and 

the add-on acquisitions of NII by Sterno, Phoenix Soil and EWS by Clean Earth and Baby Tula by Ergobaby.

Approximately $103.0 million of goodwill is deductible for income tax purposes at December 31, 2016.

F-34

Other intangible assets subject to amortization are comprised of the following (in thousands):

Customer relationships

Technology and patents

Trade names, subject to amortization

Licensing and non-compete agreements
Permits and airspace (1)

Distributor relations and other

Accumulated amortization:

Customer relationships

Technology and patents

Trade names, subject to amortization

Licensing and non-compete agreements

Permits and airspace

Distributor relations and other

Total accumulated amortization

Trade names, not subject to amortization

Total intangibles, net

Weighted
Average
Useful Lives

13

9

15

4

13

5

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

$

304,751

$

212,454

44,710

128,675

7,845

113,295

606

599,882

(79,607)

(18,290)

(6,833)

(5,987)

(21,531)

(606)

(132,854)

72,183

$

539,211

$

38,230

25,003

6,024

98,673

606

380,990

(62,679)

(16,481)

(4,639)

(5,913)

(12,313)

(606)

(102,631)

72,328

350,687

(1)  Permits and airspace intangible assets relate to the acquisition of Clean Earth in August 2014.  Permits are obtained by Clean Earth for the 
treatment of soil and solid waste from various government municipalities and are amortized over the estimated life of the permit.  Modifications 
of existing permits to accept new waste streams, alterations of existing permits to enhance the permit limitations, and new permits, as well as 
the related costs associated with obtaining, modifying or renewing the permits, are capitalized and amortized over the estimated life of the permit.  

Estimated charges to amortization expense of intangible assets over the next five years, is as follows, (in thousands):

2017

2018

2019

2020

2021

$

40,808

39,420

38,130

37,644

37,641

$

193,643

The Company’s amortization expense of intangible assets for the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 totaled $35.1 
million, $28.8 million and $23.1 million, and respectively.

Note I — Fair Value Measurement
The following table provides the assets and liabilities carried at fair value measured on a recurring basis as of December 31, 
2016 and 2015 (in thousands):

Assets:

     investment - FOX

Liabilities:
    Put option of noncontrolling shareholders (1)
    Contingent consideration - acquisitions (2)

    Interest rate swap

Total recorded at fair value

Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2016

Carrying
Value

Level 1

Level 2

Level 3

$

141,767

$

141,767

$

— $

—

(180)

(4,830)

(10,719)

—

—

—

—

—

(10,719)

(180)

(4,830)

—

$

126,038

$

141,767

$

(10,719) $

(5,010)

F-35

Assets:

    Equity method investment - FOX

Liabilities:
    Put option of noncontrolling shareholders (3)

    Interest rate swap

Total recorded at fair value

Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2015

Carrying
Value

Level 1

Level 2

Level 3

$

$

249,747

$

249,747

$

— $

(50)

(13,483)

—

—

—

(13,483)

236,214

$

249,747

$

(13,483) $

—

(50)

—

(50)

(1)  Represents put options issued to noncontrolling shareholders in connection with the Liberty acquisition in 2010 and the 5.11 

acquisition in 2016.

(2)  Represents potential earn-outs payable as additional purchase price consideration by Sterno in connection with the acquisition of NII 

and Ergobaby in connection with the acquisition of Baby Tula. 

(3)  Represents put options issued to noncontrolling shareholders in connection with the Liberty acquisition.

A  reconciliation  of  the  change  in  the  carrying  value  of  the  Company’s  Level  3  fair  value  measurements  for  the  year  ended 
December 31, 2016 and 2015 is as follows (in thousands):

Balance at January 1st

Contingent consideration - NII

Contingent consideration - Baby Tula

Put option issued to noncontrolling shareholder - 5.11

Payment of contingent consideration - NII

Increase in the fair value of put option of noncontrolling
shareholders - Liberty

2016

2015

$

(50) $

(50)

(1,500)

(3,780)

(50)

450

(80)

—

—

—

—

—

Balance at December 31st

$

(5,010) $

(50)

Valuation Techniques

Investment in FOX

The investment in FOX is measured at fair value using the closing price of FOX's shares on the NASDAQ stock exchange as of 
the last business day in the reporting period.  Since the FOX shares are traded on a public stock exchange, the fair value measurement 
is categorized as Level I. 

Options of noncontrolling shareholders:

The put options of noncontrolling shareholders were determined based on inputs that were not readily available in public markets 
or able to be derived from information available in publicly quoted markets. As such, the Company categorized the put options 
of the noncontrolling shareholders as Level 3. The primary inputs associated with this valuation are earnings before interest, taxes 
amortization and depreciation times a multiple established in the shareholder put option agreement, which is used to determine a 
per share equity value for the shares that can be put back to the Company.  The per share equity value of the Liberty put option is 
discounted for liquidity and marketability, as well as a the probability of a triggering event.  An increase or decrease in these 
primary inputs would not have a material impact on the determination of the fair value of these put options.  As a result of the 
Liberty recapitalization (refer to "Note O - Noncontrolling Interest" for a description of the transaction), the number of shares  that 
can be put back to the Company by the noncontrolling shareholders increased, resulting in an increase in the fair value of the put 
option.  

F-36

Interest rate swap:

The Company’s derivative instruments at December 31, 2016 consisted of over-the-counter interest rate swap contracts which are 
not traded on a public exchange. The fair value of the Company’s interest rate swap contracts were determined based on inputs 
that were readily available in public markets or could be derived from information available in publicly quoted markets.  As such, 
the Company categorized the swaps as Level 2. Changes in the fair value of the interest rate swap liability during the year ended 
December 31, 2016 were expensed to interest expense on the consolidated statement of operations. Refer to "Note K - Derivative 
Instruments and Hedging Activities".

Contingent Consideration:

Sterno Products entered into a contingent consideration arrangement associated with the purchase of NII in January 2016.  The 
earnout provision provides for payments up to $1.8 million over a two year period subsequent to acquisition.  Earnings before 
interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization ("EBITDA") is the performance target defined and measured to determine the earnout 
payment due, if any, after each defined measurement period.  The contingent consideration was valued at $1.5 million using 
probability  weighted  models.    During  the  quarter  ended  September  30,  2016,  Sterno  paid  $0.5  million  of  the  contingent 
consideration.  At December 31, 2016, Sterno determined that it was more likely than not that the full amount of the contingent 
consideration would be paid out, and recorded an additional $0.4 million in earnout, which was recorded though the statement of 
operations.

In connection with the acquisition of Baby Tula in May 2016, Ergobaby entered into a contingent consideration arrangement with 
the sellers.  The earnout provision provides for additional consideration of $8.2 million if the gross profit for Baby Tula for the 
2017 fiscal year exceeds a specified level.  No earnout amount will be paid if the specified gross profit level is not met.  Ergobaby 
valued the contingent consideration at a fair value of $3.8 million using a probability weighted option pricing model.  At December 
31, 2016, Ergobaby determined that the fair value of the liability was appropriate.

2014 Term Loan and 2016 Incremental Term Loan

At December 31, 2016, the carrying value of the principal under the Company's outstanding 2014 Term Loan, including the current 
portion, was $565.7 million, which approximates fair value because it has a variable interest rate that reflects market changes in 
interest rates and changes in the Company's net leverage ratio.  The estimated fair value of the outstanding 2014 Term Loan is  
classified as Level 2 in the fair value hierarchy.

Nonrecurring Fair Value Measurements

The following table provides the assets and liabilities carried at fair value measured on a non-recurring basis as of December 31, 
2016 (in thousands).  Refer to "Note H – Goodwill and Intangibles", for a description of the valuation techniques used to determine 
fair value of the assets measured on a non-recurring basis in the table below. There were no assets and liabilities carried at fair 
value measured on a non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2015 or 2014.

Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2016

Year ended

Expense

(in thousands)

Goodwill - Arnold
Property, plant and equipment (1)
Tradename (1)
Technology (1)
Customer relationships (1)
Permits (1)

Carrying
Value

$

$

$

$

$

$

35,767

$

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

Level 1

Level 2

Level 3

December 31,
2016

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

35,767

$

16,000

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

— $

1,824

317

3,460

2,426

1,177

(1)  Represents the fair value of the respective assets at the Orbit Baby product line, and the Clean Earth Williamsport site.  Refer to "Note 
H - Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets" for further discussion regarding the impairment and valuation techniques applied.

F-37

Note J – Debt

2014 Credit Agreement

On June 6, 2014, the Company obtained a $725 million credit facility from a group of lenders (the “2014 Credit Facility”) led by 
Bank of America N.A. as Administrative Agent.  The 2014 Credit Facility provides for (i) a revolving credit facility of $400 million
(the “2014 Revolving Credit Facility”) and (ii) a $325 million term loan (the “2014 Term Loan Facility”).  The 2014 Credit Facility 
permits  the  Company  to  increase  the  2014  Revolving  Credit  Facility  commitment  and/  or  obtain  additional  term  loans  in  an 
aggregate of up to $200 million.  The 2014 Credit Agreement is secured by all of the assets of the Company, including all of its 
equity interests in, and loans to, its consolidated subsidiaries.  The 2014 Credit Facility was amended in June 2015, primarily to 
allow for intercompany loans to, and the acquisition of, Canadian-based companies on an unsecured basis, and to modify provisions 
that would allow for early termination of a "Leverage Increase Period," thereby providing additional flexibility as to the timing 
of subsequent acquisitions.  On August 15, 2016, the Company amended the 2014 Credit Facility to, among other things, increase 
the aggregate amount of the 2014 Credit Facility by $400 million.  On August 31, 2016, the Company entered into an Incremental 
Facility Amendment to the 2014 Credit Agreement (the "Incremental Facility Amendment").  The Incremental Facility Amendment 
provided for an increase to the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility of $150 million, and the 2016 Incremental Term Loan, in the amount 
of $250 million.  As a result of the Incremental Facility Amendment, the 2014 Credit Facility currently provides for (i) a revolving 
credit facility of $550 million (as amended from time to time, the "2014 Revolving Credit Facility"), (ii) a $325 million term loan 
(the "2014 Term Loan Facility"), and (iii) a $250 million incremental term loan "the "2016 Incremental Term Loan"). 

2014 Revolving Credit Facility

The 2014 Revolving Credit Facility will become due in June 2019.  The Company can borrow, prepay and re-borrow principal 
under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility from time to time during its term.  Advances under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility 
can be either LIBOR rate loans or base rate loans.  LIBOR rate revolving loans bear interest at a rate per annum equal to the 
London Interbank Offered Rate (the “LIBOR Rate”) plus a margin ranging from 2.00% to 2.75% based on the ratio of consolidated 
net indebtedness to adjusted consolidated earnings before interest expense, tax expense and depreciation and amortization expenses 
(the “Consolidated Leverage Ratio”).   Base rate revolving loans bear interest at a fluctuating rate per annum equal to the greatest 
of (i) the prime rate of interest, or (ii) the Federal Funds Rate plus 0.5% (the “Base Rate”), plus a margin ranging from 1.00% to 
1.75% based upon the Consolidated Leverage Ratio.  

2014 Term Loan Facility

The 2014 Term Loan Facility expires in June 2021 and requires quarterly payments  that commenced September 30, 2014, with 
a final payment of all remaining principal and interest due on June 6, 2021.  The 2014 Term Loan Facility was issued at an original 
issue discount of 99.5% of par value and bears interest at either the applicable LIBOR Rate plus 3.25% per annum, or Base Rate 
plus 2.25% per annum.  The LIBOR Rate applicable to both base rate loans and LIBOR rate loans shall in no event be less than 
1.00% at any time. 

2016 Incremental Term Loan

The 2016 Incremental Term Loan was issued at an original issue discount of 99.25% of par value.  The Company incurred $6.0 
million in additional debt issuance costs related to the Incremental Credit Facility, which will be recognized as expense during 
the remaining term of the related 2014 Revolving Credit Facility,  and 2014 Term Loan and 2016 Incremental Term Loan.  The 
Incremental Facility Amendment did not change the due dates or applicable interest rates of the 2014 Credit Agreement.  The 
quarterly payments for the term advances under the 2014 Credit Agreement increased to approximately $1.4 million per quarter.  
The Company used the proceeds from the Incremental Facility Amendment to fund the acquisition of 5.11 Tactical (refer to Note 
C - "Acquisitions").  

Other

The 2014 Credit Facility provides for sub-facilities under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility pursuant to which an aggregate 
amount of up to $100.0 million in letters of credit may be issued, as well as swing line loans of up to $25.0 million outstanding 
at one time. The issuance of such letters of credit and the making of any swing line loan reduces the amount available under the 
2014 Revolving Credit Facility. The Company will pay (i) commitment fees on the unused portion of the 2014 Revolving Credit 
Facility ranging from 0.45% to 0.60% per annum based on its Consolidated Leverage Ratio, (ii) quarterly letter of credit fees, and 
(iii) administrative and agency fees.  

F-38

 
Debt Issuance Costs
Deferred debt issuance costs represent the costs associated with the entering into the 2014 Credit Facility as well as the issuance 
costs  associated  with  the August  2016  Incremental  Facility Amendment  and  are  amortized  over  the  term  of  the  related  debt 
instrument. Since the Company can borrow, repay and re-borrow principal under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility, the debt 
issuance costs associated with this facility have been classified as other non-current assets in the accompanying consolidated 
balance sheet.  The debt issuance costs associated with the 2014 Term Loan and 2016 Incremental Term Loan are classified as a 
reduction of long-term debt in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet.  

The Company paid debt issuance costs of $7.3 million in connection with the 2014 Credit Facility (of which $0.2 million was 
expensed as debt modification and extinguishment costs and $7.1 million is being amortized over the term of the related debt in 
the 2014 Credit Facility) and recorded additional debt modification and extinguishment costs of $2.1 million to write-off previously 
capitalized debt issuance costs associated with the Company's prior credit facility. The Company paid $6.0 million in debt issuance 
costs in connection with the 2016 Incremental Facility Amendment.  

The  following  table  summarizes  debt  issuance  costs  at  December  31,  2016  and  December  31,  2015,  and  the  balance  sheet 
classification in each of the periods presents (in thousands):

Deferred debt issuance costs

Accumulated amortization

Deferred debt issuance costs, net

Balance sheet classification:

Other noncurrent assets

Long-term debt

December 31, 2016

December 31, 2015

$

$

$

$

18,960

$

(6,248)

12,712

$

4,698

$

8,014

12,712

$

12,974

(3,508)

9,466

4,863

4,603

9,466

Covenants

The Company is subject to certain customary affirmative and restrictive covenants arising under the 2014 Credit Facility. The 
following table reflects required and actual financial ratios as of December 31, 2015 included as part of the affirmative covenants 
in the 2014 Credit Facility:

Description of Required Covenant Ratio
Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio

Total Debt to EBITDA Ratio

Covenant Ratio Requirement

greater than or equal to 1.5:1.0

less than or equal to 4:25:1.0

Actual Ratio

4.24:1.00

2.88:1.00

A  breach  of  any  of  these  covenants  will  be  an  event  of  default  under  the  2014  Credit  Facility.  Upon  the  occurrence  of  an 
event of default under the 2014 Credit Facility, the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility may be terminated, the 2014 Term Loan Facility 
and all outstanding loans and other obligations under the 2014 Credit Facility may become immediately due and payable and any 
letters of credit then outstanding may be required to be cash collateralized, and the Agent and the Lenders may exercise any rights 
or remedies available to them under the 2014 Credit Facility. Any such event would materially impair the Company’s ability to 
conduct its business. As of December 31, 2016, the Company was in compliance with all covenants as defined in the 2014 Credit 
Agreement.

Letters of credit

The 2014 Credit Facility allows for letters of credit in an aggregate face amount of up to $100.0 million.  Letters of credit outstanding 
at December 31, 2016 totaled  $4.2 million and at December 31, 2015 totaled $4.2 million.  Letter of credit fees recorded to interest 
expense was $0.1 million in each of the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014.

F-39

  
Interest hedge

The Company entered into an interest rate swap on $220 million of outstanding debt for a period from April 2016 through June 
2021 in connection with the term of our 2014 Term Loan. Refer to "Note K - Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities" for 
further information on the interest rate derivatives entered into as part of the Term Loan Facility.

The following table provides the Company’s debt holdings at December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015 (in thousands):

Revolving Credit Facility

Term Loan Facility
Original issue discount (1)

Deferred financing costs - term debt

Total debt

Less: Current portion, term loan facilities

Long term debt

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

$

$

$

4,400

$

565,658

(4,706)

(8,015)

557,337

(5,685)

551,652

$

$

—

320,125

(3,633)

(4,603)

311,889

(3,250)

308,639

(1)  The Company recorded $4.6 million in original issue discount upon issuance of the 2014 Term Loan Facility in June 2014 and $1.9 

million in original issue discount upon issuance of the 2016 Incremental Term Loan. This discount is being amortized over the life of the 
2014 Term Loan Facility and 2016 Incremental Term Loan.

Annual maturities of the Company's debt obligations under the 2014 Credit Facility are as follows (in thousands):

2017

2018

2019

2020

2021

$

$

5,685

5,685

10,085

5,685

538,212

565,352

The following details the components of interest expense in each of the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 (in 
thousands):

Interest on credit facilities

Unused fee on Revolving Credit Facility

Amortization of original issue discount

Unrealized losses on interest rate derivatives

Letter of credit fees

Other

Interest expense

Average daily balance of debt outstanding

Effective interest rate

Year ended December 31,
2015

2014

2016

$

19,861

$

17,590

$

16,392

1,947

802

1,539

108

415

1,612

671

5,662

121

286

1,914

882

7,709

62

138

$

$

24,672

477,656

$

$

25,942

443,348

$

$

27,097

379,034

5.2%

5.9%

7.2%

Note K — Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

Interest Rate Swaps

On September 16, 2014, the Company purchased an interest rate swap ("New Swap") with a notional amount of $220 million.  
The New Swap is effective April 1, 2016 through June 6, 2021, the termination date of our 2014 Term Loan.  The interest rate 
swap agreement requires the Company to pay interest rates on the notional amount at the rate of 2.97% in exchange for the three-

F-40

month LIBOR rate.  At December 31, 2016 and 2015, the New Swap had a fair value loss of $10.7 million and $13.0 million, 
respectively, principally reflecting the present value of future payments and receipts under the agreement.

In October 2011, the Company purchased a three-year interest rate swap (the "Swap") with a notional amount of $200 million
effective January 1, 2011 through March 31, 2016.  The interest rate swap agreement required the Company to pay interest on the 
notional amount at the rate of 2.49% in exchange for the three-month LIBOR rate, with a floor of 1.5%.  At December 31, 2015, 
this Swap had a fair value loss of $0.5 million.  A final payment under the Swap of $0.5 million was made on March 31, 2016 
when the Swap contract ended.     

The  following  table  reflects  the  classification  of  the  Company's  Interest  Rate  Swaps  on  the  Consolidated  Balance  Sheets  at 
December 31, 2016 and 2015 (in thousands): 

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

Other current liabilities

Other non-current liabilities

Total fair value

$

$

4,010

6,709

10,719

$

$

3,914

9,569

13,483

The Company did not elect hedge accounting for the above derivative transaction associated with the Credit Facility and changes 
in fair value are included in interest expense on the consolidated statement of operations.

Foreign Currency Contracts

The Company's Arnold operating segment from time to time will use forward contracts and options to hedge the value of the 
Eurodollar against the Swiss Franc or the British Pound Sterling.  Mark-to-market gains and losses on these instruments were not 
material to the consolidated results during each of the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 or 2014.  At December 31, 2016 and 
2015, these contracts had notional values of €0.8 million and €1.6 million, respectively, and maturity dates within three months 
of year-end.

Note L — Income Taxes

Compass Diversified Holdings and Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC are classified as partnerships for U.S. Federal 
income tax purposes and are not subject to income taxes. Each of the Company’s majority owned subsidiaries are subject to Federal 
and state income taxes.

Components of the Company's pretax income (loss) before taxes are as follows (in thousands):

Income Before Income Taxes

Domestic (including U.S. exports)

Foreign subsidiaries

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

$

63,783

$

29,432

$

267,796

(564)

(5,440)

7,327

63,219

$

23,992

$

275,123

F-41

Components of the Company’s income tax provision (benefit) are as follows (in thousands):

Current taxes

Federal

State

Foreign

Total current taxes

Deferred taxes:

Federal

State

Foreign

Total deferred taxes

Total tax provision

Year ended December 31,
2015

2014

2016

$

12,994

$

16,079

$

2,486

3,857

19,337

(5,816)

(1,357)

(2,695)

(9,868)

2,567

688

19,334

(764)

70

(3,639)

(4,333)

$

9,469

$

15,001

$

16,821

(2,728)

1,008

15,101

(8,238)

(1,394)

(423)

(10,055)

5,046

The tax effects of temporary differences that have resulted in the creation of deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities at 
December 31, 2016 and 2015 are as follows (in thousands):

December 31,

2016

2015

Deferred tax assets:

Tax credits

Accounts receivable and allowances

Net operating loss carryforwards

Accrued expenses

Other

Total deferred tax assets

Valuation allowance (1)

Net deferred tax assets

Deferred tax liabilities:

Intangible assets

Property and equipment

Repatriation of foreign earnings

Prepaid and other expenses

Total deferred tax liabilities

Total net deferred tax liability

$

11,485

$

1,032

28,896

7,324

3,966

52,703

$

(7,256)

45,447

$

(120,645) $

(19,810)

(8,973)

(6,857)

$

$

$

$

$

60

661

6,254

5,927

3,243

16,145

(1,308)

14,837

(92,083)

(17,750)

—

(1,723)

(156,285) $

(111,556)

(110,838) $

(96,719)

(1)  Primarily relates to the 5.11 and Arnold operating segments.

For the years ending December 31, 2016 and 2015, the Company recognized approximately $156.3 million and $111.6 million, 
respectively in deferred tax liabilities. A significant portion of the balance in deferred tax liabilities reflects temporary differences 
in the basis of property and equipment and intangible assets related to the Company’s purchase accounting adjustments in connection 
with the acquisition of certain of its businesses. For financial accounting purposes the Company has recognized a significant 
increase in the fair values of the intangible assets and property and equipment in certain of the businesses it acquired. For income 
tax purposes the existing, pre-acquisition tax basis of the intangible assets and property and equipment is utilized. In order to 
reflect the increase in the financial accounting basis over the existing tax basis, a deferred tax liability was recorded. This liability 
will decrease in future periods as these temporary differences reverse but may be replaced by deferred tax liabilities generated as 
a result of future acquisitions.

A valuation allowance relating to the realization of foreign tax credits and net operating losses of $7.3 million was provided at 
December 31, 2016 and $1.3 million was provided at December 31, 2015. A valuation allowance is provided whenever it is more 
likely than not that some or all of deferred assets recorded may not be realized.

F-42

The reconciliation between the Federal Statutory Rate and the effective income tax rate for 2016, 2015 and 2014 are as follows:

United States Federal Statutory Rate

State income taxes (net of Federal benefits)

Foreign income taxes

Expenses of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC representing a pass 
through to shareholders (1)

Effect of (gain) loss on equity method investment
Effect of deconsolidation of subsidiary (2)

Impact of subsidiary employee stock options

Domestic production activities deduction

Non-deductible acquisition costs
Effect of undistributed foreign earnings (3)

Non-recognition of NOL carryforwards at subsidiaries

Other

Effective income tax rate

Year ended December 31,
2015

2014

2016

35.0%

0.6

1.5

3.6

(41.2)

—

1.3

(0.9)

1.9

4.2

3.6

5.4

15.0%

35.0%

6.5

1.2

29.1

(6.6)

—

1.3

(3.2)

—

—

(6.1)

5.3

62.5%

35.0%

(1.0)

(0.3)

2.3

(1.4)

(33.6)

—

(0.3)

0.1

—

0.5

0.5

1.8%

(1)  The effective income tax rate for each of the years presented includes losses at the Company’s parent, which is taxed as a partnership.
(2)  The effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2014 includes a significant gain at the Company's parent related to the 

deconsolidation of FOX in July 2014.

(3)  During the quarter ended September 30, 2016, management changed the previously asserted position that Arnold planned to permanently 
reinvest foreign earnings of controlled foreign corporations.  The principal reason for changing our position is management's plan to repatriate 
excess foreign cash at Arnold to pay down intercompany debt at the Company.   

A reconciliation of the amount of unrecognized tax benefits for 2016, 2015 and 2014 are as follows (in thousands):

Balance at January 1, 2014

Additions for current years’ tax positions

Additions for prior years’ tax positions
Reductions for prior years’ tax positions (1)

Reductions for settlements

Reductions for expiration of statute of limitations

Balance at December 31, 2014

Additions for current years’ tax positions

Additions for prior years’ tax positions

Reductions for prior years’ tax positions

Reductions for settlements

Reductions for expiration of statute of limitations

Balance at December 31, 2015

Additions for current years’ tax positions
Additions for prior years’ tax positions (2)

Reductions for prior years’ tax positions

Reductions for settlements

Reductions for expiration of statute of limitations

Balance at December 31, 2016

$

$

$

$

7,960

19

141

(7,620)

—

(67)

433

73

—

(15)

—

(102)

389

64

10,150

(16)

—

(87)

10,500

(1) $7.6 million of the reduction for prior year tax positions relates to the deconsolidation of FOX in July 2014.  

(2) The increase in prior year tax positions during the year ended December 31, 2016 relates to an unrecognized tax benefit at the Company's 
5.11 business, which was acquired in September 2016.

F-43

Included in the unrecognized tax benefits at December 31, 2016 and 2015 is $10.4 million and $0.2 million, respectively, of tax 
benefits that, if recognized, would affect the Company’s effective tax rate.  The Company accrues interest and penalties related 
to uncertain tax positions. The amounts accrued at December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 are not material to the Company.  Such 
amounts are included in the provision (benefit) for income taxes in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations.  The 
change in the unrecognized tax benefit during 2016 resulted from the acquisition of 5.11.  The change in the unrecognized tax 
benefit during 2015 was not material.  The change in 2014 in the unrecognized tax benefits resulted from the deconsolidation of 
FOX.  It is expected that the amount of unrecognized tax benefits will change in the next twelve months. However, we do not 
expect the change to have a significant impact on the consolidated results of operations or financial position.

Each of the Company’s businesses file U.S. Federal, state and foreign income tax returns in multiple jurisdictions with varying 
statutes of limitations. The 2012 through 2016 tax years generally remain subject to examinations by the taxing authorities.

Note M – Defined Benefit Plan

In  connection  with  the  acquisition  of Arnold,  the  Company  has  a  defined  benefit  plan  covering  substantially  all  of Arnold’s 
employees at its Lupfig, Switzerland location. The benefits are based on years of service and the employees’ highest average 
compensation during the specific period. 

The following table sets forth the plan’s funded status and amounts recognized in the Company’s consolidated balance sheets at 
December 31, 2016 and 2015 (in thousands):

Change in benefit obligation:

Benefit obligation, beginning of year

Service cost

Interest cost

Actuarial (gain)/loss

Employee contributions and transfer

Plan amendment

Benefits paid

Foreign currency translation

Benefit obligation

Change in plan assets:

Fair value of assets, beginning of period

Actual return on plan assets

Company contribution

Employee contributions and transfer

Benefits paid

Foreign currency translation

Fair value of assets

Funded status

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

$

13,392

$

14,712

409

130

817

—

315

(810)

(449)

13,804

578

167

143

(497)

(107)

(1,579)

(25)

13,392

$

10,897

$

11,408

122

390

315

(810)

(365)

10,549

$

(3,255) $

310

427

350

(1,579)

(19)

10,897

(2,495)

The  unfunded  liability  of  $3.3  million  and  $2.5  million  at  December 31,  2016  and  2015,  respectively,  is  recognized  in  the 
consolidated balance sheet within other non-current liabilities. Net periodic benefit cost consists of the following (in thousands):

Service cost

Interest cost

Expected return on plan assets

Net periodic benefit cost

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

2014

$

409

130

15

$

578

167

310

554

$

1,055

$

425

271

(468)

228

$

$

F-44

Assumptions used to determine the benefit obligations and components of the net periodic benefit cost at December 31, 2016 and 
2015:

Discount rate

Expected return on plan assets

Rate of compensation increase

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

0.65%

1.40%

1.00%

1.00%

1.40%

1.00%

The Company considers the historical level of long-term returns and the current level of expected long-term returns for the plan 
assets, as well as the current and expected allocation of assets when developing its expected long-term rate of return on assets 
assumption. The assumptions used for the plan are based upon customary rates and practices for the location of the Company.

The Company, for 2017, will be contributing per the terms of the agreement, and the expected contribution to the plan will total 
approximately $0.7 million.

The following presents the benefit payments which are expected to be paid for the plan in each year indicated (in thousands):

2017

2018

2019

2020

2021

Thereafter

$

$

676

502

873

1,132

645

3,140

6,968

Asset management objectives include maintaining an adequate level of diversification to reduce interest rate and market risk and 
providing adequate liquidity to meet immediate and future benefit payment requirements.

The assets of the plan are reinsured in their entirety with Swiss Life Ltd. (“Swiss Life”) within the framework of the corresponding 
contracts with Swiss Life Collective BVG Foundation and Swiss Life Complementary Foundation. The assets are guaranteed by 
the insurance company and pooled with the assets of other participating employers. The allocation of pension plan assets by 
category in Swiss Life’s group life portfolio is as follows at December 31, 2016:

Certificates of deposit and cash and cash equivalents

Fixed income bonds and securities

Private equity and hedge funds

Real estate

Equity and other investments

68%

7%

1%

15%

9%

100%

The plan assets are pooled with assets of other participating employers and are not separable; therefore the fair values of the 
pension plan assets at December 31, 2016 and 2015 were considered Level 3.

Note N — Stockholder’s Equity

Trust Common Shares

The Trust is authorized to issue 500,000,000 Trust common shares and the Company is authorized to issue a corresponding number 
of LLC interests. The Company will, at all times, have the identical number of LLC interests outstanding as Trust shares. Each 
Trust share represents an undivided beneficial interest in the Trust, and each Trust share is entitled to one vote per share on any 
matter with respect to which members of the Company are entitled to vote.

F-45

Trust Preferred Shares

Pursuant to the Trust agreement, the Trust is authorized to issue up to 50,000,000 Trust preferred shares and the Company is 
authorized  to  issue  a  corresponding  number  of  Trust  Interests. As  of  December  31,  2016,  the  trust  had  no  preferred  shares 
outstanding. 

Secondary Offering

In December 2016, the Company completed an offering of 5,600,000 Trust common shares at an offering price of $18.65 per 
share.  The net proceeds to the Company, after deducting the underwriter's discount and offering costs, totaled approximately 
$99.4 million.

Allocation Interests

The Allocation Interests represent the original equity interest in the Company.  The holders of the Allocation Interests (“Holders”), 
through Sostratus LLC, are entitled to receive distributions pursuant to a profit allocation formula upon the occurrence of certain 
events. The distributions of the profit allocation is paid upon the occurrence of the sale of a material amount of capital stock or 
assets of one of the Company’s businesses (“Sale Event”) or, at the option of the Holders, at each five year anniversary date of 
the acquisition of one of the Company’s businesses (“Holding Event”). The Manager, as the original holder of the Allocation 
Interests, previously had the right to cause the Company to purchase the Allocation Interests upon termination of the MSA in 
accordance with a Supplemental Put Agreement. On July 1, 2013, the Company and the Manager amended the MSA to provide 
for certain modifications related to the Manager’s registration as an investment advisor under the Investment Advisor’s Act of 
1940,  as  amended  (the  “Advisor’s Act”).  In  connection  with  the  amendment  resulting  from  the  Managers’  registration  as  an 
investment advisor under the Advisor’s Act, the Company and the Manager agreed to terminate the Supplemental Put Agreement.  
In connection with the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, on June 27, 2013, the Manager assigned 100% of the 
Allocation Interests to Sostratus LLC.  The Company historically recorded the obligation associated with the Supplemental Put 
agreement as a liability that represented the amount the Company would have to pay to physically settle the purchase of the 
Allocation Interests upon termination of the MSA.  As a result of the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, the Company 
currently records distributions of the profit allocation to the Holders upon occurrence of a Sale Event or Holding Event as dividends 
declared on Allocation Interests to stockholders’ equity when they are approved by the Company’s board of directors.

The following is a summary of the profit allocation payments made to the Allocation Interest Holders during each of the year 
ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014:

Year ended December 31, 2016

• 

• 

• 

$8.6 million paid in the second quarter as a result of a Sale Event related to the sale of FOX shares in March 2016 (refer 
to "Note F - Investment");

$8.2 million paid in the third quarter as a result of the five year ownership holding period of our ACI business.  The 
payment is in respect of its positive contribution-based profit during the five years ended June 30, 2016;

$7.0 million  paid in the fourth quarter as a result of a Sale Event related to the sale of FOX shares in August 2016 (refer 
to "Note F - Investment") and the sale of Tridien in September 2016 (refer to "Note D - Discontinued Operations").  Under 
the terms of the Company's LLC Agreement, the Company offset the profit allocation distribution resulting from the 
FOX Sale Event by the negative profit allocation amount from the Tridien Sale Event, resulting in a net distribution to 
the Allocation Member; 

Year ended December 31, 2015

• 

• 

$14.6 million paid in the fourth quarter as a result of a Sale Event related to the sale of CamelBak in August 2015 and 
the sale of Tridien in October 2015 (refer to "Note D - Discontinued Operations").  Under the terms of the Company's 
LLC Agreement, the Company offset the profit allocation distribution resulting from the CamelBak Sale Event by the 
negative profit allocation amount related to the American Furniture Sale Event, resulting in a net distribution to the 
Allocation Member.  

$3.1 million paid in the fourth quarter as a result of a Holding Event for our five year ownership holding period of our 
Ergobaby business.  The payment is in respect of its positive contribution-based profit since our acquisition in September 
of 2010. 

Year ended December 31, 2014

• 

$11.9 million paid in the third quarter of 2014 as a result of a Sale Event related to the Sale of FOX shares in September 
2014.  

F-46

In the fourth quarter of 2016, the Company's board of directors declared a profit allocation payment to the Allocation Interest 
Holders of $13.4 million as a result of a Sale Event related to the Sale of FOX shares in November 2016.  This amount has been 
recorded as "Due to related parties" in the accompanying balance sheet at December 31, 2016, and will be paid in the first quarter 
of 2017.  

Earnings per share

Basic and diluted earnings per share for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 is calculated as follows:

Income (loss) from continuing operations attributable to Holdings

Less: Profit Allocation paid to Holders

Less: Effect of contribution based profit—Holding Event

Income (loss) from Holdings attributable to Trust common shares

Income from discontinued operations attributable to Holdings

Less: Effect of contribution based profit

$

$

$

2016

2015

2014

51,788

$

3,858

$

258,416

23,779

2,862

17,731

2,804

11,870

2,259

25,147

$

(16,677) $

244,287

2,898

$

157,980

$

20,419

—

—

546

Income from discontinued operations attributable to Trust common shares $

2,898

$

157,980

$

19,873

Basic and diluted weighted average shares outstanding

54,591

54,300

49,089

Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share attributable to Holdings

Continuing operations

Discontinued operations

Distributions

$

$

$

0.46

0.05

0.51

$

$

$

(0.30) $

2.91

2.61

$

$

4.98

0.40

5.38

During the year ended December 31, 2016, the Company paid the following distributions:

•  On January 28, 2016, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of January 21, 2016. 

This distribution was declared on January 7, 2016.

•  On April 28, 2016, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of April 22, 2016. This 

distribution was declared on April 7, 2016.

•  On July 28, 2016, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of July 21, 2016.  This 

distribution was declared on July 7, 2016.  

•  On October 27, 2016, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of October 20, 2016.  

This distribution was declared on October 6, 2016.  

On January 26, 2017, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of January 19, 2017.  This 
distribution was declared in January 5, 2017.

During the year ended December 31, 2015, the Company paid the following distributions:

•  On January 29, 2015, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of January 22, 2015. 

This distribution was declared on January 8, 2015.

•  On April 29, 2015, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of April 22, 2015. This 

distribution was declared on April 9, 2015.

•  On July 29, 2015, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of July 22, 2015. This 

distribution was declared on July 9, 2015.

•  On October 29, 2015, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of October 22, 2015. 

This distribution was declared on October 7, 2015.

During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company paid the following distributions:

•  On January 30, 2014, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of January 23, 2014. 

This distribution was declared on January 9, 2014.

F-47

•  On April 30, 2014, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of April 23, 2014. This 

distribution was declared on April 10, 2014.

•  On July 30, 2014, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of July 23, 2014. This 

distribution was declared on July 10, 2014.

•  On October 30, 2014, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of October 23, 2014. 

This distribution was declared on October 7, 2014.

Note O — Noncontrolling Interest

Noncontrolling interest represents the portion of a majority-owned subsidiary’s net income and equity that is owned by 
noncontrolling shareholders.

The following tables reflect the Company’s percentage ownership of its businesses, as of December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 
and related noncontrolling interest balances as of December 31, 2016 and 2015:

5.11 Tactical

Ergobaby

Liberty

Manitoba Harvest

ACI

Arnold Magnetics

Clean Earth

Sterno Products

% Ownership (1)
December 31, 2016

% Ownership (1)
December 31, 2015

% Ownership (1)
December 31, 2014

Primary

Fully
Diluted

Primary

Fully
Diluted

Primary

Fully
Diluted

97.5

83.5

88.6

76.6

69.4

96.7

97.5

100.0

85.1

76.9

84.7

65.6

69.3

84.7

79.8

89.5

n/a

81.0

96.2

76.6

69.4

96.7

97.5

100.0

n/a

74.2

84.6

65.6

69.3

87.3

86.2

89.7

n/a

81.0

96.2

n/a

69.4

96.7

97.9

100.0

n/a

74.3

84.8

n/a

69.3

87.5

86.2

91.7

(1)  The principal difference between primary and fully diluted percentages of our operating segments is due to stock option issuances of 

operating segment stock to management of the respective business.

(in thousands)

5.11 Tactical

Ergobaby

FOX

Liberty

Manitoba Harvest

ACI

Arnold Magnetics

Clean Earth

Sterno Products

Allocation Interests

Noncontrolling Interest Balances

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

$

5,934

$

18,647

—

2,681

13,687

(11,220)

1,536

5,469

1,305

100

—

17,754

—

2,934

14,071

4,295

2,113

4,308

644

100

$

38,139

$

46,219

The Company's businesses had the following transactions with minority shareholders during the year ended December 31, 
2016:

ACI Recapitalization

During the second quarter of 2016, the Company completed a recapitalization at ACI whereby the Company entered into an 
amendment to the intercompany debt agreement with ACI (the "ACI Loan Agreement").  The ACI loan agreement was amended 
to  provide for additional term loan borrowings of $61.0 million to fund a cash distribution to shareholders totaling $60.1 million.  

F-48

Minority interest shareholders of Advanced Circuits, including certain members of management at Advanced Circuits, received 
total distribution proceeds of $18.4 million.  The Company used cash on hand to fund the distribution to minority shareholders.  

Liberty Recapitalization

During the first quarter of 2016, the Company completed a recapitalization at Liberty whereby the Company entered into an 
amendment to the intercompany loan agreement with Liberty (the “Liberty Loan Agreement”). The Liberty Loan Agreement was 
amended to (i) provide for term loan borrowings of $38.0 million and revolving credit facility borrowings of $5.0 million to fund 
cash distributions totaling $35.3 million to its shareholders, including the Company, and (ii) extend the maturity dates of the term 
loans and revolving credit facility.  Liberty’s noncontrolling shareholders received approximately $5.3 million in distributions as 
a result of the recapitalization.  Immediately prior to the recapitalization, management exercised stock options for 75,095 shares 
of Liberty common shares, resulting in net proceeds from stock options at Liberty of $3.8 million.  Liberty recognized $0.3 million
in compensation expense related to the accelerated vesting of a portion of management's stock options at the time of exercise.  The 
Company then purchased $1.5 million in Liberty common shares from members of Liberty management, resulting in Liberty's 
noncontrolling shareholders holding 11.4% of Liberty's outstanding shares subsequent to the recapitalization.  The purchase of 
the Liberty common stock from noncontrolling shareholders and issuance of Liberty common stock related to the exercise of stock 
options by noncontrolling shareholders were at fair value and resulted in no change in control of Liberty.   The difference between 
the consideration paid for the noncontrolling interest and the adjustment to the carrying amount of the Company's noncontrolling 
interest in Liberty was recognized in the Company's equity.  Subsequent to the purchase of Liberty common shares and the exercise 
of the options, the Company owns 88.6% of Liberty on a primary basis and 84.7% on a fully diluted basis.  

Ergobaby Share Issuance

In connection with the Ergobaby acquisition of Baby Tula in May 2016, Ergobaby issued shares of their stock valued at $8.2 
million to the selling shareholders (refer to Note C - Acquisitions for the methodology used to determine the value of the shares 
at issuance).  Subsequent to the issuance of the shares, the Company's ownership interest in Ergobaby was 77.9% on a primary 
basis and 71.2% on a fully diluted basis.

Ergobaby Share Repurchase

In June 2016, Ergobaby repurchased 77,425 shares of Ergobaby common stock from certain noncontrolling interest shareholders 
for a total purchase price of $15.4 million.  Ergobaby financed the repurchase of shares with an increase to the intercompany debt 
facility with the Company.  The difference between the consideration paid for the noncontrolling interest and the adjustment to 
the carrying amount of the Company's noncontrolling interest in Ergobaby was recognized in the Company's equity. Subsequent 
to the repurchase, the Company's ownership interest in Ergobaby was 83.9% on a primary basis and 76.2% on a fully diluted basis.  
The repurchased shares have been accounted for as treasury shares by Ergobaby.

Ergobaby Share Issuance and Share Repurchase

In December 2016, an Ergobaby employee exercised stock options resulting in the issuance of  10,989 shares of Ergobaby common 
stock.  Ergobaby then repurchased 6,204 of these shares from the employee for a total purchase price of $1.4 million.  The difference 
between  the  consideration  paid  for  the  noncontrolling  interest  and  the  adjustment  to  the  carrying  amount  of  the  Company's 
noncontrolling interest in Ergobaby was recognized in the Company's equity.  Subsequent to the option exercise and repurchase, 
the Company's ownership interest in Ergobaby was 83.5% on a primary basis and 76.9% on a fully diluted basis.  The repurchased 
shares have been accounted for as treasury shares by Ergobaby.

Note P — Commitments and Contingencies

Leases

The  Company  and  its  subsidiaries  lease  office  and  manufacturing  facilities,  computer  equipment  and  software  under  various 
operating arrangements. Certain of the leases are subject to escalation clauses and renewal periods. The Company and its subsidiaries 
recognize  lease  expense,  including  predetermined  fixed  escalations,  on  a  straight-line  basis  over  the  initial  term  of  the  lease 
including reasonably assured renewal periods from the time that the Company and its subsidiaries control the leased property.

F-49

The  future  minimum  rental  commitments  at  December 31,  2016  under  operating  leases  having  an  initial  or  remaining  non-
cancelable term of one year or more are as follows (in thousands):

2017

2018

2019

2020

2021

Thereafter

$

$

15,002

12,882

10,363

9,412

7,824

40,409

95,892

The Company’s rent expense for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 totaled $15.9 million, $10.7 million 
and $9.1 million, respectively.

Legal Proceedings

In the normal course of business, the Company and its subsidiaries are involved in various claims and legal proceedings. While 
the ultimate resolution of these matters has yet to be determined, the Company does not believe that any unfavorable outcomes 
will have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position or results of operations.

Note Q — Supplemental Data

Supplemental Balance Sheet Data (in thousands):

Summary of accrued expenses:

Accrued payroll and fringes

Accrued taxes

Income taxes payable

Accrued interest

Accrued rebates

Warranty payable

Accrued inventory

Accrued transportation and disposal costs

Other accrued expenses

Total

Warranty liability:

Beginning balance

Accrual

Warranty payments

Ending balance

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

$

22,440

$

18,350

5,307

6,232

182

12,289

1,258

20,763

7,324

15,246

1,435

2,164

70

8,081

1,259

—

5,714

6,694

$

91,041

$

43,767

Year ended December 31,

2016

2015

$

$

1,259

$

252

(253)

1,258

$

1,264

343

(348)

1,259

F-50

Supplemental Statement of Operations Data (in thousands):

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

December 31,
2014

Other expense, net:

Foreign currency gain (loss)

Gain (loss) on sale of capital assets

Other income (expense)

Supplemental Cash Flow Statement Data (in thousands):

Interest paid

Taxes paid

$

$

$

$

(1,386) $

(2,561) $

(1,249)

(284)

(138)

376

(2,919) $

(2,323) $

389

(288)

(778)

(677)

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

December 31,
2014

22,840

15,324

$

$

21,180

6,494

$

$

21,455

12,226

Note R — Related Party Transactions

The Company has entered into the following related party transactions with its Manager, CGM:

•  Management Services Agreement
•  LLC Agreement
• 
•  Cost reimbursement and fees

Integration Services Agreement

Management Services Agreement 

The Company entered into a MSA with CGM effective May 16, 2006, as amended. The MSA provides for, among other things, 
CGM to perform services for the Company in exchange for a management fee paid quarterly and equal to 0.5% of the Company’s 
adjusted net assets, as defined in the MSA. The management fee is required to be paid prior to the payment of any distributions 
to shareholders.

Pursuant to the MSA, CGM is entitled to enter into off-setting management service agreements with each of the operating segments. 
The amount of the fee is negotiated between CGM and the operating management of each segment and is based upon the value 
of the services to be provided. The fees paid directly to CGM by the segments offset on a dollar for dollar basis the amount due 
CGM by the Company under the MSA.

For the year ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, the Company incurred the following management fees to CGM, by entity 
(in thousands):

5.11

Ergobaby

Liberty

Manitoba Harvest

Advanced Circuits

Arnold Magnetics

Clean Earth

Sterno Products

Corporate

December 31,
2016

December 31,
2015

December 31,
2014

$

$

333

500

500

350

500

500

500

500

$

n/a

500

500

175

500

500

500

500

n/a

500

500

n/a

500

500

125

125

25,723

22,483

$

29,406

$

25,658

$

19,622

21,872

F-51

Not included in the table above are management fees paid to CGM by Tridien of $0.2 million, $0.4 million and $0.4 million in 
each of the years ended December 31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively, and CamelBak of $0.3 million, and $0.5 million in each 
of the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.  These amounts are included in income (loss) from discontinued 
operations on the consolidated statements of operations.

Approximately $7.4 million and $5.9 million of the management fees incurred were unpaid as of December 31, 2016 and 2015, 
respectively, and are reflected in Due to related party on the consolidated balance sheets.

LLC Agreement

The LLC agreement gives Holders the right to distributions pursuant to a profit allocation formula upon the occurrence of a Sale 
Event or a Holding Event. The Holders are entitled to receive and as such can elect to receive the positive contribution-based profit 
allocation payment for each of the business acquisitions during the 30-day period following the fifth anniversary of the date upon 
which we acquired a controlling interest in that business (Holding Event) and upon the sale of the business (Sale Event).  Holders 
received $23.8 million in distributions related to Sale and Holding Events that occurred during 2016.  Additionally, at December 
31, 2016, a distribution payable of $13.4 million due to Holders as a result of the sale of FOX shares in November 2016 has been 
accrued and will be paid to Holders during the first quarter of 2017.  Refer to "Note N - Stockholders' Equity" for a description 
of the 2016 profit allocation payments.  

During the year ended December 31, 2015, Holders were paid $14.6 million related to the sale of CamelBak and American Furniture 
(Sale Event) and $3.1 million related to the five year holding event for Ergobaby (Holding Event).  During the year ended December 
31, 2014, Holders were paid $11.9 million related to a secondary offering completed by FOX in July 2014 (Sale Event). 

Certain persons who are employees and partners of the Manager, including the Company’s Chief Executive Officer, beneficially 
own (through Sostratus LLC) 60.4% of the Allocation Interests at December 31, 2016 and 58.8% of the Allocation Interests at 
December 31, 2015.  Of the remaining 39.6% non-voting ownership of the Allocation Interests, 5.0% is held by CGI Diversified 
Holdings LP, 5.0% is held by the Chairman of the Company’s Board of Directors, and the remaining 29.6% is held by the former 
founding partner of the Manager.

Integrations Services Agreements

5.11, which was acquired in 2016, Manitoba Harvest, which was acquired in 2015, and the 2014 acquisitions entered into Integration 
Services Agreements ("ISA") with CGM.  The ISA provides for CGM to provide services for new platform acquisitions to, amongst 
other things, assist the management at the acquired entities in establishing a corporate governance program, including the retention 
of independent board members to serve on their board of directors, implement compliance and reporting requirements of the 
Sarbanes-Oxley Act and align the acquired entity's policies and procedures with our other subsidiaries.  Each ISA is for the twelve 
month period subsequent to the acquisition and is payable quarterly.  Clean Earth paid CGM $2.5 million and Sterno Products 
paid CGM $1.5 million under the agreements.  Manitoba Harvest paid CGM $1.0 million under the agreement.  5.11 Tactical will 
pay CGM $3.5 million under the agreement,  During the year ended December 31, 2016, 5.11 paid CGM $1.2 million in integration 
services fees and Manitoba Harvest paid $0.5 million in integration services fees.  During the year ended December 31, 2015, 
Manitoba Harvest incurred $0.5 million in integration service fees, Clean Earth incurred $1.9 million in integration service fees, 
and Sterno Products incurred $1.1 million in integration service fees.  During the year ended December 31, 2014, Clean Earth 
incurred $0.6 million in integration services fees, and Sterno Products incurred $0.4 million.  During the year ended December 
31, 2016, 2015 and 2014, CGM received $1.7 million, $3.5 million and $1.0 million, respectively, in total integration service fees. 

Cost Reimbursement and Fees

The Company reimbursed its Manager, CGM, approximately $3.8 million, $3.5 million, and $4.5 million, principally for occupancy 
and  staffing  costs  incurred  by  CGM  on  the  Company’s  behalf  during  the  years  ended  December 31,  2016,  2015  and  2014, 
respectively.

The Company and its businesses have the following significant related party transactions:

FOX

Investment  in  FOX  - The  Company  owns  approximately  14.0%  of  FOX  at  December  31,  2016.   The  Company  purchased  a 
controlling interest in FOX on January 4, 2008.  On July 10, 2014, 5,750,000 shares of FOX common stock, held by certain FOX 
shareholders, including us, were sold in a secondary offering.  As a selling shareholder, we sold a total of 4,466,569 shares of FOX 

F-52

common stock.  Upon completion of the offering, our ownership in FOX decreased from approximately 53% to 41%, or 15,108,718
shares of FOX’s common stock. We recorded a gain of $264.3 million in July 2014 in connection with the Fox deconsolidation.  
In March, August and November 2016, through three additional secondary offerings and a share repurchase by FOX, the Company's 
ownership in the outstanding common stock of FOX was further reduced to 14.0%.  Refer to "Note F - Investment" for additional 
information related to the Company's investment in FOX.

FOX Services Agreement - In September 2014, the Company and FOX entered into an agreement for the provision of services to 
FOX for assistance in complying the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, as amended (the “Services Agreement”).  The Services Agreement 
terminated on March 31, 2016. A statement of work was agreed to in connection with the Service Agreement, which provided that 
the Company’s internal audit team would assist FOX with various tasks, including, but not limited to, the development of internal 
control policies and procedures, risk and control matrices and the evaluation of internal controls.  Services provided in accordance 
with the Services Agreement were billed on a time and materials basis. Fees paid for services provided in 2016, 2015 and 2014 
were approximately $72,000, $135,000, and $50,000, respectively. 

5.11

Related Party Vendor Purchases - 5.11 purchases inventory from a vendor who is a related party to 5.11 through one of the executive 
officers of 5.11 via the executive's 40% ownership interest in the vendor.   During the year ended December 31, 2016 (from the 
date of acquisition) 5.11 purchased approximately $2.3 million in inventory from the vendor.  

Liberty

Liberty  Recapitalization  -  Refer  to  "Note  O  -  Noncontrolling  Interest"  for  additional  details  with  regards  to  the  Liberty 
recapitalization.

Liberty Related Party Vendor Purchases - Liberty purchases inventory raw materials from two vendors who are related parties to 
Liberty through two of the executive officers of Liberty via the employment of family members at the vendors.   During the years 
ended December 31, 2016 and 2015, Liberty purchased approximately $2.5 million and $3.3 million, respectively, in raw materials 
from the two vendors.  During 2014, Liberty purchased $0.3 million in raw materials from one of these vendors.  The related party 
relationship at the other vendor did not exist in 2014 because the executive was not employed at Liberty during 2014. 

Advanced Circuits

Advanced Circuits Recapitalization - Refer to "Note O - Noncontrolling Interest" for additional details with regards to the Advanced 
Circuits recapitalization.

Note S – Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data

The following table presents the unaudited quarterly financial data. This information has been prepared on a basis consistent with 
that of the audited consolidated financial statements and all necessary material adjustments, consisting of normal recurring accruals 
and adjustments, have been included to present fairly the unaudited quarterly financial data. The quarterly results of operations 
for these periods are not necessarily indicative of future results of operations. Typically, the first quarter of each fiscal year has 
the lower results than the remainder of the year, representing the Company's weakest quarter due to seasonality at our businesses.  
The per share calculations for each of the quarters are based on the weighted average number of shares for each period using the 
two class method, which requires companies to allocate participating securities that have rights to earnings that otherwise would 
have been available only to common shareholders as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per share; therefore, the 
sum of the quarters will not equal to the full year per share amount.

F-53

(in thousands)

Total revenues

Gross profit

Operating income

Income (loss) from continuing operations

Income from discontinued operations

Gain (loss) on sale of discontinued operations, net of
income tax

Net income (loss) attributable to Holdings

Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share
attributable to Holdings:

  Continuing operations

  Discontinued operations

Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share
attributable to Holdings

$

$

$

December 31,
2016 (1)

September 30,
2016 (2)

June 30,
2016

March 31,
2016

$

318,561

$

252,285

$

214,176

$

193,287

103,366

(10,867)

1,802

—

175

82,415

11,358

48,544

(455)

2,134

76,670

10,489

18,017

1,341

—

64,119

8,081

(14,614)

(413)

—

1,764

$

49,705

$

19,239

$

(16,023)

(0.14) $

—

0.72

$

0.03

(0.05) $

0.11

(0.31)

—

(0.14) $

0.75

$

0.06

$

(0.31)

(1) The quarter ended December 31, 2016 includes a full quarter of operating results from 5.11, which the Company acquired on August 31, 
2016, and reflects the goodwill impairment expense of our Arnold business of $16.0 million.  The Company recognized an additional $0.2 
gain on the sale of Tridien in the fourth quarter related to the working capital settlement with the buyer.  

(2)  During the three months ended September 30, 2016, the Company sold their Tridien operating segment  for a net gain on sale of approximately 
$1.5 million.  The Company also purchased 5.11 Tactical for a purchase price of approximately $408.2 million - refer to "Note C - Acquisition 
of Businesses".

(in thousands)

Total revenues

Gross profit

Operating income

Income from continuing operations

Income from discontinued operations

Gain on sale of discontinued operation, net of tax

Net income attributable to Holdings

December 31,
2015 (1)

September 30,
2015 (2)

June 30,
2015

March 31,
2015

$

199,531

$

184,830

$

180,757

$

162,860

67,598

16,397

1,839

(2,098)

(1,277)

(2,217)

64,750

14,628

10,009

4,934

151,075

164,500

59,025

14,119

18,467

8,108

—

24,457

49,363

4,774

(21,324)

(3,963)

—

(24,902)

Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share
attributable to Holdings:

  Continuing operations

  Discontinued operations

Basic and fully diluted income per share attributable to
Holdings

$

$

(0.37) $

(0.02)

0.14

$

2.87

0.28

$

0.12

(0.42)

(0.05)

(0.39) $

3.01

$

0.40

$

(0.47)

(1) The Company accrued an additional $1.3 million during the three months ended December 31, 2015 related to the expected working capital 
settlement for the sale of CamelBak.

(2)  During the three months ended September 30, 2015, the Company sold their Camelbak operating segment and entered into a sale of their 
American Furniture operating segment (the sale was finalized on October 5, 2015) for a net gain on sale of approximately $151.1 million.  
The Company also purchased Manitoba Harvest for a purchase price of approximately $102.7 million - refer to "Note C - Acquisition of 
Businesses".

F-54

Discontinued Operations

During the quarter ended September 30, 2016, the Company sold its Tridien operating segment and reclassified the historical 
operations of Tridien to discontinued operations.  During the quarter ended September 30, 2015, the Company sold its CamelBak 
and American Furniture operating segments and thus reclassified the historical operation of both segments to discontinued 
operations.  The following summarizes the results of Tridien that were reclassified as discontinued operations during the 2016 
and 2015 quarterly periods, and the results of CamelBak and American Furniture that were reclassified to discontinued operations 
during the 2015 quarterly period.

(in thousands)

Total revenue

Gross Profit

Operating income

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax

December 31,
2016

September 30,
2016

June 30,
2016

March 31,
2016

 N/a

 N/a

 N/a

 N/a

$

15,978

$

15,212

$

14,760

3,223

967

(455)

2,821

1,107

1,341

2,142

(577)

(413)

(in thousands)

Total revenue

Gross Profit

Operating income

Income from discontinued operations, net of tax

December 31,
2015

September 30,
2015

June 30,
2015

March 31,
2015 (1)

$

18,555

$

79,409

$

89,519

$

1,509

(2,201)

(2,098)

15,347

4,797

4,934

13,483

14,473

8,108

94,409

22,552

(2,665)

(3,963)

(1)  During the three months ended March 31, 2015, the Company incurred $9.2 million of impairment charges at its Tridien operating 
segment.

F-55

 
SCHEDULE II – Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

(in thousands)

Allowance for doubtful accounts - 2014

Allowance for doubtful accounts - 2015

Allowance for doubtful accounts - 2016

Valuation allowance for deferred tax assets - 2014

Valuation allowance for deferred tax assets - 2015

Valuation allowance for deferred tax assets - 2016

Balance at

beginning
of year

Additions

Charge to costs
and expense

Other (1)

Deductions

Balance at
end of Year

$

$

$

$

$

$

2,065

3,756

3,445

1,348

2,776

1,308

$

$

$

$

$

$

3,431

3,164

4,775

1,180

1

2,266

$

$

$

$

$

$

494

15

2,105

248

$

$

$

$

— $

3,692

$

2,234

3,490

4,814

$

$

$

— $

1,469

10

$

$

3,756

3,445

5,511

2,776

1,308

7,256

(1)  Represents opening allowance balances related to current year acquisitions, and the ending allowance for FOX, which was 

deducted as a result of the deconsolidation of the FOX subsidiary during 2014.

S-1

Exhibit
Number
2.1

2.2

2.3

2.4

3.1

3.2

3.3

3.4

3.5

3.6

3.7

3.8

3.9

3.10

3.11

3.12

3.13

4.1

INDEX TO EXHIBITS

Description

Stock and Note Purchase Agreement dated as of July 31, 2006, among Compass Group Diversified Holdings
LLC, Compass Group Investments, Inc. and Compass Medical Mattress Partners, LP (incorporated by reference
to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2006 (File No. 000-51937)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated June 24, 2008, among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC and the other
shareholders party thereto, Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sellers’ Representative, Aeroglide
Holdings, Inc. and Bühler AG (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on June 26, 2008
(File No. 000-51937)).

Stock Purchase Agreement, dated October 17, 2011, by and among Recruit Co., LTD. and RGF Staffing USA,
Inc., as Buyers, the shareholders of Staffmark Holdings, Inc., as Sellers, Staffmark Holdings, Inc. and Compass
Group Diversified Holdings LLC as Seller Representative (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form
8-K filed on October 18, 2011 (File No. 001-34927)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated May 1, 2012, among Candlelight Investment Holdings, Inc., Halo Holding
Corporation, Halo Lee Wayne, LLC and each of the holders of equity interests of Halo Lee Wayne, LLC listed
on Exhibit A thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 2, 2012(File No.
001-34927)).

Certificate of Trust of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form S-1 filed
on December 14, 2005 (File No. 333-130326)).

Certificate of Amendment to Certificate of Trust of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to
Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 8-K filed on September 13, 2007 (File No. 000-51937)).

Certificate of Formation of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.3
of the Form S-1 filed on December 14, 2005 (File No. 333-130326)).

Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.5
of the Amendment No. 4 to the Form S-1 filed on April 26, 2006 (File No. 333-130326)).

Amendment No. 1 to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006, of Compass
Diversified Trust among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of New York
(Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit
4.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 29, 2007 (File No. 000-51937)).

Second Amendment to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006, as amended on
May 23, 2007, of Compass Diversified Trust among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The
Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by
reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Form 8-K filed on September 13, 2007 (File No. 000-51937)).

Third Amendment to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement dated as of April 25, 2006, as amended on
May 25, 2007 and September 14, 2007, of Compass Diversified Holdings among Compass Group Diversified
Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees
named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Form 8-K filed on December 21, 2007 (File No.
000-51937)).

Fourth Amendment dated as of November 1, 2010 to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, as amended
effective November 1, 2010, of Compass Diversified Holdings, originally effective as of April 25, 2006, by and
among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware
Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 10-Q filed
on November 8, 2010 (File No. 001-34927)).

Second Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of the Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the
Form 8-K filed on December 7, 2016 (File No. 001-34927)).
Second Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC dated
January 9, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on January 10, 2007,(File No.
000-51937)).

Third Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC dated
November 1, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Form 10-Q filed on November 8, 2010 (File
No. 001-34927)).

Fourth Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, dated
January 1, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 10-Q filed on May 7, 2013 (File No.
001-34927)).

Fifth Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of
the Form 8-K filed on December 7, 2016 (File No. 001-34927)).

Specimen Certificate evidencing a share of trust of Compass Diversified Holdings (incorporated by reference to
Exhibit 4.1 of the Form S-3 filed on November 7, 2007 (File No. 333-147218)).

E-1

4.2

10.1

10.2

10.3†

10.4

10.5

10.6

10.7

10.8

10.9

10.10

10.11

10.12

10.13*

10.14

10.15†

10.16

10.17

10.18

Specimen LLC Interest Certificate evidencing an interest of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit A of Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on January 10, 2007 (File No.
000-51937)).

Form of Registration Rights Agreement by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass
Diversified Trust and Certain Shareholders (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Amendment No. 5
to the Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File No. 333-130326)).

Form of Supplemental Put Agreement by and between Compass Group Management LLC and Compass Group
Diversified Holdings LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 of the Amendment No. 4 to the Form S-1
filed on April 26, 2006 (File No. 333-130326)).

Amended and Restated Employment Agreement dated as of December 1, 2008 by and between James J.
Bottiglieri and Compass Group Management LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-K
filed on December 3, 2008 (File No. 000-51937)).

Form of Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass
Diversified Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of the
Amendment No. 5 to the Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File No. 333-130326)).

Form of Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass
Diversified Trust and Pharos I LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 of the Amendment No. 5 to the
Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File No. 333-130326)).

Amended and Restated Management Services Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified
Holdings LLC, and Compass Group Management LLC, dated as of December 20, 2011 and originally effective
as of May 16, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.06 of the Form 10-K filed on March 7, 2012 (File
No. 001-34927)).

Registration Rights Agreement by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified
Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP, dated as of April 3, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of
the Amendment No. 1 to the Form S-1 filed on April 20, 2007 (File No. 333-141856)).

Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified
Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP, dated as of April 3, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.16
of the Amendment No. 1 to the Form S-1 filed on April 20, 2007 (File No. 333-141856)).

Subscription Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC,
Compass Diversified Holdings and CGI Magyar Holdings, LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of
the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011(File No. 001-34927)).

Registration Rights Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings
LLC, Compass Diversified Holdings and CGI Magyar Holdings, LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit
10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011(File No. 001-34927)).

Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, the financial institutions party thereto
and Bank of America, N.A., dated as of June 6, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the 8-K filed
on June 9, 2014 (File No. 001-34927)).
First Amendment to Credit Agreement dated June 29, 2015, by and among Compass Group Diversified
Holdings LLC, the Lenders signatory thereto, U.S. Bank National Association and Bank of America, N.A.
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the 8-K filed on July 2, 2015 (File No. 001-34927)).

Second Amendment to Credit Agreement dated December 15, 2015, by and among Compass Group Diversified
Holdings LLC, the Lenders signatory thereto, U.S. Bank National Association and Bank of America, N.A.

Sixth Amended and Restated Management Service Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified
Holdings LLC, and Compass Group Management LLC, dated as of September 30, 2014 and originally effective
as of May 16, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on October 7, 2014 (File
No. 001-34927)).
Employment Agreement dated July 11, 2013, between Compass Group Management LLC and Ryan J.
Faulkingham (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on July 11, 2013 (File No.
001-34927)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of July 24, 2015, by and among Vista Outdoor Inc., CBAC Holdings, LLC
and CamelBak Acquisition Corp. (incorporated by reference to exhibit 99.1 to the Company’s Current Report
on Form 8-K filed on July 27, 2015 (File No. 001-34927)).

Commitment Letter, dated August 1, 2016, from Bank of America, N.A. Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
Incorporated (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2016 (File No.
001-34927)).

Third Amendment to the Credit Agreement, dated August 15, 2016, by and among Compass Diversified
Holdings LLC, Bank of America, N.A., and the lenders thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the
Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2016 (File No. 001-34927)).

E-2

10.19

12.1*

21.1*

23.1*

23.2*

31.1*

31.2*
32.1*+

32.2*+
99.1

99.4

99.5

99.6

99.7

99.8

99.9

99.10

99.11

99.12

99.13

99.14

First Incremental Facility Amendment, dated August 31, 2016, by and among Compass Diversified Holdings
LLC, Bank of America, N.A., and the lenders thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-
K filed on August 1, 2016 (File No. 001-34927)).

Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Combined Fixed Charges and Preferred Distributions

List of Subsidiaries

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm with respect to the Registrant's consolidated
financial statements

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm with respect to the consolidated financial
statements of Fox Factory Holding Corp.

Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certification of Chief Executive Officer of Registrant

Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certification of Chief Financial Officer of Registrant

Section 1350 Certification of Chief Executive Officer of Registrant

Section 1350 Certification of Chief Financial Officer of Registrant

Note Purchase and Sale Agreement dated as of July 31, 2006 among Compass Group Diversified Holdings
LLC, Compass Group Investments, Inc. and Compass Medical Mattress Partners, LP (incorporated by
reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2006 (File No. 000-51937)).

Share Purchase Agreement dated January 4, 2008, among Fox Factory Holding Corp., Fox Factory, Inc. and
Robert C. Fox, Jr. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on January 8, 2008 (File No.
000-51937)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated May 8, 2008, among Mitsui Chemicals, Inc., Silvue Technologies Group, Inc.,
the stockholders of Silvue Technologies Group, Inc. and the holders of Options listed on the signature pages
thereto, and Compass Group Management LLC, as the Stockholders Representative (incorporated by reference
to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 9, 2008(File No. 000-51937)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated March 31, 2010 by and among Gable 5, Inc., Liberty Safe and Security
Products, LLC and Liberty Safe Holding Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-
K filed on April 1, 2010 (File No. 000-51937)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated September 16, 2010, by and among ERGO Baby Intermediate Holding
Corporation, The ERGO Baby Carrier, Inc., Karin A. Frost, in her individual capacity and as Trustee of the
Revocable Trust of Karin A. Frost dated February 22, 2008 and as Trustee of the Karin A. Frost 2009 Qualified
Annuity Trust u/a/d 12/21/2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on
September 17, 2010 (File No. 000-51937)).

Securities Purchase Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among CBK Holdings, LLC, CamelBak
Products, LLC, CamelBak Acquisition Corp., for purposes of Section 6.15 and Articles 10 only, Compass
Group Diversified Holdings LLC, and for purposes of Section 6.13 and Article 10 only, IPC/CamelBak LLC
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011(File No. 001-34927)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of March 5, 2012, by and among Arnold Magnetic Technologies Holdings
Corporation, Arnold Magnetic Technologies, LLC and AMT Acquisition Corp. (incorporated by reference to
Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on March 6, 2012 (File No. 001-34927)).

Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of August 7, 2014, by and among CEHI Acquisition Corporation, Clean
Earth Holdings, Inc., the holders of stock and options in Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. and Littlejohn Fund III,
L.P. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the 8-K filed on August 11, 2014 (File No. 001-34927)).
Membership Interest Purchase Agreement dated as of October 10, 2014, by and among Candle Lamp Holdings,
LLC, Candle Lamp Company, LLC and Sternocandlelamp Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit
99.1 of the Form 8-K filed October 10, 2014 (File No. 001-34927)).
Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of June 5, 2015, by and among Fresh Hemp Foods Ltd., 1037270 B.C.
Ltd., 1037269 B.C. Ltd., the Stockholders’ Representative and the Signing Stockholders (incorporated by
reference to exhibit 99.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on June 8, 2015 (File No.
001-34927)).
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of July 29, 2016, by and among 5.11 ABR Corp., 5.11 ABR Merger
Corp., 5.11 Acquisition Corp., TA Associates Management, L.P., as the agent and attorney in fact of the holders
of stock and options in 5.11 Acquisition Corp. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed
on August 1, 2016 (File No. 001-34927)).

Consolidated financial statements of Fox Factory Holding Corp. (incorporated by reference to the consolidated
financial statements of FOX included in FOX’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 30,
2016 filed on March 1, 2017 (File No. 001-36040).

101.INS*

XBRL Instance Document

101.SCH*

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document

E-3

101.CAL*

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document

101.DEF*

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document

101.LAB*

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document

101.PRE*

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document

*

†

+

Filed herewith.

Denotes management contracts and compensatory plans or arrangements.

In accordance with Item 601(b)(32)(ii) of Regulation S-K and SEC Release Nos. 33-8238 and 34-47986, Final Rule: 
Management's Reports on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting and Certification of Disclosure in Exchange Act 
Periodic Reports, the certifications furnished in Exhibit 32.1 and 32.2 hereto are deemed to accompany this Form 10-K 
and will not be deemed “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Exchange Act. Such certifications will not be deemed to 
be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, except to the extent that the 
registrant specifically incorporates it by reference.

E-4

LETTER TO 

SHAREHOLDERS

OUR COMPANIES

14

CODI 

GOVERNANCE

2 

4

16

17

CODI INFORMATION

FINANCIAL REVIEW

COMPANY HEADQUARTERS

301 RIVERSIDE AVENUE, SECOND FLOOR   

WESTPORT, CT 06880, (203) 221-1703

INDEPENDENT AUDITORS

GRANT THORNTON LLP, NEW YORK, NY

COMMON STOCK LISTING

NYSE TICKER: CODI

TRANSFER AGENT

BROADRIDGE CORPORATE ISSUER SOLUTIONS

P.O. BOX 1342

BRENTWOOD, NY 11717

INVESTOR RELATIONS CONTACT

LEON BERMAN, THE IGB GROUP   

(212) 477-8438, LBERMAN@IGBIR.COM 

ANNUAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS

MAY 24, 2017, 9:00 A.M., EST   

301 RIVERSIDE AVENUE, SECOND FLOOR   

WESTPORT, CT 06880

WEBSITE

WWW.COMPASSDIVERSIFIEDHOLDINGS.COM

10 
2006
2016
YEARS
CODI

COMPASS DIVERSIFIED HOLDINGS

301 RIVERSIDE AVENUE • SECOND FLOOR • WESTPORT, CT 06880

WWW.COMPASSDIVERSIFIEDHOLDINGS.COM